Survey
* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
ArticulatingTime ListeningtoMusicalForms intheTwenty-FirstCentury RichardLukePowell PhD UniversityofYork Music September2016 2 Abstract This study sets out to explore concepts of musical time by developing two complementarystrandsofdiscussion,onepractical andtheothertheoretical.The practical strandis concerneddirectly withinstrumental works from theWestern art music tradition. Underpinning the thesis are ?ive analytical case studies; in each, a piecewritten by a living composer (George Benjamin, John Adams, Hans Abrahamsen, Kaija Saariaho and Thomas Adès) is paired with a work by a historical ?igure (Mozart, Schubert, Brahms, Beethoven and Sibelius). Emphasis falls upon the contemporary works, with the more familiar canonic repertoire servingasa lensthroughwhichmorerecentmusic mightbeviewed. Unitedbya broadconception of form as adurationthat drawslisteners to engagecreatively withanorganisingimpulse,thesepiecesfacilitatediscussionsofbroaderissuesof aural structure: continuity, repetition, energy and perspective. An overriding concernwillbetheeffectthattheseperceptualqualitieshaveuponexperiencesof timeinmusic,andthewaysinwhichthismightenabledifferentkindsofmeaning. Through this process, it is intended that more ‘dif?icult’ new works can be renderedmoreaccessible, whilefamiliar ‘masterpieces’might bythe same token beviewedinanewlight. Thismusicological endeavourwill beinformedbyaninvestigationintothe waysinwhichtimeisperceived.Thissupportingtheoreticalstrandwillsynthesise philosophical and psychological conceptions of temporality, and their contributions to subjective perspectives, to provide a framework for the experiences discussed. Whilst the ‘twenty-?irst century’ aspect ofthe thesis title serves as a nod towards an emphasis upon contemporary composition, it also refers to thediversity facingaudiences today. Thejuxtapositionofnew andoldis re?lectiveofmorerecentculturesofreception:listeninghabitsareformedlessbya socially-driven system of canons, and increasingly according to individual preference. This is an attempt to analyse the temporality of musical works at a point when their compositional chronology has perhaps never seemed so irrelevant. Ratherthanofferingoverarchingtheories ofperceptionorprescribing speci?ic methods ofanalysis and interpretation, this studyembracesthe plurality of experienced musical time in the acknowledgement that articulating these phenomenamightenrichanappreciationofavarietyofmusicalstyles. 3 Contents Abstract........................................................................................................................................................3 Contents.......................................................................................................................................................4 Listof?igures.............................................................................................................................................7 Acknowledgements.................................................................................................................................9 Author’sdeclaration............................................................................................................................10 1. Introduction.........................................................................................................................12 2. AlternativePaths–GeorgeBenjamin&Mozart..................................................28 3. DirectingTime....................................................................................................................56 4. PerceptionandPerspective–JohnAdams&Schubert................................71 Treesand?lags...........................................................................................................12 Somethingold,somethingnew..........................................................................14 Keepingscore.............................................................................................................20 Mutualbene?its..........................................................................................................24 Abouttime...................................................................................................................28 Narrativeimpulses..................................................................................................29 Graspingtime.............................................................................................................32 Losingtime..................................................................................................................34 Cyclesandspirals.....................................................................................................36 Temporaldualities...................................................................................................40 Disintegration............................................................................................................45 Timelessness..............................................................................................................50 Clutchingatmetaphors..........................................................................................57 Time,spaceandchange.........................................................................................61 Insearchofdirection..............................................................................................64 Goingwiththe?low.................................................................................................67 Placingperspective.................................................................................................73 Simplicityandcontinuity......................................................................................76 Discontinuity..............................................................................................................80 Movingbeyondspectacle......................................................................................86 Movingbeyondcontrast........................................................................................89 Formandfunction...................................................................................................95 4 Contents 5. PerceivingTime.................................................................................................................99 6. DynamicContinuities–HansAbrahamsen&Brahms.................................119 7. ExperiencingTime........................................................................................................157 8. NarrativePossibilities–KaijaSaariaho&Beethoven.................................172 Objectiveandsubjectivetime.............................................................................99 Orderandconsciousness...................................................................................102 Processingmusicaltime.....................................................................................104 Affectandattention..............................................................................................109 Diversionsandsubversions..............................................................................113 Developingvariation............................................................................................119 Multipleforms–Abrahamsen..........................................................................122 Innovationwithintradition–Brahms..........................................................128 Tracingboundaries–FourthSymphony:Finale......................................131 Findingdynamism.................................................................................................134 Ebband?low............................................................................................................136 Layersoftime–Schnee:Canon1a.................................................................140 Horizontalperspectives–Schnee:Canon1b............................................144 Temporaldimensions–Schnee:Canon2a.................................................146 Shiftingfocus–Schnee:Canon2b..................................................................148 Disintegration–Schnee:Canons3–5............................................................151 Dynamiccontinuities...........................................................................................155 Perceivingforms....................................................................................................157 Continuityandnarrativepotential................................................................160 Questioningcontinuity........................................................................................164 Dynamicforms........................................................................................................168 Surfacebalance.......................................................................................................174 Internalnarratives................................................................................................177 Fulcra..........................................................................................................................181 Insearchofstability.............................................................................................187 Self-destruction......................................................................................................193 Freshperspectives................................................................................................195 Renewedfocus........................................................................................................199 5 Contents 9. UnderstandingTime....................................................................................................201 Formalimpulses.....................................................................................................201 Autonomy..................................................................................................................204 Unity............................................................................................................................205 10. EnergyandEquilibrium–ThomasAdès&Sibelius.....................................209 Symphonicrenewal..............................................................................................211 Symphonicresolution?........................................................................................214 Tonalenergy............................................................................................................216 Temporalmultiplicity:Sibelius.......................................................................221 Temporalmultiplicity:Adès.............................................................................225 Disruption.................................................................................................................231 Attainingequilibrium..........................................................................................234 Sonorityandmemory..........................................................................................236 11. Epilogue:Openendings.............................................................................................242 Listofprimarymaterials.................................................................................................................247 Bibliography.........................................................................................................................................249 6 ListofUigures 2.1 Mozart,ViolinSonatainEminorK.304(2),structuraltable..........................................41 2.2 Mozart,ViolinSonatainEminorK.304(2),bars1–16(piano)......................................42 2.3 MozartViolinSonatainEminorK.304(2),bars70–81.....................................................43 2.4 Benjamin,Viola,Viola,three-partstructuralplan..................................................................44 2.5 Benjamin,Viola,Viola,bars1–19(reproducedfromBenjamin1997)..........................44 2.6 Benjamin,Viola,Viola,listofevents.............................................................................................48 2.7 Benjamin,Viola,Viola,bars92–97(reproducedfromBenjamin1997).......................49 2.8 Mozart,ViolinSonatainEminorK.304(2),bars94–102(piano).................................51 2.9 Mozart,ViolinSonatainEminorK.304(2),themes,bars1–4,94–101......................52 2.10 Benjamin,Viola,Viola,bars98–105(reproducedfromBenjamin1997)....................53 4.1 Schubert,SonatainB-SlatD.960(1),bars1–23.....................................................................81 4.2 Schubert,SonatainB-SlatD.960(1),trillderivation,bars1and8................................83 4.3 Adams,ShakerLoops(1):harmonicreduction,bars1–104..............................................87 4.4 Schubert,SonatainB-SlatD.960(1),tabledisplayingstructuralplan.........................90 4.5 Schubert,SonatainB-SlatD.960,binaryformdiagram......................................................93 4.6 Adams,ShakerLoops(3),solocellomelody,bars3–26.......................................................96 4.7 Adams,ShakerLoops,tabledisplayinggesturalinterpretationofform.......................97 4.8 Adams,ShakerLoops,excerptsshowingrhythmicmotifreversal..................................98 6.1 Abrahamsen,Schnee,canonicparingsacrosstheformalscheme................................124 6.2 Abrahamsen,Schnee,detuningprocessacrossthethreeintermezzi..........................125 6.3 Abrahamsen,Schnee,‘fourmovement’formalscheme.....................................................126 6.4 Abrahamsen,Schnee,‘diminishingstructure’formalscheme.......................................126 6.5 Brahms,FourthSymphony(4),structuralinterpretationsofform.............................126 6.6 Brahms,FourthSymphony(4),reductionofostinato,bars1–8...................................130 6.7 Brahms,FourthSymphony(1),reductionofbars393–403...........................................132 6.8 Brahms,FourthSymphony(3),harmonicreduction,bars317–26.............................133 6.9 Brahms,FourthSymphony(4),reduction,bars97–104..................................................137 6.10 Brahms,FourthSymphony(4),selectedreductionofbars129–36............................138 6.11 Brahms,FourthSymphony(4),‘twogestures’formalscheme......................................139 6.12 Abrahamsen,Schnee(1a),bars1–6(reproductionofAbrahamsen2008)..............141 6.13 Abrahamsen,Schnee(1b),bars1–3(reproductionofAbrahamsen2008)..............144 6.14 Abrahamsen,Schnee(2a),reduction,bars1–4.....................................................................146 6.15 Abrahamsen,Schnee(2a),pianoexcerpts,bars22–23and34–35..............................147 6.16 Abrahamsen,Schnee(3b),pianos(bars1–4)........................................................................151 6.17 Abrahamsen,Schnee(4a),bars1–3(reproductionofAbrahamsen2008)..............152 6.18 Abrahamsen,Schnee(5a&5b),pianoparts,bars1–4.......................................................153 7 ListofSigures 8.1 Saariaho,Jesensundeuxièmecoeur,formalscheme..........................................................175 8.2 Beethoven,‘Eroica’Symphony(1),formalscheme.............................................................175 8.3 Saariaho,Jesensundeuxièmecoeur(2),bars54–57..........................................................182 8.4 Saariaho,Jesensundeuxièmecoeur(2&4),closingsonorityreductions.................183 8.5 Saariaho,Jesensundeuxièmecoeur,tabledetailingfulcrashifts..................................183 8.6 Saariaho,Jesensundeuxièmecoeur(3),bars1–3................................................................184 8.7 Saariaho,Jesensundeuxièmecoeur(4),piano,bars1–4..................................................185 8.8 Saariaho,Jesensundeuxièmecoeur(4),piano,bars40–42,(piano)...........................185 8.9 Saariaho,Jesensundeuxièmecoeur(1&5)violaandcelloopenings.........................186 8.10 Beethoven,‘Eroica’Symphony(1),strings,bars1–14......................................................188 8.11 Beethoven,‘Eroica’Symphony(1),E-minorthemederivation.....................................189 8.12 Beethoven,‘Eroica’Symphony(1),harmonicreduction,bars248–84......................190 8.13 Beethoven,‘Eroica’Symphony(1),tonalleanings,bars284–338...............................191 8.14 Saariaho,Jesensundeuxièmecoeur(1),piano,bars26–28............................................197 8.15 Saariaho,Jesensundeuxièmecoeur(2),bars9–17.............................................................197 8.16 Saariaho,Jesensundeuxièmecoeur(3),violaandcello,bars4–7................................198 8.17 Saariaho,Jesensundeuxièmecoeur(4),reductionsofselectedbars..........................198 8.18 Saariaho,Jesensundeuxièmecoeur(5),piano,bars1–3..................................................198 10.1 Sibelius,SymphonyNo.7,reductionofbars1–4.................................................................210 10.2 Adès,Tevot,reductionofbars1–4..............................................................................................210 10.3 Adès,Tevot,harmonicreduction,bars1–13..........................................................................219 10.4 Sibelius,SymphonyNo.7,tabledisplayingtempochanges............................................222 10.5 Sibelius,SymphonyNo.7,trombonetheme,bars60–70.................................................224 10.6 Adès,Tevot,tabledetailingtempochanges............................................................................226 10.7 Adès,Tevot,cello,bars65–68,andviolin1,bars92–99...................................................228 10.8 Adès,Tevot,trumpetmelody,bars142–44............................................................................228 10.9 Adès,Tevot,counterpointmotifsutilisedinbars53–91..................................................229 10.10 Sibelius,SymphonyNo.7,stringsandhorns,bars106–08.............................................232 10.11 Adès,Tevot,reductionofbars302–323...................................................................................237 10.12 Sibelius,SymphonyNo.7,stringsandhorns,bars500–10.............................................240 8 Acknowledgements Iwouldnothavebeenabletoundertakethisprojectwithoutthe?inancialbacking of a Doctoral Studentshipfrom theArts and Humanities ResearchCouncil; I feel very fortunate to have been givenso muchtime andspace to explore, well, time andspace, andIamimmenselygratefultotheAHRCforitssupportinthisregard. The Department of Music at the University of York has provided an incredible listening and performing environment inwhich to carry out this study. Whilst I havefeltveryblessedtohavebeenableto treatitassomethingofasecondhome forthepasteightyears,Ifeelluckierstillthatafterallthattimeitstillprovidesso stimulating, sochallenging, andyet so warmandfriendlya placetowork.Thisis mostlythankstoawholehostofpeoplewhohaveinspiredandaffectedthecourse of this thesis in a variety of ways. Special thanks go to Daniel March, Mark & Vanessa Hutchinson, Martin & Zoë Scheuregger, John Stringer, James Whittle, SarahGoulding, George & AnnieWissen, Ian Hoggart, Sophie Simpson, Benjamin Gait,ThomasSimaku, ChristopherLeedham,Daniel Swain, ImogenClarke,Patrick JonesandClaireMcGinn. Thanksalso go to a numberoffriends, mentorsand family members who haveat various points offered invaluable support: David & Elspeth Dutch, Justin Evans, Eva Warren, my uncle Paul, my grandfather Pat and his wife Linda, Maryjane & Tony Clifford, Cathy Denford, Andrew Vickers, Lesley Smith, Mark & JaneLewis andallthe‘redherrings’. Particular thanks gotoPaulDryhurstforhis friendship,conversationandtea-drinkingcompanionship. I would especially like to thank Bella Clifford for her constant love and encouragement, her ability to keep me calm and grounded, and her endless patience(ifithadlimits,IthinkIwouldhavefoundthemduringthewritingofthis thesis!). Far from freaking out when I announced I wanted to study music, my parents AndyandCareyhavebeenanincrediblesourceofgenerosity, advice and supportthroughout,andthereisno adequatewaytoshowjusthowgratefulIam. Mysiblings–Katie,BethandBen–havecontinuedtoinspiremewiththeamazing livestheylead.Shadow,thegoldenretriever,hasalsobeenever-consistent. Finally, special thanks go to my supervisor Tim Howell. I feel incredibly privileged to have beenable to rely onhis guidanceand insight throughout this project.Iwillalwaysbegratefulforhisfriendshipandsupport. 9 Author’sdeclaration IdeclarethatthisthesisisapresentationoforiginalworkandIamthesoleauthor. This work has not previously been presented for an awardatthis, or any other, University.AllsourcesareacknowledgedasReferences. ChapterFour containswritten material and?igures (4.3, 4.7and 4.8)taken from myarticle‘AccessibleNarratives:ContinuityintheMusicofJohnAdams’(listedin theBibliography).CopyrightisheldbythepublisherTaylor&FrancisLtd. ShakerLoops–MusicbyJohnAdams ©Copyright1978AssociatedMusicPublishers,Inc. ChesterMusicLimitedtradingasGSchirmer. AllRightsReserved.InternationalCopyrightSecured. UsedbyPermissionofChesterMusicLimitedtradingasGSchirmer. Tevot–ComposedbyThomasAdès ©2007FaberMusicLtd,London,WC1B3DA ReproducedbypermissionofFaberMusicLtd AllRightsReserved. Schnee–MusicbyHansAbrahamsen ©Copyright2008EdWilhelmHansen. ChesterMusicLimited. AllRightsReserved.InternationalCopyrightSecured. UsedbyPermissionofChesterMusicLimited. Viola,Viola–ComposedbyGeorgeBenjamin ©1998FaberMusicLtd,London,WC1B3DA ReproducedbypermissionofFaberMusicLtd AllRightsReserved. JeSensUnDeuxièmeCoeur–MusicbyKaijaSaariaho ©Copyright2003ChesterMusicLimited. AllRightsReserved.InternationalCopyrightSecured. UsedbyPermissionofChesterMusicLimited. 10 Afterall, whyhasanoveltobeplanned?Cannotitgrow?Whyneeditclose, asaplaycloses?Cannotitopenout?Insteadofstandingabovehisworkand controllingit,cannotthenovelistthrowhimselfintoitandbecarriedalong tosomegoalhedoesnotforesee? E.M.Forster,AspectsoftheNovel([1927]2005,95) 11 One Introduction TreesandUlags ‘Ifatreefalls inaforestandnooneisaroundtohearit, doesitmakeasound?’At face value, this popular philosophical question solicits a knee-jerk reaction, apparently warranting a simple yes or no response. Nevertheless, as with any conundrum, it gentlydemandsanexplorationbeyondits surface. It echoes wider epistemological enquiriesthat havepunctuatedWesterndiscourses for hundreds ofyears.ThemethodicaldoubtsofRenéDescartesintheseventeenthcenturyand the immaterialist conjectures of George Berkeley in the eighteenth, have raised questions of rationality and sense in empirical and theoretical disciplines alike (Kantonen 1934, 483–500); even quantum physics has been led back to these issues when faced with the paradoxical characteristics exhibited by sub-atomic particles.1 In Eastern thought, the question can be traced further back, with versionsofitexpressedasconciseZenkōans.TheGatelessGate–akōancollection publishedbyMumonEkaiin1228–containsacomparablenarrative,inwhichtwo monks debatewhatismoving:the?lagorthewind. A passingChanmasterleaves themawestruck athisequallycontentioussuggestionthatratheritis theirminds thataremoving.Mumon’saccompanyingcommentaryelegantlybottlesthepitfalls ofdiscussingthephenomenon: 'Thewindmoves, the?lagmoves, themindmoves; All havemissedit. They only know how to opentheir mouths, Anddo not know thattheirwordshavefailed’(Yamada2004,143). Of course, both of these puzzles are neither solvable nor rhetorical; they cannotbeaddressedinanystraightforwardway. Theleast (orperhaps themost) thatcanbeconcludedastowhethertheunheardfallingtreeproducesasoundisa paradox:yesandno. AswithMumon’skōan,thepointofthequestionistheasking itself and the re?lective journey this provokes. It encourages a heightened self1 PhysicistJim Baggott explains that ‘eversince it wasdiscovered thatatomic and sub- atomicparticlesexhibitbothlocalised,particle-likepropertiesanddelocalised, wave-like propertiesphysicistshavebecomeravelledinadebateaboutwhatwecanandcan’tknow aboutthe‘true’natureofphysicalreality.’(Baggott,2011) 12 Introduction awarenesspreciselythroughaconsiderationofabsence;emphasisisplacedupon the relationships between individual and environment. Above all, this considerationofthenatureofperceptionisthe catalyst forashiftinperspective: anapparentlyobjectiveenquiryissoonrevealedtobeasubjectiveexploration. This philosophicalqueryalsoactsasauseful gatewayto contemplationof sound itself, underlining it as something that is experienced. It would seem that part of the desired realisation is the acknowledgement that sound, as we understand it, constitutes much more than its essential physical properties of vibrations in the air. Of comparable importance are the ways in which these propertiesare– or, in this instance, are not – receivedby a listener. What was a factofthe matter has quicklybecomeasourceofinterpretation; a leapfromthe physical to the metaphysical has occurred. There canbe no endto the different waysinwhichasinglesoundcanbeheardandinterpreted.Therewillalwaysbeat leastasmanyhearingsastherearelisteners. Evenifwemightunderstandaspects ofthosehearingstooverlap, they will nonetheless retainindependencefromone another.Musicoftenseemstocomplicatethisyetfurther–wonderfullyso. Conveniently, then, this study is undertaken fundamentally from one perspective:myown. Musichas beenacaptivatingpresenceinmylife;theact of listening to it has proved a particular source of fascination. AndIam convinced thatit is such: anecessary, creative, musical act. Ifthe ‘falling tree’questioncan impartanythingessentialaboutmusic,itisthatitsverypurpose–perhapsevenits very existence – might be calledinto questionif it does not involvealistener of somekind. Eric Clarke – whose work concerning the psychology andecology of listening will provide a theoretical underpinning at points here – underlines the uniquesigni?icanceofthisactiveandreactivemode: Perception is the awareness of, and continuous adaptation to, the environment, and,on the basisof that general deSinition, the perception of musical meaning is therefore the awareness of meaning in music while listening to it. It can be distinguished from musical meaning that arises out of thinking about music, or reSlectingonmusic,whennotdirectlyauditorilyengagedwithmusic.(2005,5) The ways in whichpeople listen to pieces of music transform and evolve over time, even if the performances themselves remain ‘?ixed’ in the form of a recording(thoughevenhereamultitudeofvariables inevitablyremain). Time, as 13 Introduction shallbeshown,amountstosomethingofa‘constantvariable’here.Musiccanonly unfoldasperformance(eitheroriginalorreproduced)intime,andmightbesaidto ‘possess’itsowntimeorduration. Butmusiccanonlytakeplaceinthesametime once; the onward nature of temporality, and the changes that accompany it, provideaneverchangingcontextforlistening.Hearingsofdifferentperformances, or‘works’(ausefulnotionthatwillfeaturethroughoutbutnotwithoutscrutinyat certain points), do not develop inisolation but enter into a subtledialogue with one another. On both conscious and sub-conscious levels, performances inform oneanotherinthemindsoflisteners, chippingawayatestablishedconceptionsto enable new aural perspectives on the familiar. This study emphasises these perceptual networks, establishingits ownecology of musical works in orderthat the broader phenomenonof musical time – an underlying essential condition of music, but one that proves elusive when considered – might be explored. Conceptual sub-divisions – principally continuity, repetition, energy and perspective–provideananalyticalframework,allowingmorespeci?icconcernsto berelatedtomoregeneraltemporalexperiences. A moresubstantialintroduction to the issues surrounding the examination of time will follow in Chapter Two (Alternative Paths); in the meantime, it is necessary to establish both the framework,andsomeoftheparameters,ofthethesis. Somethingold,somethingnew Whilst thereare no limits as to the typesofmusic that couldcontributeto these discussions, for the purposes of this study it was necessary to establish some parameters. The only strict criteria for selecting the tenworks foundhere were that they be instrumental compositions that fall within a broad tradition of Westernart-music, andthathalfofthemmightbelooselytermed‘contemporary’. Whileitrepresentsjustasmallpocketofglobalmusichistory,therangepresented hereisrelativelylarge;theoldestpiecewascomposedin1778,themostrecentin 2008: a 230-yearspread. Here the works are listedinthe case-study pairings in whichthey will appear in the courseof the thesis, with the speci?ic movements analysedreferencedatthecloseofworkswhererelevant: 14 Introduction • GeorgeBenjamin–Viola,Violaforvioladuo(1997) WolfgangAmadeusMozart–ViolinSonatainEminor,K.304(2)(1778) • JohnAdams–ShakerLoopsforstringorchestra(1978/83) FranzSchubert–PianoSonatainB-Slat,D.960(1)(1828) • HansAbrahamsen–Schnee,TenCanonsforNineInstruments(2008) JohannesBrahms–SymphonyNo.4inEminor,Op.98(4)(1885) • KaijaSaariaho–Jesensundeuxièmecoeurforviola,celloandpiano(2003) LudwigvanBeethoven–SymphonyNo.3inE-Slat‘Eroica’,Op.55(1)(1804) • ThomasAdès–Tevotforlargeorchestra(2007) JeanSibelius–SymphonyNo.7inC,Op.105(1924) Theearlierpiecesineachpairingfallintooneoftwogenres:symphoniesor sonatas. These labels immediately invoke expectations within the context of Westernartmusic(whichwillremaintheprimaryframeofreferencethroughout). Whethertheworksinquestionconform,develop, reinvent, or reactagainst those expectations is less signi?icant than the overriding implication that they will engagewiththetraditioninsomeway.Itisimportanttoconsidertheseformal–in some cases possibly even formalist – decisions as creative choices rather than restrictions. Thedevelopmentofthesegenreswasneverquiteascategorical asis popularly held; as Charles Rosen observed, ‘theprinciples of“classical” art were codi?ied(or,ifyoulike,classicised)whentheimpulsewhichcreateditwasalready dead’(1997, xi). What couldbedismissedastraditionandconventiontoday was farmorelikelytohaveseemedastimulatingstylisticevolutiontothecomposersof thetime.Intheirwide-rangingstudyofsonataform,JamesHepokoskiandWarren Darcy (2006) chart not only conventional procedures prevalent in the late Eighteenth Century but also numerous instances of individual composers diverging from these conventions, often to heightened dramatic or expressive effect. Their understanding offormal procedures as fundamentally dynamic and dialogicisalso notableonaccountofitsconsiderationoftemporalandperceptual factors: 15 Introduction Rather the composer generates a sonata – which we regard as a process, a linear seriesof compositional choices–to enter intoa dialogue with anintricate web of interrelatednormsasanongoing actionintime.Theacousticsurfaceofanysonata (whatwe literallyhear)setsforththesonictracesof thisindividualised,processual dialogue, one that, from the standpointof reception, itis the taskof the analystto reinvigorate.(Hepokoski&Darcy,2006,10–11) Readersmightnotegapsandabsencesamongthe?iguresincludedinthese case studies. Numerous composers of profound in?luence are not represented. Althoughtheninemenandonewomanshowcasedhere(thegenderimbalanceis another deeplydisturbingsideeffectofbothmusical history andtheformationof the canon, but not the focus of this project) might easily be thought of as being progressiveorin?luentialintheirownways,theywerenotselectedsolelyonthat account. Several othermajor ‘progressives’maintainanindirectpresence:Haydn casts a shadow throughhis bearing on symphonic and sonata forms; in?luential ?igures such as Wagner and Debussy are palpable in the compositional developments they rendered possible through their unique approaches; and numeroustwentieth-centurypowerhousessuchas Stravinsky, Cage, Stockhausen, Boulez, andReichare made knownthrough their in?luence uponre-castings and re-alignments ofmusical thought. Meanwhile, theSecondVienneseSchoolis here representedthroughthescholarshipandtheoreticalexplorationsofthecomposer manyregardasitsforefather,ArnoldSchoenberg;whilsthismusicwillnotfeature, hisaestheticwritingswill?indaplacehere.Aswellastheseexternalcontributions, theoretical perspectives will also be offered from the selected composers themselves. Although they present aesthetics that are undoubtedly distinct from one another,thecontemporaryworksutilisedheremightneverthelessbethoughtofas representative of widertendencies in muchwestern artmusic atthe closeofthe twentiethcenturyandthebeginningofthetwenty-?irst. Thisoverarchingtrendis not concerned with surface style but rather with more profound aspects of compositional approach. Focusing largely on music written after 1980, David Metzer(2009)framesthisleaninginmodernistterms.Here,modernismisutilised lessasahistoricalmovementandmoreasacontinuingmentalitythat‘hasastrong awarenessofitsownprecedentsandbuildsuponthem’: 16 Introduction Constantly reworking established elements, modernist idioms strengthen connections with past explorations, thereby creating the surprising result of modernismsolidifyingthepast,itsownpast.Atthesametime,theinvolvementwith previousexplorations can yield the new, not so much the shocking gesture as the differentwaysinwhichan idea hasbeen treated.Themode ofmodernistinquiryis not unlike that in science, one in which an experiment cites and departs from previousresearchinthehopeofreachingnewinsights.(2009,7) In Metzer’s reading, the notion of inquiry emerges as a central facet of modernism, one that is intertwined with the expressive characteristics that he perceives in music ofrecent decades. In these works, he asserts, the process of analysing expressive modes itselfproves to be a mode of expression (2009, 23). His examination of the expressive act is twinned with an unpacking of ‘compositional states’: particularconditionsorcircumstances thatserveas ideals to be emulated (though, importantly, not simply mimicked) through musical constructions.Throughexploringstatesofsilence,fragmentation,lamentation,and sonic ?lux, he offers a compelling case for compositional focus – rather than material–asacommongroundfordiscussionofrecentmusic(2009,8–12). Metzerutilisesthisdistinctionasonewayofseparatingwhatheterms‘late modernism’frommuchoftheavant-gardeworkproducedinthepost-warperiod; typi?ied by the largely serial styles promoted at the Darmstadt International Summer Courses during the 1950s and 60s, the latter music emerges from a stringent emphasis on ‘newness’, often seemingly at the expense of expressivity (2009, 18–19). Indeed, itis the modernist engagementwith past modes, andthe heightenedsubjectiveexpressionthisfacilitates,thatprovidesthemeansbywhich Metzer seeks to view a diverse range of recent compositional styles – including neo-Romanticism, new complexity, and spectralism – under the same light: ‘Moving back from the individual details to the larger scene, we can perceive a range of richly expressive idioms, the vibrancy of which emerges from a fascination with the immediacy and communicative force of that expressive moment’(2009,20). In this sense, it can beposited that the more recent work utilisedin this study might all be understood as displaying broader, post-avant-garde traits. Indeed, it might be argued that they exhibit seemingly modernist tendencies 17 Introduction throughtheirengagementwithstructuralprecedentsandtheirshapingofmusical form as avehicle for expression. Whilst Adès’ Tevot does this in a more explicit way through its stated invocation of the symphonic tradition, an emphasis on contrast, development and dynamism as means by which structure can be delineated proves central to the music of Abrahamsen, Adams, Benjamin, and Saariaho.Whileitisnottheintentionofthisthesis to focusuponmodernismasa principalframeofreference,itisnonethelesssigni?icantthatitcanbeevokedasa connectingfeature;JulianJohnsonprovidesthemostextensive recentexampleof thiswithhiscross-historicalstudyOutofTime (2015),emphasisingmodernismas a potential source of uni?ication rather than division once it ‘is understood in relation to the aesthetic mediation of social modernity, rather than de?ined exclusively through technical or stylistic terms to do with atonality or metrical asymmetry’:‘Whereas theaestheticsofModernismused to dividemusical sheep and goats into conservative and progressive camps, recently we have found it more interesting to explore the co-existence and interaction of diverse stylistic practices which, on closer inspection, begin to show some remarkable similarities’(2015,7). Themusicselectionprocessforthisthesiswasinevitablysubjective.These works were ultimately chosenon account ofwhat I perceivedto be potential to catalyseanexploration ofbroader musical topics. Indeed, it is these topics that, whether explicitlyorcovertly, will act asthe guiding principleofthecasestudies rather than any intention to provide a set of comprehensive analyses. Consequently, the range – and the limitations – of the analyses themselves will vary.ExaminationsofcompositionsbyAbrahamsenandBrahms,andbyAdèsand Sibelius, will take into consideration the entirety of their unfolding forms. By contrast, the focus in other chapters will fall instead on particular moments of crystallisation:discussionofworksbyAdams andSchubert willcentreupontheir openings and the perceptual implications of these passages; meanwhile, two periodsofalienationatthecentreofpiecesbySaariahoandBeethovenwillserve as a springboard for an exploration of the effect of these landmarks within the contextofthewidermusicalnarratives. TheintroductorypairingofBenjaminand Mozartwillofferconsiderationsofbothlong-termandmomentaryideas,exploring 18 Introduction both broader formal process and speci?ic passages that might be thought of as evokingasenseoftimelessness. Although the pieces are cast in pairings relative to particular temporal concepts, they each undoubtedly contribute beyond their stations, enriching broadertheoreticalexaminationaswellasoneanother.Placedbetweenthesecase studies are four shorter chapters, interludes that seek to synthesise the work of other scholars into a more cohesive navigation of surrounding conceptual and theoretical issues. Thelinks between theseinterludesandthe analyseswill often be implied rather than stated outright; it is hoped instead that they can increasingly informandstimulateoneanother,accumulatinggraduallytowards a broaderaccountofmusicaltime.Inconjunctionwiththecasestudiestheybridge, thetheoretical interludes present adevelopingexplorationofwaysinwhichtime is understood in philosophical and scienti?ic terms (Chapter Three: Directing Time),howitspassing isperceivedinpsychologicalandcognitiveterms(Chapter Five: Perceiving Time), ways in which longer durations are understood and structured(ChapterSeven:ExperiencingTime),andhowtheseimpressionsmight feed into more musicological concerns regarding musical form (Chapter Nine: UnderstandingTime).ChapterTwo(AlternativePaths)willprovideajuxtaposition of both strands of the thesis, introducing a number of the broader theoretical questionsthat will featurebeforemovinginto the?irst casestudy(Benjamin and Mozart). Meanwhile, taking the shape of a brief conclusion, Chapter Eleven (Epilogue:Openendings)willconsidertheimplicationsoftheparadoxessurveyed foranopenperspectiveonmusicandtime. There are numerous musicological movements and discourses – hermeneutics, semantics, narrativity, formalism, structuralism and poststructuralism,tonamebutafew–that,whethernamedornot,willcropupin discussion at various points. It has largely been my intention to sidestep these larger debates rather than to join them; they are sub-?ieldsthat merit theirown theses,andcertainlylittlejusticecouldbedonetotherangeofideasandliterature theyencompasswithoutgrantingthemthefocustheydeserve.Iftheyareinvoked here, it is only at moments when the essential issues of this study overlap with principlesattheheartofthosediscourses.Thewide-rangingliteratureconcerning theearliermusical works examinedherewill be treatedina similar way, drawn 19 Introduction uponatpointswhenitbearsrelevanceto thetopicsathand. Indeed,tothisend,it isnotanintentheretoprovidecomprehensiveanalyses–inaconventionalsense – of these pieces; rather they shall be explored with a view to focusing upon aspects of their construction that contribute to an ongoing discussion of temporality. Keepingscore The act of analysing a score, by its very nature, will to some degree always be predisposedtowardsascribingmeaningtomusic‘inandofitself’,grantingitakind of autonomy.2 Inevitably, within the performance-dependent context of musical time, theboundariesofmusicalmeaningmustbesetfarwider, encompassingall manner of textual, perceptual, ecological and cultural factors. Indeed, as Kevin Korsyn points out, these factors must be taken to form a network of ‘relational events’ if the dead-end binary of the ‘text/context dualism’ (analyses and discussionsofmusicthatarelimitedtomovementbetweenconceptionsof‘inside’ and‘outside’thework)is to beavoided(1999, 55–56). Inthissense, itwouldbe easytocallthesigni?icanceofthescoreintoquestion.Discrepanciesbetweenscore and sound will always serve to illustrate the shortcomings of notation as an empirical text. Inhis book Beyond the Score, Nicholas Cook expresses a desireto ful?ill the outlook of his title whilst airing the prospect of an intriguing return, suggesting that ‘it is only once you think of music as performance that you can start to make sense of scores’. Nevertheless, he is realistic regarding their limitations: In a nutshell, musicology wassetup around the idea of music as writing rather than musicasperformance.Tothink of musicas writing istosee itsmeaning as inscribedwithinthe score, and accordinglyto seeperformanceasa reproduction of thismeaning. That turns performance into a kind of supplementto the music itself, an optional extra, rather like reading poetry aloud (because isn’t the meaning alreadythere on the printed page?). Evenif thatisasatisfactorywayof 2 Thenotionofmusicalworkspossessingsomekindof‘autonomy’istoucheduponinChapterNine (UnderstandingTime). 20 Introduction thinking of poetry – which critics like Stanley Fish would deny – it is not a satisfactorywayofthinkingofaperformingartlikemusic.(Cook2013,1) Cook’s invocation of Stanley Fish is apt; whilst Fish’s theory of ‘interpretive communities’ and its accompanying theory of text readings as largely cultural constructionsoffersawell-consideredcounter-weighttomorecategoricalthinking (1976, 483–84), it is ultimately his approach to perception and meaning that provesmost fruitful. Inhis explorationofinterpretativeclashesregardingMilton, hereachesanopen-endedconclusion: Inshort, theseare problemsthatapparentlycannotbesolved,atleast notbythe methodstraditionallybroughttobearonthem. WhatIwould liketoargue isthat they are not meant to be solved, but to be experienced (they signify), and that consequently any procedure that attempts to determine which of a number of readingsiscorrectwillnecessarilyfail.(1976,465) Ultimately, Cook’s portrayal (2001) ofthe work as emergentin theact of performance–asan‘interactionofautonomousagents’(2001,192)–servesasa useful model for musical meaning. Scores, thoughtheycontribute signi?icantlyto this process, will not hold a monopoly in the course ofthis study; the pieces of music utilisedherearerepresentedas muchbytheselectedrecordingdetailedin the primary resource list as they are by their notated forms. However, whilst speci?icaspectsoftheserecordingswillattimes bereferencedinthecasestudies, it ismoreoftenthatexcerptsfromthescorewillbeemployedasasupplementto discussion. Rather than succumbing to the kind of binary that Korsyn warns against, it is hoped that this use of notation – as representative of important aspects of many performances – helps to allow these analyses to be adapted beyondthespeci?icrecordingstheyrelatetohere.Byextension,thisuseofscores can offer a degree ofclarity that might enable the focus ofthis thesis to remain uponsubjectiveexperiencesofmusicaltimeratherthanthemoreintricatefacets oftherelationshipbetweentextandperformance.Whilstitdoesnotfallwithinthe remit of this thesis to provide a detailed discussion ofthe nature of meaning in music, various kinds ofmeaning will be impliedor invokedat numerous points. Thefocuswillnotbethespeci?icshapeofthatmeaning;interestinsteadliesinthe ways in which aspects of the construction of pieces create particular temporal 21 Introduction effects whenperformed, and the ways in whichthese perceptual features might helptofacilitatemeaningfulexperiences.3 Althoughthis thesis drawsupon andis in?luencedbyavarietyofsources, its theoretical underpinning canbe tracedto several authors whose approachto similar subjects has provedparticularly useful. Several writers inparticular deal withmusicaltimeinencouragingways. FirstandforemostisJonathanD.Kramer, whose The Time of Music (1988) provides one of the most wide-ranging, and comprehensive attempts to unpack the subject. In conjunction with numerous articlesthataddressrelatedsubtopics (1973, 1978, 1981, 1982, 1985and2004), thebookgoesalongwaytowards establishingapractical vocabularythatenables functionaldiscussionofmusicalworks.BarbaraBarry’sMusicalTime:TheSenseof Order(1990)hasalsoprovedhelpfulinthisregard;thoughreservationsmightbe heldregardingits subjectiveperceptualassumptions anditsassertionofaesthetic preferences, Barry’s written approach exhibits a directness and an intentional avoidanceofjargonworthaspiringto.ThomasClifton’sMusicasHeard:AStudyin Applied Phenomenology (1983) admirably addresses ?irst-principle dilemmas whilstrefusingto beobstructedbythem, utilisingnumerous examples ofmusical worksinordertoofferapragmaticdissectionofsubjectiveexperience.Inoutlining hisstanceaccordingtothephenomenologicaltradition,heassertshispositionas‘a way ofuttering meaningfulstatements whichareobjectiveinthesensethatthey attempttodescribethemusicalobjectadequately,andsubjectiveinthesensethat they issue from a subject to whom an object has some meaning’(1983, viii–ix). Finally, Robert Adlington offers perceptive and incisive appraisals of attitudes towards temporality in post-tonal music, skilfully highlighting limitations in a variety of approaches (1997b and2003). Although his writing is predominantly theory-centric, hisleaningis undoubtedly towardsanalysisandhisdiscussions of metaphor, gesture, and motion prove pragmatic in their consideration of aural 3 Forfurtherreadingregardingmusicalmeaningandthetensionsdiscussedhere,seeCook(1990, 2001,and2013),Korsyn(1999),Almén(2003),Small(1998)andClarke(2005). 22 Introduction effect.4 Additionally, in terms of the wider study of time, Freidel Weinert’s The March of Time (2013) provides a fascinating detailed yet relatively accessible historical survey of scienti?ic developments in temporal theory; its impact upon thisthesiswillbediscussedinmoredetailinthecourseofChapterThree. Morebroadly,EricClarke’swritinghasprovedinvaluableinitsembraceof interdisciplinarity. His book Ways of Listening: An Ecological Approach to the Perception of Musical Meaning (2005) goes some way towards constructing a bridge betweenpsychological, musicological, andanalytical understandings, with its discussions of speci?ic musical works grounded by the ways in which their elementsmightbeperceived. Acceptingthe‘truismthat different peopleperceive notionally the same event in different ways and on different occasions’ (2005, 194), Clarkesetsoutanecological approachto perception, promotingacommon aural groundbetween individualswithout sacri?icing subjectivelistening: ‘Weall havethepotentialtoheardifferentthingsinthesamemusic–butthefactwedon’t (or at least not all the time) is an indication ofthe degree to whichwe share a common environment, and experience common perceptual learning or adaptation’(2005,191). Clarke’sownattitudetowardsmusicalmeaning–assomethingthat differs accordingtohow, andinwhatcircumstancesitisperceived–iscomplementedby a number of hermeneutic ideas. One scholar who emerges on a number of occasionsisLawrenceKramer,whosedeliberateavoidanceofstrictde?initionsfor musical meaning does not prevent but rather facilitates wider discussions concerning human values (1990, 1995, 2002, 2005, 2007, 2009 and2010). With regardtomorespeci?icaspectsofmusicalcommunication,ByronAlménpresentsa compelling argument for notions ofmusical narrative that emerge in parallel to literarytheoriesratherthandirectly fromthem(2008);hisworkfeaturesheavily inChapterSeven. 4 It is encouraging that further studies into musical time are beginning to emerge. Although their focus fallsmore upon aesthetic and cultural issues contemporaryto the composers and musical works they discuss, Karol Berger (2007), Julian Johnson (2015) and Benedict Taylor (2016) number among particularly engaging recent examples of scholarship that seeks to emphasise the signiSicance of temporality in musicological endeavour. 23 Introduction MutualbeneUits Many of the earlier works in this thesis have amassed a rich reception history, somefrequentlyconsidered‘masterpieces’by‘genius’composers. Evenifaspects ofthosehistories arereferencedhere, thefocus remainsupon theexperiences of theworkstoday. Suchacclaimoftenseems to have the effect ofsteaming upthe lens,sotospeak:anaudience’s‘view’oftheartworkisobscuredormanipulatedby thelabelsattachedtoit. The‘genius’tagsometimesevenintroducesanunsettling extra-autonomous element to artistic endeavour. At an extreme, Nicholas Cook draws attentionto Heinrich Schenker’s assertion that ‘genius’composers do not speak with a voice of their own but instead are used by ‘the superior force of truth’(Cook1998,32). While many would dispute the other-worldly intervention Schenker describes, thenotionof‘masterpieces’persiststoday intheshapeof‘repertories’ or ‘canons’, ‘the imaginary museum of musical works’ as Lydia Goehr termedit (1992).WilliamWeberrightlyattemptstochallengemodernpreconceptionsabout the origins of these hierarchies, highlighting the formation of European pedagogical and performance canons throughout the sixteenth and seventeenth centuries.Nevertheless,heconcedesthatitisthecomposersofthe‘Classicalstyle’ that are popularly considered as the foundation stones upon which today’s repertoryisfounded(Weber1999,340–41). Cookpointsto theancientGreekand Roman‘standardsofbeauty’thatinspiredthelabel:‘Thistermimpliedthatsimilar standards had now been set in music, against which the production of all other timesandplacesmustbemeasured’(Cook1998,31). CertainlytheAustro-Germanicworksselectedherearelikelytobethought of in terms ofthislineage. Consequently, it might beexpected that some kind of statementregardingthecanonisintended;rather,thisthesisisdesignedsimplyto underlinetwopositivesideeffectsofit.The?irstistheresultingfamiliaritythatan audience may well have with several of the chosen pieces. The transformative power of repeated hearings cannot be underestimated, even in the context of inheritedpreconceptions. Indeed, part ofthe role of these analyses is to engage with engrained expectations that listeners may have. The second is the way in whichthis bringingtogether ofdiverse works hints atatranscendenceofperiod 24 Introduction and era, a certain kind of ‘timelessness’. Each of the pieces selected here demonstrates this paradoxical temporality, summarised eloquently by Edward Saidinhisdissectionoflatestyle: There is Sirst of all the artist’s connection to his or her own time, orhistorical period, society and antecedents, how the aesthetic work, for all its irreducible individuality, isnevertheless a part–or, paradoxically, nota part –of the era in which it was produced. This is not simply a matter of sociological or political synchronybutmore interestinglyhastodowithrhetoricalorformalstyle…There isalsoanantitheticalrelationshipinthecase of artistswhoseworkchallengesthe aestheticandsocialnormsoftheirerasandis,sotospeak,toolateforthetimes,in thesenseofsupersedingortranscendingthem.(Said2008,299–300) ApracticalapplicationofthisnotionisharnessedbyE.M. Forster,who–in his Aspectsofthe Novel – attemptedto ‘exorcise’from academic endeavour ‘that demonof chronology’, rejecting ahistorical view of literary analysis andinstead considering great writers not within their own time periods, but all working togetherinalarge,circularroom: That is why, in the rather ramshackle course that lies ahead of us, we cannot considerSictionbyperiods,we mustnotcontemplate the streamoftime.Another imagebettersuitsourpowers:thatofallthenovelistswritingtheirnovelsatonce. Theycome fromdifferentagesand ranks, theyhave different temperamentsand aims, but they all hold pens in their hands, and are in the process of creation. (Forster[1927]2005,31) Whilestudies suchas Forster’shaveprovedformativeinthedevelopmentofthis project, it shouldbeaddedthathisis not anapproachI wishto emulate. Forster assumeshispositiontoilluminateintegralfacetsofthenovelinordertoadvocate abroadertheoreticalapproachakinto that ofNew Criticism. Indeed,whilstmany of the distinctions made by ‘New Critics’ between meaning, intention and interpretation are worthattention, they carry no more weight than many ofthe otherapproachesinvokedinthecourseofthisthesis. The?iveselected works by livingcomposers present by comparison what might typically be recognised as more ‘dif?icult’ music. Gaining some kind of standardised, transferrable understanding proves tricky in the absence of many conventional footholds suchas easily perceivableharmonic, melodic, andmetric 25 Introduction hierarchies.Itisthesecontemporary piecesthattakecentre-stageas catalystsfor discussionsofmusicaltime.Thecanonicworks,analysedinparallel,taketheshape of recognisable lenses through which the new can be viewed and better understood. However,thisisnotanexclusivelyone-wayprocess.A hoped-forside effect isthat thenew might in-turnreinvigorate theold: theunfamiliarrendered moreaccessible,thefamiliarcastinanewlight.Ausefulanalogymightbefoundin LesMisérablesasVictorHugooutlinesachanceencounterbetweenthehumbleand elderly priest Monseigneur Myriel and the newly crowned Emperor Napoleon Bonaparte: ‘Seeing the old priest intently regarding him, he turned to him and asked sharply: “Who is the gentleman who is staring at me?” “Sire,” replied Monseigneur Myriel, “youare looking at a plain manandIamlookingatagreat man.Eachofusmaybene?it”(Hugotrans.Denny1982,20). Thishope–foramutuallybene?icialanalyticalecologyregardlessofsurface style–iscentral tothisthesis, anditsapproachtothemusicitutilises.Eachwork selectedherejusti?iesits placealongsideitsbedfellows onaccount ofwhat itcan facilitate.Music,atitsmostsuccessful,seems to possessaremarkablecapacityto actas acatalystformeaning–anabilityto pullinto focusforlistenersallmanner of things to do with self, emotion, intellect, spirituality, and relationships. Lawrence Kramer’s eloquent portrayal of music as a ‘dialogue between an inevitably creative intelligence and an inevitably meaningful world’ seems particularlyaptintheseterms(2007,29). The pieces utilised here been selected precisely so that they might be explored, examined,andinterrogatedinallmannerofways.Eachwaschosenwith theconvictionthat itwould not only standup to testing but also emerge all the richerforit.Thereisnodesirehereinprescribinghowanyofthismusicshouldbe heard. Rather, alternative listening approaches are offered, allowing each individualtobroadentheirownhearingofapiece. Similarly,forreasonsthatwilloccupytheremainderofthisstudy,nobroad theory regarding musical time will beoffered. Instead, I will argue that no such de?initionscanbereachedregardingsomercurialasubject.Inthefaiththatmusic ultimatelyseemsto possesstheabilitytoarticulatethingsthatwordscannot–not least regardingourrelationshipwithtime– it will bethe?inal case-studypairing (Adès and Sibelius) that will serve to underline the conclusion of this thesis 26 Introduction throughitsengagementwithprofoundparadoxesofchangeandrecurrence,stasis and?lux.Idonotwishto seethisapparentopen-endednessassomekindof‘sadly unavoidable’situation,asBenedictTaylordescribesit(2016,288).Iamconvinced that to engage with questions like those askedin the course of this thesis is to become more receptive to one’s own musical experiences and, thus, to leave oneself open to new ways oflistening andthe new kinds ofmeaning that might accompanythem.Inthisspirit, all thisendeavourasksofitsreadersisanattitude ofopennessinamannersimilarto thatoutlinedbyC.S. LewisinAnExperimentin Criticism: No poem will give upits secret to a readerwhoenters itregardingthe poetasa potentialdeceiver,anddeterminednottobetakenin.Wemustriskbeingtakenin, if we are to get anything. The best safeguard against bad literature is a full experienceofgood;justasarealandaffectionateacquaintancewithhonestpeople gives a better protection against rogues than a habitual distrust of everyone. (Lewis1961,94) 27 Two AlternativePaths GeorgeBenjamin&WolfgangAmadeusMozart Abouttime The temporally-determined quality of music does not set it wholly aside from otherart-forms.Whilstit is obviouslyaccompaniedbyallexplicitly performancebased arts, to claim thatotherwritten and visual genres differ drastically in this respect is to underestimate the ways in which they are perceived. It could very well bearguedthat theytoo areperformed, albeitinanabstractsense. They too relyuponthepassageoftimefortheirrealisation,evenifcontroloverdurationlies toagreaterextentinthehandsofaviewerorareader.Thelinearconstructionofa novelrequirestimetopassforittoplayoutasitisread;thedurationofaviewing of a painting may profoundly affect the impression it leaves. The entwining of music and time is, of course, ?irst and foremost an consequence of the fact that sound – the basic component of music – can only be comprehended within the unfoldingtimeittakesforthatsoundtoemerge.However,Iwouldproposethatis precisely this connection that can set the most profound musical experiences aside. A surrender of temporal ‘control’ on the part of a listener can lead to a heightened re?lective awareness of perceptual time. In other words, a musical experiencecanmanipulatethe?lowoftimeforitslisteners,providingtheyallowit to. RowanWilliamsisaptinhisinferencethat ifmusic ‘isthemostcontemplative ofthearts,itisnotbecauseittakesusintothetimelessbutbecauseitobligesusto rethinktime’(Williams1989,248,quotedinBegbie2000,29). Itisausefulconstantwithintherichmusicalvarietyofthisstudythateach chosenworkisnotableforitsabilityto drawlisteners–certainlythisone, atleast –intothiskindofengagementwiththeirexperiencesoftime.Indeed,beyondmere exploitation,thepiecesseemtoengineertime,structuringitinanaudiblemanner. Thanksto their (largely)?ixedexpressionsasnotatedscores, andtheattempts of most performances to realise (or ‘recreate’) these texts, time is in some sense ‘ordered’throughthechoreographedproductionofsound. The‘musicalforms’in 28 AlternativePaths the title of this thesis refer to this concept of audible design andits capacity to communicate, toactasaspringboardfor meaning beyondsimply thestructuring of sound itself. Arnold Whittall suggests that ‘forms might be de?ined simply as whatformshaveincommon,re?lectingthefactthatanorganisingimpulseisatthe heartofanycompositionalenterprise’(Grove,2007).Thesamewouldoftenappear to also be true at the receptive end of the continuum of creation and interpretation; surely this same impulse lies at the centre of any listening enterprise. Whittallclearlynotesthesigni?icanceofthisimpulseinthebroadercontext of musical reception: ‘meaning is implicated in form, yet not identical with it’(2007). Itisagapbetweenconstructionandsigni?icancethat philosopherslike Eduard Hanslick have argued is bridged by aesthetic ideals such as beauty and purity. Aspects ofHanslick’s formalist approaches are, in some ways relevant to this thesis, not least his proposal that music be de?ined as ‘tönend bewegte Formen’: sonically moving forms (trans. Cohen 1957). Indeed, the emphasis he places upon the organic, self-driven development of melodic material – the lifeforce ofmusic, as he asserts – is worthnoting. Exploring Hanslick’s conceptions, Marc Lemaninfers that thesemoving structures ‘have a direct impact onhuman physiology because they evoke corporeal resonances giving rise to signi?ication’ (2008, 17). Perceivedformal dynamism will feature at points here, withparticularfocus placed uponits contribution towards large-scale structural procedureslikegrowthanddecay,andconvergenceanddivergence(ChaptersSix andTeninparticular). Narrativeimpulses Attitudes to the role form plays in the location of meaning vary greatly. Adam Ockelforddevelopsanaesthetictheoryofmusiconthegroundsofpalpableorder, introducing the term ‘zygonic’ to denote patterns internal repetition and selfimitation within structures (2005, 5–6). Here, form itself might be taken to promote meaningintrinsically, pleasure derivedfrom self-reference. By contrast, LawrenceKrameracknowledgesthesigni?icanceofconciserepetitionandcyclical 29 AlternativePaths structures within the context of popular music, but reverses Ockelford’s focus when discussing Western classical music, highlighting the manner in which ‘the force ofdeparture ordissolutioncannot beso neatly contained’. Inparticular, he refusesto letdiscussionoftheaestheticvalueofmusicsupersedeitspracticaland perceptualcapacities: Classicalmusicconstantlyputitsclaimsofbeauty,desire,energy,clarity,andsoon at risk in the currents of contingency and metamorphosis. This willingness to engage with the passage of time from something like the inside gives the music partofitsspecialcharacter.Classicalmusicallowsustograsppassingtimeasifit were an objectorevena body. Time,whichasmutabilitydissolvesthesolidityof ourlovesand beingsintoabstraction andmemory,becomesa source oftangible, persistentpleasureandmeaning.(L.Kramer2007,38–39) In placing these temporal factors at the centre of the perceptual and emotional experience of music, Kramer highlights further a refreshingly pragmatic conception of form: ‘One doesn’t listen for the forms, but through them. Form arises as a projection of drama; the drama is not a paraphrase tacked onto the form’ (2007, 38–39). The notion of drama is apt; instrumental music might certainlybesaidtoconveyanarrative,evenifitdoesnotpossessthespeci?icityof a literary drama. In spite of his reservations, Jean-Jacques Nattiez is quick to acknowledge the ‘narrative impulse’ – a process which ‘operates when we hear musicinamoreorlessspontaneouslynarrativemodeoflistening’:‘Onthelevelof the strictly musical discourse, I recognise returns, expectations and resolutions, butofwhat,Idonotknow.ThusIhaveawishtocompletethroughwordswhatthe music does not say because it is not in its semiological nature to say it to me’(Nattiez,1990,244–45). Adapting Whittall’s impression of the act of composition, this arrival at narrative structure could be taken as part of a broader ‘organising impulse’. Barney Childs agrees: ‘Man traditionally searches to “make sense” out of experience, and art provides one means he can choose to do this’ (1977, 195). However,suchlanguagechoicesmightseemto underminethecreativeroutesthis journeycanencompass.Totalkof‘organising’or‘ordering’maysuggestsomething altogether more unimaginative, the implicationbeingof themusic possessingan inherenthierarchicalsystem.Ofcourse, formalhierarchiesshouldnotnecessarily 30 AlternativePaths beviewedin negativelight; onthe contrary, theyareoften crucial to gainingan understanding of a perceptual narrative. But to suggest that these systems of formalhierarchyaresingular–andthatinterpretationislittlemorethanajigsaw puzzle–wouldbedamaging.Toequateitwiththeactofcomposing,listeningtoois acreativeact. Such varied perceptions and visualisations of an experience as fundamentally universal as the passing of musical time throw open the interpretative ?loodgates. Paul de Man eloquently outlines the problematic temporalimplicationsforreadingsofliteraryform: The idea of totality suggests closed formsthatstrive for ordered and consistent systems and have an almost irresistible tendency to transform themselves into objective structures. Yet, the temporal factor, so persistently forgotten, should remind us that the form is never anything but a process on the way to its completion.Thecompletedformneverexistsasaconcrete aspectoftheworkthat could coincide with a sensorial or semantic dimension of the language. It is constituted inthe mindof theinterpreterasthe workdisclosesitselfin response to his questioning. But this dialogue between work and interpreter is endless. (1983,31–32) The sheer diversity of ways in which a single narrative can be read induces a paradoxical interchange between subjective and objective, boundaries between general and speci?ic irretrievably blurred. As Joseph Campbell says of hero mythologies: ‘Where we had thought to travel outwards we shall come to the centreofourownexistence;wherewehadthoughttobealone,weshallbewithall theworld.’(2008, 18). C.S. Lewis, in turn, associates these narrative experiences withareciprocalrelationshipbetweenthenaturalandthetranscendental: Literary experience heals the wound, without undermining the privilege, of individuality.Therearemassemotionswhichhealthewound;buttheydestroythe privilege. In them our separate selves are pooled and we sink back into subindividuality. But in reading great literature I become a thousand men and yet remain myself.Likethenightskyinthe Greekpoem,Iseewithamyriadeyes,but itisstillIwhosee.(1961,140–41) Largely freed from the constraints that language and visual elements might impose, instrumental music already lies some distance along this path of 31 AlternativePaths abstraction. Many pieces of music, even if they were composed with a speci?ic subjectmatter,are–inbeingheard–allowedtoassumetheformofmorepersonal expressionsthatmightneverthelessbeunitedwithbigger,‘universal’ideas. Graspingtime Lawrence Kramer’s suggestion that classical music allows passing time to be ‘grasped’ in the manner of a physical entity is indicative of a wider receptive approachto musical form(2007, 39.) Beyond the obvious referenceto rhythmic andmetricalaspectsofperformance,itwouldappeartoconsidermusicalworksas stretchesoftimethatareinsomesensepreserved–or‘kept’–andreproduced(in, nonetheless, endlessly variable forms) to express wordless narratives. An oftquoted passage in Richard II, ?inds William Shakespeare invoking this idea (5.5. 42–48): Ha,ha!keeptime:howsoursweetmusicis, Whentimeisbrokeandnoproportionkept! Soisitinthemusicofmen'slives. AndherehaveIthedaintinessofear Tochequetimebrokeinadisorder'dstring; Butfortheconcordofmystateandtime Hadnotaneartohearmytruetimebroke. With poetic concision, this passage references many of the conceptual obstacles that face examination of musical time. Apparent dichotomies are invoked – continuity and discontinuity, linearity and non-linearity, proportion and disproportion, ‘true’ time and ‘broken’ time – but within a paradoxical simultaneity. It is these kinds of distinctions that permeate Jonathan Kramer’s approach;evenhisopeningquestion–‘Doesmusicexistintimeordoestimeexist in music?’ (J. Kramer 1988, 5) – perhaps hints at the inevitable fallibilities and limitationsofanysingularenquiry. Heseemswellawareofthis,andhefrequently takes care to acknowledge both the inherent contradictions and ultimate redundanciesofthedivisions(1988,58,forexample). 32 AlternativePaths Indiscussingformal coherence, Theodor Adorno voices what heperceives as a transformation of ‘crude unmediated space, time, and causality’ within the context ofartworks from a distant contributor into ‘something other’: ‘Thus, for example, there is no mistaking time as such in music, yet it is so remote from empirical time that, when listening is concentrated, temporal events external to themusicalcontinuumremainexternaltoitandindeedscarcelytouchit’.Adorno seemsto make astriking temporal distinctionhere, asserting thatempirical time infringesuponthismusicaltime‘onlybydintofitsheterogeneity,notbecausethey ?low together’(Adorno trans. Hullot-Kentor 1997, 137). Certainly, in assuming a particular aesthetic perspective, many musicologists andanalysts might oftenbe seen as implicitly advocating a particular view of musical time. In this way, Nicholas Cook identi?ies a temporal distinction as lying at the foundations ofthe oppositionbetweenwhathetermsstructuralistandrhetoricalconceptions: Thestructuralistmodelisof anidealobjectthatisnotinherentlytemporalbut, in performance, ispresented throughtime. Time is the medium through which the music passes, rather in the manner of its steady progression across the screen whenyouare playing arecording inSonicVisualiser.... Bycontrast, therhetorical modelisoneinwhichtimeisadimensionof the musicalmaterial,sothat(asIput it)themusicisnotintime, aswiththestructuralistmodelbutratheroftime.This means that music isunderstood to be inherently temporal ... and equally that it shapestemporalexperience,ratherinthemannerofamagneticSield.(2013,126) Time is often conceived as comprising oppositional characteristics. Jonathan Kramer describes themas ‘absolute’onthe one hand and‘musical’onthe other, acknowledgingthepossibilityoftheformerasanrealityexternaltoexperiencebut promoting the powers ofthe latter to ‘create, alter, distort, or evendestroy time itself’(1988, 5).5 Nevertheless,hecallsuponthewritingofThomasCliftontohelp dissectnotionsofobjectivetimeforthepurposesofhisenquiries: Time is a relationship between people and the events they perceive. It is an ordering principle of experience. Thus I am focusing on the time that exists primarilywithin us. Yet evenwhat Icall‘absolute’ time (a term Clifton rejects) is little more than a social convention agreed to for practical reasons. (J. Kramer 1988,5) 5 Further discussion of the dualities that Jonathan Kramer’s can be found in Chapter Seven (ExperiencingTime). 33 AlternativePaths ThoughCliftonmay reject anautocratic readingoftime, heisneverthelesshappy toworkwithabinaryinterpretation,notingadifferencebetween‘thetimeapiece takes’ as opposed to ‘the time a piece presents or evokes’ (Clifton 1983, 81). Kramer’s apparent evasion of concrete conclusions regarding a concept of ‘absolutetime’ proves a concern for Jeremy Begbie, who highlights a number of inconsistencies: despite his discussions of music inits relation to absolute time, Kramer holds that it is ‘primarily subjective’, yet he confuses things further by concludingthat‘timedoesnotexistoutsideofexperience’andthatabsolutetimeis ‘objective time, thetime that is sharedby most people in a given society andby physical process’. Begbiepoints to ImmanuelKant’s conception of temporality as theformthat governscognitionanddeterminestheorganisingofsensedataasa helpfullyclear-cutexpressionofthissubjectivism(Begbie2000,32–33). Losingtime In his book Shaping Time, David Epstein’s summation of ‘dual modes’ of time outlines something perhaps more akin to a power struggle in the mind of a perceiver: One is essentially clocklike, a measurement mode that mechanically delineates equal periods. The other mode relies upon experience for its demarcation – experience that is particular and unique. Time, seen in the context of such experience,isanythingbutmechanicalorexternal;quitetheopposite,itisintegral tothe experience itself. Asa consequence, itis often measured, ordelineated, in termsofthatexperience.(1995,7) Thisapparentmistrustofclocktime–andthewiderdesiretoavoidanysurrender to a notion of objective temporality – is nothing new. In his eleventh book of Confessions, written in the ?inal years of the Fourth Century, St Augustine’s ponderingoftheBiblicalcreationnarrativeleadstoadetailedconsiderationofthe experience of time. He questions how we comprehend the passing of time, exploring duration, whether it is determined by motion, and the ever-changing regularity of how it is sensed (trans. Chadwick 1991, 221–245). Perhaps most signi?icantly, he analyses his own consideration of time, concluding that time 34 AlternativePaths cannot be appraisedfrom ‘outside’; a questioning of time is itself subject to the passing of time. Dissecting past and future, he observes how dif?icult it is to determineexactlywhatconstitutesthe‘present’andhowtoquantify it, providing aneloquentsummaryofitsparadoxicalnature(trans.Chadwick1991,241): And yet the times we measure are not those which do not yet exist, nor those which alreadyhavenoexistence, northosewhichextendovernointervaloftime, northosewhichreachnoconclusions.Sothe timeswemeasure arenotfuturenor pastnorpresentnorthoseinprocessof passingaway. Yetwemeasure periodsof time.(1991,241) Morerecentattemptstoemphasisethesubjectiveovertheobjectivemightwellbe considered withinthe fallout of what Michael Rofe describes as ‘one of themost signi?icant paradigm shifts in modern physics’: the departure from the classical mechanics premise of time as de?initively measurable regardless of subject movement (referred to as Newtonian time, in Rofe’s reading) following the subsequently veri?ied assertions ofAlbert Einstein’s Generaland Special theories of relativity that space and time are inextricably entwined not only with one anotherbutalsowithwhatoccurswithinthem. Thedirectimplicationfortheories oftimewerethat itcouldno longerbeconsideredanabsolute:numerousstudies show it to alter within the context of extremes in motion and proportion (Rofe 2014,346–7). With even an objectiveconceptionof time throwninto doubt, it becomes easytoviewmuchartandscholarshipconcernedwithtimeasareaction–positive ornegative–tothefutilityofattemptstoquantifytemporalexperience.T.S.Eliot’s FourQuartetsprovidesaparticularlyiconiccaseinpoint,theexpositiontoits?irst poem, Burnt Norton, bearing striking resemblances to St Augustine’s musings (Eliot1944,13): Timepresentandtimepast Arebothperhapspresentintimefuture Andtimefuturecontainedintimepast. Ifalltimeiseternallypresent Alltimeisunredeemable. Whatmighthavebeenisanabstraction Remainingaperpetualpossibility 35 AlternativePaths Onlyinaworldofspeculation. Whatmighthavebeenandwhathasbeen Pointtooneend,whichisalwayspresent. When dealing with such mercurial subject matter, it is unsurprising that the process of music analysis has conventionally shied away from the Einsteinian conceptionoftime.AsRofeobserves,‘theobjectofanalysisismoreoftenthescore, rather thanthelistener’s perception ofthat score, andtheunits usedto describe patterns in music are most often the (Newtonianly stable) bar, tactus or second’(2014,347). Itwouldcertainlyseemthat, withinWesternartmusic,thescorehasbeen upheld– orclung onto – as representative ofahandful ofconstants intheseaof variablesthatsurroundtheperformanceofawork,apractical blueprint forwhat might insome sense be seen as an attempted‘repeat’of a temporal experience. Thisdesireto simulatewidertemporalrepetitionwouldseemto bere?lectedina moreacutemannerwhentakingintoaccountaspectsofcomposedrepetition:the controlledrecurrence–orquasi-recurrence–offeatureswithinapiece.Theeffect of this contained recycling process upon our perception of time becomes seemingly all the more complex the more it is scrutinised. Repetition or consistency of even the vaguest kind has a bearing on perceived continuity, forming a central component of musical syntax. Even discontinuous elements, when implemented in an extreme or extended manner, are tantamount to continuitiesoftheirown.6 Cyclesandspirals Nevertheless,thepresenceofrepetitionwithinapiecedoesnotactasanindicator ofwhetherthat music mightbe thought ofas linear or non-linearinterms ofthe temporalityperceived.ThedistinctionJonathanKramerestablishesbetweenthese two extremes, although linked less convincingly with his conception of the two 6 Further discussion of tensions between continuous and discontinuous elements, and their implication for broader conceptions of form, can be found in Chapter Five (PerceivingTime). 36 AlternativePaths hemispheresofthebrain,offersafascinatingworkablecontinuum.7 MartinClayton certainlyinterpretsitthisway,concurringthat‘musiccanexploiteitherorbothof thesecomplexes, andthat anypieceofmusic exhibitsbothlinear andnon-linear features’(2000,24).Kramerassertsthatthesequalitiesarenotmutuallyexclusive: ‘Mostmusicexhibitssomekindofmixoftemporalities, attimesnebulous, attimes contradictory, at times changing, at times elusive’ (1988, 58). These linear and non-linearfeatures, hewouldseemto besuggesting, areseparatedoutwithinhis discussionsforthepurposeofclarity, facets ofacomplex, plural processisolated anddissectedinturn. Approachingthesubject ofmusical time largelythroughthelensofIndian classical music, Clayton suggests that this systematic treatment ofthe topic may wellbeendemictoparticularstrandsofmusicology: IfthereisadifferencebetweenmetreinIndianandWesternmusicitmaylienotso much inone beingcyclicaland the othernot, butinthe factthatIndian theorists havenotbeentroubledbytheapparentparadoxofmusicaltimeasbothlinearand recurrent,whereasWesterntheoristshavebeeninclinedtoplaydownthesenseof recurrence, letalone cyclicity, in favour of a more singular conception of linear development.(2000,19) Capturingmultiplicityofthiskindinwithinthecontextofspeci?icmusicalanalyses proves dif?icult. Tim Howell attempts just this (2001), mapping Kramer’s distinctiononto themusicofSibeliustoillustratethewaysinwhichthetimescale the composer employs initiates contention between motion and stasis, between progression and stagnation. Howell infers two closely-derived categories of musical time: theonwardmotionof‘linearity’, andthe repetition-basedstasis of ‘circularity’.(2001,40–1.) Articulatingmusicaltimeintheseterms, whileprovingfunctional, displays aninevitable relianceupon successfulmetaphoricalexpression. Nevertheless, the necessity of this support network has been increasingly acknowledged. Robert Adlington, points to the work of linguists like George Lakoff and Mark Johnson (1980) as having beeninstrumental in this shift in perspective: ‘Contrary to the 7 Martin Clayton refers to, but does not elaborate fully upon, doubtsexpressed by Ian Cross in a private correspondence regarding Kramer’s linking of linear and non-linear timetotheleftandrighthemispheresofthebrainrespectively(Clayton2001,24). 37 AlternativePaths traditional understanding of metaphor as an essentially poetic or ?igurative linguistic device, these theorists have stressed the centrality of metaphor to cognition and experience. Metaphor, inother words, rather thanbeing subjective and indeterminately connected to its object, is often necessary and unavoidable’ (Adlington 2003, 301). The subject of metaphor with particular relation to time, space and motion, will emerge as a topic of discussion in the courseofthisthesis,inparticularinChapterThree(DirectingTime). The‘circularity’descriptionHowellemploys–‘cyclicity’inClayton’sreading – appeals more directly to perceptual experience than any kind of temporal actuality. AsClaytonclari?ieswithinhisconsiderationofmetricalimplications,‘no musiciscyclical inanyempiricallyveri?iablesense.Thecycleisaspatial-temporal metaphor used in order to clarify, mediate, and communicate subjectivemusical experience’(2000,18–19).Nevertheless,inspiteofthisprocessofabstraction,the imagery that different theoretical approaches produce can bear striking similarities.Claytoncites two theoreticalattempts to address dissatisfaction with cyclicityasamodelformetricalperception.The?irstisVictorZuckerkandlwho,in acknowledgingtheimpossibilityofanytrue‘goingback’intime,conjuresa more linearimage:‘Since[…] everynew beatdoes bringus to a new pointintime, the process can be better understood and visualised as a wave which also best corresponds to our sensationofmetre.’Subhadra Chaudhary in her dissectionof Indian tāla, meanwhile, does not dismiss the visual signi?icance of cyclicity altogether, butis quicktoemphasise –like Zuckerkandl–themannerinwhichit differs fromcircularity: ‘Althoughbothhaveroundshapesthecircleisformedby returning to starting point whereas the cycle is formed by moving forward graduallyinaspiral.’(Clayton,2000:20–21). While Claytonalso draws parallels herewith Jeffery Pressing who, within his ownmetricalstudy, resorts –likeChaudhary – to a graphicalillustrationofa helix,itisthetheoreticalnotionofaspiralthatisre?lectedinHowell’ssummaryof temporal synthesis in the music of Sibelius. Uniting his Kramer-derived conceptions of contrasting linear and circular time within one perceptual phenomenon, Howell aptly refers to ‘spiralling’: ‘where events appear to be repetitiveandcircularbutwherethatveryrepetitiondrivesthemusiconwardand givesitasenseofmomentum.’(2000,90). 38 AlternativePaths Though speci?ics and semantics may vary, each of these examples showcasesa conscious decisionto surmisetheperceivedtimeofparticular kinds of music in terms of gestural metaphors, each an attempt to convey through straightforwardmeansaprocessofmulti-layeredcomplexity.Theyreach,itwould seem, thesameconclusionasEdwardT. Cone: ‘Ifmusicisalanguageat all, itisa language of gesture: of direct actions.... Instrumental utterance, lacking intrinsic verbalcontent,goessofarastoconstitutewhatmightbecalledamediumofpure symbolic gesture.’ (1974, 164). Here, a theoretical connection between practical soundperceptionandabstractinterpretationisforged.EricClarkeunderlinesthe rolethat implications ofmovement play inthisjourney:‘The sense of motion or self-motion draws a listener into anengagement with the musical materials in a particularly dynamic manner... andindoingsoconstitutes avitalpart ofmusical meaning.’(2005,89). Zuckerkandl, Chaudhary, Howell and Pressing each reconcile features of stasis within the context of a dynamic structure: an attempt to emphasise a relationship of duality and co-existence rather than one of dichotomy and opposition.EachexamplealsoreinforcesJonathanKramer’sviewsonthepotential simultaneity of temporal modes. As with Kramer’s own work, for the sake of clarity, a detailed exploration of apparently plural musical time will entail an unpacking process, individual components examined in turn (1988, 58). By adoptingamoresystematicapproachtorelativelyimmediateandobviousaspects ofauralconstruction, increasinglyprofoundunderlyingtemporalprocessesmight beconsidered,buildingabridgebetweenphysicalactuality(sound)andexpressive abstraction(meaningfulinterpretation).Inasimilarmanner,thisthesiswillsetout tosuggestwaysinwhichtemporalinterpretationsofmusical workscanbelinked backtofundamental,universalexperiencesoftime,inboththeshort-andthelongterm: issues of beginning and ending, of growth and decay, of convergence and divergence,ofclimaxandsubsidence,ofexpectationanddenial. 39 AlternativePaths Temporaldualities This approach can be illustrated through an initial case-study pairing of two pieces:thesecondmovementofWolfgangAmadeusMozart’s(1756–1791)Sonata forkeyboardandviolininEminor,K.304(1778),andGeorgeBenjamin’s(b.1960) piece for viola duo Viola, Viola composed in 1997. In spite of their stylistic and formal disparity, both works nevertheless hintatbroader, relatedconceptions of timeanditssigni?icance.Theyalsoexhibiton-goingdialogues betweenlinearand non-linearmodes oftime, asadualisticcoexistenceis revealedinthecontrasting waysinwhichtheirtemporaljourneyscanbeheard.Thisbriefanalysiswillbegin withanemphasisuponnon-linearcharacteristics;morestatic,structuraldivisions will beoutlinedshowing theways in whichthe durations of thesepiecescanbe segmentedaccordingtoaformalplan.Theseoverviewswill graduallygivewayto more explicitly linear conceptions, taking into account more dynamic musical processes that could be heard in order that the validity of the more clear-cut architectural readings might be queried. Finally, further questions will be raised regardingspeci?icpassagesineachpiecethat presenta‘time’thatis notsoeasily de?ined.Here, considerationsofthetheformatlargewillgivewaytoexamination of two speci?ic parallel passages in both works; these analytical perspectives – long-term andshort-term – will beutilisedtovaryingextents in thecasestudies thatfollowduringthecourseofthethesis. Mozart’s sonata was written early in the summer of 1778 while the composer was staying inParis. Comprising just two movements rather thanthe typical three, it represents one of his experiments with formal compression; a numberofother sonatas composedonthesametripfollow acomparableformat (Bromberger, 2007). Whilst the opening Allegro assumes a conventional ?irstmovement role, theTempo di Menuetto, as its non-committal title might suggest, represents something of a hybrid. Although it assimilates aspects of minuet and trio traditions throughits dance-likemetre andits bookending structure, itsalso seems to sit at odds with these in?luences via its subdued, slow-movement character.MaintainingtheE-minortonicinitsoutersections,thisissombre,highly expressivemusic, exhibitingawistful, perhapseven despondentmelancholyrare inMozart’soutput. 40 AlternativePaths Formalsegment A1 Tonality Barnumbers(total) Duration Eminor 1–32 0’46 B Eminor/Gmajor 32–69 0’59 A2 Eminor 0’35 C Emajor 70–93 94–127dividedintotworepeated A3 Eminor sections(68barsintotal) 128–148 Coda Eminor 149–171 1’58 0’20 0’37 Fig.2.1:Mozart,ViolinSonatainEminorK.304,secondmovement,tableshowing circularstructure Architecturally speaking, the Tempo di Menuetto displays a circularity of form: two related outer sections inE-minor enclose a contrasting E-major ‘trio’ episode, withthe musical material distributedaccordingly (seeFigure2.1).8 The effect is one of self-contained stasis. From the long-term revisitations of the ‘minuet’ material, to the short-term antecedent-consequent relationships found withinthe melodic andharmonic material, the movement hints at an overriding senseofcircularity. A distanceistravelledbutlevelsofrepetitionensurethatthe destinationbearsaeasilyperceivableresemblancetothepointofdeparture. Nevertheless,aspectsofthisoverviewbetraysomethingmorecomplexthan mererecurrence;a‘pure’cycleisavoidedthroughalackofdirectrepetition.Inthis sense, Mozart evades the structural norms of a minuet with the wider opening section(A1–B–A2inFigure2.1).Insteadoftwodirectlyrepeatedpassages,heopts for a through-composed developing dialogue between the two instruments. The roles oftheviolinandpianoarenotlimitedbyanunchanginghierarchyofsoloist andaccompanist, nor are they presented as constant equals; rather, a give-andtakerelationshipissetinmotionwitheachoffering differentperspectives onthe thematic material. The return to the A-material after C also differs from the conventional model in which an unaltered restatement of the opening ‘minuet’ might be expected (often literally, with scores utilising a da capo instruction). Instead, onlyabriefglimpseoftheinitial material is permitted;the movementis instead curtailed by a looping coda, a consequent-oriented passage that might appear disproportionately long relative to the short reprise (A3) it supersedes. Durationstaken from recording listed in primary resource list(Rachel Podger, violin; GaryCooper.ChannelClassics:24607). 8 41 AlternativePaths Fig.2.2:ViolinSonatainEminorK.304,secondmovement,bars1–16(piano) Whilecyclicalqualitiesarestillmaintained,theeffectupontheoverallformofthe movementisoneofdynamism:thesmall-scaleonwarddevelopmentsofthematic materialareunderpinnedbywhatmightbethoughtofasaternaryforminwhich itsepisodesdiminishinduration,ifA1-B-A2istakenasalargeropeningsection. Consideringthedevelopmentalprocessesinthecourseofthis formaddsa further dimensionto the linear interpretation. Although the melodic material of theA-sectionsisconstructedinacontained,antecedent-consequentmanner,atno point does it appear in exactly the same form twice (see Figure 2.2for the ?irst appearance ofthe theme). The themes are passed between instruments, varied, transposed, shortened, extended, and juxtaposed withdifferent countermelodies andaccompaniments. Evenatthe outsetof A3 (frombar 128), the returnofthe primary theme is found in thepiano part anoctave lower thanits original form. Whenthe violin re-joins (from bar 135) it assumes this lower octave, the piano rising to thehigher octaveto present the melody inunisonwithits counterpart, notablythe?irst instanceofafullmelodicunisonheldthroughtotheculmination ofthesubject. Thismelodyoffundamentally circulardesignisrendereddynamicwithits components subjectedto spiralling developments, variations and changes. Never repeatedentirelyinitsoriginalform,theeffectofthesethematicchangesmightbe heard as one ofgradual fragmentation, of an entity that slowly loses track ofits ownshape.Inthissense,themelodyappearsunabletofullyaccessitsownhistory, 42 AlternativePaths Fig.2.3:ViolinSonatainEminorK.304,secondmovement,bars70–81 even for a very brief period of time as might usually be expected within a conventional Classical form through the employment of a recapitulation. Most notableinthis respectare moments atwhichmultipleexpressions ofthe melody aredisplaced, theinstruments divertingfromoneanother(seeFigure2.3).These failed returns are temporally signi?icant, their palpable melodic disintegration suggesting some kind ofirreversible linear process that is taking place within a broadercyclicalstructure. Cast in one nine-minute stretch of music, George Benjamin’s Viola, Viola doesnotexplicitlysubscribetoanykindofconventionalstructuraltemplateinthe same manner as Mozart. Nevertheless, a three-part form is audibly delineated throughtwomomentsofsilencethatactasstructuralmarkers(thedurationofbar 47 and within bar 153), facilitating both upward gear-shifts in both tempo and tension.Indeed,eachsectionprovesaudiblydistinctincharacter.However,aswith Mozart’ssonatamovement,suchevidentchangesfailtodispelabroaderfeelingof stasis.Althougheachsectionexhibitsnovelfeatures,theparallel charactersofthe outersegmentscontributeto whatcouldbeinterpretedasaternaryformofsorts 43 AlternativePaths Formalsegment Barnumbers Recordedduration 1)Vivace♪.=60-66 1–46 1’25 (Silentformaldivision) 47 0’05 2)Pochiss.Piùmosso♪.=66-69 48–157 6’28 (Silentformaldivision) Firstquarterof158 0’03 3)Pocopiùmosso♪.=76-80 Secondquarterof158–175 2’00 Fig.2.4:Benjamin,Viola,Viola,three-partstructuralplan Fig.2.5:Viola,Viola,bars1–19(reproducedfromBenjamin1997) (seeFigure 2.4): two stretches of unstable, jittery volatility ?lanking a prolonged outburstofstrident,ferociousviolence(albeitonewithacentrallull).9 TheparallelswithrhetoricalaspectsofClassicalstructuredonotendthere. As Philip Rupprecht observes in his harmony-centric dissection of the work, its opening(seeFigure2.5)comprisesthesuccessive‘collisions’of‘fourevents’which hehighlightsinthescore: a‘tuningA♮’(sustainedbetweenthe two violas inbars 1–12); fortissimo C-major ‘triads’ (appearing in bars 3, 8 and 9); ponticello ‘scurrying’(establishedasacontinuoussequencebetweenthetwoinstrumentsin bars 10–13); and a harrowing ‘drone’ comprising a low E♭ with C♯ harmonics (sustained between the two instruments in bars 14–19) (Rupprecht 2005, 31). Holdingtruetothisexpositorymannerofpresentation,itistheseeventsthatserve Durationstaken fromrecordinglisted inprimaryresource list(Tabea Zimmerman and AntoineTamestit,violas.Nimbus:NI5713.). 9 44 AlternativePaths to generate much of the piece. The motives audibly pervade the form, and are subjecttonumerouschangesanddevelopments.Indeed,theopeningofthesecond episode(frombar48)almostseemstoemulatethatofasonata-formdevelopment section, the opening ‘tuning A♮’ drone recommencing proceedings but now transposed to a D♮ and juxtaposed with harmonics ?irst on E♮ and then on C♮. Despitethemany changes thatoccur, thecontinuityofthepieceis underlinedby therecurrence ofRupprecht’s four motivic features withinthe closing section of the work: sharp chordal punctuations (from bar 158), scurrying passages (from bar163,briefglimpsesofdrone-likesustainedharmonics(frombar166). Whenadoptingaperspectivethatfocusesonrecurringcontentinthisway, itwouldcertainlyseemthatViola,Viola–throughanapparentrecyclingprocess– ends upback where it started. Ofcourse, as prominentas the features described mightappearfor alistener,thisperceivedcircularityisthe product ofaselective interpretation. As with Mozart’s sonata movement, there are two contrasting impressionsatworkhere:onearchitecturalandblock-like,theothercharacterised byonwardchange. Movingbeyondastructuraloverview to takeintoaccountthe moredetailed–andinmanycasesmoresubtle–changesthattakeplacewithinthe piece reveals these linear characteristics, allowing suchacategorical view ofthe worktobechallenged. Disintegration Inhis explorationofharmonyandtextureinViola,Viola, Rupprecht highlightsits composer’s aesthetic to generate interest in musical content, but ultimately to emphasise movement rather than stasis. He refers astutely to Benjamin’s own commentsregardingacruxinthemusicofbothOlivierMessiaenandElliottCarter. Carter’s ‘dry’ sonic environment does not preclude an ‘extraordinary power of continuity andof complex developments’; meanwhile, Messiaen’s music ‘remains generallystaticinitsmosaic-likeritual’inspiteoftheextraordinary‘individuality’ ofthe chordsit comprises.Theimplicationseemsto bethatBenjamin’s ideallies somewhere between the ‘being’ of Messiaen and the ‘happening’ of Carter (Rupprecht2005,32). 45 AlternativePaths ForRupprecht,thisstrived-forequilibriumisre?lectedinthetonallanguage of Viola, Viola, with its middle-register instrumentation acting as the perfect vehicleforaworkthatisnotrestrictedbythetexturalhierarchiesofconventional bass-centric harmonicstructures. Poweroftenstemsinsteadfromthecore ofthe texture with seemingly gravitational consequences for the surrounding material, controlnowexertedviawhathedescribesasa‘mirror-symmetricinversionabout a central pitchaxis’ (2005, 28–30). Inaural terms, theconsequence might bean audiblepulltowardsapointwithintheharmonictextureofagivenpassagerather than a guiding, or often overriding, tonal rooting below it – a kind of audible epicentre. An example that Rupprecht uses to argue this is the ?irst instance of the ‘scurrying’ motif in the second viola part (bars 10–12, see Figure 2.5), and the mannerinwhichthesecondhalfofeachbarrevolvesaroundD♮asacentralpitch sandwichedby semitones, perfect?ifths andminorsixths aboveandbelow(2005, 32). Themotifis also,notably,constructedfromasequenceoftritonedyads that, asRupprechtobserves,provesigni?icantforthelong-termplayingoutofthework. Rather than leaning towards consonance, Benjamin’s tritones prove generative throughanongoingdissonance:‘Its“willto resolve”isnotexactlyabandoned, but largelyevaded:tritonesstillsound‘dissonant’,buttheyprogresstoothertritones. […] Parallel motion by tritone dominates the voice leading’ (2005, 32–33). This unconventionalvarietyoftonalmotionfacilitatesabroader dynamismacrossthe piece, withtritoneshapespresentindifferentformsattheclimacticculminations ofboththe?irst(chordsbindingfourtritonedyads,bars33–46)andsecondformal segments(abroaderrecurring‘pedal’ofC♮andF♯spanningbars 138–57)(2005, 29–34).TheformalchangesofViola,Violaareinthiswaydemarcatedbyrecurring expressions of a ‘vertical’ harmonic relationship; a broadly static – or perhaps ‘non-linear’–featurepervadesalinearconstruction. However,perhapsthereisamoreaurallydistinguishableexpressionofthis duality.Thefour‘events’thatRupprechtoutlinesattheoutsetmightbeunderlined lessonaccountoftheirharmonicandtimbralcharacters,andmoreintermsofthe perceived temporal continuum they establish. Indeed, their collision-style effect might be a consequence of their extreme contrast. Viewing these motifs as symbolicofapolaritybetweenlinearandnon-linearfeaturesallowsthecontentof 46 AlternativePaths theworktobequanti?iedinamoreaccessiblemannerintermsofbothsoundand score.The‘events’fallalongaspectrumbetweensustained,horizontal(continuous time, typi?iedby the opening ‘tuning A♮’), ormomentary, vertical (discontinuous time: typi?ied by the sudden, fortissimo ‘triads’) gestures.10 The ‘scurrying’ and ‘drone’ motifs exist as hybrids that lean towards the vertical and horizontal extremes respectively, with their prolonged patterns punctuated by rearticulations.Followingthemusicalnarrativeaccordingtoapolarity–andoftena duality – between these notions of time and space reveals a dynamic musical journey;thisonwardmotion is enhancedbythe slight increase in tempo marked foreachofthethreeepisodes. Figure2.6offersanaccount oftheauralevents in thecourseoftheworkwithemphasisplaceduponthecontrastbetweenhorizontal andverticalgestures. To combine this continuous drama with thestructural overview explored earlier, it is possible to view Viola, Viola as a gradual process made accessible throughitstriptychform.Asseen,theexpositorysegmentofthework(bars1–46) starklyjuxtaposeshorizontal andverticalgestures that graduallybeginto merge; bars 36–46illustratethisblendingasshort,angularchordsseemtobecomemore and more sustained through interactions with ‘scurrying’ ?igures. The development-style centre seems to present an alternate perspective on the preceding‘exposition’,withthemusicat?irstrobbedofverticalpunctuations,only horizontalmaterialretained.Evenwheninterruptivestaccatooutburstsre-emerge from bar 56, they do so in rapidly succeeding pairs, contributing to the audibly goal-directedbuildintensionthatthepassageconveys. Thesepairedpunctuations operate conjunction with the scurrying ?igures as the ?irst climax is reached; vertical andhorizontal expressions are united within a teleological design. With thescurryingpassagesnowoutliningrepeatedsequencesofincreasinglengthand ever-ascending pitch, the paired outbursts eventually revert to a singular form. TheysignalabreakoutintothepeakoftheclimaxasalowD♮droneseepsoutfrom thescurrying,coupledat?irstwithaC♯andthenwithaG♯twooctavesabove,the tritone character of the augmented eleventh sustaining tension at a supposedly catharticstructuraljuncture(seeFigure2.7). 10 In this instance, it should be clariSied thatthis concept of ‘vertical time’ differsfrom JonathanKramer’suseofthatphrase(1988,375);heretheemphasisisonthemomentary natureofthechordsratherthanonbroaderlinearrelationshipsofcauseandeffect. 47 AlternativePaths Bars 1–46 47 48–55 Events 1)Vivace ♪.=60-66 Silentbar 2)Pochiss.Piùmosso ♪.=66-69 56–94 AscenttoUirstclimax 95–98 Firstclimax 99–102 ‘Timeless’lull 102–14 Firstclimaxresumes 114–22 Lull 122–38 Secondascenttoclimax 138–57 SecondClimax 158 Silencedottedcrotchet 158–75 3)Pocopiùmosso ♪.=76-80 Implications Contrasting motifs are introduced, with particular emphasis on a contrast between ‘horizontal’ (drones) and ‘vertical’ (brief chords) gestures, and slurred (‘scurrying’, in Rupprecht’sdescription) Sigurationsthat seem to offer a compromise between the two. The different ideas merge andcombine, propelled towardsa climaxthatisabruptlycutshort. A sudden absence of sound and audible rhythmic Slow creates a build in tension and also allows a clear structuraldivision. The piece appears to restart with a different sonority. However, this time only the ‘horizontal’ material is utilised. The sustained quiet dynamic serves to further heightentension. ‘Vertical’ material is gradually reintroduced, but disruptive chords now occur largely in immediately succeedingpairs,creatingamoredynamiccharacter. Frantic ascending Sigurations lead to a climax with fortissimochordspunctuatingsustaineddrones. Astrangeparallelpassageseepsgraduallyintothe midst of the climax, with the drones graduallyrobbed of tone and volume. For a short period of time they are transformedintoharmonics,renderingthemtransparent andalmostchorale-like. Promptedbyareturntotheheldfortissimonotesbythe Sirstviola,itisasiftheclimaxattemptstoresumeinspite of the interruption; but the sojourn has taken its toll, semi-stallingthepassageasifitwerenowtakingplacein slow-motion, movement in pitch and gesture now notablyhindered. Motion is gradually slowed further as passages appear fragmented, momentum lagging. Harmonics return in a chorale-like formationbrieSlyoncemore,whilstpizzicato isnotablyintroducedfortheSirsttime,seeminglyderived as inverted punctuations of the of the horizontal scurrying passages they are in dialogue; the scurrying passagesascend,whilstthepizzicatoSiguresdescend. Motion is returned through the triplet Sigures as they ascendagain,dynamicsbuilding.Fromb.132momentum is truly regained with loud dynamics and barrelling Sigures. Thesecondclimaxtakestheshape ofahorizontalwallof sound, a desperate attempt tosustain as much sonority as possible, demonstrated at an extreme in the case of trillingbetweendouble-stoppedchords. The second climax cuts itself brutally short with a fortissimochord. The shortsilencethatfollowsservesto create a structural break akin to the earlier break between‘exposition’and‘development’. The predominantly pizzicato conclusion ensures that – although related material is utilised –focus has shifted from ‘horizontal’ gestures to ‘vertical’ ones. Ratherthan ascending, the pitch material now largely descends. Passages are brief and fragmented. Although dynamics aremostlyquiet,evenfortissimooutbursts(includingthe closing chords) appear muted by comparison with the ferocityofthedevelopmentsection. Fig.2.6:Viola,Viola,listofeventswithemphasisonhorizontalandverticalgestures 48 AlternativePaths Fig.2.7:Viola,Viola,Uirstclimax,bars92–97(reproducedfromBenjamin1997) Within the lull that precedes the similarly tritone-capped second climax (bars138–157),the?irstinstancesofpizzicatointhepieceoccur:threedescending arpeggiated phrases of increasing length(bars 119–125), anapparent counterto the ascending phrases that have dominated the central section. Although this occurswithinthecontextofapredominantlyhorizontal passage, itpre?iguresthe ?inal, pizzicato-dominatedsegment ofthe piece (bars 158–75). Here, themusicis seemingly robbedof much of its previous horizontal material, withmost bowed materialnow dispensedwith.Themusic is, forthe?irsttime,riddledwithwhatto an audience might well interpret as silent pauses. The plucked techniques represent–bytheiracoustic nature–akindofverticality, aninabilitytosustain. Nevertheless,althoughtheexecutionmaydiffer,thematerialofthisthirdsegment isfarfromnovel:thedescendingfragmentsthatpervadetheepisodeseemtooffer an inverted perspective upon the ascending material that catalysed the earlier climaxes; beyond simply assuming a post-climactic status, the material seems deliberately anti-climactic. While abrupt vertical chords dominate, attempts to reignitehorizontal eventsareoftenstuntedorlimitedtothe textural background via pianissimomarkings. Whenthe scurrying material returns, theemphasis falls instead uponthe pizzicato phrases that punctuate it (for example, see bar 167). Meanwhile,severalnodsto thebygonedrones aremadethroughstrikingplucked 49 AlternativePaths accents in the secondviola, that are followed by the rapidly-fading afterglow of bowedfalseharmonicsinthe?irstviola(forexample,seethestartofbar170). Thesefeaturescontributeto agradual shiftinfocusfromthehorizontalto thevertical, fromdevelopmenttodisintegration, fromalinear,goal-directedform, to a non-linear, comparatively goalless one. After the sustained, horizontal materialhas facilitatedthe climaxes ofthecentral ‘development’, acrystallisation occursatthe start ofthe closing segment; the suddenpredominance of plucking rather bowed techniques creates a change in perspective, with emphasis now falling on vertical attack rather than horizontal prolongation. These acoustic propertiesimbueanoverallsensationofdecay,ofmaterialexpiringovertime.The notionofgrowthanddecay is also underlinedinmetaphorical termsthroughthe repeateduseofascendinggesturestoimbueasenseofgrowththroughthecentral section,atacticthatisinvertedthroughthedescending?iguresofthe?inalportion. As Rupprecht observes, this downward trend is re?lected in the long-term tonal scheme of the segment – the ‘acoustic chorale’, in his description – with a descending series of tritone dyads (2005, 35–37); a frustrated conclusion is provided by the emphatically repeated ?inal chord, its central pitch axis of B♭ juxtaposedwithsurrounding E♭s, with theadditionofC♮, C♯, D♮ andA♮ (seebar 175). Timelessness So far this case-studyhas beenarticulatedaccordingto dualities oflinearity and circularity. These temporalities have been mapped, through gestural and metaphorical means, onto wider experiences of time. Benjaminand Mozarthave implicitlyexploredthe ideaofdisintegrationordecay throughtheir treatment of material across forms; nevertheless, by rendering fundamental aspects of these processes audible throughgradualchanges andmetaphoricalgestures, bothoffer blueprints for meaningful interpretations that utilise these ideas. Reconsidering Mozart’s Tempo di Menuetto in terms of the gradual disintegration of its basic thematic material, Mozart realigns his content within the powerful coda, as if intent on evoking a kind of control over the conclusion – or perhaps the 50 AlternativePaths Fig.2.8:ViolinSonatainEminorK.304,secondmovement,‘C’theme, bars94–102(piano) destruction–ofthepiece. ThereactiontodecayinViola,Violaislessassertive, as its?inalpassagesstruggleinvaintoregainthesustained,accumulatingqualitiesit possessedatitsoutset.Itsculminationtakestheshapeofaresignation:notonalor motivicresolutionfound,littleinthewayofcatharsisachieved. Ofcourse, manyaspectsofmusical experience cannot beaccountedfor in terms of a contrast between linearity andnon-linearity. Articulating events that mightbeperceivedto occurbeyond thisduality is inevitablygoingto provemuch moredif?icult.Withemphasisnow shiftingfromlong-termstructureto theshortterm effect of particular musical gestures, focus now falls upon two parallel passages at theheartsoftheseworks;bothpointto atimealtogether apart from the continuous notions discussed, adding another dimension to the manner in which this music can be comprehended. The passage in question in Mozart’s Tempo di Menuetto is more structurally clear-cut, comprising the entirety ofthe central section ‘C’ (bars 94–127). The peculiar nature of the episode is compounded by the unprecedented switch to the tonic major, with the piano simply slipping suddenly andunambiguously into thenew mode atbar 94. What ensues feels, in one sense, a world away from the melancholy of the opening ‘minuet’.Therhythmic motionwithinthesepatternsappearslessfrantic, withthe initial subject consisting primarily of successive crotchets. The melody, too, is much simpler: a pulsating ?igure that falls gradually in steps but rises predominantly in leaps of ?ifths or sixths (seeFigure 2.8). The harmonic motion presentedis explicit andstable, withatriadicaccompanimentilluminatingclearly atonal paththatfavours conventionalshifts–usually utilising a circle of?ifths – ratherthanthechromaticslipsthatriddlethe‘minuet’. However, the section still bears relationto its surroundings. The melodic emphasisonacontrastbetweenstepwiseandleapingintervalsisstillreminiscent oftheprimary‘minuet’subject.Moreover,acasecouldevenbemadefortherising 51 AlternativePaths Fig.2.9:ViolinSonatainEminorK.304,secondmovement,‘A’(bars1–4)and ‘B’(bars94–101)sectionsubjectswithpitchgesturerelationshipindicated and falling gestures of the ‘C’ section theme representing a ‘slow-motion’ interpretationofthe‘A’subject(seeFigure2.9).Inadditiontothis,abroadersense of metre and construction is retained with the phrase structure of the ‘minuet’ replicated here: even-numbered measure divisions emphasise a continuing symmetryofantecedent-consequentrelationships. Theonlyexceptionto this is a moment of repose, four in-tempo beats of silence within the second repeated sectionbeforethe?inalphraseisplayed(bars118–19). In‘C’, thesamenotionsof cyclicity established in the earlier music are still present – arguably more so on accountoftheuseofliteralrepeatmarks.Butthe‘slow-motion’melodicstructure, therhythmic andtonalstabilityandtheuseofpausescontributetoasensationof detachment. It is as ifthepassage presents an alternatemusicalpath, running in paralleltotheouter‘minuets’,inwhichthesamesetofmaterialsistakeninavery different direction. The relevance of the episode to its surroundings is demonstratedaboveallintheeffortlessmannerinwhichasottovocereturntothe ‘minuet’ is initiated, a simple ascending chromatic scale of quavers in the righthandofthepiano(bar127b)allowinganalmostunnoticedslipbacktoE-minoras ifthemusichadsimplyregainedconsciousnesswithinitsoriginalspace. Thepassage inquestioninViola, Viola is much smaller, comprising just a few bars (bars 99–102). Here, at the ?irst point of climax in the central formal segment, the fortissimo peak suddenly drops away to reveal a sparse, fragile texture of harmonics moving disparately, almost in the style of a fragmented chorale (seeFigure 2.10). Withthe strikingclimactic gestures havingnow faded, theeffectisnotsomuchafree-fallasalossoftonalandrhythmicgravity.Boththe 52 AlternativePaths Figure2.10:Viola,Viola,bars98–105(reproducedfromBenjamin1997) D♮pedalandtheC♯andG♯juxtapositionsthathadcharacterisedthe?inalascentto theclimax vanish;the harmonics that remainavoidthese notes, sounding G♮, F♯, E♭, A♮, andC♮. Only at theclose of bar 101, with the emergence ofanA♭, is the previously overridingtritone relationship enharmonically referred to oncemore. This promptseems to triggera resurgence ofthe climactic material, but onethat onlyachievespartialsuccess.Therhythmicmotionthathadaccumulatedgradually from the start of the section has now been lost and efforts to reignite it prove stilted. Chordaloutburstsarelonganddrawnout andwiththe‘scurrying’?igures con?inedtopredominantlychromaticmovementswithinarestrictedpitch-space. Forallitsinterruptivequalities,theharmonicsarefarfromunrelatedtothe development of the piece, seemingly derived from the horizontal gestures (the ‘tuning A♮’ and the ‘drone’) at the outset. Yet here they emerge, unbound and undirected, robbing the ?irst major peak of the work of both momentum and impact. As with Mozart’s sonata movement, an alternative musical reality is presented,materialhithertoutilisedaspartofadynamic, goal-directedformnow brie?ly revealed in a static, detached fashion. The glimpse of this apparently parallel piece proves unsettling for the singular narrative ofViola, Viola, stalling theclimaxandinitiating, inthe long-term, a 19-barlullthat is onlyendedbythe startofanascenttowardsasecondpeak. 53 AlternativePaths Thesecentral passagesinthe Tempo di Menuetto and inViola,Viola prove paradoxical. Both give the effectthat they inhabit a time that lies beyond that of theirpieces,somehoweludingthetensionsoflinearityandcyclicitythatdominate. Nevertheless,theseepisodesremainas muchapartofthe‘practical’timeoftheir piecesas everythingelseinthem: theyrepresentanequallyquanti?iableduration withinthecontextofaperformance,andoccupyanunremarkableamountofspace withinthesingulardirectionofthenotatedscore. Itwouldnotbeaccurateto say that they appear wholly ‘non-linear’. Whilst they evade the linearity of the immediate, foreground musical narrative, they still possess their own linear temporal?low–theyarenotstatic. Here, it is appropriate to return to Jonathan Kramer, who makes a particularly useful distinction within his discussion of what he terms ‘vertical time’, a ‘present extended well beyond normal temporal horizons’ that nevertheless does not ‘destroy the temporal continuum’ (1988, 375–97). He distinguishes between timethat is ‘slowed’or ‘stopped’ (anacute, often restless, awareness of time passing) and time that is ‘frozen’ in an ‘eternal present’: timelessness.KramerconcurswithCliftonthatstaticmusicdoesnotleadmerelyto aperceivedabsenceoftime.Rather,asheoutlines,‘theavoidanceofmotionleads toaspecialkindoftime’: Theterm‘timelessness’doesnot, despiteitsetymology,implythattime hasceased toexist, butratherthatordinarytime has become frozen in an eternalnow… The extended presentcanexist. Whenit does,onlyone kind oftime issupended while anotherkind, that we may call (paradoxically) the time of timelessness, replaces it (Kramer1988,377–78). Perhapsitisthisideathatcomesclosesttoarticulatingwhatmightbeexperienced at these crux points in Tempo di Menuetto and in Viola, Viola. Whilst Kramer’s concernisthebroadereffectof‘non-teleological’music,hereMozartandBenjamin induce these sensations within the context of teleological pieces. Rather than simply bringing the primary (hitherto, only) temporal narrative to a point of standstill, both composers break off from it entirely for a brief period, its time continuedinstead withinthecontext ofasecondary narrative. As problematic as articulating it may prove, an experience of timelessness is offered within the context ofa dynamic artwork. It is aconcept that will recurin theanalyses that 54 AlternativePaths follow. Indeed, the ?irst port of call in the next case-study (Chapter Four: Perception and Perspective) will be a description that would seem particularly pertinent to this case-study, that of ‘released time ?lowing’. However, ?irst it is necessaryto expandfurtheruponthetheoretical frameworkforthisdiscussionof temporality. 55 Three DirectingTime Attempting to de?ine experiences of time in language might be seen as either a persistently fruitless task or one of limitless reward. Even a shared experience might be describedin very different ways by different individuals; their already unique perspectives might well divergefurther from oneanother whenthey are expressedthroughwords. By thesametoken, ourownexperiencesoftimemight often be subject to change; we might repeat fundamentally the same event at a later date only to ?ind that the temporal sensation it produces is markedly different.Justasreaders maydistinguishtheirownunderstandingofthe‘time’of thecase-studypiecesfromthe way they aredescribed inthisthesis, Imightalso return to them and?indthat theway Iperceiveaspectsofthe performances has changed. Hopesforclear articulationoftemporal experiences arefurtherclouded bythefactthattheyaredescribed‘aftertheevent’;writersareseparatedfromthe duration they wish to account for by a further elapsed duration. In this way, impressionsoftimerelyuponmemory–itselfsubjecttotemporaldistortions–for theirarticulation.Meanwhile, anyattempt toarticulateanexperienceoftimeasit happens(orimmediatelyfollowingit)islikelyto profoundlyaffecttheexperience itself through the heightened analytical awareness it would require. Of course, these various levels of ambiguity only serve to make our relationship with time seemallthemorefascinating. This chapter will begin by outlining ways in which time is commonly addressed, examining in particular the role of metaphor in this process and proposals fromanumber ofscholars – principallyDedre Gentner(2001)–as to the ways in which metaphorical concepts might emerge. Focussing upon the aspects of these descriptions that emphasise space, motion and change, the discussionwillcontinuebyreviewingofsomeofthetheoretical relationshipsthat underpinthis network oflinguisticideas, withthework ofIanHinckfuss (1975), RobertAdlington(1997a,1997band2003)andJ.M.E.McTaggart(1993)featuring prominently.Thiswillleadintoaclosingexplorationofthemovement–or?low– of time; numerous claims will be surveyed regarding questions of temporal 56 DirectingTime direction, linearity, and asymmetry, and the perspectives that we, as subjects, might have upon these phenomena; here emphasis will fall upon the work of Friedel Weinert (2013), Eric Clarke (2005) and P.J. Zwart (1976). Much of the discoursepresentedhere, particularlyearly on, isdeliberately detached fromthe musicalfocusofthisthesis.Itisintendedthatthissynthesisofapproachestowards time from a number of disciplines might help begin to construct a broad theoreticalframeworkwithinwhichtheensuingcasestudiesmightsit. Clutchingatmetaphors The intention of achieving true precision in addressing time is often misplaced. Whilst relativist approaches may have revolutionised strategies for dealing with time, itscontributionto any attempttodeUine it has beensurprisingly limited. As P.J.Zwartasserts,itisoftenonlyincircumstancesinvolvingextremesofspeedand distancethatanEinsteinianapproachcomesintoitsown: In fact the new relativistic time is nothing but the old common time with a relativisticcorrectionaddedtoitwhereandwhennecessary.Thisisshownclearly by the fact that Einstein’s famous analysis was notan analysis of the concept of time, butonlyan analysisofthe processof measuring time. In physicstime isnot deSined atall, oratthe mostonly as that quantitywhich ismeasured byclocks. (Zwart1976,9–10) Here,theinterestofconventionalphysicsliespredominantlyinquantitiesoftime. Zwartarguesthatthesubstanceofthesedurationsisamatterbeyonditsremit:‘In factitevencannotgiveade?initionoftimeallbyitself, forsuchade?initionwould haveto beprecededbyaphilosophical analysis inwhichamongother thingsthe uses and meaning(s) of the common sense concept of time would be examined’(1976,10). Friedel Weinert–inhis helpfully open-mindedsurvey ofthe development of different strands of temporal theory – offers a more inclusive perspective; he concedes that, whilst Einstein’s theory of Special relativity is best consideredan ‘extensionofclassicalmechanics’, itnevertheless‘hadarevolutionaryeffectonthe classicalnotionoftimeinthesamewayinwhichtheGeneral theoryhadeffecton 57 DirectingTime thenotionofspace’(2013, 64). Consequently, Weinert’s broader outlook proves less compartmentalised by ?ield, with temporal measurement considered a ‘ubiquitous phenomenon, whichtouches on all the central issues involvedinthe discussions ofthe nature oftime’ (2013, 86). Of course, reframing everything in interdisciplinary terms does not make describing time any easier. IanHinckfuss aptly observes that the task of referring to space andtime is one that we seem intent on assigning ourselves; he suggests that many problems arise from limitations inlanguage, raisingtheideathatthey areinfact ‘pseudo-problemsto be resolved by using a reformed language more appropriate in describing this world’(Hinckfuss1975,1). Most everyday language choicesregardingtimerely uponmetaphor. Time issaidto‘ebband?low’, it‘?lies’, it‘expands’,occasionallyiteven‘stops’. Although suchdescriptionsmayseemtofallshortofanykindofquanti?iableprecision,they act as far more than functional stopgaps. Instead, they attend to issues of perception, outlining important aspects of subjective experience. Indeed, numerous scholars in recent decades have argued that these parallels are embedded far deeper within cognitive processes, revealing metaphor to be, ?irst andforemost, a matter ofconcept. George LakoffandMark Johnson’s Metaphors We Live By (1980) has proven particularly in?luential in this regard. Reconsiderations of what constitutesmetaphor havepromptedLakoff to suggest subsequentlythatbroaderalterationstothelexiconofthesubject:whilstlinguistic devices might be referred to more speci?ically as ‘metaphorical expressions’, the term ‘metaphor’ in fact constitutes ‘cross-domain mapping in the conceptual system’: The generalisations governing poetic metaphorical expressions are not in language, butinthought. […]Inshort,the locusofmetaphorisnotinlanguage at all, butinthe waywe conceptualise one mentaldomainintermsof another. The general theory of metaphor is given by characterising such cross-domain mappings.Andintheprocess,everydayabstractconceptsliketime,states,change, causation, and purpose also turn out to be metaphorical. The result is that metaphor…isabsolutelycentraltoordinarynaturallanguagesemantics,andthat thestudyofliterarymetaphorisanextensionof the studyof everydaymetaphor. (Lakoff1993,203) 58 DirectingTime JannaSaslawarguesthattherootsofthismappingprocessmayevenbebiological, asserting that it stems from recurring patterns of ‘kinesthetic’ experience groundedprimarilyinthehumanbody(Saslaw1996,217–18). This pervasive character of metaphor is re?lected in philosophical discoursesregardingthenatureoftime.Here,metaphorscantakevariousshapes, withtimeactingasbotharesource(to ‘haveplenty’, orto‘runout’,oftime)anda container (to act ‘within’a period oftime) (Gentner, Imai and Boroditsky 2002, 560). However, most common temporal metaphors rely upon an image of movementofsomekind, or arelativelackofit.Motionis thetheme,whetherthe agency in these descriptions is ascribed to time (‘time passes’) or to people (‘to pass time’). Dedre Gentner identi?ies these descriptions – the ‘time-moving’ and ‘ego-moving’ metaphors – as the two distinct time-space metaphoric systems, noting ‘an orderly and systematic correspondence between the domains of time and space in language’ (Gentner 2001, 203). These linguistic links have been explored extensively by scholars including David Bennett (1975), Elizabeth Traugott(1978), and ManfredBierwisch(1996). PaticularlyintriguingisHerbert Clarke’s exploration of space-time metaphors in English language acquisition (1973),inwhichhearguesthatchildrenlearnhowtoapplyrelevanttermstotheir prior knowledge and experiences, with spatial expressions later extended to describetemporalphenomena: The main evidence for this thesis is the strong correspondence between the properties of the spatial terms and the properties of man's innate perceptual apparatus, and between English spatial and temporal expressions. The correspondenceissostrong,Iwouldargue,thatitsimplycouldnotbecoincidental anditthereforeneedsexplanation.Time,forexample,isnotjustexpressedwithan occasionalspatialsimile, butratheritisbasedon athoroughlysystematicspatial metaphor,suggestingacompletecognitivesystemthatspaceandtimeexpressions haveincommon.(Clarke1973,62) Casasanto, Fotakopoulouand Boroditsky(2010)argue in favourofthis mapping from familiar to less familiar concepts throughtheir experimental results. They ?indthatspaceandtimeareasymmetricallyrelatedintheminds ofchildren, with their subjects able to ‘ignore irrelevant temporal information when making judgments about space’, but incapable ofmaintaining suchseparationwhen it is 59 DirectingTime timethatisbeingjudged;itisapatternthatseemstobemirroredinthecognitive processingofadults(2010,403). Gentner refusestotakeforgrantedthat thesemappingproceduresarethe soleprovider ofspatio-temporal metaphor. Herlineofenquiryintothe linguistic linkingofspace andtimealsotakes into account thein?luenceoflong-developed idioms, entertaining the possibility that many phrases may be inherited rather than intuited. To evaluate this, she suggests three other cognitive roles that linguistic space-time mappings might play. Least plausible, she ?inds, is the possibility that theuseofparallel metaphors for space andtime is derived from comparabledirect similaritiesinphrasestructures –whatsheterms ‘locallexical relations’– rather than any systematic mapping relevant to the actual concepts thatlie behindthese phrases. This idea is echoed in thesecond, altogether more likelysuggestionof‘cognitivearcheology’:thatpeoplemaydefertoalinkbetween spaceandtimethat existsinthehistoryoflanguagewithoutanycontinuingneed to connect the two withinthe context of temporal reasoning. A third alternative Gentner presents is‘structuralparallelism’, in whichconceptual systemsofspace and time have been constructed entirely separately from one another, but similarities between the two independent cognitive structures allow for comparisonstobedrawnthroughlanguage(2001,205–06). Gentner’s evaluation of these further possibilities makes her ultimate preferenceforsystem-mapping–inwhichourconceptionsoftimearedrawnfrom our more readily articulated notions of space – all the more convincing (2001, 220): ‘An initial alignment between common relational structures invites the mapping of further inferences from the more systematic domain to the less systematic domain. Thus, candidate inferences are projected from the highly structureddomainofspacetothemoreephemeraldomainoftime.’Shealsopoints to the ways in which these mapping systems are represented in functional and expressiveaspectsofordinarylife,citinggraphs, clocks,timelines,drawingsand– appropriately–musicalnotation(2001,205). 60 DirectingTime Time,spaceandchange As Gentner’s work demonstrates, the cognitivewebofparallels andassociations thatlinkspaceandtimeiscomplexandnoteasilydeciphered.Evenifthelinguistic productsofthislink canbebrokendownintotwoprimarytypes ofmotion-based metaphor (ego-movingandtime-moving), comprehending fully thepsychological processes that leads to them proves impossible. Thetheoretical interdependence of space and time has been compounded in the course of the twentiethcentury through numerous theories – predominantly stemming from Einstein and Minkowski–thathavenecessitatedthecombinationofthetwo:spaceandtimeare frequently treatedas spacetime, ‘a unitary entity that decomposes into different spatialandtemporalintervalsfordifferentreferenceframes’(Dainton2010,314). John Earman (1970) offers a particularly astute navigation of some of the philosophicalquestions that arisewhen examining the intertwining of space and time,outliningthelogicalimplicationsofconsideringspace-timeasaunit. Distinctions can be made between the ways we treat space and time. Hinckfuss observes that often the language we use to address each can quickly becomeincompatible.Thattimecanbesaidto‘?low’whilstspacecannotisjustone of a number of notions that allows separations to be made. Indeed, itis motionbasedconceptionsoftimethatcreatethebiggestrifts,withthetemporalplacingof ‘now’or ‘present’differingin anumberofsenses from the spatial placing ‘here’; thepotentialassociationsthatthe‘present’canbearwithmovementdistinguishes it altogetherfrom asupposedlyunchanging, categoricallocation(Hinckfuss 1975, 63–83). Anthony Quinton, meanwhile, draws attention to an apparently unique quality of time through a series of logical conjectures involving dreams and potential multi-temporal myths, concluding that we can conceive of things in distinctspacesbutnotindistincttimes, ourexperiencesbeingcon?inedtoasingle temporal series. Furthermore, he asserts that it is possible to conceive of an experience that is non-spatial, but impossible to conceive of a non-temporal experience(1993,203–20). Ofcourse, as withtheseexamples, manyexceptionsto thelinkingofspace and time occur within theoretical realms. Hinckfuss issues repeated reminders that ?inding time andspaceto possess exclusiveproperties does not necessarily 61 DirectingTime equate to a fundamental difference between the two; rather it only indicates a difference in semantics (1975, 82). For reasons of function, it is perhaps best to acceptafundamentalrelationshipbetweenspaceandtime,notleastwithregardto music. Whilstitismetaphorical conceptionsofmotionthatservetoseparatetime from space, it is physical motion that unites them. The three – time, space and motion– arecommonlytakenfor grantedas forming a web of interdependence: the perception of one typically requires the perception of all three. Music itself comprisesformsofmotion:the movements of performers uponinstruments, the kinetic nature of travelling sound particles, the biological and neurological impulses that allow sound to be received and comprehended. David Epstein deployssuchfundamentalideas fullyandwithoutapology, describingmotionnot just as ‘the quintessential property of time’ but also ‘the essence of life itself’: ‘Motionisbasically understoodby usingtimeasitsindex.[…]Thereverseofthat correlationisequallytrue:timeisonlyexperienced,andthusunderstood, through motion’(1995,8). Robert Adlington (1997a, 1997b and 2003) calls Epstein’s thesis into question, expressing concerns regarding the logical contradictions that might plague such assumptions. Both scholars have distinctmotives; it is verymuch in Epstein’s interestto acceptsuchviewsoftime andmotiongiventhethrustofhis work, which largely revolves around proportional relations in metre and speed acrosstonal pieces largely composedinthe eighteenth andnineteenth centuries. Adlington’s interest, meanwhile, lies primarily in addressing the ways in which such frameworks of motion-based description do not adequately serve the best interestsofmanytypesofmusic,inparticularpost-tonalworks,manyofwhichare often written off as ‘static’. Crucially, though, his concerns stretch further, encompassing the potentially damaging impact that ‘hardened’ concepts of time mighthaveuponpeople’s lives.Forthepurposesofhisargument, andinorderto evaluateaspectsoftheseeffectsofimposedtemporalparameters,Adlingtontreats timeas‘asocialconstructionfordealingwithchange’(2003,298–300). Change–asafundamental expressionofmotion–has lainat thecentreof discourse regarding temporality for thousands of years; for Aristotle, time and change possess what Weinert surmises as a reciprocal relationship: ‘Without change, there can be no recognition of time; and without time, there can be no 62 DirectingTime measurementofchange’(2013, 8–10). Indeed,Aristotle’squanti?icationofchange through conceptions of ‘before’ and ‘after’ bears great relevance to McTaggart’s starting point in his in?luential ‘The Unreality of Time’ (McTaggart 1993). His argument for this ‘unreality’restson a distinction betweentwo ways ofviewing time:oneisuntensed(the‘Bseries’),relyingon?ixedpointsinanabstractedtime that lie earlier or later than one another. The other is tensed (the ‘A series’), utilising subject positioning to organise events according to past, present and future within thecontext ofa ‘moving now’.11 Change, McTaggart asserts, relies uponthe A series; characteristics ofanevent canonly change by virtue of their context within the on-going shift from future, to present, to past. Whilst the B seriesremainsabstracted,itnonethelessreliesuponthetensedtemporalityofthe A series, giventhatearlier-laterrelationshipsrequiretemporalpassage. Thus,the B series cannot exist without the A-series. As one event cannot simultaneously possess the characteristics ofpast, present andfuture, the realityofthe A series leadstoanunavoidablecontradiction–bothseriesmustberejected.Onthefaceof it,McTaggart’sconclusionmightprovesomewhatstartling: Nothing isreallypresent, past, or future. Nothing isreallyearlierorlaterthan anything else or temporally simultaneous with it. Nothing really changes. And nothing isreallyin time. Wheneverwe perceiveanything in time–whichisthe only way in which, in ourpresent experience, we do perceive things –we are perceivingitmoreorlessasitreallyisnot.(1993,34) Whilst McTaggart’s ‘proof’ of the unrealityof time has loomed large in temporal philosophyeversince,itschallengesunderpinningmuchsubsequentdiscussion,it has only served to open the debate yet wider rather than to narrow it. More broadly, it hassatMcTaggart alongsidemanyotherswho chooseto view time as fundamentallyidealised,thatistosayaproductofthehumanmind;McTaggartin factsitswithinatraditionthatincludesKantandAugustinebeforehim,asWeinert observes(2013,97–98). 11 To put it another way, the ‘A-series’ is a series of positions (containers for events) runningfromthepast,throughthepresent,andintothefuture–itislargelyreSlectiveofa ‘time passing’ perspective; the ‘B-series’,meanwhile,assumesa ‘passing time’ approach, organising positionsbyvirtueofwhentheyoccurrelativetootherpositions.Asuggested C-seriesoffersanextra-temporalinterpretationofperceivedorder,thoughcruciallynotof changeortime. 63 DirectingTime Weinert’s description of McTaggart’s ‘proof’ as ‘verbal summersaults’ proves ?itting (2013, 98), not least when taking into account subsequent writers who have helpfullyreframedhisargumentwithinacontextofseeking to address and qualify time. D.H. Mellor’s ‘The Unreality of Tense’ (1993) does just this, evaluating the ways in which change and variation might be articulated whilst allowinghis focustoremainasmuchontensedanduntenseddescriptors. Arthur Prior, meanwhile,skilfullydraws attentiontotheconceptsweattachtonotionsof change, event and process, and how these ideas can often be misattributed in discussion (Prior, 1993). Also intriguing is Sydney Shoemaker’s compelling argumentforthehypotheticalbutnonethelessintriguingpossibilityofintervalsin time that couldbe perceivedwithout thesupposedly essential markerof change (Shoemaker,1993). Insearchofdirection Paul Horwich (1987) takes McTaggart’s work to particularly intriguing ends. Sidestepping a preoccupation with perceiving change itself, his focus lies in the three statesoftheA-series:past,presentandfuture. Whilst Epsteinholds change to bethequintessential propertyoftime, Horwichsuggeststhatitmight bemore speci?icallyde?inedas‘thedifferencebetweenthepastandthefuture’,onaccount ofthetwo temporaldirectionsbeing‘fundamentallyunalike’.Itisinthisrespect– of temporal ‘movement’ being possible in one direction but not the other – that time is judged to be asymmetrical. To an even greater degree than McTaggart, Horwich rejects a ‘moving now’ view of time, but in doing so establishes an especiallyinsightfulaccountsofthewayinwhichsuchaconceptionisformedand therolesitplaysinthewaystimeisthoughttoplayout.Heattributesthesenseof time passing or ?lowing to causes phenomenological (the psychological constructionofacontinuumbetweenrecollectionandanticipation)andlinguistic (descriptionsoftheplacingofeventsalongthatcontinuum).Referringtothework ofAdolfGrünbaum(1973),heproposesthatthenoun‘now’acquiresthestatusof ‘asingleentitywhosevaryinglocationsareinstantsoftime’.Hisexplorationofthe asymmetries oftimegivesriseto a numberofwaysofapproachingthelong-held 64 DirectingTime notion of time possessing a ‘direction’, including the ‘tree model of reality’, in whichhistory represents a ?ixed pathand the future aproliferation of potential branches;andfatalism,inwhichacausalapproachtotimeseesthe?ixednatureof historical events contributing to a future paththat is also ?ixedby consequence (Horwich1987,15–36). This view of temporality as a ‘cause-effect relationship of events’ has contributedto theon-goingconsiderationofthe topologyoftime, reinforcingthe suggestion that time might be thought ofas moving inalinear fashion(Weinert 2013, 26–30). A directional view of time continues to prove of both use and intereststoscholarsacrossanumberof?ieldsinspiteoftheoriesthatcontradictit. Zwart comprehensively concludes that the direction of time is ‘non-existant’, contenttothinkofitassimply‘asuccessionofeventsandofstates’: ‘Theopinion thattime,beinga?low, musthaveadirectionisjustas incorrect aswouldbethe opinionthatastreamofwordsmusthaveadirection’(1976,103–05). This remarkofZwart’sis particularly telling. Inthesamesensethatmany linguistic constructions can appear to us as possessing some kind of ‘direction’, perhapsasimilarprocessisfrequentlyundertakenwithtime. Timeitselfmaynot possess a linear character, but subjective experience seems to project such a qualityontoitwithsurprisingregularity.Regardlessoftherealityofphysicaltime, spatio-temporal metaphors of motion continue to provide a widely understood and highly transferrable framework for discussion. Though the more speci?ic mechanics of theories may vary, there is consistent imagery to be noted across manymajortheories oftime. Thecontrastbetweenego-movingandtime-moving metaphorsthatGentnerpresents(2001,203–05)issimplyareframingofwhatshe summarisesasa‘front/back’interpretationofthetimeline: Inthe ego-moving system, the future isnormallyconceivedof as infront and the pastasbehind.Inthetime-movingsystem,thereverseistrue:timemovesfromthe futuretothepast,sothatpast(earlier)eventsareinfrontandfuture(later)events arebehind. Such an approach bears much in common with Smart’s ‘river of time’ analogy(1949)–tobe discussedinmore depthinChapterFour–butisperhaps morebroadlyre?lectiveofawidertrendofcontraststhatdatesbackasfaraspreSocratic philosophy. Weinert draws a distinction between what he terms 65 DirectingTime ‘Parmenidean Stasis’ and ‘Heraclitean Flux’, derived from their eponymous thinkers(2013,89–90).ThepoetParmenidesofEleaadvocatedanidealistoutlook of unchanging‘being’, in which change andthus time are merelyproducts ofthe human mind. Heraclitus of Ephesus, meanwhile, denied an unchanging ‘being’, expressinginsteadapreferenceforafundamentalworldofchangingappearances; his employment of river imagery – ‘we cannot step into the same water yet the riveristhe same’–seems to haveprovedparticularly formativeformetaphorical approaches to temporal thought. In thecourseofhissurvey ofthe way in which strands of temporal theory have developed in light of scienti?ic discoveries, Weinerthighlights thepervasivenatureofthiskindofdistinction. Most temporal theory is ultimately alliedto eitheraParmenidean, idealist (frequentlytied with realistnotionsoftimeasanindependent,consistentpropertyoftheuniverse)ora Heraclitean, relationalperspectiveontime. Respectively, changeiseither illusory orfundamental,timeiseitherstaticordynamic,andtheworldiseitheratemporal ortemporal. Weinert’s achievement in The March of Time is the intricate manner in whichheoutlinesbothsidesofthisfundamentaldivide,demonstratingeloquently theprincipaltheoriesthatunderpinthecontrastsbetweenperspectivesof?luxand stasis, and between temporal symmetry and asymmetry. He ultimately states a preferenceforaHeracliteanviewoftime, principallyonthebasis oftheapparent anisotropic (that is to say,asymmetrical ordynamic)natureoftimeas explained throughthe quantummechanism ofdecoherence.12 It is an argument thatI ?ind particularly convincing and, although it is not a primary aim of this study to support broader claims regarding the nature of time itself, Weinert’s balanced approach to the ?ield has proved particularly informative and might be said to providesomethingofatheoreticalunderpinningformuchofwhatfollowshere.Of greaterrelevanceishisimplicitacknowledgementthatcontrastingunderstandings oftemporality(relational, idealist andrealist)canallfeaturenotonlyaselements a philosophical examination of time, but also as facets of subjective experience. Musical phenomena, as will be shown, can serve to underline this pluralist, perhapsevenparadoxical,characteristicoftime. 12AdetailedexaminationofquantumdecoherencecanbefoundinWeinert2013,211–59. 66 DirectingTime GoingwiththeUlow Maintaining some kind of lexicon of metaphor is particularly useful when addressing atopic as potentiallyconfusing asmusic, where thesewaters become increasingly muddied. Whilstit might ?irst appearto take on akindofmediating roleintemporalperceptionprocesses,furtherinvestigationmayreveal thatithas a disrupting presence. Articulating experiences of motion becomes particularly tricky:doesthemusic movethroughtime, ordoestimemovethroughthemusic? Similarly, as listeners, do we move throughthemusic, or doesthemusic pass us by?Itis,asAdlingtonnotes(2003,299),possibletoexperienceeither.EricClarke’s consideration of such questions leads him to invoke the idea of ‘subjectpositioning’, a term primarily employed in cultural and ?ilm studies (2005, 91– 125). Subject-position, Clarke explains, ‘describes the way in which the construction of a ?ilm causes a viewer/listener to adopt a particular attitude to what she or he is witnessing’ (2005, 92). He readily concedes that subjectpositioningwillofteninvolvean‘utterlyindividual’perspectiveonthepartofeach listener, incorporatingthe perceiver’s ‘skills, needs, preoccupations, andpersonal history’.Nevertheless,heoutlinesthewaysinwhichthenotionofsubject-position might not just inform but also direct analyses of both vocal and instrumental works, on account of its profound ecological implications. He asserts that an importantcomponentofsubject-positioningis‘builtintothematerialpropertiesof theobjectofperception, andisthereforea shaping force (at least potentially)on everyperceiver’(2005,125). One of the most detailed and compelling frameworks for metaphors of musical motion is provided by Mark Johnson and Steve Larson (2003). They proposethreeprincipalconcepts: the‘movingmusic’metaphor, inwhichmusical eventsmovefrom thefuture towards thelistener, areexperienced, andpassinto thepast;the‘musicallandscape’metaphor,inwhichthepiecetakestheshapeofan imagined geography and can be experienced from either the perspective of an active participant (or traveller) or a distant observer; and the ‘musical force’ metaphor, in which pieces act as causal forces uponlisteners. Beyond providing comprehensiveexplorations of lexiconsforeachframework, JohnsonandLarson 67 DirectingTime are above all realistic about the variety of musical motions that are available throughouthistoryandacrosscultures: The absence of any core literal concept of musical ‘events’ should direct our attention to the ways we imaginatively conceive of the Slow of our musical experiencebymeansofmultiple metaphorsthatprovide the relevantlogicsofour various conceptions of musical motion and space. There is no more a single univocal notion of musical motion than there is of causation, and yet we have gottenalongreasonablywellbyknowingwhenaspeciSicmetaphorforcausationis appropriatewithinaspeciSiccontextofinquiry.(2003,80) Ultimately,speci?icaspectsofmusicalandtemporalmotionprovesecondarytothe ways in which metaphors for such motion can facilitate discussion of pieces of music in relation to our experience of them. Signi?icantly, Clarke points to the deeperimplicationsofmeaningthatarise(2005,89):‘Thesenseofmotionorselfmotion draws a listener into an engagement with the musical materials in a particularlydynamicmanner(heorsheseemsto actamongthematerials),andin doingsoconstitutesavitalpartofmusicalmeaning.’ Beyond purely motion-based descriptions, Robert Adlington offers a convincing account of the ways in which some music can inspire a plethora of altogether distinct metaphors (1997b, 79–120, and 2003). Seeking primarily to advocateavarietyofwaysinwhichpost-tonalworksmightbeaddressedinmore accurate, andindeedmoreimaginativetermsthan‘static’,he equatesthe view of musicasmovingwithculturalconceptsoftime(2003,317–318): […] change possesses no intrinsic properties that give it a special afSinity with onward motion over anyof the otherphysical metaphorsbymeans of which we mightgrasp it. Anotherwayof expressing thiswould be asfollows: music,partly byvirtueofitssusceptibilitytometaphoricalconceptualisation,implicitlypointsto thelimitationsofourcustomarydealingswithchange. In this sense, musical experiences might be regarded as querying cultural conceptionsoftemporality.Indeed,inthecourseofthechaptersthatfollow,pieces of music can be seen calling into question aspects of time generally taken for granted. Temporal asymmetry is engaged with through the notion of musical repetition,raisingthepossibilityofsimultaneouslylinearandcircularexperiences; 68 DirectingTime this recurrence of musical ideas encourages alternate perspectives on the irreversibilityoftime. Itisuseful heretorecallThomasClifton, withhisassertion that‘continuityisinvolvedintheopennessoftime:intheideathatpasteventsare not forever sealed off from a present which constantly re-searches it, and that futureeventsdo notresideinsomeunknowable“other”, ignoring,andignoredby, thepresentsituation’(1983,97).Indeed,thisnotionofapastthatcanberevisited – in both musical and cognitive terms – will underpin the case-study pairing of worksbyAdamsandSchubertthatfollows,withtheiropeningpassagesexamined in terms of the perceptual implications for their unfolding form (Chapter Four: PerceptionandPerspective). The singularity of perceivedtimewill alsobe called into question, withmusical forms emergingthat offerimpressions of multiplicity (see Chapters Six and Ten in particular). Jonathan Kramer holds a particular interestinwhathelabels‘multiply-directedlinear time’,referringto music which possesses a ‘sense of motion, but the direction of that motion is anything but unequivocal’; although an underlying linearity can be recognised, for Kramer a displacementofvariousformal goalscanprovide amultipletemporal continuum (1988,46). A major part ofaddressing the temporality of music through language is accepting inevitable inconsistencies. Indeed, it can be easy to discount the very effectthatlanguagecomprehensionitselfcanhaveuponthewaywemightexpress anunderstandingofmusic. Onerecent set ofcross-cultural psychological studies carried out by Athanasopoulos, Tan and Moran (2016) has suggested a link between linguistic ability and perceived temporal directionality. When participantsintheUK,JapanandPapuaNewGuineawereaskedtoprovidegraphic representations of rhythmic patterns, literate participants were morenoticeably disposedtolinearinterpretationsofmusicalperformances, displayinga‘tendency to depict informationalong a timeline, inamanner generally consistentwiththe directionality of their script’; non-literate participants, meanwhile, appeared to displaynoclearrelianceupondirectionality(2016,1139).Suchstudiesarefurther indicatorsas to theculturalcomplexity ofthefactorsthatcontributetowards not only how weexperiencemusicbutalso how wemight thenattemptto articulate thatexperience. 69 DirectingTime In light of these variables, establishing a consistent framework for the discussion of musical time proves especially dif?icult. However, to bring this discussiontoatemporaryclose,itishelpfultoreturntoZwartinhisevaluationof three prominent outlooks on the nature of time: the realist view, that time is a physicalpropertyoftheuniverse,on-goinginspiteofoccurrence;theidealistview, thatthe passage of time is a construction of thehumanmind; and therelational view, that the passage of time is dependent upon and effected by changes, processes and events in the universe (Zwart 1976, 15–33, also discussed in Weinert2013, 14). Hisconclusionhighlightsadeptlywhymusicalinterests might lieinthe notions thattherelationalperspectiveontimemight offer,hinting once againatthepeculiarnotionoftimelessness: Common sense does not have a clear and distinct conception of time; its conception is confused and contains all sorts of different and contrary elements alongsideeachother.Thatthecommonsenseviewismainlyrealist,forinstance,is evidencedby the factthatinthisviewtime wouldSlowon even if therewere no world,thatin the voida beforeandan aftercouldstillbedistinguished.Butthere is also a strong relational element in this view, for, to common sense, time is intimatelyconnectedwithchange.Theword‘time’makesusthinkintheSirstplace of events and processes, and not of stationarystates. In this respect it is highly signiSicant thatone iswontto sayof some out-of-the-wayvillage where nothing changes thatit isasif time were standing still there. Thisis clearevidence fora relationalviewontime,forontherealistviewtheconceptof time standingstillis completelymeaningless.(Zwart1976,33) Sucha?lexible attitude – andone so considerate towards temporal experience – seemstobeskilfullyre?lectedintheconclusionsofJohnsonandLarson, whogoto lengths to emphasise that ‘what is true of musical motion is equally trueof our incompatibleconceptionsoftimeand,generally,ourinconsistentconceptionsofa vastrangeofabstractconcepts’: Our claim is that each of these different, and often inconsistent, metaphorical structuringsofa conceptgivesusthedifferentlogicsthatweneed tounderstand the richness and complexityof our experience. Howeverstrong ourdesire fora monolithic consistent ontology might be, the evidence does not support such a uniSiedandsimpleviewofhumanexperience.(2003,80) 70 Four PerceptionandPerspective JohnAdams&FranzSchubert Ina1928essay,TheodorAdornohighlightedpoetically–ifperhapshistrionically– the problems posed by Franz Schubert’s relationship to his outwardly radical contemporary Ludwig van Beethoven. He notes a difference in the expressive musical characters perceived, asserting that ‘althoughSchubert’s music may not always have the power of active will that rises from the inmost nature of Beethoven,itsendemicshaftsand?issures leadtothesamechthonicdepthwhere thatwillhaditssource’: Yetthe starsthatburnforSchubert’smusicarethe sameasthosetowardswhose unattainable light Beethoven’s clenched Sist reached out. So when it comes to Schubert’smusic we speak of ‘landscape’. Nothing could betray the substance of his music more – since he cannot be understood in terms of Beethoven’s spontaneously integrated personality – than trying to construct him as a personalitywiththeidea–avirtualcentre–ofpuzzlingoutdissociated elements. (Adornotrans.DunsbyandPerrey2005,7) Although subsequent commentary has not been so heavily dogged by the misplacedexpectationsthatAdornosoughttoaddress,thecruxofthiscomparison haslingered. Beethoven,forsome,hascometorepresentanovert–ifnotanideal – representative of musical progress. Schubert, by implication, sidestepped the revolution. In reality, of course, things could never be quite so black and white; just because Schubert did not subscribe to the kind of innovation that Beethoven espoused,itcouldneverleavehisartstagnantinitswake.Exploringthe‘depths’to which Adorno alluded, more recent scholarship has in fact pointed to a radical compositional approach. Publications such as the 2003 multi-author volume SchuberttheProgressiveattesttoawidespreadeagernesstorenewthecontextsin which his work is considered (Newbould 2003). Susanne Kogler’s contribution seeks to posit anotably‘modern’perspective, placinghis musicinthe context of contemporary composition, utilising both the outlooks and the music of Dieter 71 PerceptionandPerspective Schnebel(principally hisLiederohneWorte writtenbetween1980and1986)and Wolfgang Rihm (his WölUli-Liederbuch of 1980–81) in conjunction withAdorno’s essay. Her means is anunderlining ofSchubert’s skill in engineering perceptual time and an exploration of the ways in which this foreshadows the expressivity found in the ‘emotionalised’ New Music establishedinthe 1970s. Emphasised in particularistheeffectof‘timelessness’(Kogler2003,89–100). TheabilityofSchubert’s musictoseemingly‘escape’theregularpassageof time emerges frequently in responses to his music, especially his instrumental work. A 2012 survey in The Guardian newspaper, for example, canvassed musicians and listeners, asking each participant to select and discuss their favourite Schubert piece. Not only did pianist Stephen Hough and actor Simon Russell Beale both select examples from Schubert’s ?inal trilogy of piano sonatas butbothmadereferenceto histreatmentofmusicaltime, concurringwithKogler inhighlightingitasindicativeofhis‘progressiveness’.Houghoutlinedparadoxical sensations in the Andantino of the A-major sonata D. 959, describing it as ‘prophetic yet timeless’, whileRussell Beale discussedthe‘experimental’Andante sostenutooftheB♭-majorsonataD.960intermsofthecomposer’sabilityto‘make timestandstill’: It is as if he has distilled the process of music-making. He takes a harmonic progression, exploresit, changesa singlenote, exploresitagain;hebreaksdowna simplemelodyuntilonlythebonesareleftandthemusicissuspended.Theresultis aplayofpuresound,withoutexternalreference,thatgivesusaglimpseofeternity. (Service2012) Ratherthanacommonplacecon?lationofprogressandcomplexity,thefocus here is simplicity. This reductive approach can lead to surprising extremes, with absenceseeminglytakingonanincreasinglyactiverole.Koglerisquickto ground thisnotionwithintherealmsofhumanperception,observinga‘dialectic’between soundandsilence(2003,89–92). This pragmatism also proves useful with regard to Schnebel’s similarly melodramatic portrayal of the power of musical repetition. From his musings, Kogler delineates two basic ‘structural elements that determine the timeappearance of the sound’: ‘immediate time’ (points of time) and ‘time passing by’(?lowingtime). A thirdtemporal category is outlinedwithspecial referenceto 72 PerceptionandPerspective Schubert’s work: ‘[…] time is ?lowing totally naturally, which makes us almost forget its transitoriness. It appears so much as unfolding of itself that the compositionalwillseemstodissolveinitsvegetativecharacter.[…]Thus,released time starts ?lowing’. Kogler elaboratesonthese ‘enclaves ofspatial andtemporal distance’:‘AccordingtoSchnebel,thesepassagesrefertoachangeofperspective… and therefore stand out strikingly against their sound environment. They constituteextra-territorialmomentsbeyondtime’(2003,90–91). Placingperspective Both Schnebel and Kogler draw on valid experience when recalling Schubert’s music in these terms; as shown above, they are far from alone inreferring to a profound ‘timeless’ quality. Their attempts to de?ine and quantify these experiences help to address contradictory aspects of temporal experience. To conclude that any musical passage occurs beyond time – even in poetic or perceptual terms – is, of course, to turn a deliberately blind eye to music’s fundamental grounding in the linear reality of time; as Kogler herself acknowledges,‘musicmaterialisesasastreamofsound’(2003,89). Nevertheless, as discussed earlier, the temporary musical effect of ‘timelessness’iswidelyrecognised.Indeed, partoftheattractionofsuchmoments or episodes lies inthefactthat, forall their apparentevasivequalities, themusic never leavesthe passageoftime, evenperceptually. Evenasense oftimelessness could only ever be understood within the context of time passing; to assert otherwise would be a leap of pure subjective interpretation. This seemingly illusoryfeaturecanbe adaptedto assumebroadformalsigni?icance, contributing static or detached experiences within the context of a linear actuality. Jonathan Kramer is quick to assert the linear context of musical timelessness within his wider discussion of what he terms ‘vertical time’, claiming that suchmusic ‘can provoke intense and unusual responses, but it does not destroy the temporal continuum’. In spite of the unwavering continuation of time, the variety of experiences availablewithinthedepths ofthe‘extendedpresent’, as Kramerputs 73 PerceptionandPerspective it, is surprising; as well as the distinct ‘lack of time’ that ‘timelessness offers’, perceptualtimemightalsobe‘frozen’,‘slowed’or‘stopped’(1988,575–81). Isit possible to explorethese perceptualcomplexitieswithoutlosing sight ofthedirectnessand,aswiththiscase,thesimplicityofthemusicalconstructions thatarouse them? Theseexperiencesare awidelyaccessible aspectofSchubert’s work; surely they embrace more fundamental aspects of listening? If so, maybe theseperceptualprocessesneednotbethoughtofinsuchintricateterms.Perhaps Kogler’sinitialde?initions–oftimeaseitherimmediateorpassing–havemoreto offer. Surely a third temporal category of ‘released time ?lowing’ – for all its professeduniqueness – is infact some kind of simultaneous experience of both pointed and ?lowing time in combination. Indeed, are immediate and passing temporal states usually experiencedentirely independent of one another? Ifthe passageoftimeistakenasaconstant, thensurelythedifferencebetweenpointed and?lowingtimeiswhollyoneofperspective,shiftsintheattentionoflisteners. Articulatingtemporalpositionsisachallengingtask. IntheFourthCentury, Augustine grappled withthe notionofapresent ‘so made that it passes into the past’: ‘So indeedwe cannot say that time truly exists except in thesensethat it tends towards non-existence’ (trans. Chadwick 1991, 231). Keen to examine conceptsusuallytakenforgranted,hecontinuesbydismantlingthenotionsofpast and future, dismissing them – like much functional language – as inaccurate description: Perhapsitwouldbe exacttosay:there arethreetimes,apresentof thingspast,a presentofthingspresent,apresentofthingstocome.[…]Thepresentconsidering the past is the memory, the present considering the present is immediate awareness,thepresentconsideringthefutureisexpectation.(1991,235) EchoingAugustine’semphasisuponthesubjective,Kramerreframestheseideasin aesthetic terms: ‘The present is not simply the place where perception happens, not simply the place from which linear and nonlinear perception are projected respectivelyintothefutureandpast. Itisalso themeetinggroundofmemoryand anticipation,bothofwhichcolourperception.’(1988,367) Thesediscussionsoftemporalperspectivemayleadtofurtherquestionsof subject positioning and dynamism – put simply, does time pass by or is time passed? Reimagining the concepts that underpinMcTaggart’s ‘The Unreality of 74 PerceptionandPerspective Time’(1993,introducedpreviouslyinChapterThree)inanotablymoreaccessible manner, J.J.C. Smart introducesissuesofsyntaxandmetaphortothe discoursein hisessay‘TheRiverofTime’(1949). His openingremarksseemhighlyapplicable toaestheticexperience: Wesaythatweareadvancingthroughtime,fromthepastintothe future,muchas ashipadvancesthroughtheseaintounknownwaters.Sometimes,again,wethink of ourselvesasstationarywatching time go by, justaswe maystand ona bridge and watch leaves and sticks Sloat down the stream underneath us. Events, we sometimes think, are like such leaves and sticks; theyapproach from the future, aremomentarilyinthe present,and thenrecede furtherandfurtherintothe past. ThusinsteadofspeakingofouradvancethroughtimeweoftenspeakoftheSlowof time.(1949,483) Indeed,theseimpressionslieattheforefrontofEdwardA.Lippman’sdiscussionof canonic works inhis article‘ProgressiveTemporality inMusic’ (1984). Crucially, hisnotionofprogressiondwells notuponbroadertastebutrefersdirectlytothe sensationsoflistening:‘Thefeelingthatmusicisprogressingormovingforwardin time is doubtless one of the most fundamental characteristics of musical experience;yetitmanifestssucharemarkablerangeofvariationinitsprominence anditsqualitythatattimesitseemstobeabsentaltogether’(1984, 121). Hecites examples and their effects: the tonally-induced irrelevance of time orderings in Webern,thestaticcharacterofpassagesinDebussyandWagner, andtheabilityof many contemporary works freed from pitch constraints to seemingly regress in time. Re?lectingupontheseconsiderationsoftimeprovesfascinatingbutcanlead to an analytical headache. Obviouslyin practice, thereis no dangerof a piece of music hindering the passage of time on a practical level, yet impressions of stoppageand regressionabound. Herethe subjective-objective divide thatmusic scholars face becomes all too blurred; when human perception is one of the primarymediumsofmusic,howcanaperceivedtimelessnessbeignored?Howcan abalancebefoundbetweenpragmaticdiscussionofthemusicthatdoesnotstray from both the actuality of its performance and the continuity of its expressive form, andthehighly accessibleandengagingindividual experiences that so often leadtolinguistictail-chasing?Earlier,itwasaskedwhetheritmightbepossibleto 75 PerceptionandPerspective exploreperceptualcomplexitywithoutlosingsightofmusicalsimplicity.Perhapsit might be ofuse to turn this questionupon its head. Through consideration of a pianosonatamovementbySchubert(1797–1828)andamorerecentworkbythe American composer John Adams (b. 1947) this chapter will look to turn this question around, asking instead whether analysing musical simplicity might facilitate a discussion of the complex perceptual phenomena that surround it. Ratherthanexaminingtheformatlarge,analyticalfocusherewill fallprincipally upon the openings of both works, and some of the temporal expectations and evaluations that might emerge. Whilst emphasis will remain upon these parallel momentsofcrystallisation, someoftheauralimplicationsforthelong-termform ofthesepieceswillalsobediscussed. Simplicityandcontinuity Arelativelyrecentcompositionaltrendthathasbecomesynonymouswithideasof musical simplicity is thatof minimalism, pioneered during the 1960s and70s in theUnitedStates by ?igures including La Monte Young, Terry Riley, Steve Reich, andPhilipGlass.Althougheachcarvedoutastrikinglyindividualvoiceforhimself, there are overarching qualities of note. For the most part, their music is uncompromisinglydirect, self-driven, almostindustrial initsseeminglyceaseless onward development. As for its construction, Keith Potter writes aptly of an ‘intentionally simpli?ied rhythmic, melodic and harmonic vocabulary’ (Potter, Grove).K.RobertSchwarzdelineatesthewiderstructuralimplicationsofthis: Likesomuchnon-Westernmusic,minimalistpiecesdonotdrivetowardsclimaxes, do not build up patterns of tension and release, and do not provide emotional catharses. They demand a new kind of listening, one lacking in ‘traditional conceptsof recollection andanticipation’, asGlasshasputit. In minimalism, you willnotSindthecontrasts–loudandsoft,fastandslow,bombasticorlyrical–that arethesubstanceofWesternclassicalmusic.(1996,8–9) Althoughhehasoftenbeenaf?iliatedwiththestyle,JohnAdamsisnotaminimalist composer, emphatically so if Schwarz’s checklist is anything to go by; Adams seemingly falls short in almost every category. He has, perhaps a little more 76 PerceptionandPerspective accurately, been described as a ‘post-minimalist’ or a ‘second generation minimalist’ (Service 2011, and Clark 2015). But while facets of the minimalist aesthetic emerge as prominent audible in?luences in his music, there can be no doubt that they are absorbedas a feature within a much broader compositional palate that almost equally encompasses post-Romantic and early-twentieth century styles(Cahill, Grove).Utilisingthisinclinationto drawuponawide range ofsources–adistinctlymodernisttendency,atleastinthepost-avant-gardeterms discussed in the introduction– Adams exhibits an economic handling ofmusical content,producinghighlyengagingandcommunicativemusicalstructures.Though hismusicis,inmanysenses,minimal,itseffectisdecidedlynot. Althoughhe de?ies a strictminimalistaesthetic inmanyways, Adams falls intoalargegroupoftwentieth-centurycomposerswhosemusic–onaccountofits apparentsimplicityofconstruction–hasoftenbeenfailedor,worse,side-linedby more traditional analytical approaches that do not account for its perceptual intricacies. ItispreciselythisimbalanceinscholarshipthatDaniel Marchseeksto address inhis thesis Beyond Simplicity(1997). From theoutset, heexpresses his concern that a negative association between minimalism and simplicity leads writers todismiss themusic asbeing ‘ofinsuf?icient compositionalinteresttobe takenseriously’: Such discussions usually focus on the limited amount of basic material… and equate simplicity of means with simplicity of effect. Even those pieces which involveagreatervarietyanddensityofmaterial[…]aretosome extentimplicated inthisprocess,inthattheiruseofrepetition…isviewedasdemonstratingalackof ‘musical sophistication’, which is again equated with absence of musical effect. (1997,11) Exhibiting a complexity of effect in spite a simplicity of means, Adams’s piece Shaker Loops for string ensemble provides an apt representation of the dichotomyMarchoutlines.Firstemergingin1978andrevised?iveyearslater,the work represents not only a career breakthrough for Adams but also a stylistic watershed; althoughit comprehensively displays the?irstutterances of amature and now recognisably distinctive musical language, it also stands as one of the clearest remnants of the composer’s minimalist lineage. Its direct and novel powers ofcommunicationareillustratedclearlyinthisexcerptfromDavidNice’s 77 PerceptionandPerspective review of a 2013 performance given by the London Symphony Orchestra conductedbyAdamshimself:‘Williteverstopelectrifyinguswiththeshockofthe new,thatseriesofroof-rocking,steam-trainacceleratingchords?Audiencesinthe SeventiesandEighties musthaveimmediately realisedtheywereinthepresence ofamasterpiece;westillfeltitlastnight.’(Nice2013) Aspectsofthisdistinctiveimpression, itmight beargued, areformedfrom the very opening of the work, a gesture of bold economy: two notes (a perfect fourth, G♮ and C♮ an octave above middle C) recycled rapidly in rhythmic uniformity.Fewgesturescouldseemmoreminimal.Fromthe?ifthbaronwards,a B♮ ?lickersintermittently betweentheinterval,andforafurther18barsthis isall thatoccurs. Insome senses, such employment of material is far from unusual. Onthe contrary, it might appear to subscribe to a conventional pattern in Western art music, assuming theroleofamusicalfoundationoraccompaniment, aconsistent undercurrentofsoundthatprovidesarhythmicandtonalframeworkintowhicha featureofgreaterinterest–usuallysomekindofmelodictheme–canthenstep.At this point in the work, on a ?irst hearing, it is likely that many typical Western listeners will still be expecting the musical ‘main event’. Thomas Clifton (1983) helpfully frames these anticipations in terms of different notions of ‘beginning’. Theexample hechooses – theopening ofBeethoven’sNinthSymphony – proves particularly relevant to this case study; like Adams, Beethoven commences his workwithjustone motoric, recycledinterval – aperfect?ifth. Cliftonassertsthat he hears Beethoven’s symphony as possessing two beginnings: this opening undercurrent, and the climactic unveiling of the primary subject 17 bars later, reached through a brief process of establishedstability, ensuing disruption, and aggregatecumulation: Myexperienceofasecondbeginningentailsasituationwhichisneitherarepeat,a recapitulation, a new beginning, nor another beginning, but which refers to a complexactivityofbothobservingandparticipatinginaneventwhich(1)belongs tothesametimeeventastheSirstbeginning;(2)showsitselfintheappearance of the Sirst beginning; but (3) presents an idea essentially different from that presentedbytheSirstbeginning.(1983,83–88) 78 PerceptionandPerspective Perhapsitisthisexpectationofa‘secondbeginning’thatanaudiencefamiliarwith canonic staples such as Beethoven’s Ninth Symphony would subconsciously subscribe to at the outset of Shaker Loops. Its initial gestures would certainly indicatesuchanunfolding.Ofcoursethedenialofthisexpectationisonlyaf?irmed gradually,anaggingpossibilitytransformedintoapersistentreality.Audiencesare forced to reappraise their reception of the piece as they continue to receive it, realigning their expectations andmentally reviewing – perhaps evenreplaying – theopeningpassagesinordertofollowanon-goingnarrativethread. Oncethese anticipations are redirected, it is possibleto move beyondthe surfacesimplicityoftheseinitialgestures,allowingtheirrelevancetotheprojected musical narrative to emerge. Indeed, these connections that are crucial to a present-tense aural continuity, an integral aspect of the highly communicative natureofShakerLoops.Clifton’sobservationsareapt: A mere succession of sensory experiences cannot be experienced as having continuityif eventssucceedeachotherwithoutinSluencing eachother.Continuity isnotanadditive process;tonalatoms,bythemselves,cannotcoagulate toforma melody. Rather, it is continuity which enables us to recognise melody, and to atomiseitbyanalysis.(1983,96) As thework progresses, therepeatedcellularpatterns–‘loops’–thatspringfrom the texture prove generative through their interaction with one another. The architectural shape that emerges from these accumulations and interactions establishes an unbroken narrative stretch. Adams’s own preface to the score indicatesthat theseissues offormal unityandcommunicationfeaturedheavilyin hiscompositionalapproach: Although being in its own way an example of ‘continuous music’, Shaker Loops differsfrommostotherworksofitskindbecause itseessomuchchange withina relativelyshort amount of time. Alsoit avoids the formal and temporal purity of much ‘minimal’ music bynot adhering toa single unbending tempo throughout. Thislesssevere approach allowsa freer movement from one level of energyto another,makingamoredramaticexperienceoftheform.(Adams1989,3) It was such considerations that prompted Adams to revisit the original 1978 ‘modular’version,inwhichtheintroductionanddurationofeach‘loop’wasleftto thediscretionoftheconductor.Dissatis?iedwiththe‘overallshape’and‘harmonic 79 PerceptionandPerspective movement’ of performances that he himself did not direct, Adams produced a through-composedversion, ‘lockinginthe harmonic and formal designin a time scale that made the most sense’ (Adams 2008, 107). The in-vogue brand of regulated aleatoricism that permeatedtheinitial incarnation– the string quartet Wavemaker – had by now been replaced entirely with a more conventional, composer-controlledstructuralconsistency. The cellular properties of the ‘loops’ themselves contribute to this continuity;beyondsimplyreappearinginquasi-leitmotivicfashion, thesequences undergo transformations through their interactions with surrounding materials, inciting changes in pace and direction. This often occurs discreetly, with developmentsassumingtexturalroles:theresultantunityislargelysubconscious. Discontinuity Inmusical terms, there is no doubt that theopening ofShaker Loopsexhibits an extremelevel ofcontinuity. A threadofsoundunwinds, without pause, break, or fracture; indeed, for a large part of the opening movement this thread is only reinforced. However, a radical simplicity of construction allows the passage to evade conventional expectations; paradoxically, a form of discontinuity is precipitated. Ratherthanarisingdirectly–andabruptly– frommusical gestures, the discontinuance is a gradual realisation for ?irst-time listeners as the economicalnatureofthematerialiscon?irmed;aprocessofre-contextualisationis necessitated. The discontinuity takes place ‘in the audience’ rather than ‘in the music’. Jonathan Kramer underlines the signi?icance of musically experienced discontinuity, asserting that an evasion of expectations can prove particularly profound; for him, the unexpected ‘is more striking, more meaningful, than the expectedbecauseitcontainsmoreinformation’: The musical experiences that are the most memorable are the magical moments whenexpectation issubverted, when complacencyisdestroyed,andwhen a new world opens.... Tonal discontinuities, when pushed to extremes, create new experiencesoftime–timethatisnotlinearandnotone-dimensional.(1978,177) 80 PerceptionandPerspective Figure4.1:Schubert,SonatainB♭,D.960,Uirstmovement(bars1–23) Whereas Adams ?inds ways to challenge audiences with an unprecedented continuity,SchubertconfrontslistenerswithanunexpecteddiscontinuityinhisB♭ sonata,onethatcanbepinpointedtotheunprecedentedbasstrillintheeighthbar. The very opening ofthe work seems to be imbued with a remarkable power to hold its listeners with a seemingly minimal amount ofeffort (see Figure 4.1). A 81 PerceptionandPerspective largely stepwise, rhythmically steady theme – spaciously harmonised – at the higherendofthemiddleregisterissupportedbyatonic-dominantinterplayinthe bass. A motoric presence is imbued from interceding quaver oscillations. The passagebetrays very little intent ofharmonic motionaway from theestablished tonalcentreofB♭ withinthe?irstsevenbars.Thefocalinteractionsoccurbetween tonic and dominant; even a sojourn into the subdominant in the ?ifth bar is underpinned by continued tonic emphasis in the bass. Withthe exception of an ascendingleapto E♭ inthe ?ifthbar(the?irstpoint atwhichthethematic motion extendsbeyonda stepofatoneorsemitone),themelodytooisheldcomfortably withintherangeofaperfectfourth. Disregarding the aural question-mark provided by the closing imperfect cadence (second half of bar seven), the phrase evokes a strong sense of the conventional antecedent-consequent patterns that might indicate a contained, small-scaleform.Infact,thesonatathatensuesfromtheseopeninggesturesisone ofgiganticproportions,usuallylastingover40minutesinperformances, withthe Moltomoderato ?irst movementitselfcomprising approximatelyhalfofthatspan. Suchanexpansive and supposedly complexstructureappearsto sit at odds with thetonal andmotivic simplicityofthe openingseven bars. Comparison mightbe drawn with the opening Allegro con brio of Beethoven’s Third Symphony (itself often approaching 20 minutes in duration), which will be discussed in Chapter Eight (Narrative Possibilities)in terms ofthe thematic drop to C♯ in its seventh bar. The effect is of a brief tonal upheaval, a magnetic disruption that is immediately correctedbut nonetheless precipitates thewidertonal introspection and interrogation that will serve to project forward an unusually vast musical architecture. This brief melodic departure from, and return to C♯ is the audible germofthenarrativecon?lictthatensues. No such disruption occurs within the thematic content of the ?irst seven bars of Schubert’s sonata; by this point in a ?irst-time hearing, it is dif?icult to conceive of any ofthe presented material necessitating a 20-minute movement. Indeed,the disruptionisyetto come. Unlike inShakerLoops,the discontinuityat play in Schubert’s sonata does take place within the parameters of the notated music. Nevertheless,itstillevokesasenseofotherness.Indeedaftersuchatonally straight-laced opening, the G♭–A♭ bass trill in bar eight presents a jarringly 82 PerceptionandPerspective Figure4.2:SonatainB♭,D.960,Uirstmovement,selectedbars(1and8)with bracketshighlightingbassornamentderivation chromatic enigma.Whilsthetakesnoteofitsmysteriouscharacter, CharlesRosen viewsthe gestureas highlygenerative, suggesting thatthe ‘entire work seemsto arise’ from it (1988, 249). Charles Fisk acknowledges this catalytic function but still underlines the status of the trill as a ‘foreign element’: ‘a harbringer of something outside or beyond what is implied by the theme itself, something fascinating in both its allure and its danger.’ He suggests that the harmonic modulations thatitfacilitates inthe course ofthe movement– and, by extension, the remainder of the sonata – seem to in turn suggest ‘a state of Entfremdtheit (‘alienation’)’(Fisk2001,241–42). An analysis abstracted from aural experience can in fact reveal a motivic connection that runs through the apparently disparate initial elements; when transposed, the stepwise ascent of the melody in the ?irst bar can be seen to reappear as the ?lourish that sets up the trill (see Figure 4.2). However, this connectiondoes not surfaceasacrucialcomponentofthe passage as it isheard; thetrillappears insteadasanunrelatedentityintheunfoldingmusical narrative, not only hinting at new tonal realms but doing so inathus-far unexplored pitch register. Indeed, bythesame token, the differencesbetweenthe two gestures do notaudiblyamounttoanoppositioninthesamesenseasRobertHatten’stheoryof ‘markedness’ (1994, 34–38, discussedfurther in Chapters Seven and Eight). The melody and the trill sit in stark contrast to one another but do not necessarily appear opposed. Rather, the effect of theinterruptionmight be ofaglimpse of a distinctivemusicalnarrativerunninginparallel –two alternativeplanesofmusic momentarily overlapping; indeed, the trill sounds like it belongs to an entirely 83 PerceptionandPerspective different, fardarkerpieceofmusicinthe wakeofsuchplacidity. The occurrence creates a stylistic and aesthetic clash: contained clarity meets open-ended ambiguity; a straightforward sequence of antecedence and consequence is curtailedbyanominousquestionmark. Whatprovesperhaps moreradicalistheway music continuestounfoldin thewakeofthisdisruption. Asfaras anaudience mightbeconcerned, thesonata simplyrestartsitself:fornearlyfourbars,anidenticalreprisetakesplace,withthe melodyalteredandextendedfora further?ivebars beyondthat. WhereasShaker Loops might be seen as inciting a memory-based reassessment of its opening, Schubert seems to insist upon restarting the sonata from scratch, the trill apparently presenting a hurdle that cannot be overcome in a conventionally through-composed manner. The perceptual effect is one of temporal disruption, directlinearitysacri?icedforasecond,arti?icial attemptatcontinuity. Bygranting listeners the inside track on this process, of course, the effect is of a jarring discontinuity. For all its understatement and pianissimo dynamic, such a blatant cut-and-rewinddecisionseemsparticularlybrazen. In sonata theory terms, this disjointed introduction would appear to constitute what Hepokoski and Darcy (2006) might term a ‘deformation’, an instance of a composer creating a particular expressive effect through the manipulationor ?louting of astructural norm(614–21); inthis instance, it is the anticipation of melodic, tonal, and metric continuity that is aroused and offset. What is particularly notable is the unexpected poignancy with which this discontinuityisimplemented;whatmightatothertimesprovelittlemorethanan eccentric disruption here proves unsettlingly evocative, with the passage seemingly possessing signi?icant narrative potential. David Damschroder, in his principally harmonic commentary, is even prompted here to speculate as to whether the openingofthe movement might set inmotiona readingthat draws parallels withits composer’s con?licted sexuality (2010, 257 & 304–05); heeven goes so far asto extendthis metaphor to thetonal playing-outofthe movement, describingthepursuitofa‘gradual conversionfromdeviantD♭–F♭–A♭todiatonic D♮–F♮–A♮’ (258–259). As conjectural as suggestions like this might seem, the potential impact ofsuchanalogies isnonethelessderivedfromthe solelymusical deformations – bothlocaliseddiscontinuities andlong-termtonal leanings –that 84 PerceptionandPerspective permeate the movement. Writing more broadly, Hepokoski and Darcy (2006) reinforcetheseconnections: The expressive or narrative point lies in the tension between the limits of a competentlistener’sSieldofgenericexpectationsandwhatismadetooccur–ornot occur–in actual sound atthatmoment.Within anyindividualexemplar(suchasa single musicalcomposition)operating undertheshapinginSluenceofa communitysharedgenre-system,anyexceptionaloccurrencealongthese linescallsattentionto itselfasastrongexpressiveeffect(2006,614). EvenatthisearlystageinSchubert’ssonatathemusicaltime–or‘times’–it presentshasreachedasurprisinglevelofcomplexity.Kramer,inhisbreakdownof what heterms temporal modes, acknowledges the challenges inunpacking their application within musical works, admitting that ‘the categories are not always comparable, and distinguishing between them is often far from a clear-cut procedure’(1988,58).Althoughheutilisesparticularexperiencesofdiscontinuous musicaltimeasdescriptivemarkersbetweenextremesoflinearandverticaltime, heidenti?ies limitations in their near-consistent impurities: ‘Most music exhibits some kind of mix of temporalities, at times nebulous, at times contradictory, at times changing, at times elusive’ (1988, 58). Nevertheless, bearing the blurred nature ofthese experiences inmind, they resonate strongly withthe opening of this sonata. Two modes prove particularly apt: ‘moment time’, in whichmusical continuityiscontainedwithinsectionsratherthandevelopingbyimplication;and ‘multiply-directed time’, in which implications are not realized in subsequent sections but rather elsewhere, at other points in the musical form. Schubert’s opening would appear to showcase characteristics of these concepts: two seemingly disparate types of material, both audibly self-contained, the consequences oftheirimplications eitherplayedoutat alaterstage(theopening melody)ortemporarilyfrustrated(the‘alien’trill). Thewidermusicalresultisthe establishment of an engaging journey for listeners. Perceptually, the piece has barelybegun, yet it has already appearedto ?indaway to engineer, manipulate, andrevisititsownhistory. AsCliftonnotes,‘continuityisinvolvedintheopenness oftime:intheideathatpasteventsarenotforeversealedofffromapresentwhich 85 PerceptionandPerspective constantlyre-searchesit,andthatfutureeventsdonotresideinsomeunknowable “other”,ignoring,andignoredby,thepresentsituation’(1983,97). Movingbeyondspectacle With their opening gestures, both pieces issue intriguing challenges to preconceivednotionsofmusicalcontinuity.Butasfascinatingasthesesubversions prove when they are subjectedto detailed analysis, they fail to account for any deeper dramatic signi?icance that might occur. Denials of expectations like the ones discussed cannot necessarily garner and sustain enough interest to draw listeners into engagement with musical narratives over a longer period of time. SuchgesturesareperhapscomparabletoAristotle’snotionof‘spectacle’withinhis wider prescriptions for dramatic narrative; whilst some degree of spectacle constitutesannecessarycomponentofsuccessfuldrama,heisquickto rank itthe least signi?icant of the qualities, deeming it ‘attractive’ but ‘very inartistic andis leastgermanetotheartofpoetry’(trans.Heath1996,13).Whenimplementedfor a prolonged duration, such gestures make for ‘dif?icult’ listening; incessant discontinuity amounts to a continuity of its own – one potentially remembered moreforitsmonotonythanitsmeaning.Focusfortheremainderofthiscasestudy pairingwillnowshifttothelonger-termstructuralimplicationsthatemergefrom theopeningsofeachwork. ShakerLoopscomprisesanuninterruptedhalf-hourofmusic,its four parts directly interconnected as one extended, unbroken strand. Once its initial simplicity has encouraged an audience beyond a super?icial reception to a more actively-involvedstateoflistening, it mustsatisfy theserealignedexpectationsby providing a suf?icient basis for musical drama. An emotionally communicative dramaticstructure waspart ofAdams’s originalintentionsforthepiece. Thetitle takesitscue–inpart–fromthedancesofthe‘Shakers’;thetermisacolloquialism fortheUnitedSocietyofBelieversinChrist’sSecondAppearing,ofwhichtherewas a colony near Canterbury, New Hampshire, where he grew up. Through this reference, Adams draws upon facets of a spiritual experience, deliberately summoningup ‘thevisionofthese otherwisepious and industrious soulscaught 86 PerceptionandPerspective Figure4.3:Adams,ShakerLoops,PartI:reductionofharmonicaccumulation (bars1–104) upintheecstaticfrenzyofadancethatculminatedinanepiphanyofphysicaland spiritual transcendence’ (Adams, 2014). Although the music itself does not call uponspeci?icimageryinanexplicitlyprogrammaticsense,itsfoursubdivisionsare granted notably motion-based titles: ‘Shaking and Trembling’, ‘Hymning Slews’, ‘LoopsandVerses’,and‘AFinalShaking’.Whethertheaudienceaurally ‘observes’ these motions or enters into a kind of perceptual participation is dif?icult to ascertain.Ultimately,theemotionalthrustoftheworkisunlikelytoleavelisteners inastateofdetachment;onthecontrary,theyaredrawntoitsverycentre. The end result of this compositional approachis the encouragement of a kind of self-re?lective listening, raising broader questions of motion, space, subjectivity and temporality. The surface simplicity of the musical material presented at theoutset of Shaker Loopsprompts aheightened introspection, the lack ofeventbeyondtheestablishedrepetitionstirringadiscontentmentwithan attitudeofpassivereception. Spurredbeyondaface-valuehearing,meaningmust instead be sought in the basic construction of the sound. With no distinctive melodic shapeuponwhichto focus, attentionisdivertedto thenotes themselves andhow they relatetooneanother. Itisanapproachthatisfrequentlytakenfor granted within the context of conventional tonal music. When a hierarchy of harmonicrelationshipsis established, itsprogressivefunctionisusually assumed bylisteners. Until this hierarchyis musically challengedor subverted, itis rarely questioned.Manypiecesin?luencedbytheminimaliststylereaf?irmthissystemin aparticularlyblack-and-whitemanner. WhileShakerLoopsundoubtedlytendstowardstonality,itsapproachisnot so clear-cut. Seemingly, at the outset, no permanent tonic key is established. Indeed, it could easily be argued that the entire ?irst movement comprises an extendedseriesoftonalcentres–emerging,overlapping,con?licting,fading.Itisin this manner of continued allusion without allegiance that the drama – and, by extension, the broader narrative – of the piece is set in motion. Rather than 87 PerceptionandPerspective implementing an harmonic ‘gravity’, the composer initiates an audible dialogue between different gravitational ?ields (seeFigure 4.3). Ina conventional context, theimplicationoftheopeningperfectfourthisatonalcentreofC♮.Theinterceding B♮ that follows throws this initial assumption into imbalance, a centre of C♮ still likely but the possibility of G♮ as a ‘tonic’ of sorts now emerging (a likely proposition for the score-reader given the one-sharp key signature). The subsequentintroductionofE♮(ShakerLoops:‘PartI’,bar26)–spatiallythelowest note – transforms all preconceptions, casting the accumulating chord withinthe light ofE minor (againin-keeping withthe key signature); theD♮ that ?lickers at thetopofthechordinconstantinteractionwithitsadjacentC♮ immediatelyserves toaddasenseoftransiencetothecurrentEminor,achangeincourseapparently imminentbyvirtueoftheseventh. While the addition of A♮ (appearing withincreasing prominence from bar 40)andF♯ (alargelyconsistentpresencefrombar51)servestoperpetuateanEminoremphasis, thegradualextensionofthecello linesdownto C♮ (frombar75) reasserts thepower of thesonoritywith whichthe piece began. The result is an over-saturationoftonal possibilities andthe arrival at a breaking point. At such junctures, Adams invokeswhat mightperceivedas changes ingestural trajectory. The potential for palpable shifts in tonal gravity is vastly reduced by the sheer numberof notes collected withinsucha limited pitch range. As changes in pitch gradually become near-imperceptible, the oscillations cease and the ensemble settlesupononechord(C♮,D♮,F♯,B♮)beforechangingdirectionentirelythrougha shifttoFmajor. While an audience may remain largely unaware of the mechanics of the tonal process, attention will nonetheless be drawn to the interaction between these competing gravities. Expectations are constantly aroused, averted, and deniedat differentstagesoftheaccumulation.Propulsivemotionisreinforcedby theconstant transformationsofthematerial –asnewloops areintroduced, fresh tonalperspectives areofferedonexistingsonorities.Theeffectuponaperception ofthelargerformalarchitectureisanenhancedclarityofgestureatoddswithany preconceived stasis. There is a present-tense awareness of an adaptive, goalorientated structure: the music feels like it is ‘going somewhere’ even if its audiencecannotpredictwhere,orindeedwhenitwillarrive. 88 PerceptionandPerspective Movingbeyondcontrast Aplotisnot(assome think) uniSiedbecauseitisconcerned witha single person. An indeterminately large numberof things happen toanyone person, notall of which constitute a unity; likewise a single individual performsmanyactions, and theydonotmakeupasingleaction.(Aristotle,trans.Heath1996,15) Aristotle’ssummationofthevarietyofeventsthatauni?iedplotcanencompassis aptwithregardtoSchubert’s sonata.The?irstpageofits score–whenrealisedin performance–doesnotofferanimmediateimpressionofunity.Ratherthejarring contrastsofthemusicalmaterialitpresentsincitesapuzzlingaside:howmightthe composerunitethesedisparate elements withinthecontextofacohesivewhole? Theanswer, it emerges, is not quiteso straightforward, yet itis arguably simple, nonetheless: rather than any immediate attempt to reconcile or resolve the differences,Schubertiscontenttoletthesetwo‘characters’–self-containedclarity and other open-ended ambiguity – coexist alongside one another. Indeed, it is throughchangingauralperspectivesuponthesematerials andtheirrolesthatthe long-term drama of the movement arises (see Figure 4.4 for a summary of the formalscheme).13 Followingthe?irstappearanceofthetrillinbar8,theextendedrestatement oftheopeningthemeculminatesinaperfectcadenceatbar18.Thereturningtrill, however,isnowplaceduponthetonicitself(bar19),itschromaticoscillationwith C♭ incitingadescenttowardsitsoriginal G♭ contextattheupbeattobar20. This diversion sets up an entirely new context for the restatement of the principal theme: althoughthethemerecommencesonthetonic (aswiththeopeningofthe movement), itnow?indsitselfrelegatedtothestatusofmediantwithinthenewlyforgedpathofG♭ major(seeFigure4.1). As Fisk readily acknowledges, such emphasis upon the ?lattened submediant in a major-key work is not out of the ordinary, even within the classicalstyle.Whathequiterightlyemphasisesthough,isthe‘portentous’nature of its signi?icance in this opening passage (2001, 241). While these events themselves constitute nothing unusual, the way they are paced does. The 13 Durationstakenfromrecording listedin primaryresource list(MitsukoUchida,piano. Decca:4756282). 89 PerceptionandPerspective Formaldivision FirstExposition (+Sirst-timebars) SecondExposition (+second-timebar) Development Recapitulation Bars Tonalregion(bars) Duration 1–116 +9bars B♭major(1–19) G♭major(20–34) B♭major(35–47) F♯ minor(48–73) Fmajor(74–117i) 0’00–5’44 1–116 +1bar B♭major(1–19) G♭major(20–34) B♭major(35–47) F♯ minor(48–73) Fmajor(74–117ii) 5’44–11’04 118–215 C♯ minor(118–148) D♭major(149–156) Emajor(157–161) Cmajor(162–165) Transition(166–170) Dminor(/B♭major)(172–202) Fmajor(Voftonic)(203–215) 11’04–15’15 216–357 B♭major(216–234) G♭major(235–238) F♯ minor(239–253) B♭major(254–266) Bminor(267–288) B♭major(289–357) 15’15–21’54 Fig.4.4:SonatainB♭,D.960,tabledisplayingstructuralplan expansive B♭ sonoritywithits comfortably placedmelodydoesnotsoundinany wayprecarious;onthecontrary,italmostgivesthesensethat,freeofinterference, it couldcontinue onwardsinaperpetual state. Suchadramatic uprootingwithin the ?irst 20bars of the work belies an underlying competing tonal gravity – its orbit stationed aroundG♭ –withprofoundimplications for themusicalnarrative to follow. Beneath the tranquil surface of the opening bars, a fundamental hierarchyhasbeencalledintoquestion. Withnecessaryintervallic adjustmentsmade, themelodyisgraduallyspun furtherwithanonward ?low ofquavers from bar 27cascadingintoadeveloping 90 PerceptionandPerspective sequenceofsemi-quaversfrombar29.Theepisodeiscurtailedbytheintroduction of triplet quavers (from bar 34), the accumulated momentumpropelledforward into a forte restatement of the opening material, underpinned by the newly acquiredtripletrhythm. The melodic subject is, by this point, outgrowing its shape and its tonal allegiance with understated ease. Rather than assuming a concrete form, a perceived ‘theme’ takes the shape of a broader gestural pattern by which each passage is fashioned; a basic entity never revealed in an ‘essential’ form but instead continually altered. Schubert extends, elaborates, and fragments the melody with tireless variety, allowing it to permeate the form of the work. The effect is a notable temporal dichotomy: on one hand, the form bears an audible repetitivestreak,asenseofstasisandcircularitythatallowsthemovementtotake theshapeofameditationononeessentialsubject;ontheother,thereisapalpable sense of onward development, ofthe sameideaappearing and altering within a varietyofequallychangeableaudiblecontexts.14 The melodic freedom that this perceptual paradox engenders serves to counteractthestringencythatmightarisefromtheclearlydelineatedsonataform withfantasy-likeexploratoryqualities.Theever-developingnarrativeofthetheme itself eventually proves to be an alienating factor for the audience as it strives furtherandfurtherfrom its initialstatethroughincreasingly unfamiliarterritory. The tonal scheme represents, for Charles Rosen, the ‘tour de force’ ofSchubert’s treatment of the three-key exposition, the gravity towards F♯ minor (a minormode enharmonic transformation of the G♭ that ?irst appeared at bar 20) that emerges in the extended transitory episode serving deftly to offset the typical oppositionbetweentonicanddominant(1988,234–249). Rosenisquick to point towardsthe‘wonderfullyexpressiveambiguities’oftheharmonicprogressions: […] the way that A major appears, only to be immediately inSlected and weakenedbythe B♭ in the bass(bars 58–59),the suggestion ofBminorthatis 14ThisthematicapproachbearsrelationtowhatbothArnoldSchoenberg,andlaterWalter Frisch with his derived study, have identiSied in the music of Brahms, praising the evolutionofhisthemesasanexempliSicationofwhattheyterm‘developingvariation’:the basictrace ofamotifretainedthroughoutan‘endlessreshaping’ (Schoenberg1975,129). ThisisanideathatiscoveredfurtherinChapterSix(DynamicContinuities)ofthisthesis. 91 PerceptionandPerspective nevercarriedout, andthe newharmonicmeaningof DminorattachedbrieSlyto theF♮ inthebassbutsustainedsobrieSly.(1988,249) In seeking to develop an harmonic approach that bypasses conventional diatonicism infavour ofvoice-leading ef?iciency between triadic shapes, Richard Cohn(1999 & 2012) is quick to ascribe further signi?icance to F♯ minor. Rather than comprising what he terms (with deliberate verbosity) ‘an enharmonically respelled minor in?lection of the triad on the ?latted submediant degree’, the sonorityconstitutes a‘polar’key, sharingno tones withtheestablishedB♭major yetofferingrapidmodulatorypotentialthroughsemitonemovement(1999, 218). Assuming this perspective onthe relationship between B♭ major and F♯ minor, Cohn argues, casts new light upon the unnervingly brief switch to the audibly distantC♯ minor atthe outset ofthedevelopment section,withthisnew point of tonal gravity representing the corresponding polar relationship to the conventional dominant of F major (1999, 218–19). Establishing a tonal network thatrevolvesaroundaseriesofmajorthirds(andtheirresultingtriadicoverlaps) stemming from the tonic, he takes his analysis further, proposing a structural schemeinwhichtheoverlapsbetweentriadicshapesallow aconventionaltonic– dominant–tonic sequenceoverthecourseofthemovement, withtheexceptionof the‘doubledominant’usedattheoutsetofthedevelopment(2012,125–28). For listeners, it may well be that such a variety of harmonic implications andforecastsserves only to enhanceagrowingfeelingofdisorientation.Somuch so thatby thecloseofthe?irstexposition, aremarkableshifthas occurredinthe characters of thematerials:with thesudden, fortissimoreappearance in the?inal bar of the ?irst-time-repeat segment, it becomes apparent that although its peripheraltreatmentlendsitasomewhatspectralquality,thetrillisnowrendered familiar by comparison. Serving as a jolting reminder of the interruptions with whichthework began, it seems to precipitate theexposition repeat itself. A role reversal has occurred: the tonally rooted primary subject has taken on a more restless, searchingcharacter,whilstthetrillisrendereditsgroundingfactor. With each appearance the trill makes it is further absorbed into the consciousness of listeners; although it may at ?irst seem ‘foreign’, it has before long become somethingofafamiliarlandmark. 92 PerceptionandPerspective Fig.4.5:SonatainB♭,D.960,diagramdisplayinglevelsofbinaryformthroughwork Indeed, this perceptual transformation might be seen as providing a compellingargument for the inclusionofthe expositionrepeatinperformance.15 Bypassingitaltogetherproducesaprofoundlydifferentpieceofmusic.Notonlyis thebalanceofa potential binary-formreadingofboth themovement andindeed the entire sonata (see Figure 4.5) destroyed, but nine bars of music are cut altogether,nevertobeheard, somethingperhaps moreforgivableifitweren’tfor thefact that these bars present not only anentirely new ?iguration, but also the only fortissimorenditionofthetrill motif. Thework isirrevocablychanged,quite contrary to the composer’s intentions; so extensive is Schubert’s compositional preparationfor the return to the opening that it seems unwise to view it as an optionalformalitythatcanbeignored. Thefullextentoftheshiftsinfunctionofthethemeandtrillishighlightedat the close of the development. The C♯ minor that opens the section (bar 118 onwards) quickly pivots to D♭ major paving the way for a cascade of far-?lung progressions (Emajor, Cmajor, A♭ minor, Bminor)thatlandthe music ?irmly in the bleak realm of D minor with no apparent signposts to indicate a way out. Indeeditis,asFiskobserves,thereturnofthetrill–inanotablystationarymode– thatcon?irmsDminor asanew tonal centre (bars 186–87). Asifthe sonata was exercisingitsownmusicalmemory, theuseofthetrillservesasamotivicprompt, bringingabout a recollection of theopening theme but transposed – as withthe G♭-majoriterationfrombar20–tothemediantofthenewtonic.Fiskobservesthe signi?icanceof this melodic decision, incorporating his own ‘wanderer’-narrative interpretation(Fisk2001,252): 15AlfredBrendelinparticularexplainsthathemakesthischoiceprimarilyinorderthathe mightbe able to comfortablyperform Schubert’sSinal three pianosonatasasatrilogyin one evening, his conSidentoverriding of the composer leading to a disagreement and a fascinatingexchangewithWalterFrisch(FrischandBrendel,1989). 93 PerceptionandPerspective Improvising a version of this passage in which the return of the theme begins instead with thetonicrevealsatonce howcruciallythe melodicemphasison the third degree affects its feeling. It still feels more like the song of the exiled protagonist, the lonely wanderer, than like the theme in its more choral, more angelicinitialform. Iterationsofthethemefailtoprovideanykindoflong-termharmonicmomentum asthe intercedingbasstrillscon?irmoscillations betweenDminorandB♭ major. Hepokoski and Darcy frame this passage in terms of its recapitulatory allusion, describing it as ‘one of the most moving series of false starts in the repertory’ (Hepokoski & Darcy 2006, 262). The tonic key not only appears as a subordinate to itsmediant, but as nothingshortofa momentaryescapist fantasy within a foreign environment; so thorough has the change of perspective been upontheopeningsonoritiesthat,bythispointinthemovement,theyserveonlyto enhanceasenseofdisorientation.Thesameisalsotrueofthedominantforatime, F major robbedof‘all its conventional power’ inRosen’s words, initially leading back to D minor (Rosen 1988, 291). As he points out, it is only through the fp emphasis (bar203) upona dominant-seventh chord that the re-establishment of the tonic for the recapitulation is undertaken. It is at this point that the trill is recalled in its original form (bars 213–14), its miniature departure from and return to the dominant sonority via chromatic unfamiliarity having proved symbolicofthewidertonalschemethathasunfurled:amicroscopicexpressionof a macrocosmic procedure. In thedesolatepassage that has precededthis return, the B♭ major triad has been reintroduced in cryptic segments as a ?iguration plagued by disorientationanduncertainty, with eachconstituentnote utilised as the root of a suggested tonal direction: D♮ as a minor-key continuation of the development-section wilderness; B♭ paradoxically as an exotic escape to the unfamiliar;F♮at?irstas adeadendandeventuallyasapotentialpathbacktothe tonic stability ofa recapitulation. Noteworthy in this sense is Nicholas Marston’s reading(2000),inwhichhesuggeststhatthisnotionoftonaltransformationmight be carried yet further; highlighting the way in which a heard augmented sixth chord(B♭♭–D♭–F♭–G)inthecourseoftherecapitulation(bar 253)is infactspelt as a dominant seventh chord inD major (A♮–C♯–E♮–G♮), heargues that the very notion of B♭ major as a ‘home’ key is challenged: ‘Consequently, whereas the 94 PerceptionandPerspective correspondingmomentintheexpositionbroughtareturntothetonicfollowingan extendeddigressiontothe?lattenedsubmediant,hereinbars254-5Schubertpulls off the feat of “chromaticising” the tonic, speci?ically by colouring it as a ?lat submediantitself’(2000,257–258). Formandfunction By the closing passages of the ?irst movement of Schubert’s sonata, a profound shiftinauralperspectiveuponthemusicalcontenthasbeencompleted.Whilethe materialitselfhasremainedlargelyunchanged, itistheroleeachmotivicelement playsthathasbeensubjecttoatransformation.Attheoutsetofthemovement,the trill surfaced as a disruptive presence, its ambiguous chromaticism throwing a spannerintheworksoftheplain-statedopeningsubjectandprecipitatingjarring discontinuities. Bythe close ofthemovement, it recurs as a familiar landmark, a homecomingpromptforthe verysubjectitonceunsettled.As theaudiencehears thetrill,itisacatalystfortonalmotion,butthetonalgoalinquestionchanges.The ability of the trill to initially transport the music to a new tonal realm is now transformedintoanabilityto bringithome. Theopeningmelody, meanwhile,has developed a restless character; it seems to ?ind little catharsis in its ?inal appearances, the movement drawn to a conclusion more on account of its continued iterations within a perpetuated tonic than through any audible resolution of note. Indeed, it is throughthis lack of satisfactory culminationthat the subduedgrief of the ensuing Andante sostenuto – set within the tonally far?lungkeyofC♯ minor–andtheauraljourneyofthesonataatlargeisfacilitated.It is a shift redolent of what Janet Schmalfeldt terms ‘becoming’: ‘the special case whereby the formal function initially suggested by a musical idea, phrase, or section invites retrospective reinterpretation within the larger formal context’(2011,9). AlthoughAdams’s approachto motivicmaterialandits functionmight not seem so clear cut, the broader concept of melody – and more speci?ically of melodic ‘convergence'– is ofgreat signi?icance, audiblysoinShakerLoops. While thebroader,lyricalgesturesthatemergeattheoutsetofPartII(‘HymningSlews’) 95 PerceptionandPerspective Figure4.6:ShakerLoops,PartIII,solocellomelody(bars3–26) sit seeminglyatodds withthe rapidinitial cells andloops that haveprecededit, thisapparentdisparityismerelyare?lectionoftime-scale.Aswiththeouterparts of thework, these centralpassages arebuiltfromreiterationsof simplecellular motifsutilisingintervalsofsecondsandthirds.However,these?iguresnowappear stretchedandprolonged;hyperactivetextural jostling ofthe openingofthework has unwound into a drifting, slow-motion dialogue of interlocking fragments across the ensemble. The transformation of prior materials in this re?lective manner belies a unity of construction that in turn serves to enhance a sense of long-termauralcontinuity. This economical approach to thematic material continues into Part III (‘Loops and Verses’) as a solo cello emerges atop tranquil textures from the preceding calm, gradually expanding a slow oscillation between two notes into a prolongedmelodicmeditation(seeFigure4.6).Thisnew focusupononesingular subjectratherthantheinteractionsbetweenseveraloverlappinglines –facilitated bytheprecedingperiodofrelativecalm–mightbeheardasincitingadistortionof thetemporalityofthework. Contrary to theshiftingattentionencouragedbythe musical multiplicity exhibitedthroughtherestofthework, theextendedmelodic outpouringfromthecello providesaclearfocalpoint,acrystallisationofthepreexisting material that engenders a sense of detachment from the temporal ?low, what might be interpreted as a kind of timelessness within the context of the broaderform. This refashioning of basic material through long-term gestures of convergence can be observed at its pinnacle when the large-scale structure of Shaker Loopsis considered. Althoughit is experiencedas a singlespan ofmusic, the narrative form of the work can be reduced to four broad gestures in 96 PerceptionandPerspective Part Duration Gesturalcontent I.‘ShakingandTrembling’ 7’59 An onward rush of multiple agents, interacting and reacting to one another while joined in a motoricforwardaction. II.‘HymningSlews’ 5’23 A lull gradually precipitated bythe lack of goal achievedthroughtheinitialmotion. 8’10 The slow convergence of the ensemble upon a repeatedrhythm (an inversionof acell from the opening of the work) catapulted through multiple accelerations culminating in a climactic collisionandasubsequentdissipation. 3’25 Are-visitation of themotoricmotionsofthe Sirst part, an entirely new perspective now gained upon the material – rather than a race to burn out,the music instead graduallysinksand fades toitsconclusion. III.‘LoopsandVerses’ IV. ‘AFinalShaking’ Figure4.7:ShakerLoops,tabledisplayinggesturalinterpretationofform accordancewiththedivisionsAdamsmakes(seeFigure4.7).16 Itisintheseterms that the architecture – and the narrative framework – of Shaker Loops can be comprehended. Continuityisachievedthroughprocess, but far from themotoric, accumulative operations of minimalism, this takes a far more organic shape: the pieceoffersanexplorationoftheprocessofuni?ication.Seekingdirection–at?irst throughoutwardexplorationandfrenziedonwardmotion–themusiceventually reaches apointofcrisis and, subsequently, ofcrystallisation. The self-exhausting locomotive climax of the third movement comprises a series of rhythmic contractions and expansions of two repeated notes. The initial short-long ?igurationofthecellisapparentlyderivedfromtheB♮ entriesattheveryopening of thework (Part I – ‘Shakingand Trembling’, bars 5–30). In the course ofwhat proves to be the formal cataclysm of the work, the length of the two notes is reversed as the ensemble converges with increasing muscularity (Shaker Loops: Part III – ‘Loops and Verses’, bars 71–123). The incision has been inverted, the abruptactionoftheshorternotenowactingasacut-offratherthanasaherald;an invertedperspective uponthe samebasic motivic shape has been achieved(see Figure4.8). 16 Durations taken from recording listed in primary resource list (London Chamber Orchestra,conductedbyChristopherWarren-Green.VirginClassics:724356185128). 97 PerceptionandPerspective Figure4.8:ShakerLoops,excerptsshowingrhythmicmotifreversalacrosswork After this watershed, earlier material is revisited but with an inevitably alteredperspective.Thefourthand?inalmovementbearsgreatresemblancetothe ?irst, motoricpulsationsemergingandinteractingacrosstheensemble.Butrather than inciting dramatic builds in tension, these accumulating loops lead to an ultimate sense of release and relief. Perspectives on essentially unchanged materialshavebeentransformedoverthecourseofthework.Themusicalcontent of both Shaker Loops and Schubert’s sonata, it would appear, has retained its simplicity;thecomplexitiesandchangesthathavearisenareinfactpredominantly perceptual. In terms of aural content, the experiences of both works end where theybegan;ratheritistheinterceding‘events’thathavereshapedhowtheymight beheard. 98 Five PerceivingTime Objectiveandsubjectivetime Psychologistshaveshownthatsubjectivetimedoesnotgenerallyequalclocktime. In the process of experiencing and then remembering lengths of time, we alter them. It is misleading, however, to think of subjective time alterations as distortions. Subjective duration is more relevant to the understanding of music thanisdurationmeasuredbyaclock.(J.Kramer1988,327) Although he underlines the variety of temporal experiences that music can highlight,JonathanKramerlaysthegroundworkforhisin-depthstudyTheTimeof Music by making a number of interconnected distinctions regarding our perceptions of time itself (1988, 1–19). He is quick to acknowledge the correspondencebetweenhisdivisionoflinearandnon-lineartime–akeystoneof his writing – and the long-held philosophical separation between ‘becoming’ (‘Heraclitean Flux’, as Weinert puts it) and ‘being’ (Weinert’s ‘ParmenideanStasis’).17 The ongoing, quanti?iable ‘ordinary’ time of daily life is seemingly at odds with a more malleable, immersive musical time, one that is described as being ‘repeatable, reversible, accelerating and decelerating’ (J. Kramer 1988, 17). DavidEpsteinisquickto align the?irst ofthese‘times’witha clocklike measurement mode, withthe latter dependentupon‘experience for its demarcation’: The clocklike mode iseasiestto comprehend, especially in an age dominated by precision timepieces. The exactitude of the clock (ormetronome) is Janus-faced, however; itisgained atthe expense of interest, forthough clocktime isreliable and predictable, it is also dull. (How long can a ticking clock, devoid of other content,hold the attentionof alivelymind?) Experientialtime,bycontrast,isthe stuffoflife,endlesslyinteresting,rarelythe same,Silledwiththeepisodesofliving by which it is framed. By this same token it is unpredictable, its particular structures drawn from and formed by those very elements that make a given experience unique. In reality, we live by both modes of time. They run simultaneously, attimescorresponding, atother timesin conSlict. (Epstein 1995, 7) 17 Weinert’sdistinction(2013,89–90)isdiscussedinChapterThree(DirectingTime). 99 PerceivingTime ForEpstein, theidea ofthe clock proves particularly signi?icant, evenifhe does appear to underestimate its expressive potential in certain contexts. The notionofa‘biologicalclock’evenunderpins his explorationofthe ways inwhich periods of time are perceived and understood (1995, 135–55). He highlights research into the way in which continuous movements or sensations are transmittedviaintermittentprocesses in thehumannervous system (principally Gooddy 1969 & 1977), the leaning of these processes towards synchronicity (Fraser 1978), and their signi?icance in perceiving units of time (Pöppel 1978). Whilst his resulting observations about our understanding of metre and tempo prove useful, there can be no doubt that they serve a particular agenda; his emphasis upon systematic consistency in time perception re?lects the broader musical regularity (rhythm, metre and phrase structure) of the classical and romantic works that dominate his study. His interpretations of musical time are unapologeticallytiedupwiththeteleologicalstructuralandtonalprinciplesofthe pieces he deems the most successful. His reasoning for this selection process is evidencedperhapsmosttellinglyinhisuseofacounterexample,whathedeemsto bea‘miscalulatedsection’inaScriabin’sPiano Concerto:a12-bardominantpedal inthe?inal-movementcodajudgedtobeunnecessary–a‘musicalfalsehood’–on accountofitsapparentintentiontore-establishthealreadyaf?irmedtonic.Inspite of the climactic effect Epstein himself describes the passage as possessing, he dismissesitas‘rhetoricallyempty’: The passion seems hollow, the sweep of the line unconvincing. The phrase feels untrue. Nor is thisaffective response unfounded; it isgrounded in the structure itself. Scriabin’s miscalculation provides a musically unneeded passage whose climacticcharacterisunsupported.The musicis thus atoddswithitsunderlying structure,andtherebystemsfromnointrinsicneed.(Epstein1995,90–93) By contrast, Kramer’s approach proves helpful in its aversion to such a categorical, and indeed intrusively self-certain presentation. Although the framework he proposes is also marked by contrasting understandings of time, their simultaneity becomes a point of recurring emphasis. The seemingly paradoxical experiences that are enabledby this interactionbetween perceptual extremes becomes something that can be embraced and explored rather than simply bypassed in favour of a more stable, regularised, middle-ground 100 PerceivingTime interpretation. Kramer points to the impact of cultural thought upon interpretations oftime, outlining the linear, absolute time ofthe Westernworld andthecausalunderstandingitgenerates. Twentieth-centuryartsandtechnology serve to illustrate a gradual leaning towards less obviously sequential understandings oftime:theincreasingobsolescenceoftraintravel asametaphor for modern experience relative to the ‘imperceptible motion’ (and thus the apparent stasis) of ?light serves as a particularly potent example. Even the advances that have ensued since Kramer committed his thoughts to print have only served to enhance his accompanying analogy regarding computing: ‘A program consists of doubling back, of loops within loops, of branching off in different directions. It is thus an apt symbol for contemporary temporality.’ (J. Kramer,1988,9–19) Moreconvincingly, Kramer’scaseisgroundedinneurologicalthought.The long-accepteddivisionsinfunctionbetweenthetwohemispheresofthebrainlead himto concludethat contrasting perceptionsoriginateindistinct butnonetheless cooperating sections of the brain. The left hemisphere acts as the ‘seat of linear logic’, offering analytical, compartmentalised readings based on a causal understanding; theright hemisphere, meanwhile, offersaholistic comprehension ofcomplexwebsofevents, remainingopento notionsofsimultaneity, expression andmetaphor.Musicalexperiences–andthusmusicaltime,heasserts–relyupon both the objective perspective of the left hemisphere, and the subjective understandingsofferedbytheright(1988,9–12). Acknowledging this psychological synthesis of perceptual extremes may help us to elucidate the variety of experiences Kramer alludes to. Instead of representing direct contrasts, perceptions of time could be located at points on what might be thought of as a continuum between absolute and relational conceptions of temporality. Certainly this rooting in cognition provides a more pragmaticframeworkforan explorationof musical time. Forall their discernible alignments, the impossibility of a predictable theoretical reconciliation between objective and subjectivetime must be conceded. Instead, what broadly inclusive surveys like those by Weinert (2013) seem to underline is how much more complexandmulti-facetedourunderstandingoftemporalitymightbe;itcannotbe reducedtoasimplecontrastbetweentwoextremesofregularity and?luctuation. 101 PerceivingTime Studies like Kramer’s The Time ofMusic demonstrateacommitment to exploring whatliesbetweenandindeedbeyondthesetwo extremes, andacknowledgethat theyarenotnecessarilyde?inedbytheiroppositiontooneanother. I wouldsuggest that writers continue to employ(or imply) theobjectivesubjective distinction – in spite of the apparent oversimpli?ication it risks – on account of how relatable it remains. It is best regarded as an indicator of how universally standardised temporal measures cannot even guarantee perceptual consistency.Rather,itisbesttoacceptthattheco-operationsandtensionsthatare experiencedbetweenthesetwo contrastingtemporalperspectives –andall those perceptions of time that might bethoughtofas inhabiting a continuum between thesetwoextremes–areevidencenotsomuchofadifferencetobereconciledbut of a coexistence that is in fact characteristic of lived experience. Certainly this inclusive approachis ofmost use within the contexts ofstudies like this one, in whichcanonicmusicmoreconventionallythoughtofasengagingwithlineartime is juxtaposedwithnewerpiecesthatinmanyinstancescanbeseentoundermine or defy such a reading. This chapter will ?irst provide a brief survey of psychologicalandcognitiveresearchconcernedwiththemannerinwhichmusical timeistypicallyprocessedandhowtheseoperationsmaybesubverted.Focuswill gradually shift to musical characteristics and how the design of compositions might be thought of as manipulating temporal perceptions. The closing segment will highlighttwoscholars –RobertAdlingtonandJonathanKramer– whohave provided particularly insightful ways ofcomprehendingmore recent music that, through the absence of regularised elements, provokes less conventional perceptionsoftime. Orderandconsciousness The German philosopher Edmund Husserl modelled a more inclusive attitude towardstemporalperceptionwithhisphenomenologicaltheoriespublishedinthe ?irst halfof thetwentiethcentury (Husserltrans. Brough,1991). Inparticular, he offers areconciliationofsortsbetweenabsoluteandrelationaltimethroughwhat hedeemstobeanecessarydismissalofthenotionofobjectivetime;hisintention 102 PerceivingTime isnottorejecttheconceptoutright,butrathertosuspenditforthepurposeofhis inquiries(1991,4–8).18Instead,itisanemphasisonintentionalconsciousnessthat underpins his investigations, providing ‘the very grounding condition of our knowledge of the world’, as David Clarke surmises (2011, 1–2); for Husserl, temporality comprises a stream of lived experiences uni?ied within the consciousnessofthesubject. Music holds some signi?icance within this view of time perception, articulating both this momentary ?low and its broader sequential unity in an undeniably direct manner. Clarke is justi?iably forthright about this relationship, assertingthat participating in musical acts‘capturesinitsverytemporal essence thetemporalitythatisessentialtotheknowingofbeing–i.e.consciousness’(2011, 1–2).ItisapointHusserlharnessesinordertoillustratethisprocessofsuccession, using the example ofthe perceptionof a melody (de?ined here as a sequence of tones)as aspringboardforhis examinationofmemoryandcontinuity. Crucialto thisishisconceptofretention:anenduring,present-tensegraspofelapsedtones, a‘consciousnessofwhathasjustbeen’(Miller1984,120). It is this process of conscious, invoked memory – distinct from a more isolated act of recollection – that enables temporal structure to take shape, allowing events to fall into a potentially meaningful sequence rather than a disparate array of occurrences. Husserl also outlines a corresponding notion of protention, what Clarke helpfully describes as ‘the fringe of expectation where what is just about to happen colours our experience of now’. However, this supposedlysymmetricalcounterparttoretentionprovesalittlemoreproblematic; Clarkeraisesaptconcerns regardingboththeincompatibilityofthisconcept with the apparent asymmetry of time itself and with Husserl’s failure to tackle anticipation as an opposite to recollection (D. Clarke 2011, 5). It is enough for present purposes to accept Izchak Miller’s description of the reciprocal relationshipas it is experienced(1984, 121): ‘According to Husserl, I have[…] a primal-impression, a continuous manifold of retentions which are‘modi?ications’ of past primal-impressions and a continuous manifold ofprotentions which are 18 A helpfully detailed examination of this ‘phenomenological reduction’, its distinction fromCartesian philosophy,anditsimplicationsforthenotionsofobjectandessence, can befoundinMiller1984,175–98. 103 PerceivingTime responsibleformyhaving…ananticipatoryawarenessofacontinuousmanifoldof futureprimal-impressions.’ 19 Inthecontextofaperformance,suchaviewoftimeperceptionwouldseem to place listeners in the crux of the momentary present, with potential musical meanings accessiblethroughacombinationof‘moving’memoriesofthepast and shiftingexpectationsofthefuture.Theideaofan‘organisingimpulse’lyingatthe heart of the listening enterprise (in the spirit of Whittall’s take on the act of composition,discussedattheoutsetofChapterTwo:AlternativePaths)appearsto hold true here.20 It is aconclusion echoed by Hodges andSebald, who conclude their survey of neurological hearing mechanisms by outlining a psychological tendency:‘Wemayhaveinventedmusic,inpart,becauseweweresurroundedbya sound worldfrom whichwe couldnot escape. Musical sound results, at least in part, from thehuman need to organise andelaborate sensory input’(2011, 96– 110). When it comes to sound, order and meaning are unavoidably linked; listening to music necessitates, on some level, a direct engagement with our temporal consciousness. In its broadest sense, ‘musical time’ might best be understoodasanapproachtowardstheorganisationofsoundthatfacilitatessuch meaning. Processingmusicaltime Practicallyspeaking,it is rhythm andmetrethat mightbethoughtofas themost rudimentary subdivisions of musical time. However, ‘rhythm’ in particular has come to encompass a number of de?initions. Christopher Hasty navigates the ‘extraordinary range of reference’ that it has acquired by separating this variety into threedistinct groups:broadertemporal organisationin music, the unfolding of musical form, and quanti?iable patterns of rhythm and metre. Although he 19 Detailed examinations of Husserl’s account of the perception of a melody and its implicationsfortemporalphenomenologycanbefoundinClarke2011:1–24,Miller1984: 117–44,andSmith1979:100–16. 20 ChristopherSmallalsoemphasiseslisteningasanactiveroletoplayintheperformance of music in his Musicking (1998); his theory will be explored further in the coming chapters. 104 PerceivingTime identi?iesthethirdoftheseasthemostcommonlyemployedde?inition,heisquick to emphasise the implications that anexploration of such features may have for wider‘rhythms’,eveniftheseareoftenneglectedindiscussion(1981b,183–85). Indeed, a positivethat might be gleaned from the broadening of‘rhythm’ into something ofan umbrella term is the way in which temporal processing in music might accordingly be connected with aspects of more general experience. Hodges andSebaldprovidea convincingoverview ofthe ways in whichahuman senseofrhythmmightbecontextualisedwithinauniversethatexistsina‘stateof vibration’, contrasting recurring cosmic shifts with the oscillations of atomic particles outlinedin String Theory (2011, 31–36): ‘Althoughwe cannot perceive vibrationsatthemacro-andmicroscopicscales,theperiodicitieswecanperceive create a rhythmic environment. Seasons of the year, phases of the moon, and periods of daylight anddark follow in regular, timely patterns.’ In a manner inkeeping with Epstein’s idea of a ‘biological clock’, these natural patterns are mirroredbythehumanbody, withprocesseslikeheartandbreathingrates,brain waves,hormonaloutputsandsleepcyclesactingasreadilyobservableillustrations ofphysiologicalrhythms(HodgesandSebald2011,33). The fundamental nature of these traits has lead to questions of whether some basic understandings of rhythm might be considered universal. Although conceding a decidedly Western perspective, Carolyn Drake and Daisy Bertrand have set out suggestions for cross-cultural research methods that might helpto identifycommonprocessingcharacteristics(2003,21–31).Thetraitstheypropose demonstrate leanings towards regularity of sequence, moderation ofspeed, and the perceived interrelation of durations and intervals, all features that might facilitatearhythmicunderstandingthatiscapableofextendingbeyondwhatthey describeasa‘memorybuffer’ofprocessingtime: One can imagine a temporal window gliding gradually through time, with new eventsarriving atone endandoldeventsdisappearing atthe otherduetodecay. Thusonlyeventsoccurringwithinaspanofa fewsecondswouldbeaccessiblefor processing at any one time, and only events occurring within this limited time window can be situated in relation to each other by the coding of relevant relationalinformation.(2003,23) 105 PerceivingTime Theability to movebeyondthis basic limitationis just one ofthewaysin which humans prove themselves to be notably selective in issues of time organisation;JustinLondonoutlinesacommonapplicationofthisfacilitywithina musical context, asserting thatoftentheresponsibility lies withlisteners to make an ‘effort to project and maintain an established meter in passages that involve things like syncopation and hemiola’ (2004, 25). Both physiologically and psychologicallyevolvedconstitutions allowpeopleto be‘more time–independent thanother livingthings’, as Hodges andSebaldputit. This abilityto register and respondto speci?ic rhythmicpatterns is usually demonstrated fromanearly age, principallythroughtheincreasinglycomplexprocessesoflanguageacquisitionand themovementsandexchangesofsocialinteraction(HodgesandSebald2011, 35). Also developed, albeit more gradually, are tactics for rhythmic adjustment in a variety of contexts, with people altering their own gestures to accord with the motions of others, a shift referred to by cognitive theorists as entrainment. As Londonexplains: Entrainmentleadsustofocusourattentiontothemostsalienttemporallocations for events; attention is, by its very nature, selective. We are almost always immersed in a rich and, from an information-processing perspective, noisy environment.Thereismuchgoingonthatcommandsourattention,butonlysome of the activity and information in our environment – including musical environments–isrelevanttousatanygivetime.(2004,14) London continues by outlining this as a two-way exchange, with humans projecting orderandsequenceontothesurroundingenvironmentas time passes. A long–acknowledged phenomenon he describes as subjective metricisation – where listeners perceive or impose their own rhythmic groupings upon regular aural patterns – serves to placefurtheremphasis onthe power listenersholdto modifyandmanipulatemusicalinformation: In temporal attending, it is useful (and perhaps necessary) for the perceiver to establisha self-generated groundagainstwhichthe continuing temporalpatterns maybediscerned.Thisattending strategymayoriginate inextrapolationsfroma local invariant or characteristic rhythmic Sigure that implies a particular metric schema,butthe continuationofa meterislessdependenton subsequentmusical invariantsthan on (a)the listener'sabilitytogenerate metricpatterns(an ability 106 PerceivingTime that may vary with age, talent, training, and enculturation), and (b) the lack of interference from subsequent musical stimuli (interference here meaning the emergenceofapatternofalternatemetriccues).(2004,14–15) Theinclination of listeners to attempt to break up longstretches of aural informationintosmallercomparablechunks asameans to comprehendinglarger musical structures isanidea thathas beenmuch discussed. The most in?luential theoretical research carried out in this regard is that by Fred Lerdahl and Ray Jackendoff,whoseAGenerativeTheoryofTonalMusic(1983)hasprovidedaformal examination of grouping techniques. Distinct from metre, which constitutes divisions ofbeats or demarcations (1983, 18), grouping is a process by which a pieceisdividedupinto temporalunitsaccordingtoaspectsofitsmusicalcontent. Theseunitsrarely overlap, andtheyfall withinarecursivehierarchy ofdominant andsubordinateregionsaccordingtotheirsize.21 Directapplicationsofthisgroupingtheoryarelimitedwithinthecontextof across-historical study suchas this given Lerdahl andJackendoff’s speci?ic focus uponmoretraditional, tonal music. Inthis sense, themannerinwhich they deal withmusicalformremainsquiteconventional;subjectandcountersubjectgroups, regular phrase lengths and established tonal mapping procedures continue to dictate many broader structural readings. However, all ofthis analytical detail is notallowedtosupersedeinnatemusicalintuition, withtheauthors assertingthat the grouping procedures they outline are not con?ined to musically experienced listeners (1983, 18), with facets of even themost nuanced operations remaining accessible when presented and af?irmed in the right contexts: ‘Unconscious processes ofamazingcomplexity andsubtletyarebyno meansincompatiblewith a conscious impression of great ease and ?luidity, and with the sense that one learns these cognitive tasks by “just picking them up” from experience with suf?icientenvironmentalstimulation’(1983,249).Aparticularlyconvincingrecent af?irmationofthiskindofprocessispresentedbyLondonwhonotestheabilityof listeners to retainandapplypatternsofattentionto varyinglevelsofrecurrence. Hehighlightsmusicalexperienceasanotablydynamicphenomenon: 21 A helpfulredaction ofLerdahl& Jackendoff’s theoryof grouping canalso be found in West,Howell&Cross,1985:34–42. 107 PerceivingTime We donotencounter‘generic4/4’oreven ‘4/4 ata tempoofquarter-note =120’ butapatternoftiminganddynamicsthatisparticulartothepiece,the performer, andthe musicalstyle.Therefore,togiveanecologicallyvalidaccountofmeter,we mustmovebeyond atheoryoftempo-metrical types to ametrical representation that involves particular timing relationships and their absolute values in a hierarchicallyrelatedsetofmetriccycles.(2004,159) Developing this notion, he proposes the ‘Many Metres Hypothesis’: ‘A listener's metric competence resides in her or his knowledge of a very large number of context-speci?ic metrical timing patterns. The number and degree of individuation among these patterns increases with age, training, and degree of musicalenculturation’(2004,152–53). Themore empirical rootingofthe ‘generativetheory’incognitivescience seemstohavestooditingoodsteadwithregardtosubsequentempiricalresearch. Although Ian Cross (1998) expressed reservations as to whether it provided a suf?icient alternative to what he termed ‘folk psychologies’ regarding temporal perception,researchintosegmentationandgroupingprocessescarriedoutbyEric ClarkeandCarol Krumhansl (1990)hasprovidedoutcomes thatnotonlysupport LerdahlandJackendoff’stheorybutdemonstrate–throughastudyutilisingmusic by Mozart and Stockhausen – its potential overlap with less conventional, posttonalmusic. Christopher Hasty also seeks to account for a wider variety of compositional styles in his writing concerning metre as it is experienced by listeners (1981a, 1981b, 1984, 1986 and 1997). In seeking to re-establish a broaderde?initionofmetreandreaf?irmitsplacewithinavarietyofcompositional styles,heexplores its impactintermsofattentionandanticipation, formulatinga theoryofprojection: Projectivepotentialisthepotentialforapresentevent’sdurationtobereproduced for a successor. This potential is realised if and when there is a new beginning whose durationalpotential isdetermined by the nowpast Sirst event. Projective potentialisnotthepotentialthattherewillbeasuccessor,butratherthepotential ofa pastand completeddurationalquantitybeing takenasespeciallyrelevantfor thebecomingofapresentevent.(Hasty1997,84) 108 PerceivingTime Thesheerbreadthofthisinterpretationofmetreallows awideningofthekindof musical gestures it can encompass, allowing greater ?lexibility with regard to phraselengths: As the phrase is being formed, primary constituents are open to future interpretation and may bear considerable ambiguities, particularly in the initial stages.TheclosureofthephraseisthefulSilmentofcertainofthesepossibilitiesat theexpenseofothers.Attheconclusionofthephrasethestructuralmeaningofthe constituentshasbecomerelativelySixed. Totheextentthe structureisclosed, the partsnolongerprojectfuturepossibilities.Ofcourse,closureisrarelysocomplete as toentirelydenythe future. Normally, something isleft unincorporated which can engender a new phrase, or there may be residual ambiguities which are resolvedbysucceedingphrases.(Hasty1984,188) Affectandattention Beyond the practical and socialworld of clockordered events there isthe inner world […] the musical world[…]a Slux where eventshappen ata multiplicity of unit speeds, where the units themselves are subject to distortions, and where uncounted episodes, unit-free durations, are a large part of our experience. Our sense of time comes closest to clock time when we are experiencing a regular successionof perceptuallyequalunits.Whentheunitsbecome very,verylong the experience becomes that of unit-free duration. […]When the units become very shorttheyblurintotexture.(Erickson1963,177) Undertaking any kind of scienti?ic examination of the relationship between functional clock time and musical time is no easy feat. Attempted comparison between a quanti?iable absoluteand a wholly subjectiveexperience inempirical termsisboundtoprovesomewhatfutile.Apartfromanythingelse,?indingasclose toanobjectiveandstandardisedmeansofexpressionaspossiblereturnsustothe problems of articulatory variety discussed in Chapter Three (Directing Time). Indeed,theapproachofcomposerRobertEricksonquotedaboveservesasanapt illustration ofthe partiallyestrangedtemporalitythat music is oftenregardedas inhabiting, atleastforits participants; here, musical timeseeminglythreatensto acquireakindofperceptual‘autonomy’withregardtotheclock-de?inedabsolutes 109 PerceivingTime of ordinary functional time. Musical learning and experience may even enable subjects to develop an independent ‘clock’, with research by Deborah Sheldon (1994) pointing to the possibility of an ‘internalised steady beat’ acting as the yardstickbywhichtempochangesarecomprehendedandimplemented. What can most certainly be gleaned from many studies that attempt to correlate listeners’ expectations and intuitions of musical durations with clock timings isthesheervariety offactors that cancontributeto theextremevariation between these two temporal modes. As Henry Orlov outlines, ‘if the ‘biological clock’ does not always tell the right time, it is because its readings are often obstructedanddistortedinsomewaybyphysiologicalandpsychologicalreactions and processes of different intensity and colouring, of which pleasure and displeasure, satisfaction and dissatisfaction are the ?irst and most usual’ (1979, 375). Emotions have been shown to have a profound bearing upon the way in whichtimeand durations inparticular are registered (see Droit-Volet and Meck 2007,andAngrilli,Cherubini,PaveseandManfredini1997),andthisextendstothe perceivedaffectconveyedbythemusicitself.22 Exploring further links between emotion, tonality and timing, Naomi Ziv andElad Omer’s study ofdurationestimations intonal andatonal music (2010) considers theadditional complexitiesofthedifferencesbetweenexperiencedand remembered time. Some participants listening to keyboard works by Bach and Schoenberg were asked in advance to judge the amount of time passing (the prospective paradigm), whilst others were only asked to provide a durational estimate afterthe fact(theretrospective paradigm). As well as providingfurther evidenceoftheprofoundroleemotionsplayintimeperception,itwas foundthat ‘themorepleasantandconsonantapiecesounds, theshorteritisperceivedinthe prospective paradigm, and the longer it seems in the retrospective paradigm’(2010,192). Suchresults raisequestions ofattentiveness andits effect upon impressions of time. Recent research emphasises its signi?icance, in particular with regard to processing duration; Scott Brown’s review of research concerning this relationship (2010) ?inds attention – on both conscious and 22 Forexample, a studycarried outbyMaria Panagiotidiand Stavroula Samartzi(2010) demonstrates that, while musical training can help to imbue a more objective sense of passing clock time,itiscommonplace forall listeners tounderestimate the durationof a ‘happy’ piece (quick in tempo, majorin key) and to overestimate that of a ‘sad’ piece (slower,minorinkey). 110 PerceivingTime subconsciouslevels–tobearequirementformoreaccuratetemporaljudgments.23 Emphasisonthenecessityofattentivelisteninginevitablypromptsqueryastothe effect of altered states of consciousness uponthe processing of musical time, in particular direct manipulations of subject perception such as those induced by drugs.24 While such physiological and neurological issues are not a primary concern here, it is helpful to takenote of a contextualisationoffered by Richard Elliott: If consciousness studies has shown an interest in the effects of drug-induced alteredstatesofconsciousnessonmusic,wemightaskwhysuchalteredstatesare mostly seen to concern transformations of the immediate perception of individuals,understoodfromtheperspectiveofchemicalchangesintheirbrains.It isequallythecasethatwe neverhearanypieceof musicthesamewaytwice,that wealwaysbring something newand differenttoit, and thatthese differencescan arise as much from to the impact of history, culture, and politics as of mindalteringdrugs.(2011,336–37) Somuchscholarlyenergyhasbeendirectedtowardsattentionlevelsthatit has been suggested that other qualities have been underplayed by comparison. Whenexaminingdurationspeoplehadassignedtostimuli,DavidEagleman(2010) foundpredictabilityandmagnitudeofneuralresponse to be especiallyimportant factors. However, evenaspects ofdirectedpredicationcanplay into theeffect of attention upon time. In his survey ofstudies concerned with ‘prior entry’ – the phenomenonofaforthcomingstimulusseemingtobeperceivedsoonerintimeifit is anticipated than if it is not – Charles Spence (2010) ?inds that accumulated empirical evidence sits ?irmly in favour of the theory. Once stimuli have commenced, however, subjects more often experience the opposite effect, with focussed attention upon events causing them to seem longer in duration. In 23 A large body of research has been undertaken concerning the use of music as a background element in commercial contexts and its effect upon consumers. Given that musicinthesestudiesisutilisedasaperipheralpresenceratherthanapointoffocus,they donotwarrantdetailed explorationhere.However, a numberof publicationsdo explore aspects of duration experience and estimation with regard to the tempo, content and familiarityofbackgroundmusic:BaileyandAreni,2006;KellarisandKent,1992;Kellaris andMantel,1996;CaldwellandHibbert,1999;andOakes,2003. 24 Twouseful and especiallyaccessible recentexplorationsof the effectof drug-induced altered states upon musical consciousness can be found in Music and Consciousness: Philosophical,Psychological,andCulturalPerspectivesed.Clarke&Clarke,Fachner,2011: 263–76;andShanon,2011:281–92 111 PerceivingTime examining this temporal expansion, Peter Ulric Tse (2010) has questioned the traditional model of distraction as causing aproportion oftemporal information units to be missed, whilst attention causes less to be missed. He suggests that listeners assumeamoreengagedroleinthis process throughevidencethat focus inducedbyanunexpectedeventinfactacceleratesinformationprocessing: More unitsaredetectedduringtheeventanditthereforeseemstolastlonger,but thisoccursbecausethere aremore unitsdetected, notbecause feweraremissed. The previous hypothesis assumed that attention affected sensitivity, leading to fewer missed cues in a stream of constant rate. Alternatively, it could be that sensitivityremainsunchangedbyattentionbuttherateof informationprocessing increases.These interpretationsare notmutuallyexclusive.Bothcouldcontribute todistortionsinperceived durationandbothare compatible withthe notion ofa counterthatmeasuresthe amountof information processed inordertocalculate the duration of perceived events. For either reason, an attended stimulus may appear to last longerthan a lessattended stimulusthatlaststhe same objective duration.(2010,146) Such notions ofattention and distraction inform questions as to whether people are capable of judging multiple durations simultaneously. Although researchqueryingtheabilityofsubjectstotimeoverlappingstimulihasnotruled out thepotentialforthe employment ofmorethanone‘clock’, it has highlighted notable inclinations: that greater numbers of parallel stimuli cause increasing disruption in duration judgment (Brown andWest 1990); and that people more oftenutiliseasingletimesourceas a referencepointby whichto gauge multiple durations (Rijn and Taatgen 2008). That listeners might seek to organise and simplify anarrayofstimuli according to anaudiblelowest commondenominator comes as no surprise. However, this singular ‘pacemaker’ approach is more complex than such an account would suggest. Inher study concerned with time estimation in music, Marilyn Boltz is keen to emphasise the effect of different perspectivesofattentionupondurationperception(Boltz1991).Acknowledginga common hierarchy of metre, phrase length and rhythm, she asserts that the processing of these units depends crucially upon whether the material they contain aligns or avoids expectation; broader structural coherence and predictability allows the attention oflisteners to move freely betweenlarge and small units, whilst unpredictable, incoherent music does not so readily facilitate 112 PerceivingTime suchshifts.Moreover, diversionsfromexpectationwithinphraselengths–suchas disruptiveaccentplacement,orunexpectedchangesinmelodiccontour–canskew perceivedunitdurations. Boltz contrastsmelodiesthatconcludeonthetonic with thosethatdonot,withthelattertypicallyoverestimatedinlength(1991,425–27). Diversionsandsubversions It is particularly interesting that Boltz places emphasis upon the variety of structural levels that canbe identi?iedin pieces ofmusic andthe ways in which attentional perspective can move between these levels. With regard to the perceptionoftime,bothmusic andaudienceprove decidedly complex. Focus can bedrawntowardsdifferentfacetsofcompositionsonvaryingplanesofdetail, and it is this process of shifting attention between musical characteristics that can produce changes in how temporality is processed. In the sense that particular musical traits can elicit certain kinds of reactions from listeners, it might be perceivedthatagreat deal ofpowerliesinthehandsofcomposers, leavingthem withtheability not only toorganise musical timeina morelinear-mindedsense but further to manipulate time for their audiences in a rather more non-linear fashion. Robert Newell’s assertion that ‘whoever makes music also moulds time’ provesaptinthisregard(1976,147). Beyondpatternsofrhythm,controlledusesoftimbre,pitchandtonalityadd further dimensions to audible time. Robert Erickson rightly acknowledges the lessened signi?icance of timbre in much music of the eighteenth and nineteenth centuries, where melodic writing is often notably faster and attention thus focussed on pitch (1975, 82–85). However, there can be little doubt that the timbralfocus intheoftenmoreprotractedgestures ofmorerecentmusic offersa more immersive time. Just as unexpected events incite accelerated reception of temporal information units, a distinctive timbral effect might prompt a similar heightenedmodeoflisteninginwhich moments perceptually expand; withinthe context of this study, movements from Hans Abrahamsen’s Schnee might be consideredintheseterms.Pitchcanprovidesimilarmanipulations. DianaDeutsch (1980) provides an account of how parallel movement between two separate 113 PerceivingTime groupings of pitch class can blur the rhythm and order of their perceived relationships. Firmino, Bueno andBigand(2009) extend this disruptive effect of pitch movement to tonality, using their research to demonstrate the temporal acceleration created by music that involves tonal movement to more distant, unrelatedkeys. Ofcourse, generalisationregardingthetemporalpotentialofthesemusical featuresisofonlylimitedusegiventheeffectofsuchfeaturesisdependentonthe context in whichtheyare presented. Indeed, theinterdependencebetweenthese characteristicsleadsRobertCutietta(1993)toquestionwhethertheelementsthat form the basis of much music education (pitch, rhythm, form, dynamics and timbre)areinfactre?lective ofacategorisationprocessthat doesnotcorrespond with how pieces are heard. Indeed, his response is to suggest alternative perception-based elements: three that deal with aspects of musical movement (motion, energy, ?low), and two that constitute less systematic reinventions of textureandtimbre(fabricandcolour).Itisnocoincidencethatthesearetermsfar more readily suited to addressing more recent music. Those describing musical movementinparticularfeatureheavilyinthisstudy.Withoutdoubt,theyaremore aural-centric, holistically mindedanalyticalthemes thatmight allow an approach to musical form that does not rely quite so heavily upon long-held hierarchies. Indeed, it may well help to provide a more dynamic alternative than simply mapping a different set of hierarchies onto more progressive music, as Michel Imbertysuggestsinaddressingtheperceptionofatonalworks(1993). Of course, even the terms Cutietta suggests constitute necessary distillations ofafarmorecomplexandintegratedauralreality, one thatdoes not afford such separations. As Barbara Barry puts it, ‘in analytic time an objective technique is applied to the work to identify objects for attention, whereas in experientialtimeitisthemusicalworkasperformancewhichrequiresrecognition of time as organised motion and ongoing progress’ (1990, 105). Barry’s own approach to musical time revolves around her ‘tempo/density theory’ derived fromaparticularunderstanding,that‘thespeedatwhichtimepassesisthespeed atwhichinformationisprocessed’(1990,165);inessence, the?luctuatingspacing – or density – of musical events in the course of a composition determines its perceived temporality and duration. Although her applications of the theory are 114 PerceivingTime mostly con?ined to works that echo or engage with more traditional structural values, the reasoning she offers would appear to resonate with both cognitive theory and, potentially, more recent music: ‘higher density musical information ?ills a longer experiential time than more normative information played at the same tempo. It requires more processing ‘effort’ because it has a greater uncertainty (less predictability, which would reduce complexity) and so is less easilyassimilatedtostandardsasreferencepointsoforganisation’(1990,167). Itismorerecent, ‘post-tonal’musicthatRobertAdlingtonspeci?icallyseeks to account for (1997b and 2003). He establishes a useful branch of questioning with regard to received temporal notions, highlighting their failure to offer convincing treatments for certain musical experiences. Indeed, highlighting its relianceuponculturalconstructs, hepointstoalackofinternalcoherenceinmost commonconceptions: ‘It would appear thatno social concept oftime couldever adequately contain experience. Rather, what we conventionally refer to as an individual’s “temporal experience” is the result of personal idiosyncrasies – assemblages of, and elaborations upon, diverging constructed concepts of time’ (1997, 21–22). In unpacking these conglomerations of language and metaphor, Adlington seeks out solid theoretical ground that might be?it the consideration of new music. A major obstacle he confronts is that of perceived motion in music, a broadly accepted notion that, he claims, limits the ways in whichmusical experiencesmightbe described. Studies like thoseby Epstein and Barry, he asserts, are preoccupied with intuited motion as an essential facet of musical temporality, oneoftentiedto moretraditionalgoal-orientedperspectives on tonality andmetrical structure (Adlington, 1997b, 82–88). Inhighlightingthe insuf?icienciesofsuchdescriptions, Adlingtonpointsto passagesinmoreformally conventional pieces – Schoenberg’s Piano Concerto and Poulenc’s Sextet – that might be experienced as temporally ‘static’ as a consequence of their metrical conformityratherthansimplyinspiteofit(1997b,90). Taking this ideaofstasis further with more recent examples by Cage and Reich, Adlington draws upon Jonathan Kramer’s description of ‘vertical time’ to advocate a different mode of understanding for much new music; rather than claiming post-tonal composition to represent any kind of ‘withdrawal’ from standard temporality (Adlington 1997b, 22), he instead proposes a ‘non-spatial’ 115 PerceivingTime interpretationoftimethatsidestepsmorecommonframeworksoflinearprogress: ‘Attentionis insteadabsorbed by the contents of working memory – sifting and sortinginanefforttolocatedregsofstructure,pattern,ororder’(1997b,103–11). The implications ofthis interpretation for comprehensionofmusical forms over longer periods of time will be discussed further in the course of the next theoreticalinterlude,chapterseven. Adlington’s scepticism proves particularly useful in identifying the shortcomings of temporal conceptions that are often taken for granted. His interrogativemannertowardstheseperceptualmodespavesthewayforaccounts of previously neglected or unexplained musical experiences. However, his approachinfactprovesmostconvincinginthecourseofhisclosingexaminationof Ligeti’sViolinConcerto inwhichsomeofthemore radicalattitudes towards time hehas proposedareintegrated with more familiar, linear-mindedideas (1997b, 196–215). Focusingupondifferentaspectsofthe?irstmovement oftheconcerto, Adlingtonconveysbesttheeffectofnon-spatialisedtimewhencontrastingit with expectationsoflinearity.Theseexpectationsareaf?irmedandsubsequentlydenied through the composer’s careful deployment of isorhythms and ‘glimpses’ of organisedpulsethatbrie?lyarouselonger-termanticipations–‘evokethelistener’s temporality’, as he puts it – before frustrating them once more through their renewedabsence (1997b, 207). The audible terms in which these distinct ideas abouttimeintermingleprovesespeciallycompelling: At the outset of the section, Ligeti’s grouped rhythm connotes a ‘structure’ by appearing, initially, to measure. Yet this compliance with spatio-linearity is invoked, only to be gradually and remorselessly withdrawn as the section proceeds. The music very evidentlycontinues, butwe are explicitly deprived the usuallinearmeansofconceptualizingit. Broughtfacetoface with the inadequacy of these means, a listener ischallenged instead to formulate alternative ways of understandingtheircontinuingexperienceofchange.(1997b,203–4) This thesis seeks to emphasise that kind of interplay between temporal modes as a point of analytical interchangebetweenold andnew styles ofmusic; although compositional means may differ, the end result is a perceptual variety thatservestounderlinetheexpressivepotentialofthepieces.Tothisend,itisthe work of Jonathan Kramer that exerts the greatest in?luence. His embrace of the 116 PerceivingTime oftenseemingly paradoxicalvarietyofmusical‘times’availableto listenersoffers aninclusiveoutlook thatmight bene?itananalytical approach. Inparticular,heis careful to try to distinguish between different ‘times’ that might often be consideredasone,highlightingnuancesthatmighthelpto explainveryparticular perceptual phenomena. As discussed earlier in this chapter, his broadercontrast between linear andnon-linear timeis subject to numerous furtherquali?ications andextensions. Linearity, for example, mighttakeona plural character, withthe music aurally travelling towards more than one ‘goal’ (‘multiply-directed linear time’)thanksto elementsofformaldisruptionthatoffsetperceivedsingularity(J. Kramer 1988,46–49). Evenmoresingular expressionsoflinearitycanbesubject to re-orderings and discontinuities thatcreateeffects ofmultiplicity, notleast in relation to beginnings and endings of various kinds. Kramer utilises the ?irst movementofBeethoven’sStringQuartetinF,Op.135, todemonstratethewaysin which the deployment of particular musical gestures and statements – a particularly emphatic ‘?inal’ cadence in the 10th bar, for example – can give the impression of displaceddirections, beginnings andendings (‘gestural time’) and thusraisetheideaofa‘multipletemporalcontinuum’(1988,150–61). Kramer also explores a variety of ways in which direction can be absent frommusicaltime.Makingreferenceto worksbyBach,ChopinandSchumann,he observes that pieces can paradoxically convey a sense of motion without also conveying direction thanks to compositional elements that remain constant throughout: linearityandmotiondo notalways equateto directioninperceptual terms. Two further non-linear musical structures also offer subversions of teleological form. The ?irst – ‘moment form’– constitutes asubversionoftypical continuitiesthroughthe employmentofdiscontinuousmusicalevents, disrupting standard notions of linearity in favour of a succession of self-contained occurrences (J. Kramer 1978 and 1988, 201–20). The second is the antihierarchical ‘vertical time’, in which a dispensation of phrase structuring can createaplayuponaspects ofperceivedstasis andin?inity that inturnenablesan immersivetemporalform: The result is a single present stretched out into an enormous duration, a potentially inSinite ‘now’ that nonetheless feels like an instant … A vertically conceived piece, then, does notexhibit large-scale closure. Itdoesnot begin but 117 PerceivingTime merelystarts. Itdoes notbuild to a climax, does notpurposefullyset upinternal expectations,doesnotseektofulSillanyexpectationsthatmightariseaccidentally, doesnotbuild orreleasetension, anddoesnotendbutsimplyceases.(1988,54– 55) It is anotherkindoftemporal paradox that will formthe starting point of thecasestudythatnowfollows.CompositionsbyHansAbrahamsenandJohannes Brahmswillbeexaminedonaccountofthewaysinwhichtheyareableto convey sensations of motion and stasis simultaneously; whereas focus has previously fallen on particular passages, emphasis here will instead fall upon some of the implicationsthatthisperceptualsynthesismighthaveforthelong-termstructural unfolding of both works. As progressive as this seemingly contradictory coexistenceofdynamicandstatic temporal modesmightappear, itmightalsobe consideredto arise from a thematic approachto material developedprimarily in thenineteenthcentury,theprincipleof‘developingvariation’. 118 Six DynamicContinuities HansAbrahamsen&JohannesBrahms Developingvariation On the face of it, Schoenberg’s 1947 essay ‘Brahms the Progressive’ (1975b) – adapted from a 1933radio talk – was promptedby musicological concerns. For manyatthetime,itwasmorethanamatterofchronologicalfactthatBrahmswas considered a nineteenth-century composer. His seemed an aesthetic with little perceivabledistance left to run; few saw inhis music anythingona parwiththe uncompromising futurism of Wagner, the enduring purity of Mozart, or the ‘forevercontemporary’Beethoven–all?igureswhosemusicwasalready‘escaping’ itsowntimeinpopularcriticism. The label of conservatism had at no point been entirely unanimous. In addition to Eduard Hanslick’s adoption of Brahms as a standard-bearer for his aesthetic notions of musical beauty (Hanslick 1957, 47–70), Nicole Grimes has recentlyobservedthatatrioofwritersfortheAllgemeinemusikalischeZeitungand theNeue ZeitschriftfürMusik inthe1860sand1870s– HermannDeiters, Selmar Bagge and Adolf Schubring – presented a ‘signi?icant foreshadowing of Schoenberg’s view’ (Grimes 2012, 132). Indeed, even following the composer’s death, somesought tocounterprevailingviews;writingin1929,J.H.Elliotsought torailagainst‘atendencyobservableincertainaspectsofcurrentcriticismtodeny theexistenceofa complete andall-round signi?icanceinthesymphonic music of Brahms’(Elliot1929,554). Nevertheless, Schoenberg’s article offered, as its title indicates, a muchneeded reappraisal of a ?igurehead of the Austro-German Romantic tradition whose music was being written off more and more frequently by scholars as antiquated.Promotionfroma?igureconventionallyregardedatthetimeasoneof themostprogressiveinWesternartmusicmaywellhavehelpedtofacilitatewhat MichaelMusgravedescribedas‘aperiodwhenitisnolongernecessarytoplaythe advocatetoBrahms’(1990, 136). Inparticular,PeterGayandJ. PeterBurkholder 119 DynamicContinuities have both made compelling cases for re-evaluations, Gay with regard to the detrimentaleffectsofculturaloverfamiliarityonourreception(1977),Burkholder inconsideringthemusic ofthetwentiethcentury:‘Hehasprovidedthemodelfor futuregenerationsofwhatacomposeris,whatacomposerdoes,whyacomposer does it, what is of value in music, and how a composer is to succeed…. In this respect, the “music of the future” has belonged not to Wagner but to Brahms.’(1984,81). Threadedthrough ‘Brahms the Progressive’ was a thematic principle that Schoenberghadbeenexpoundingforsometime,thatof‘developingvariation’:the basic trace of a motif retained throughout a process of ‘endless reshaping’(Schoenberg1975, 129).Thespeci?icsofthetheoryhavelongbeenthe subject of debate. Grimes notes the ?irst appearance of the concept in a 1917 manuscript: ‘Coherence, Counterpoint, Instrumentation, Instruction in Form’ (Schoenberg, 1994). From the text, she delineates six types of musical changethatcancontributeto theprocess: rhythmic,intervallic,harmonic,phrase, instrumentationand dynamic. Writing before the publication of thattext, Walter Frisch (1984, 1–2)?inds a particularly helpful explanation in a muchlateressay, ‘Bach’of1950.Here, Schoenbergmovesbeyondtheobviouslymusical,alludingto themoreconceptualunderpinningoftheprinciple;developingvariationallowsthe ‘idea’ofthepiecetobe‘elaborated’,producing‘allthethematicformulationswhich provide for ?luency, contrasts, variety, logic and unity on the one hand, and character, mood, expression, and every needed differentiation, on the other hand’(Schoenberg1975,397).25 Although writing about variation form more generally, Jeffery Swinkin eloquently outlines a way in whichsuch attitudes towards musical material can translateintobroaderaestheticoutlooks: The implicit corollary of the belief that Classical variations are essentially decorative is thatthe theme in a Classicalsetisanautonomous entitywith Sixed melodic and harmonic components, susceptible to embellishment but not reinterpretation… By contrast, anyone who granted variations greater interpretative potencywouldprobablyregard thetheme notasanapriorientity 25 Fora detailedexaminationof the widerimpact ofBrahms’smusicupon Schoenberg’s thought,seeMusgrave1979. 120 DynamicContinuities but as something whose identityis contingent upon the processesto which it is subjected.(2012,37) However, it isFrischhimselfwho provides themost persuasiveinterpretationof thenotionwithregardtobroadermusicalstructure: Schoenbergvaluesdevelopingvariationasacompositionalprinciplebecauseitcan prevent obvious, monotonous, repetition … And Brahms’s music stands as the most advanced manifestation of this principle in the common-practice era, for Brahmsdevelopsorvarieshismotivesalmostatonce,dispensingwithsmall-scale rhythmic or metrical symmetry and thereby creating genuine musical prose. (1984,9) Of course, Schoenberg had a dual agenda. Beyond his concerns for the reception of Brahms, he was also busy engineering his own place in musical history. In portraying a progressive artistic bloodline ?lowing from J.S. Bach throughHaydn,Mozart, BeethovenandBrahms, hewascarefullyestablishing his ownaesthetic inheritance. Overtly, Brahms’s music was being promoted through re-evaluation,butthisreframing process wasalso theproductofacovert motive, pavingthewayforSchoenberg’sownparticularbrandofradicalserialism.Indeed, Frisch’s descriptions of the ‘inversions and combinations … augmentations and displacements’(1984, 9) that comprisedeveloping variationfall tellingly closeto thelexiconoftwelve-tonecomposition. The signi?icance of Brahms being utilised in this way should not be underestimated. After all, Schoenberg was calling upon his music to help precipitate–perhaps evenprescribe –oneofthemost signi?icant sea-changes in Westernmusical history, through aradicalrethinkingoftonality and its function within–andindeeditsbearingupon–musicalform. Itcertainlyprovidesauseful retorttoaccusationsofartistic conservatism.Butforthepurposesofthisstudy,it might in turn be of use to adapt Schoenberg’s concept of developing variation, namely by moving beyond speci?ic musical characteristics to focus upon its fundamental aural effect. It could be concluded that, at its core, developing variationisatreatmentoftime.Presentingablendofrepetitionandchangeallows equilibrium of focus to beestablished: past events are directly recalled to mind, butareplacedwithinthecontextofaudiblealterationsthatemphasisethepassing of time. Reminiscence is grounded within a palpably future-bound present. A 121 DynamicContinuities temporalparadoxofsimultaneousdynamismandstasisissetinmotion: theaural sensationis atoncebothlinear andcircular. Beyondsimply takingtheshapeofa compositional approach to melody, developing variation becomes a force of structural continuity in the heard form of the music. Aspects of this perceptual effect will be discussed in the course of the case study that follows, with the apparent interplay between movement and stillness that it facilitates forming a pointoffocus. Multipleforms–Abrahamsen Tempo can be fast or slowand perhaps life has the same thing […]. We can be living seeminglyquickly, butunderthe surface something movesmore gradually. Sometimes we have to acknowledge this and wait it out, like living through the winter.(Molleson2015) Viewingthenotionofdevelopingvariationinabroader, temporallight,opensthe ?loor to more recent music. Being at its heart a juxtaposition of change and retention,thecontinuitytheconceptrequirescanbeachievedthroughavarietyof means beyond the melodic. The work ofDanish composer Hans Abrahamsen(b. 1952)actsasanintriguingcaseinpoint, notleastgiventhathewasalignedearly in his careerwiththe ‘New Simplicity’ofhis compatriots inthe1960s, apointed responseto the‘new complexity’serialism advocatedby many in centralEurope (Beyer 2016). Although the composer distances his current work from the reactionary nature of those initial pieces (Molleson 2015), he has cultivated subsequently a deeply personal style in which, as Anders Beyer observes, ‘a modernist stringency and economy are incorporated into an individual musical universe’(Beyer2016). Inbroader terms, his approachmightwell beconsidered ‘post-avant-garde’inthe truestsense, havingsteppedout ofastylecharacterised by extreme ‘newness’(itself a counter to anequally radical trend) to embrace a range of historical in?luences and preoccupations. Indeed, formal rigour still features prominently on Abrahamsen’s agenda, as he himself outlines: ‘My imaginationworks wellwithina?ixedstructure […]. The more stringentit is, the 122 DynamicContinuities morefreedomI havetogodowninto detail. Formandfreedom: perhaps muchof mymusichasbeenanattempttobringthetwoworldstogether’(Beyer2016). In an interview for the Krakow-based Sacrum Profanum Festival in September2010,Abrahamsendescribedhisownmusicintermshighlyrelevantto theperceptualissuesthatthedevelopingvariationconceptpresents(Abrahamsen 2010): Perhapsyou can compare music to an author. There are authorsthatare making long novels. But of course a novelcan also have differentlengths. Some are only 120pagesandthensomeareathousandpages.AndperhapsIasacomposerama kindlikea poemcomposer.I’mwriting shortpieces–likea poem–butthenthey canbeputtogetherformingakindofcycle.(2010) Here, in outlining his approach, the composer would seem to point towards the verytemporalparadoxthatdevelopingvariationgenerates.Dynamismisprovided by the motion from one short piece – or ‘poem’ – to the next. However, their relevance to one another generates a palpable coherence; remaining, or indeed cycling, withinonebroadmusical ‘subjectmatter’createsasenseofcontainment, orperhapsevenstasis. Abrahamsen’s Schnee (‘Snow’) is an apt re?lection of these compositional concerns. Completed in 2008 for the Wittener Tage für neue Kammermusik in Germany, it is writtenfor anine-piece ensemble dividedinto threeequal groups: strings (violin, viola, and cello), wind (piccolo/?lute/alto ?lute, E-?lat/B-?lat/bass clarinet, and oboe/cor anglais), and percussion (two pianos, and one performer utilising tam-tam, schellen, andpaper). Lastingjust under one hour, the work is builtup of canons. The composerrecalls thathe hadbecome fascinatedwiththe genrewhilearrangingworksbyJ.S.Bachinthe1990s.Struckbytheideaoftaking theirrepetitionto extremes, andbytheparadoxesmirroredinthepicturesofthe twentieth-century DutchartistM.C.Escher,Abrahamsenbeganto conceivemusic inwhathedescribes asa‘new animatedworldoftimeincirculation’: ‘Depending on how one looks at these canons, the music stands still, or moves forwards or backwards. Asformy ownwork, afurther ideacrystallised: towrite apiecethat consistsofcanonicmotion,andexplorestheuniverseoftime’(Abrahamsen2009). With regardto thetitle ofthe work, its composerreadilyacknowledges a long-heldfascinationwithwinter.Hisinterestinsnowliesprimarilyinitseffects: 123 DynamicContinuities Movement Instrumentation Duration Strings/piano1 8’43 Tutti 9’12 Woodwinds/piano2 6’57 Strings/woodwind 2’01 Canon2b Lustigspeilend,abernichtzulustig,immerein bisschenmelancholisch Tutti 7’24 Canon3a Sehrlangsam,schleppendundmitTrübsinn(im Tempodes‘TaiChi’) Strings/woodwind 6’53 Canon3b Sehrlangsam,schleppendundmitTrübsinn(im Tempodes‘TaiChi’) Pianos/percussion 7’20 Strings 1’57 Canon4a(minore) (HommageàWAM) Stürmich,unruhigundnervös Tutti 2’34 Canon4b(maggiore) Stürmich,unruhigundnervös Tutti 2’38 Intermezzo3 Cello/piccolo/clarinet 0’41 Canon5a(rectus) Einfachundkindlich Violin/viola/pianos/ piccolo/clarinet 1’07 Canon5b(inversus) Einfachundkindlich Violin/viola/pianos/ piccolo/clarinet 1’15 Canon1a Ruhigaberbeweglich Canon1b Fastimmerzartundstill Canon2a Lustigspeilend,abernichtzulustig,immerein bisschenmelancholisch Intermezzo1 Intermezzo2 Fig.6.1:Schnee,canonicparingsacrosstheformalscheme ‘Snowcantransformafamiliarlandscapeinacoupleofminutesanditdampensall the usual noises. It allows us to imagine something different. Seasons are very basicinour livesandwinter is atimeofslowtransition’(Molleson2015).Whilst snowoffersnewwaysofviewinguponfamiliarscenes,thecanonsofSchneeincite freshperspectivesonthesamesetsofmaterial.The tencanonsthat makeupthe 124 DynamicContinuities Intermezzo Detuningsequence • Celloplaysseventhpartialharmoniconfourthstring(alreadytuned • 1 • • • • 2 • • • 3 • • scordaturafromaC-naturaldowntoaGfromthestartofthework), whichprovidesF-naturalloweredby1/6th; CoranglaisSlattensitsconcertF-naturalaccordinglyandthenplaysits newlySlattenedconcertA-natural; Strings,altoSluteandbassclarinetadjusttotheSlattenedA-natural; Thestringtrioremains,detuningbya1/6thpairsofstringsin descendingSifthsbeforeclosingwithperfectSifthofG-naturalandDnaturalatopanoctaveGbassinthecello,graduallyfadingout. Celloagainplaysseventhpartialharmoniconfourthstring(Gnow loweredby1/6th),whichprovidesF-naturalloweredbyafurther 1/6th; ViolinandviolaadjusttheirDandAstringsdownwardbyafurther 1/6th(now2/6thsSlat); Violinandviolathenadjusttheirremainingstringsdownwardin accordancetogetherinadescendingpatternofopen-stringedSifths; Violinandviolaproceedtochecktheirnewtuningsusingoctave harmonicsoneachparingofstrings,nowinanascendingpattern,toa fade-out. Celloplaysoctaveharmonicdouble-stopofDandAstrings(stillonly 1/6thdetunedfromSirstintermezzo); PiccoloandE-Slatclarinetadjusttheirtuningsaccordingly; Allthreeinstrumentsfadeouttogether. Fig.6.2:Schnee,detuningprocessacrossthethreeintermezzi work are arranged in ?ive successive pairs, with short ‘haiku-like’ (Abrahamsen 2009)musicalideasdevelopedacrosseachcoupling(seeFigure6.1).26 However, this surface unity of canon pairings does not proceed uninterrupted. Interposed throughout the form are three brief intermezzi, disrupting the series of couplings. In each intermezzo, different instruments are detuned by microtones ahead of the canons that follow. Rather than simply indicatingapausebetweenmovementsforthedetuningtotakeplace,Abrahamsen ensures thecontinuity ofthewholework bycarefullyengineeringtheprocess of each intermezzo, utilising the existing harmonic sonorities of the instruments to precipitate the detuning (see Figure 6.2). In this way, the detuning process becomes part of the architecture of the work, each intermezzo showcasing a particularly effective set of sonorities and minute harmonic shifts. The effect is striking,withtheshortmovementsofferingastarkcontrastwiththesurrounding 26 Durationstaken from recording listed in primaryresource list(Ensemble Recherche. MusicEdition,Winter&Winter:910159–2). 125 Fig.6.5:FourthSymphony,fourthmovement,outlineofcyclicalformdisplayingstructural divisionsdrawnbyFrisch(2003,130–40),Pascall(1989,233–245),Rostand(1955,291–299), andOsmond-Smith(1983,147–65). Fig.6.4:Schnee,formalschemesegmentedaccordingto‘diminishingstructure’perspective (C=Canon,I=Intermezzo) Fig.6.3:Schnee,formalschemein‘fourmovement’perspectivewithapproximatetimings DynamicContinuities 126 DynamicContinuities canonsthroughanaudiblelackofrhythmicde?initionandawashofsubtlyshifting harmonic sequences. Perhaps more profoundly, their placement throughout the workallowsthemtoactasauraldividers,suggestinganewoverallformofthefour larger‘movements’(seeFigure6.3). Inaddition,thereisafurther,moregradualformalprocessatplayherethat canbededucedfromanoverview:thedecreasinglengthofthecanonpairingsand, by extension, the four ‘movement’ groupings. Abrahamsen candidly admits that when he envisaged the full work following the composition of the ?irst canon pairings,hehadamoreobviouslystaggeredshorteningprocessinmind: The Sirst pair laststwo times nine minutes, so Iconceived the following pairs in termsof2timessevenminutes,2timesSiveminutes,2timesthreeminutes,and2 timesoneminute.Finally,timerunsout,justasthatofourlivesrunseverfasterto itsend.Thiswasmyinitialvision,andthetemporalidea;theexecutionturningout abitdifferently,andCanons3aand3binparticulargotlonger.(2009,3) Eventhough the composer’s original plans for a gradually diminishing structure may not haveworked out in such detail, the effect remains a notable part ofthe performance (see Figure 6.4). Indeed, the whole work is lent an increasingly palpablesense ofonwardmotiontowardsitsclose thanks to this audibleprocess of structural compression and reduction – the broader transience Abrahamsen speaksofisevokedbytheformalplayingoutofthemusic.Evenwithinthecontext of a formal overview of Schnee, at least three different formal gestures can be observed: ?ive pairings of canons, four longer ‘movements’ delineated by three interludes, andonegraduallydiminishingseries. Aspectsofeachcanbeperceived in the course of the piece, with different points of unity and division moving betweenthe backgroundandforegroundofawareness atdifferenttimes. Itisthe interactions between these contrasting structural interpretations that emerge as theworkunfoldsthat will formthefocusofthis casestudy. A parallel analysis of the ?inale of Brahms’ Fourth Symphony will be presented in tandem; here, comparably distinct formal readings that arise as the piece develops will be examined. 127 DynamicContinuities Innovationwithintradition–Brahms The symphonies of Brahms might not appear the most likely candidates for a comparison with Abrahamsen’s multi-faceted structure. The intricacies and logistical complexities of thegenre itselfdo not lend themselvesreadilytowards formal experimentation, and, ataglance, Brahms’s four contributionsdo littleto exemptthemselves;eachfollowsthefour-movementstructurethathadremained the norm for the best part of a century, with inner constructions deviating relatively littlefrompost-Classical conventions.Hissymphoniesemergedmoreor less inpairs. Whilethe First Symphony endureda gestationperiodof atleast 15 yearsbeforeit was?inallycompletedin1876,itssuccessorfollowedwithrelative ease during the summer of the following year. Although a gap of seven years ensuedbeforehewouldputpentopaperontheThird–writtenentirelywithinthe summer of 1883 – his compositional choices for the Fourth were already well underway;inJanuary1882,hediscussedwithHansvonBülowandSiegfriedOchs the potential for utilising a chaconne by J.S. Bach as the basis for a symphony movement, expressing his ownreservations in theprocess: ‘But it is too clumsy, toostraightforward.Onemustalteritchromaticallyinsomeway’(Knapp1989,4). Theworkcametofruitionacrosstwoconsecutivesummers,in1884and1885,and was premièred in Meiningen under the composer’s baton on 25 October 1885 (BozarthandFrisch,Grove). Onits surface, theFourthSymphony mightnot seemlikeparticularlyideal ammunition against accusations of conservatism. A sonata-form ?irst movement exploitsrecurringtriadicrelationshipsinitsmelodicandharmoniccontent;aslow movement – set in the Phrygian mode – adapts that sonata form through its removal ofthe developmentsection; a scherzo also employs a variant on sonata form, combining various compressions with allusions to older minuet and trio constructions. Indeed, it isonly the?inale– upon whichthis chapterwill focus – thatdepartsfromexpectations.Here,Brahmsutilisesachaconneostinatofromthe ?inal movement of J.S. Bach’s Lutheren churchcantata ‘Nach dir, Herr, verlanget mich’,BWV150,tosetinmotionacyclicseventeenth-centurypassacagliaform–a boldyetseeminglyantiquatedmove. 128 DynamicContinuities Music built upon numerous levels of repetition may well seem to be the least likely methodofproducing a‘progressive’symphony. IfBrahms wasinany waylookingtodismisssuspicionsofadesiresimplyto recycleandperpetuatethe musicofthepast,thisdescriptionwouldseemtobeoneoftheleastef?icientways ofgoingaboutit.Butthensuchasummarycouldnevergivethefull picture.What canbeheardisasubversiveorchestralnarrative,expectationsrepeatedlyaroused, avertedand denied. The progressive character ofthe Fourth Symphony is not a consequence of boundaries broken and traditions de?ied, but rather of a quiet determinationtoemploytheparametersofthepastasaframeworkforadynamic, innovativemusicaldrama. The?irstmovementglides intoviewasifunannounced,theviolinsslipping effortlessly into a sinuous theme that traces a pattern of ‘descending’ thirds (incorporating upwards displacements); the underpinning accompaniment provides the continuity of a self-perpetuating harmonic cycle. Versions of these sequences underpin the long-term thematic and tonal structure of not only the ?irstmovementbutalsothesecond;DavidOsmond-Smithmakesacompellingcase fortheharmonicpathoftheAndantemoderatoprovidinganinvertedcontinuation of the modulations that characterise the ?irst movement, observing a ‘series of third-based relations that once more imply anupward risingchain’ (1983, 156– 57).Themovementisheraldedbyanundulatinghorncall;althoughthemotifitself appearsinthePhrygianmodesuggestingsomethingakintoCmajor, theextended subjectthatfollowsfromit–andthemovementatlarge–issetinEmajor. This tonal duality is only enhancedfurtherby the scherzo, set in C-major proper–purportedly,atleast;themovementholdsparticularsigni?icanceforKo?i Agawu,notleastonaccountofthenotablelackof‘tonaldesire’itdisplaystowards its apparent‘home’(1999, 150). Itswhirlwind?igures seemregularly to threaten tospinoutofcontrol,theirpulsingdriveandever-shiftingrhythmicaccentuations often hurling them beyondthe reach oftypical phrase structures. As profoundly workedoutastheoverall formalschemeofthemovementis, whatisheardisan uncomfortable, hyper-active passage of music, even in its supposedly calmer central episode. Agawu’s suggestion of a ‘mosaic’ like construction might offer further explanation for this, drawing ‘af?inities with other musical traditions in 129 DynamicContinuities Fig.6.6:FourthSymphony,fourthmovement,harmonicreductionofpassacaglia ostinato(bars1–8) which metrical, textural and phrase-structural play serve to inaugurate a modernisttrend’(1999,151). Notions of change and dynamism prove central to the ?inale of thework, whichmaycomeasa surprisegivenitsformal scheme: 32iterations ofthesame fundamental ostinato ?igure, each lasting eight bars in length, followed by a spiralling coda in which versions of the theme are distorted and spun out in a varietyofways(seeFigure6.6).Cappedbyaskywards-climbingmelody,the?igure infactopensinthesubdominant:thissetsinmotionarestlesssequenceoftriadic relationships that wheel inevitablytowards thetonic, imbuing thesamesense of perpetualonwardmotionaswiththematerialofthe?irstmovement. Theinitial statement frontedbywoodwindandbrass gives wayto stringled variations, rhythmic expansions and evasions allowing phrases to seemingly over?low their original eight-bar shape. The variations gradually grow calmer in character, allowing meandering woodwind solos to emerge. Forays into Emajor furtherbroadenthecharacterofthe?igurebeyondrecognitionand, as theclarity of the metrical divisions becomes increasingly lost, it is hard not to sense a growingsenseofcomparativetimelessness;theurgencyoftheopeningchoralehas been robbed of its purpose, leading to stasis and a seemingly melancholic stagnation. A reiteration of the chorale in its initial state reinvigorates the full orchestra to a cataclysmic re-engagement. Earlier principles of rhythmic and metrical instability are now carried to the furthest possible degree, variations gradually gainingmomentumbeforespiralinginto acodaoffreneticmodulations. The severity of the E-minor close seems an inevitability, the ensemble working multiple fragments and snippets of the chorale into the closing passages. A ?inal nodtowards Cmajorintheclosingbarsneverthelessoffersareferral backtothe 130 DynamicContinuities tonal duality that has surfaced previously in the course of the symphony, seeminglysuggestingthattheminor-keyconclusionhasnotgoneunchallenged. Tracingboundaries–FourthSymphony:Finale Althoughthe?irstmovementofthesymphonyhasprovidedagreatdealofinterest forscholars,perhaps its mostintriguinginterpretationarises inlightofthe?inale. It has been asserted that both movements take on the shape of chaconnes, the opening Allegro non troppo implicitly, the ?inale explicitly. The most detailed interpretationofthe ?irst movement inthis way is provided by JonathanDunsby (1981), who initially picks up up oncomments made ?irst by Edwin Evans with regard to the ‘spirit’ of the passacaglia form running through the entire work (1935, 146–71), andlater by Claude Rostand (1955, 291-299)on account ofthe ?irst movement’s thematic recurrence.27 Using as a springboard the apparent metrical asymmetries of the nonetheless ‘mechanical’ opening theme and its sequential nature, Dunsby unveils thematic procedures along the lines of developingvariation, ?inding intheexpositiona‘mixedform, reconcilingtheidea of transformed repetition – that is, a variation process – with the sonata process’ (1981, 76). Indeed, for him it is in some senses the less orthodox symphonic form that frequently prevails: ‘The transformations which move forward the sonata structure are often far more subtle than the repetitive characteristics: the tension between the two processes of the mixed form – chaconne and sonata – often swings in favour of the chaconne, because the repetitivecharacteristicsaresostrong’(1981,77). It could certainly bearguedat the veryleastthat principles ofdeveloping variationplayamajorroleintheworkingout ofthe?irstmovement, withaltered repetition displayed on macro and micro levels. More broadly, the sequence of thirdsthat theopening themesetsinmotionismirroredinthe tonal mapofthe 27 Although Evans points to features of the Sirst movement that prelude the Sinale, including the Bach-like ‘leading characteristics’ of its theme, he ultimately seems unconvinced by the attempted fusion of symphonic and passacaglia structures: ‘The attempt, thoughresulting inSine work, onlyprovesthatthese formscan neverbe united and places the frank passacaglia–form of the Sinale of this symphony in the light of a revancheforcertaintraitsoftheSirstmovement’(1935,148). 131 DynamicContinuities Fig.6.7:FourthSymphony,Uirstmovement,reductionofstringpartstoshow canonicinterplayatclimax(bars393–403) movement, as Frisch and Edward Cone both attest to (Frisch 2003: 117). Meanwhile,thematicrepetitionsbeginaudiblyto overlap, aclimactic point inthe recapitulationallowingtheprimarysubjecttobrie?lytakeontheshapeofacanon (bars394–401)(seeFigure6.7). A numberof writers haveshown this to be a two-way street, pointing to divisions akinto thatof a sonata form design in thepassacaglia ?inale, including Frisch (2003, 130–40), Pascall (1989, 233–245), Rostand (1955, 291–299), and Osmond-Smith(1983, 147–65).Acomparisonoftheseinterpretations oftheform of the movement can be found in Figure 6.5. However, whilst all are agreed in principle, the underlying shape of this apparent architecture is subject to some disagreement. Frischpresentsperhapsthemoststraightforwardinterpretationin terms of its adherence to convention, outlining an exposition comprising two theme groups linked by a bridge, a development section (from bar 129), a free recapitulation(frombar193),andacoda(frombar253). ThearchitecturePascall outlinesisbroadlyidenticaltothatofFrisch,butcontainsaddedcomplexitywithin the‘development’section.ForPascall,‘development andrecapitulationaremixed processes in a responsive secondhalfto the form’(1989: 239): the returnto Eminor andthe 3/4metre at bar129signals not theopening ofthe development section but, in fact, the ?irst point of recapitulation. A development section intercedes in the following chaconne cycle, taking hold before a ‘retransition’ occursinaheadoftheresumptionoftherecapitulationatbar193.Osmond-Smith, meanwhile,seems initiallylesscomfortablewithimposingafull sonataformonto themovement,contentinsteadtosuggestamorethoroughmergingofsonataand passacaglia forms (1983, 161–65). Rather than asserting the status of an expositionwith?irstandsecondsubjectgroupingsonto theopeningpassages, his divisionsliemoreinlinewiththeconventions ofchaconneform, withchanges of metre (from 3/4to 3/2in bars 97–128)and mode (from Eminor to Emajor in 132 DynamicContinuities Fig.6.8:FourthSymphony,thirdmovement,harmonicreductionofearly appearanceofchaconneostinatofragment(bars317–26) bars 105–28). It is in the second half of the work that he shows an interest in notionsofrecapitulation–bothfrombar129andagainfrombar193–andcoda. Eventhenumberofcycles ofthechaconnethemeseemstobeasubjectfor debate. Both Pascall and Osmond-Smith depict 32 cycles, with the ?inal cycle spinning out directly into a coda conclusion. Although Rostand remains in agreementthatthecodacommencesatbar253,hechoosestolendmorestructural credencetowhattheothersarecontenttolabelasanextendedcoda:hepresentsa ?ive-part subdivision, determining four ‘cycles’ ofunequal barlengths (8, 12, 16, and16)givingwayto aseven-barpassage inwhichthe ?inalcadence is af?irmed (Rostand1955,299). Frischoptsto labelthe cycles asvariations;consequently, heportraysthe movementascomprisinganeight-bartheme,30subsequentvariations,andacoda separate instatus from thevariations but nonetheless still beginning at bar 253 (2003, 130–40). Whilstthis keepstheinterpretedform ofthe work very muchin line with the principle ofdeveloping variation that Frischpropounds elsewhere, theideaofthe?irsteight bars ofthe?inaletakingtheshapeofaconcretestarting point – the ‘origin’ of the movement – could in fact be seen as somewhat undermined by Frisch elsewhere in his writings. In Brahms and the Principle of DevelopingVariation,hedrawsattentiontoaninterruptionatthecloseofthethird movement of the symphony (bars 317–25) in which a direct transposition (downwards byaperfect ?ifth)oftheimminent passacagliaostinato(downwards byaperfect?ifth,E§ –F♯ –G§ –A§ –B♭ becomingA§ –B§ –C§ –D§ –E♭)is‘expanded intoagrotesqueparody’bywayof‘enourmousregistraldisplacement’(seeFigure 6.8). Frisch explains that, with the onset of the ?inale, the process Brahms undertakesisoneof‘restoringdignityandlogictothetheme’,citingthesuggestion 133 DynamicContinuities from the composer’s pocket calendar that the passacaglia may well have been composedbeforethe scherzo, withthe ostinato referencedeliberately plantedin lightofwhatwasto comeinthecourseofthesymphony:‘Hereturnsitto asingle registerandcompletesitbyraisingthesharpedfourthtoa?ifthandresolvingthat pitchtothetonic. Hethenpaystributetotheresuscitatedthemebyproceedingto buildanentirevariationmovementfromit’(1984,143). Findingdynamism There can be no doubt that these interpretations all have value, not least with regardto shrugging offthe percieved‘self-conscious archaism shotthrough with romantic feeling’ that, as Agawu notes, often dominates discussion of the movement(1999, 150). Nevertheless, to whatextent theyre?lect a present-tense listening experience remains in question; whilst many of thestructural markers outlinedcanindeedbeheardasmusical‘events’, orcrystallisationsofchange,the focus of audience attention is less likely to be the nuances of their formal role. Perhapsitisworthconsideringthesearchitecturalelementsintermsoftheiraural consequences.ApassagetakenfromPeterSmith’saligningofBrahmsandHeinrich Schenkerintheirresponsestosonataformofferssomeperspectiveinthisway: With respecttorecapitulation, the mostsigniSicantelementof sectionalisation in sonataform,BrahmsandSchenkerstrovetosubsumetheelementsofdivisionand repetition within a continuous and dynamic unfolding. While they remained committedtoahistoricallyvalidatedformaltype characterisedbythe restatement of large blocks of material, they refused to sacriSice the romantic ideal of an unbroken, goal-directed Slow. Theyboth struck a compromise between a strong organicist impulse and theirsensitivity to the realitiesof a formaltype based in partonthedramaticdelineationofaparallelthematicdesign.(Smith1994:78) Regardless of whether it might be classi?ied as an adaptation of theme and variation,passacagliaorsonataforms, the ?inaleoftheFourthSymphony –when performed–takestheshapeofjustsucha‘continuousanddynamicunfolding’.As signi?icantastheprogressionproves,theauralexperienceisnotsimplyreducedto identifying successions of cycles, pinpointing the conclusion of one and the 134 DynamicContinuities commencement of the next. Indeed, Brahms demonstrates particular skill in adoptinganobviouslyvariation-basedapproachwithoutincurringtheboundaries that might typically accompany it. By blurring the lines that traditionally divide cycles in the passacaglia form, emphasis is placed upon change and continuity ratherthanstasisanddemarcation. The composer achieves this blurring principally through two types of ambiguity: metric andharmonic.28 Occurringat notable points inthe movement, metric ambiguity is implemented largely through relatively small alterations in rhythmicemphasisthat, whenembeddedwithinoragainstrecurringpatternsand ?igures, contribute toawider senseofstructural destabilisation.Achangeintime signature at the centre of the movement (bars 97–128) also allows for more profound expansion of metrical possibilities. Harmonic ambiguity, meanwhile, proves more pervasive, with the opening cycle itself seemingly predisposed towards harmonic motion. The ?irst four bars in particular reveal a tension betweentonic,subdominantandsubmediant(seeFigure6.6), theresultantnodof therootpositionsofthesechordstowardsanA-minortriadinturnalludingtothe patterns of thirds that punctuated the ?irst movement of the symphony. The voicing ofthe subdominant chordthat opens the work has implications for how themovementplaysout:withC§andE§featuringasthelowestandhighestpitches respectively, invoking the long-term tonal signi?icance of those keys across the preceding movements. The ascent of the top-register ‘theme’ to an F♯ in the following bar serves to foil what might otherwise have been a more powerful assertionofthesubdominantbynatureofthebassdroptoA-natural.TheE-minor chordofthethirdbardoesnotprovidetheauralstabilityassignedto atonickey, failing to offset a recasting of the opening in bar four, a ?irst-inversion subdominant chord withregisters now further extended inboth directions. The cadence that ensues across the four bars that follow is riddled with chromatic in?lectionsthatservetocomplicatematters(bars5–8).Theupwardssemitonestep oftheupper‘theme’toanA♯helpsfacilitateF♯major,hereassumingtheroleofa secondarydominantwithregardtothepartitplaysinbringingthe?irstphraseto its culmination; with the continued presenceof E§ as the seventh in the timpani 28 Forfurtherdiscussionsof thiskindof ambiguityin Brahms’smusic, seeSmith(1996) andMurphy(2009). 135 DynamicContinuities forces the sequence onwards. E minor reappears but once again fails to provide respite, giving way to a dominant seventh distorted by a diminished ?ifth that resolvestothemajormodeofthetonic. The consequence of all this is an opening cycle that, in spite of its progressions neatly contained within an eight-bar phrase, proves inherently dynamicthankstoitsrestlessharmonicconstruction.WhilstE§remainsaconstant presencethroughallbutthepenultimatebar,itseemstoemergeasmoreofatonal pivotthananunchallengedtonic,failingtoprovidethenecessaryresolutioninthe course of its three root sonorities. This initial sequence is adapted through the course of the opening cycles as the ascending upper-register theme becomes embeddedwithinthebassparts,insuringEminorasatonalcentreandfacilitating variationsintheharmonicpath. The?irstmetricalambiguitiesbegintocreepinasthetemposlowstowards the time signature expansion from 3/4 to 3/2 that accompanies thestart ofthe 13th cycle(frombar97). Thelatterhalves ofboththeninthand10thcycles (bars 69–72and77–80)introduceadropinmomentumthroughtheintroductionofbarto-a-bow slurred ?igures in the strings with descending chromatic scales in the woodwind.Theopeningofthe11thcycle(bar81)revealsthe?irsthintsofEmajor as a starting point for the iteration, rather than as an ending. Instead of aurally initiating another cycle, the impression of a through-composed development is given, a change in tonal direction offering a new avenue of musical explanation. Thelossofrhythmicdriveat thispointandthesuddenrelianceuponablock-like dialogue of chords betweenstrings andwoodwinds gives thesense ofthe initial drive and rigour of the movement beginning to lag. Here, a precise balance is struck: a drop in metric momentum is countered by the exploration of more interestingharmonicavenues. EbbandUlow Theexpansion of thetimesignature to 3/2without anychangeintempo forthe 13th iteration (from bar 97) – a doubling of the cycle duration – arouses disorientation. Rhythmic emphasis, falling on the crotchet of?beat in the upper 136 DynamicContinuities Fig.6.9:FourthSymphony,fourthmovement,Ulutemelody(upperline)with reductionofstringsandhornaccompaniment(lowerline),bars97–104 stringsasacounterpointtotheplaintive,searching?lutemelody,giveslittleclueas totheexactnatureofthechangethathastakenplace(SeeFigure6.9).However,it soonbecomesclearthatcyclesarenowprogressingmoreslowly,withversionsof the now familiar chord sequence now seemingly the most reliable way of distinguishingtherateofchange.Theharmonicsequences,inturn,aresoonmade more dif?icult to discern through the full switch to E major from the 14th cycle (bars105–12). Thesonorities themselvesaremostly expressedinthemiddleand upperregisters,withthebass emphasislargelyabsent. Theresultisanincreased sense of stasis, with the goal-directed drive of the initial cycles diminished in presence; this is initially emphasised by anE-natural pedal throughout the 14th cycleintheviolasandhorn, withthepedalcontinuedby thehornthroughoutthe 15th(bars113–20). Bass emphasisdoes notreturnuntil the?inalbarofthe16th iteration(bar128),withthelowA§ofthecelliemphasisingAminor,andproviding adirectconnectionwiththereprisethatfollows.Inthemeantime,themetreofthe music has remained largely ambiguous; although the wind instruments have provided two eight-bar cycles of consistent rhythmic phrase structure, this has beenroutinelyunderminedbytheemphasisofthestringsuponthesecondminim beatofeachbar. The ?irst four bars of the 17th cycle (bars 129–32) bring the ?irst, and indeedonly,pointofdirectrepetitioninthecourseofthemovement,theopening ‘theme’oftheopeningreprisedinthewoodwindandbrass. Thedescendingstring 137 DynamicContinuities Fig.6.10:FourthSymphony,fourthmovement,selectedreductionofbars 129–36 passage that appears in counterpoint to the ascending ‘theme’ instigates a cataclysmic redirection, curtailingtheiterationnot inEmajorbutinanharmonic collision (bar 136): a minor third of E§ and G§ is pitched against a violent reappearanceof thesecondary dominant, an F♯ bass underpinning a suspension resolvingtowardsF♯majorthroughthe?irstviolinsdropfromD§toC♯ (seeFigure 6.10). Nevertheless, the chromatic in?lections that dogthe two largely ascending cyclesthatfollow,servenotonlytoreinstallEminor asatonalcentrebutalsoto blurtheeightbarsofeachcycleintoonecohesiveupwardgesture.Withthestable broader metre of each iteration re-established, focus shifts from the ‘vertical’ nature of the harmonic content to the ‘horizontal’ development of melodic and rhythmic?igures.Broaderrhythmicshiftsproveaparticularpointofauralinterest, with the beat of emphasis in prominent orchestral parts changing for each iteration. A particularly dynamic pattern can be observed from the 20th cycle throughtothe23rd,withthepointoffocusshiftingfromtheoff-beatquaver?igure ofthe20thcycle(bars 153–60)tothesforzandosecondcrotchetsofeachbar(an accompaniment used in tandem with the newly tripletised-quaver ?igure in the upperstrings)inthe21st(bars161–68),andtheweightedsecondandfourthbars inthe22nd(bars169–76). Bythearrivalofthesuddenlysubdued23rdcycle(bars177–84),asenseof metrical disorientation has takenhold, with off-beat quaver punctuations in the woodwindnowjuxtaposedwithanundercurrentofmotorictripletquaversinthe strings. Theascentofthe24thcycle(bars185–192)towards theaclimactic point of partial recapitulation continues this juxtaposition, arpeggiated triplet quavers ascending forcefully above descending straight quavers in the lower strings. 138 DynamicContinuities Fig.6.11:FourthSymphony,fourthmovement,formalschemeoftwogestures, withcyclesdepictedinproportiontoapproximatedurations Addingto theconfusion, two woodwindinterjections beginonthe quaverupbeat rather than at the start of bars 186 and 188, lending the passage an onward lurching sensation. Angular descending outbursts then project a contradictory dupletimeacrossthe?inalthreebarsofthecycle,abeatofsilenceallowingthefull orchestra to reassembleforthe partial recapitulation of the25th , 26thand27th cycles, reframing earlier material from the second, third and fourth iterations respectively. The27thcycleinparticular (bars209–16)reintroducesaparticular harmonic questionfrom theearlystages ofthemovement, with aC§ pedalinthe bassesnotonly casting thepassage in thelightofC major, but reintroducingthe sonority to theopening of thesubsequent iterations. Meanwhile, metricevasions continue to abound, fromchromatic bass hemiola(bars 209–12)to theforwardtrippingoff-beats andsyncopations thatcharacterise therun-intowards thecoda (bars233–52).Thecodaitselfpresentsareversalofthebalancefoundaheadofthe recapitulationatthemid-pointofthemovement:fromheretheharmonicavenues areconsiderably narrowed,withE-minorgainingarelentlessstrangleholdonthe courseofthemusic. Ratheritisrhythmandmetrethatentersastateofoverdrive, ascyclesaretruncated,spliced,andextendedwithferociousabandon. Thismirroring mightbeviewedwithinthecontext ofanadditionalwayof viewingtheform ofthemovement,oneinkeepingwithanauralexperienceofit. Takingintoaccount thatthepartial recapitulationthatopensthe17thcycleisthe only point of direct repetition, it is possible to divide the piece at this almost precisemid-point(withrespecttobothnumberofcyclesandperformedduration). The ?inale of the symphony can be heard as two gestures of equal length, two directionsinwhichthepassacagliamightbetaken:the?irstgraduallyslows,metre becomingmoredisparate, harmonymoreambiguous;the secondacceleratesinto overdrive, relentless driving rhythms underpinning a close tonal circling of E 139 DynamicContinuities minor (see Figure 6.11).29 Although played in succession to one another, these gestures could be thought of as presenting two alternate timespans, stemming from thevery samestartingpoint–two longformal gestures inwhichthe same fundamentalmaterialisworkedouttoverydifferentends. Layersoftime–Schnee:Canon1a As with the ?inale of the Fourth Symphony, there are several different ways in which the form of Abrahamsen’s Schnee might be interpreted; as has been discussed, surface divisions could bemade accordingto the canon pairings, as a consequence of the placing of the intermezzi, or the work might be seen as a diminishing series of partitions. However, again in a manner comparable to Brahms’spassacaglia,anauralexperienceoftheworkrevealsaconsiderablymore dynamic,continuouscomposition.Thesuccessofbothworks,itwouldseem,liesas much in their ability to defy or subvert their own formal boundaries in performanceasitdoesintheirabilitytoretaintheclarityofthosedivisionswhen analysedafter, or indeed before, the fact. Inthislight, thediscussion of thework thatfollowsherewill–asitdidtoalargedegreewiththeBrahms–beconcerned withthelinearpassageofthepiece, andwillbestructuredassuchwithaviewto gainingadeeperunderstandingofsomeoftheperceptualprocesseslistenersmay experienceinthecourseofaperformance. Abrahamsen echoes Brahms’s manner of presenting two alternate timespansinsuccessionthroughoutthe courseofSchnee. Muchoftheshort-term continuity of the work depends upon an audible recognition of this process occurring within the ?ive pairings of canons: each pair is underpinned by one fundamental musical idea that is rendered in two different ways. The composer invokesBaroqueforms,particularlythoseofBach,describingthesecondcanonin eachpairasakindof‘double’ofthe ?irst. InthecaseofCanons1a and1b, which had originally been both conceived and premièred as a standalone coupling in 2006, Abrahamsen is candidabout bothhis selectionofrepeating structures and 29Durationstakenfromrecordinglistedinprimaryresourcelist(WienerPhilharmoniker, conductedbyCarlosKleiber.DeutscheGrammophon:457706-2). 140 DynamicContinuities Fig.6.12:Schnee,Canon1a,bars1–6(reproductionofAbrahamsen2008) thedesiredeffectthesechoiceshaveuponthelisteningexperience:‘Itisbasically thesamemusic,butwithmanymorecanoniclevelssuperimposed.Sothetwoform apair, andshouldbeheardassuch.Theyareliketwo bigmusicalpictureswhich, whenheardwithdistant,unfocussedears,mayproduceathird,three-dimensional picture’(Abrahamsen2009,3). Any danger of this approach translating into an aurally transparent accumulative process inpractice, though, is countered byanintricately designed complication. Inspired by late-nineteenth-century stereoscopic photography techniques in whichtwo pictures taken from slightly displaced perspectives are overlaidto create an illusory three-dimensional image, Abrahamsen attempts to reframe this idea in temporal terms, asking: ‘If one laid two ‘times’ over one another, would a deeper, three-dimensional time be created?’ (2009, 2). It is 141 DynamicContinuities perhapsinthis waythatSchneenot onlymirrorsaspectsofBaroquecounterpoint (independent melodic lines layered polyphonically, each starting at different points andinmany instances movingat different speeds withinasetmetre) but also heightens it through the introduction of multiple metrical layers. The simultaneity ofthesecompetingmetresprovesto bean important featureofthe listening experience, with the interaction between them contributing to the perceivabledevelopmentofthework.Inthecomposer’sownwords,‘inthecourse ofeachindividual canon, a gradualprocessis revealed: onethat sheds lightupon variousaspects, eachpushedintoeithertheforegroundorthebackground’(2009, 3). Thisprocessofchangingperspectivesandpositionscanbeobservedacross the?irsttwopairsofcanons.Canon1aopenswithadirectjuxtaposition,thesteady quaver pulseofthe violin at odds withthesparseinterjections ofthepiano (see Figure6.12). Whilst bothinstrumentsinitiallyuseonlyA§s,theiraural effectsare more distinctive; the arti?icial harmonics of the violin, and the cello soon after, soundsohighinpitchthattherecomes,inthecomposer’sdescriptioninthescore, ‘only air, like an icy whisper, but with a pulsation’, whilst the high pitch of the piano notes lends them a chilling incisiveness, cutting through the texture with rhythmic clarity. Indeed, the rhythmof thepiano line is outlinedinsuchminute detail–frequentlythroughtheuseofcontradictorydupletandtripletpunctuations – that it seems deliberately to counter the regularity of the violin quavers, presenting an obviously competing metre from the very start of the work as it outlinestherisingandfallingcanontheme.Althoughthepianolinewouldseemto holdagreatdealmoreinterestthanthatoftheviolin,thetwoarepreventedfrom entering into a simple foreground-background hierarchy by the fact that they appeartofunctionas astructural unit, withtheendoftheinitial canonthemein thepianopromptingtheviolinalsotocurtailitsrepetitionsatthecloseofbar?ive, witha quaver of silence at the start of bar six allowing the cello to pick up the ostinato, pianoswiftlyfollowingsuit.Thisbriefauralcommaisrepeatednotonly atthecloseofthe?irst-timebar(bar10)andthroughtherepeatofbar?ive, butis prolongedatthecloseofthesecond-timebar(bar10a)throughanotatedpause,in whichtheviolaholdsanharmonicopen?ifthonA§. 142 DynamicContinuities Even as further levels of activity are added towards the centre of the movement,thesenseofhiatusat thecloseofeachiterationofthecanonthemeis maintained, lending the impression less of thoroughly independent polyphonic parts, but rather a collection of distinct lines that exhibit connections with one another at various points. In fact, the most notable change that occurs in the movement – the transformation of the violin’s pianissimo repeating quaver ostinato into fortissimo triplet semi-quavers complete with arti?icial harmonic glissandi (frombar 19) – turns out to be very muchin-keeping withpre-existing material; although this new ?igure initially appears as a foreground textural feature, itsglissandi infact createatranslucentdoubling of thecanon theme, the piano’slucidpunctuationsactingasmomentary ‘stations’forthe violinandcello, incitingthenecessary changes inpitchdirection. Theconsequenceofthefrenetic characterofthis centralepisode(bars19–30a)isoneperhapscomparabletothat of a traditional ternary form, witha second contrasting section allowing a fresh perspective on the musical landscape of the ?irst section when subsequently it returns. This interpretation is certainly supported by Abrahamsen’s labeling of these three successive passages as numbered ‘parts’, with all other succeeding canons in the work – save 5a & 5b – also following this design. However, this structural change does notnecessarily precludeacompletely new set ofmusical materials. In Canon 1a, the metrically evasive theme presented by the piano is presentthroughout;rather,itisitssettingthatisaltered,withits‘accompaniment’ movingfrombackgroundtoforegroundbeforeretreatingoncemore.Thereturnof thecomparatively static quaver ostinato from bar 31(‘Part Three’), serves to reestablish the piano theme as a point of focus; familiarity renders the rhythmic discrepancies (initially heard perhaps as a metrical incompatibility)betweenthe two ?igures asasourceofinterplayratherthanofcompetition. Withthisdialogue now acceptedas auni?iedmusical?low, thepassageisallowedto assumea more dynamicquality givingthe impressionofaperceptual accelerationto thecloseof themovement. 143 DynamicContinuities Fig.6.13:Schnee,Canon1b,bars1–3(reproductionofAbrahamsen2008) Horizontalperspectives–Schnee:Canon1b The material of Canon 1a is reframed from the outset of its double, Canon 1b. Whilst the fundamental theme is retained, certain elements of its character are nowconcealed,allowingotherfacetstocometo thefore(seeFigure6.13).Whilst thepiano line (nowperformedonthesecondpiano)is enhancedthroughupperregister octaves, the quaver ostinato is robbedentirely ofpitch, performednow throughthe rhythmic rubbingofpaper on thesurface ofa table. These lines are nowoverlaidbydistortionsoftheirmaterial:thequaverostinatoisnowoffsetbya percussive ‘guiro’ effect produced on the ?irst piano via glissandi with the ?ingernailsacrossthewhitekeysinline withthe rhythms anddistancesspeci?ied 144 DynamicContinuities in the score. Meanwhile, violin and viola (the latter in rhythmic unison but transposeddown a perfect ?ifth) utilise arti?icial harmonics to outline the canon themein long sustainedgestures, an idea then taken up by piccolo and clarinet from bar six – an all-new ‘horizontal’ perspective on what has hitherto been presentedasamorepunctuated‘vertical’thematicidea.Althoughthesenewlayers areaudiblyrelatedtothefeaturescarriedoverfromtheprecedingmovement,they serve to introducea contrasting metre, working intandemto set 15/16 phrases against the broader 9/8 time signature; their sound, however, is not so uni?ied, withtheglidingstring line lending thepassage anincreasedsense of freedom in contrast with the the obviously rhythmic input ofthe ‘guiro’ ostinato. Yet again, though, this effectofduple‘times’isnot oneoftwo indifferentmusicalpaths;the ensemble stilloperates asaunitfor anabrupthiatusatthecloseofeach?ive-bar phrase. The clarity of these independent musical lines is gradually lost as the movementprogresses. The?irstsignsofthisoccurasthestringsandwoodwind– previously sharingresponsibilitiesforthesame lines –beginto divergefromone another: inthecourse ofa violaandcello iterationofthesustainedcanontheme, oboe and clarinet offer a chromatically-in?lected and metrically displaced distortionoftheline,?loatingat?irstinparallelbeforetakingoverfromthestrings completely(bars 11–18a). This initial split preludes themore intricatebranching thatoccursinthecentralepisode–thesecond‘part’intheternaryformdesign–of themovement(bars19–30a). Thereturnfromtheopeningmovementofglissandi triplet semi-quaver ?igures staggered across violin and cello curtails the ‘guiro’ effect, but ushers in trilled echoes of the canon theme in the viola, piccolo and clarinet, accompanied by sharp punctuations from the oboe. Thecontinuation of the canon theme in the second piano is soon set in dialogue with a delayed variationofthethemeinthe?irstpiano,thericocheteffectcreatedbytheresulting interlockingrhythmsgivinganoverallphasingeffectwiththethemere?lectedand refractedinthemidstofthenotablythickenedtexture. Indeed,atthispointinthe movement there are now ?ive broader musical ideas now employed simultaneously, withthree ofthoseideas further separated in multiplelayers of displacement. 145 DynamicContinuities This surface novelty conceals a radical continuity: the canon theme has beenaconstantfeatureofSchneefromits veryopening.BythecloseofCanon1b, thismotifhasbeenperpetuallyrepeatedthroughoutthe17-minutedurationofthe two movements, a temporal undercurrent left almost entirely untouched by the more ?leeting ‘times’ that have emerged and faded around it. This feature is underlinedinthethird‘part’ofthemovement(bars31–48a):anotablyprolonged hiatus–markedby a sustainedcello pedal on thescordaturalow open-string G§ (the detunedC-string, its ?irst deployment and indeed thelowest pitchofSchnee thusfar)–curtailsthecentralsection;initswake,theternary-esquereturnofthe materialwhichopenedthemovementbringsthecanonthemeofthepianointothe foregroundoncemore,highlightingitscontinuedpresenceasafamiliarlandmark, consistentinspiteofthesurroundingtexturaltrends. Temporaldimensions–Schnee:Canon2a Similar processes canbe observed in the second pairing of canons, in whichthe three-part form ofeachis subdivided further: as well as signposting eachofthe three parts, silent pauses also split each part into two sub-sections, usually also signalingtexturalchanges.Canon2a(forwoodwindtrioandsecondpiano)opens in a notably direct manner: alto ?lute and clarinet alternate to set in motion a ‘theme’ of seemingly perpetual quavers built of arpeggio fragments seemingly gravitating towards D minor (see Figure 6.14). Both are encouragedto produce Fig.6.14:Schnee,Canon2a,bars1–4,canontheme(excludingleft-handopen noteinpianopart) 146 DynamicContinuities notes that are‘half pitch andhalfair’, withsyllables of short phrasesexclaiming thearrivalofsnowandtheonsetofwinter(‘EsistSchnee!’and‘EsistWinternacht, Winternachtjetzt!’)underpinningeachnote.Theresultisaparticularlypercussive sound, enhanced by Blu-tack-muted F§ punctuations from the piano, wider resonance provided by the silent depression of the F§ key anoctave lower. The establishedline soon assumes a broader familiarity, withjust a handful of short patterns subjectedtoagreatmanyrepetitions. However,thisrecyclingprocessis far from simple; in addition to nearly every bar presenting a change of time signature (9/8 and 8/8 initially proving the most common), repeat markings present at the end ofevery bar or pairs of bars create a subversive texture for listeners, with aroused expectations of sequences and rhythms routinely underminedbysmallalterations. Only a short time passes before this unit of thematic interplay is itself disrupted.ThepianobreaksfromitsusualmutedF§s,producingtwostaccatoC§sin bars 15–16, and a further three in bars 22–23. The sound is tonally distinctive, withC§fallingoutsidetheestablishedD-minorpurview,andindeedfarlouderthan themutedF§susedsofar.However, theseinterjectionsprotrudemostnotablyina rhythmic sense, contradicting the wider quaver pulse with the effect of dotted quaveroff-beats;the aural effectisoneofajarringhemiola, ametrical mismatch subverting thealternatingpatterns ofthree-andtwo-quavergroups. However, in the second sub-section of the ?irst part of the movement this interruption is graduallyintegratedwithinthetheme;itsmoreconsistentappearancesalliedwith its increasinglymelodic oscillationbetweenC§ andC♯ allow it to berhythmically normalised, no longer disrupting but rather phasing in and out ofsync withthe Fig.6.15:Schnee,Canon2a,excerptstoshowscoringofintroductionof metricallysubversivepianoC§anditssubsequentintegration 147 DynamicContinuities more familiar quaver groups (see Figure 6.15). The result is a direct musical representationofAbrahamsen’s stereoscopic photographyanalogy oftwo images overlapping to create the illusionof a further dimension, two metres moving in andoutofalignmentwithoneanother. Thesecondpartofthemovementseesthepiano’srepeatedF§sretainedasa constant whilst textural shifts occur around it. The once perpetual arpeggiated ?igures becomeincreasingly sporadic inthe alto ?lute line, with thequaverpulse often maintained only by new oscillating shapes in the piano line. Instead, the primary dialogue takes place between piano and the quintuplet punctuations of the newly introduced cor anglais, staccato underlinings from the clarinet also becomingincreasinglyfrequentbothtowardsandduringthesecondsectionofthe part.Meanwhile,thealto?luteproducesincreasinglyabstract?igures, startingwith the downward glissandi effects that recur frequently from bar 70 onwards, and culminating in the violent ‘wind-like’ sforzando arcs that ?irst appear in the movement’sthirdpart(frombar155)alternatedwithhyperactivetrills. Shiftingfocus–Schnee:Canon2b Thesechanges highlightthe wider agitationthat has takenhold of theensemble. Continuingquintupletquaverpatternsdisplacedbetweencoranglais andclarinet growinprominencetowardsthecloseofthesecondpart,maskingwhatremainsof the canon theme which began the movement. What occurs in the course of the thirdpartisagradualreturntothisbasictexturalunit. Coranglaisandclarinetreenter into the cyclic dialogue of the theme, allowing the piano – which proved crucial inretaining thequaver pulsethroughout thesecondpart–to reassertits apparent‘dupletime’hemiola. The ?inal subsection ofthe movement (bars 179– 207)recreatesthesametexturallandscapeoftheopening,onlysporadicreturnsof thepiano’shemiolainterjectionsareminderofthelayeringprocessthathastaken place. Thetwo-minuteinterlude that intercedesthesecondcanonpairingproves particularlystrikinginitsfocusupon‘horizontal’materialratherthan‘vertical’,the series of de-tunings providing an opportunity for long sustainednotes. It is the 148 DynamicContinuities ?irst point in Schnee at which rhythmic momentum is abandoned entirely, the onwardmetricaldriveoftheopeningthreemovementsreplacedbyanaltogether freerexpansiveofsuccessivemergingchords.Itsignalsaseachangeforthemusic thatfollows. Elementsofthissojourncreepaudiblyinto theopeningofCanon2b, cello and bass clarinet both undertaking drones (F§ and F♯ respectively) with dovetailinghairpindynamicstocreateadiscordantthrobbingeffect. Violaandcor anglaisalternatelycontributetheirownsustainedloopingcalls(initiallyanF§ and a D♭ respectively). The return of the canon theme, meanwhile, is a scattershot affair, withitsalreadyconglomeratenaturenow enhancedfurtherbythefactthat violin and alto ?lute are now rendering it in nontuplet and octuplet quavers, metrically incompatible with the regular quaver pulse maintained by the two pianos. Theresult is astuttering texture, momentumfrequentlystiltedorstalling aspart ofamuddleddialogue. Thematerialappears halfremembered, fragments reappearinginanuncontrolled,inconsistentmanner,likeseparatestreamsoftime interrupting or jostling with one another. The music attempts to continue in a mannersimilarto theprecedingmovement but withonly limitedsuccess,energy ebbing and ?lowing throughout. Whilst recognisable features resurface, in particularthemoreabstract violent‘wind-like’?lute arcs thatarealso echoedby the violin andtwo pianos inthe third part, the effect is of familiar material lost among numerous other layers, its original clarity and rhythmic strength now cloudedbythedistortionsanddisplacementsthatsurroundit. Itis throughthis building upoflayers acrossthe ?irst two pairs ofcanons that it becomes possible to enter into a mode of listening similar to the one Abrahamsen himself suggests. Perhaps, though, his prescription for ‘distant, unfocussed ears’ lands slightly wide ofthe mark. Rather, an aural experience of Schnee mightbesaidtobebycontrastboth‘close’and‘focussed’atcertaintimes; insteadofsimplyassumingone‘point’from–or‘manner’in–whichtolisten,the process that is gradually unveiled in thecourse ofthe work seems to encourage audience members to actively alter their ‘position’, shifting their focus and distances to engage with particular patterns or combinations of patterns at particularmoments, orforgivenpassages.Thecontinuousnatureofthethemein Canon 1a, for example, seems to invite closer examination in its earlier stages beforeitisveiledbeneathnewlayersofmaterial,astaticfeature(ofsorts)withina 149 DynamicContinuities movingscene;itisdesignedtobetakenincreasinglyforgranted.Whenitisspot-lit once more towards the close ofthe movement by virtueof its returnedtextural prominence, its familiarity means it does not need to be utilised as a point of deliberatefocusinthesamemannerasbeforebutcaninsteadbeheardasiffroma distance.Therealisationofitscontinuous natureinspiteofwiderchangessparks anautomatic changeinperspective; thelack ofneedforfocussedaural analysis, allowsittoassumeamoredynamicpresencethanitpreviouslypossessed. Comparable processes occur across the second pairing of canons. The perpetual‘theme’ofCanon2aistakenforgrantedinthecourseofthemovement once its subversive shifts in rhythmic emphasis have become familiar; it moves from a point of focus and examination to a peripheral constant, a background feature. However, its reappearances inCanon 2bas afragmentary presence in a stateofmetric?luxservetochangeitscharacterentirely.Whilstitisreassertedas a point of aural interest, its haphazard movements across the ensemble and its mercurial metric character make it impossible to utilise as a singular point of focus; rather, a more ‘distant’ listening approach proves necessary, with focus readjustedtoencompassthe widerframeofreferencerequiredto makesenseof thejourney the motiftakes. Focus is no longer trained on one ‘time’ – insteadit shifts between the multiple overlapping ‘times’, from the background to the foreground, creating the sense of a three-dimensional sonic landscape that Abrahamsenintended–atransientmodeoflistening. The pattern established in the course of the piece so far is of increasing textural complexity, each canon presenting an idea that is subsumed by new complementary – or, insome instances, contradictory – ideas resultingin multilayered passages. This recognisable trend of increasing density prompts new questions for the wider form of the work. In a sense, Abrahamsen faces similar structuralissuesto Brahms.Whilstthecompositionalchallengeinthe?inaleofthe Fourth Symphony seems to havebeen to lendafundamentally cyclic movement theeffectofathrough-composednarrative,inSchneeitisrelevantto wonderhow aformassembledunambiguouslyfromtenaudiblypairedsectionsmightmaintain asenseofcontinuity;beyondthedeliberate‘interruptions’ofthethreeintermezzi, howcanthispiecesoundasauni?iedwhole? 150 DynamicContinuities Fig.6.16:Schnee,Canon3b,pianos(bars1–4) Disintegration–Schnee:Canons3–5 The answer to these questions seems to begin to emerge in the third pairing of canons.Canon3aprovidesastarkcontrasttowhathascomebefore,withasudden dropintempo and ineasily perceivablemetreseeminglycoaxinganew listening approachfromits audience. The bass clarinet sets inmotion a theme of sorts, a slowthrobbingthree-note?igurewhichrumblesawayatfrequentbutnotprecisely regularintervals.Violinandviolasoonbegintobridgesomeofthesepatternswith sustained?iguresthat culminate in adescendingglissando, workingtogetherina similarmannertoCanon2b:inrhythmicunison,butseparatedbyaperfectfourth. Theseinitialexchangesbetweenwoodwindandstringssetthetonefor thewhole movement. Although these roles are exchanged and further related layers are quietlyadded, thelisteningexperienceis seemingly guidedbythisslow momentby-moment dialogue;whatmayhaveintheearlier,fasterstagesofthepiecehave been heard as rhythmicallyinterlocking gestures arenow understoodinamuch freer sense. Thenatureofthe music serves to realignthe aural focus oncemore, with the previously prominent concepts of rhythm and metre moving to the peripheries whilst space, tone, interaction, and silence become points ofgreater interest. Whilst the broader structural trend of Schnee so far might create the expectationofanincreaseinmusicalcomplexityandtexturaldensityinCanon3b, 151 DynamicContinuities Fig.6.17:Schnee,Canon4a,bars1–3(reproductionofAbrahamsen2008) whatoccursisinfact, aurallyspeaking, theopposite. Atthiscrucialjuncture–the formal centre of the work – the process is reversed: through the use of just percussionandpianos,thethematicmaterialoftheprecedingcanonisreducedto its very essence, the throbbing patterns now barely recognisable having been transferredtothecircularmotionsofpaperonatable.Thetwopianos,meanwhile, attempttorecallthemoresustainedgesturesofthestringsandwoodwindthrough 152 DynamicContinuities Fig.6.18:Schnee,parallelpresentationofpianopartsofCanon5aandCanon 5b(bars1–4)toshowexchangeofcanonthemeandrhythmicpatterns theuseofpedal;however,limitedbytheinabilitytoperformcrescendi,theeffectis ofaperpetual dyingaway,asonic transiencemarkedallthemorebythesilences that intercede gestures (see Figure 6.16). Tonal changes serve to highlight this particularly desolate musical landscape: although perfect fourths and ?ifths still abound, the harmonic waters are muddied by recurring semitones, augmented sevenths and ?latted ninths, enhancing a broader sense of tonal drifting and disintegration. Although thethirdcanonpairing lasts no longer than thesecond, thebroaderloss ofmomentum it containsservesto stretchtheperceptual ‘time’ outwards,creatingaspaceatthecoreofSchnee devoidoftherhythmicdrivethat hadpreviouslydominated. 153 DynamicContinuities Thisnotionofdisintegration–underlinedbythesteadydetuningprocessof the intermezzi – is taken to the opposite extreme in Canons 4a and 4b, two movements which mirror one another and allude inform to ‘minor’ and ‘major’ versionsofaminuetandtriorespectively,thecomposerlabelingtheminthescore as anhomageto ‘WAM’– Wolfgang Amadeus Mozart(Abrahamsen2009, 4). The spiky canon theme – played by violin, viola, ?lute and clarinet – appears rhythmically fragile; rumbling chromatic piano lines and a pair of sleigh bells (themselves a nod to Mozart’s Die Schlittenfahrt, K. 605 No. 3) outlinine two separate pulses (one marking each beat of the 3/8 bars, the other marking a quaverquintupletforeachbar),servingtofurtherdistortanyperceivedregularity (seeFigure6.17). Gradually more andmorefeatures fromthe early stagesofthe piecearerecalled, including sustainediterations ofthe canontheme inthe violin andviola(frombar10onwards)echoingCanon1b, andthe ‘wind-like’sforzando arcs and trills of the ?lute harking back to Canons 2a and 2b (from bar 13 onwards).Thereturnofsuchfeaturesseemsto nudgetheensembletowardstwo central ‘trios’ ofeerily suddenstasis, momentum suddenly dropping to reveal a partialrecollectionofthe?irstcanonpairing,violinprovidingapulseofharmonics whilst the two pianos reproduce a rhythmically steady ‘guiro’ effect. The cor anglaisevenbegins tooutlinethedescendingthirdsofthevery?irstcanontheme, a gesture veiled by the oboe, clarinet and cello via their own sustained ?igures. When these half-remembered features fail to produce any momentum of their own, the ‘minuet’ passages are reprised, launching the ensemble onwards, an unforgivingtemporalonslaught. After the third intermezzo (itself now acting as a brief point of repose), thereislittleletuptowardsthecloseofthework;whilstthetempoofthe?inaltwo canonsisnotablymoresedate,theirsurprisingbrevitygiveslittleopportunityfor listeners to absorb the new material. Following the example of JS Bach, Abrahamsen divides the ensemble in two (violin, viola and ?irst piano against piccolo,clarinetandsecondpiano)to presenta‘rectus’andan‘inversus’, withthe materialgiventoeachintheformerswappeddirectlyoverforthelatter(see6.18). Indeed, thematerial itself is a series ofrefractionsand re?lections, with theboth groups essentially producing different versions of the same patterns simultaneously. The interlocking piano lines produce a steady quaver pulse 154 DynamicContinuities reminiscentoftheostinatoattheveryopeningofthework.Indeed,giventhatboth Canons 5aand5bpresentessentially thesame music twice, thegapbetweenthe movements(marked‘attaccaalCanon5bintempo’)actsfarmoreasabriefhiatus like those found in the ?irst two movements, lending the close of the work an unsettling circular character, with new material framed in a strikingly similar manner. Dynamiccontinuities Althoughtheyharnessverydifferentstylesoverradicallydifferenttimescales,the two works explored in this case study exhibit similarities in their approach to issues ofform.BothSchnee andthe?inaleoftheFourthSymphonyarebuilt from small unitsofrepetition.Theinevitablechallengefacingcomposersofsuchpieces istoretaintheinterestoflistenersoveralongerperiodoftimebyminimisingthe potential dulling effect of such recurrence. Brahms and Abrahamsen certainly achievevariety, butthey do not attemptto conceal the circularity of theirforms. Rather they engage with the perceptual aspects of cyclical music over longer periodsoftime,deployingsmall-scale repetitivecells insuchawaythat listeners might be drawn into an interaction with the recurring material, prompting a developingrenewal ofaural perspective. Brahms manages this throughacareful blurring of formal boundaries, more often manipulating the metrical context of recurring material rather than directly altering the content itself. In Schnee, meanwhile,itisthedistinctionsbetweencontentandcontextthatbecomeblurred. As repeating?igures surfaceandenterinto dialoguewithoneanother,they move inthemindsoflistenersbetweenforegroundandbackground,ashiftingecologyof motifsandcycles. It is in this way that both works manage to convey broader continuities, offering forms that, inspiteof their built-in circularity, somehow allow listeners thesense ofa through-composedmusical ‘journey’. Whilst Brahms’s ?inaleoffers two successive time-spans in which the same material is taken in alternate directions, Abrahamsen’s Schnee takes the shape of a onward process of disintegrationwhilstneverlosingsightofitsbeginnings,withitsclosehintingata wider circularity. In this way, the concept of developing variation has profound implications for the way in whichforms are perceived, highlighting a seemingly 155 DynamicContinuities contradictory duality of stasisand ?lux. Tensions betweensegmentedrepetitions andunfolding forms create added temporal interest, drawing further awareness towards anunderlying temporal experience. It is theway inwhich this broader continuity emergesfromtheseparadoxicalexperiencesthatwillformthefocusof Chapter Seven, with applications of narrative ideas representing a particularly engaging, if sometimes problematic, way of dealing with long-term musical structure. 156 Seven ExperiencingTime Perceivingforms Theanalystisconcernedwiththepartiallyorimperfectlyheard,withrelationships between musicalelements as wellasthe elements themselves, and withmusical contexts. He orshe realises that some things which cannot literallybe ‘heard’ – that is, cannot be accurately identiSied, named, or notated – may still have discernible musical reasons for being in a piece. A psychologist may dismiss as irrelevantstructuresthatalistenercannotidentify. […]Butitdoesnotfollowthat there is no reason forsuch piecesto be structured the waythey are. (J. Kramer 1988,328–29) Accounting for musical perception over longer durations proves yet more challenging, not least given the in?luence of time itself as a crucial factor in comprehending form. This chapter will explore ways of approaching the perception of large-scale musical designs, moving through a number of more cognitive-basedapproachesto discuss how aspects ofperceivedcontinuity might form the basis of structural understanding. Particular focus will ultimately fall uponwaysinwhichnarrativeconcepts mightbeappliedto temporal experiences of compositions, with particularemphasis fallingupon contributions fromByron Almén(2003and2008),JannPasler(2008)andSusanneLanger(1953). As Hugues Dufourt notes, ‘cognitive psychology has shown that mental structures active in perception are above all dynamic and integrating processes which unceasingly compose and transform data’ (1989, 223). The developing interplaybetweensmall-scalemusical elementsover prolongedperiodsmakesit increasingly dif?icult to separate out the effects of these elements when considering long-term structure. In attempting to locate the perceptual limits of what he terms ‘form-bearing dimensions’, Stephen McAdams considers the contributionofavarietyofmusicalfeatures–principallypitch,duration,dynamics andtimbre–tolarge-scalemusicalconstruction(1989and1999).Thedimensions he outlines might helpfully be summarised with regard to the metaphorical directionsthey relate to: the structuringovertime of signi?icant ‘vertical’ events, 157 ExperiencingTime andthe‘horizontal’organisationofrelatedevents into sequential andsegmented musicalstreamsandgroups(1989,182–83).However,bothMcAdamsandCélestin Deliège(Deliège,1989)acknowledgethatthesedimensionsareinturndependent uponabstractknowledgeaccumulatedthroughreceivedculturalconventions and extensiveexperienceofmusicthataccordswiththoseframeworks:‘Thisdomainis perhaps the most important for the consideration of form-bearing capacity because it is clear that if a system of habitual relations among values along a dimension cannot be learned, the power ofthatdimensionasastructuring force wouldbeseverelycompromised’(McAdams1989,183). Nicholas Cook provides an insightful overview of the intricacies facing empirical research in this ?ield within the context of the elaborate systems of expectationfoundinWesternartmusic (1990, 22–43). Thenetwork ofmeanings apparently conveyed by musical works and the conventions they engage with introduces new levels of complexity. Heard performances seem to constitute a durationsomewhatremovedfromthe?lowofnormal time,‘logicallydistinctfrom anyexternal context’, as Cook puts it: ‘Musical form de?ines anindependent and repeatablecontextwithinwhichtheeventsofamusicalcompositioncanbeheard as meaningful. These events gain a kind of objective identity by virtue of their relationshiptothiscontext.’(Cook1990,38) Echoing the dimensional aspect invoked by McAdams, Cook outlines an abstract spatialisation of musical forms. Placing himself in concordance with Schoenberg, Carl Dahlhaus and Thomas Clifton, he expresses a preference for a visualexpressionofaworkinwhichtheinterrelationofitspartsmightbeseenas ‘constituting an objective structure’, a simultaneous expression of a temporal duration (Cook 1990, 38–41). In attempting to account for a broader range of musical styles than Lerdahl and Jackendoff’s ‘generative theory’ (1983), Irène DeliègeandMarcMèlenalsoproposethenotionofanabstractedvisualisationofa musical work, advocating a model that seeks to unite surface characteristics (DeliègeandMèlen1997).Particularmotifsandgesturestaketheformofcuesthat are, they suggest, abstracted from the linear progress of the work through repetition. These cues are subsequently categorised in vertical (separate groups containing similar cues) and horizontal (relationships between different cue categories)terms,aprocedurecomparabletothatinferredfromMcAdams above. 158 ExperiencingTime The end result is what they term an ‘imprint’, a ‘standard auditory image’ that establishes‘theboundarybetweenwhatisandwhatisnotthenormwithinagiven piece’(1997,402–08). The holistic functionof repetitive components withina musical work has beenthesubjectofnumerouscognitivestudies.Issuesofcoherenceandcontinuity feature heavily in experimentation carried out by Lalitte andBigand concerning the sensitivity of listeners to large-scale forms, with deliberate alterations to structuralorderingspickedupuponbylistenerswhonoticedalackofprogression or development (LalitteandBigand2006).AdamOckleford, meanwhile, supports his own‘zygonic’theorymodelby venturingto suggestthat aurally recognisable derivation of musical material may also play a crucial role in helping to build a ‘structuralnarrative’forthelistener,anideathatwillbereturnedtoshortly(2004 and2005). Jonathan Kramer evaluates a theory of long-term perception in which durations are encoded through the memorisation of the musical mechanisms of particular passages andgestures; whilst he readily accepts ‘chunking’ as amajor contributor to temporal processing, he is keen to emphasise its limitations, stressingthat‘musicistoocomplexandmusicalinformationistooelusivetoform thebasisforaquantitativetheoryofperception’(1988,342): Themostcommonlyvoicedcriticismoftheinformation-processingmodelisthatit is curiously static for a theory of time perception. Surely as we experience an extended duration, informationis encoded stepbystep, notallat once. Youread thesewordsone (orafew)ata time, graduallybuilding amentalimage ofwhatI am saying; the meaning doesnot suddenly leap into your consciousness as you Sinisheachparagraphorsentence.(1988,345) Kramer convincingly argues that at least two mental processes (information encoding and timing) form the basis of the perception of large-scale structures (1988,365–67),playingintoabroaderdualitypresentinmusicaltimeperception. Just as ‘chunking’isdistinctfromitslessmalleablebut nonetheless simultaneous ‘clock time’ counterpart (1988, 337–38), the act of listening is a mixture of two cooperativebutsometimesseeminglycontradictorymodes. The?irstis described as‘still-spectatorobservation’andprovidesparticularinsightintothemechanisms offormalperception: 159 ExperiencingTime The still spectator in us builds up a mental representation of the piece, which becomesgraduallymore completeaswemovethroughthe musicandaswelearn it better with subsequent hearings. Our mental representations are not in themselvesdynamicbutare more orlessstatic,exceptwhen we discover(orare led by a critic’s or analyst’s insights to uncover) structurally important relationships we had not previously encoded. The gradual accumulation of encoded information in the form of a mental representation of a piece is what nonlinearperception,orcumulative‘listening’,reallyis.(1988,367) Thisrelativelystaticreceptiveapproachiscontrastedwithamoredynamicone,an ‘active listening mode’ focussed upon ‘continually changing materials and relationships’:‘Thiskindoflisteningisconcernedwithexpectations, anticipations, andprojections into thefuture.Itislessinvolvedwithformingrepresentationsin memoryandmoreinvolvedwiththeimmediacyofthepieceandwhereitis going (ornotgoing)’(1988,367). Ofcourse,assigningdescriptionsofstaticanddynamic tothetwomodesinthiswayisrepresentativeofjustoneperspective.Inaparadox typical of temporal philosophy, the labels could just as easily be reversed: the activemodeis static onaccountofits?ixationinthepresent, whilsttheobserving modeisdynamicwithregardtothechangingaccumulationsand?igurationsofthe abstract construction it creates. Musical structures that balance recurrence and change–likethoseofAbrahamsenandBrahmsanalysedinChapterSix–attestto thisseeminglyparadoxicalinterchangeability. Continuityandnarrativepotential Although earlier lengths may not determine later lengths in the same way that earlier materials or tonal relations generate later ones, the simple fact that the music is heard in sequential order may cause us to compare later durations to earlierones. In other words, although there may be no clear implications about proportions early in the piece, we may still form expectations about durational spansbasedonthewaythepieceinitiallyunfolds.Ourlisteningstrategy,then,may wellbelinearevenifthemusicisnonlinear.(J.Kramer1988,326) 160 ExperiencingTime Althoughasenseofoverridinglinearitymightseemtobeanobviouscharacteristic of temporal experience, Kramer’s observations allude to implications for formal readingsthatmighteasilybeoverlooked.Arecurringconcernthroughoutthecase studies in this thesis has been the reconciliation of time-bound impressions of musical performances with seemingly atemporal – or at least retrospective – structural interpretations of the forms of the works in question. Examining the formal anticipations of listeners remains, of course, particularly dif?icult. Articulatingwithclaritysomethingwhichultimatelymaynotcomeintobeingisa dauntingtask;analystsmustoftensettleforexploringthewaysinwhichemerging musical structures ful?ill, or leave unful?illed, broader expectations. Janet Schmalfeldt attempts to approach early nineteenth-century forms from the perspective ofa perceptual unfolding withher study In the ProcessofBecoming (Schmalfeldt 2011). Meanwhile, notions like Robert Hatten’s ‘markedness’ – in whichmusical features are ‘asymmetrically valued’ according to other opposing features (Hatten1994, 291)– feed into issues oflong-term tensionthatecho the suggestion of scholars, as Byron Almén notes, ‘that it is the relations between elements and not the elements themselves that are the foundation of narrative’(Almén2008,36).30 That the term ‘narrative’ continues to appear is no coincidence. Indeed, although Ockleford takes the notion in a very speci?ic analytical direction, his broader description of a ‘structural narrative’ stands as an apt summation of a centralcontrastinmusicperception:astable,logically-designedwholeintuitedvia asuccessionofperceivedmomentsandevents.Althoughitdoesnotfallwithinthe remit of this thesis to appraise the concept of musical narrative in full, certain aspectsoftheidearetainrelevance.Alldiscussionsofnarrativepersistinengaging with fundamental continuities of works and performances, in short the binding essenceofexperiencedmusical time. ForJean-JacquesNattiez itisthelinearityof this basissuccessionofeventsthatincites narrativeattachment(1990, 257). Just as musical form entwines with the inescapable linearity of temporal experience, his recognitionofa‘narrativeimpulse’inmusical listening (discussedinChapter Two: Alternative Paths) strikes upon an apparently universal trend in human 30Notably,amongthosewriterstowhomAlménalludesisJosephCampbellwithhiscross- culturalnarrative studyTheHerowitha ThousandFaces(2008);Campbell’sthoughtson universalaspectsofnarrativearediscussedinChapterTwo(AlternativePaths). 161 ExperiencingTime nature. Anthropologists Elinor Ochs and Lisa Capps delineate the cross-cultural social role that narratives play indepicting temporal transition (Ochsand Capps 1996). The chronological dimension of these narratives lends a ‘reassuring coherence’todisconnectedevents,servingtoaf?irmnotonlyorderbutalsosenses ofselfandmeaning: Personal narrative simultaneously is born out of experience and gives shape to experience. In this sense, narrative and self are inseparable. Self is here broadly understood to be an unfolding reSlective awareness of being-in-the-world, including a senseof one’spastandfuture. Wecome toknowourselvesaswe use narrative to apprehend experiencesand navigate relationshipswith others. The inseparability of narrative and self is grounded in the phenomenological assumption that entities are given meaning through being experienced and the notionthatnarrativeisan essentialresource in thestruggle tobringexperiences intoconsciousawareness.(Ochs&Capps1996,20–24) A long tradition exists of scholars utilising this inherent leaning towards continuity as a springboard for interpretations which organise musical forms according to facets of literary and dramatic structure. As Fred Everett Maus explains, listeners can perceive musical events ‘as characters, or as gestures, assertions, responses, resolutions, goal-directed motions, references, and so on. Once they are so regarded, it is easy to regard successions of musical events as formingsomething likeastory, inwhichthesecharactersandactionsgotogether toformsomethinglikeaplot’(1991,6).Numerousfeaturesofmusicalworkslend themselvesto suchtreatment: theuse ofsungtexts oraccompanyingstories can inspire more detailed programmatic readings; the manipulation of thematic subjects can beviewed as mirroring dramatic character developmentprinciples; changing phrase structures can be equated to rhetorical and syntactical conventions(Almén2008,14–15). Ofcourse,therearelimitationstosuchreadings.Manyofthefeatureslisted aboveareprevalentonlyinmusicthataccordswithClassicalandRomanticstyles. Themajorityof narrative theories deal withworks from the late-eighteenth and nineteenth centuries because the governing tonal principles of those pieces are decidedly teleological. It is simply easier to attach established plot templates (tragedy, romance, comedy) to music that echoes the cultural relevance of such 162 ExperiencingTime archetypes through its formal construction, with motivic, harmonic and tonal continuitiesre?lectingthenecessary tensionsofcon?lictandresolution,departure andreturn. Just as thedistinct musical continuities (or, indeed, non-continuities) foundinmanyrecent pieces maywell call for afreshsetofnarrativearchetypes, anexplorationthatseekstoplaceoldandnewworksinparallelwilllikelyrequire fresh,perhapsbroaderperspectivesonformalunderstanding. Expressing concerns that narrative readings have little bene?it for posttonal music, Robert Adlington airs far broader reservations regarding what he deems ‘one of the vogues to have emerged from the recent rush to celebrate music’s ways of meaning and its manifold relations to other cultural practices’(1997b,121–23).Narrativeanalogiesanddescriptions, heargues,have become so embedded within the critical lexicon that even some more recent attemptsto evadethe subjectivityofnineteenth-century modes of analysis serve instead to reinforce them: ‘So the attribution of what may loosely be termed narrative characteristics to music frequently occurs quite innocently – in (for instance)theprioritisationofsequentialorder, theassumptionoftherelatedness of events, and the expectation of a measure of retention of the course of events’(1997b,124). For Adlington, the notion of ‘unfolding structure’ is just one such way in whichabidtosidestepextra-musical attachments stillendsuprelyingonliterary principles, albeit in a less overt manner. Just as the suggested meaningful ‘unfolding’ burdens listening with a syntactic dramatisation, imagery is invoked unavoidablythroughtheideaof‘structure’;thelinguistic andvisualreadingsthat aresupposedlybypassedemergeasunderlyingperceptualconcepts.Furthermore, though they are both commonly harnessed by analysts to provide cohesive readings of pieces, Adlington argues that verbal and visual approaches to form address irreconcilably distinct aspects of musical experience, and that these differencesareimplicitlyglossedoverorrarelyquestionedbywritersandreaders alike (1997b, 140–48). The cultural implications have proved damaging, with a moretraditionalemphasisuponthescoreitselfandthesupposedneedto‘explain’ it creating decidedly awkward circumstances for contemporary music. Here composersseemcompelledtoprefaceperformanceswithaf?irmationsofnarrative 163 ExperiencingTime elements that do not feature so prominently (if at all) for ?irst-time audiences, leadingtoquestionsofinadequacyonallsides: Alltoorarelydoessucha failure totrace musicalnarrativepromptan alternative response:namely,a confrontationof theassumptionsaboutmusical form thatso regularlyserve toembarrassanddemean. Ratherthan automaticallyassume that one'sexperiencehasbeeninadequate,itmightbearguedthatconventionalbeliefs about music's afSinity with narrative are in some way unsatisfactory and misleading. The manner in which listeners organise sound is simply not done justicebytheanalogy.(1997b,125–26) Thefailureofsuchapproachestosupportexperiencesoflessconventional music in this way proves to be a killing blow for narrative theories as far as Adlingtonisconcerned.Parallelswithliteraryformsburdenlistenerswiththetask of perceiving and understanding works as a plot, with only a comprehensive realisationofthesequenceofeventsconstitutingan‘adequatemusicalexperience’. Questioning the ability of pieces to convey sequential relations as effectively as language, he casts doubt upon the speci?icity that many identify in music: ‘Although we are often loath to admit it, music, particularly on ?irst hearing, frequentlygives little enduring sense of its sequential form, leaving insteadonly thesketchiestlong-termimpressions’(1997b,133–34). Questioningcontinuity The line of questioning Adlington presents constitutes a welcome appraisal of aspectsofnarrativeandmeaningthatmighteasilybetakenforgranted. However, it is pertinenttowonderifhisconclusions servetounderestimatethecapacityof listeners to engage with, and derive meaning from, the temporal continuity of musical experience. Jean-Jacques Nattiez reaches similarly sceptical conclusions regarding narrative theory and its applications to musical form; ‘nothing but super?luous metaphor’ is his somewhat damning indictment (1990, 257). However, hedoes ?indapositivemeans of progress throughaspects oftemporal continuity: 164 ExperiencingTime Butifoneistemptedtodoit,itisbecausemusicshareswithliterarynarrativethat factthat,withinit,objectssucceedoneanother:thislinearityisthusanincitement toanarrativethreadwhichnarrativizesmusic.Sinceitpossessesacertaincapacity forimitativeevocation,itispossibleforittoimitate the semblanceofa narration without our ever knowing the content of the discourse, and this inSluence of narrative modes can contribute to the transformation of musical forms. (1990, 257) Giventhatacentral premiseofnarrative–orofanykindofjourney–isits engagement with aspects of temporally-bound continuity and coherence, the employmentofnarrativeconceptsinaccountingforforminanymusicishelpfulin as far as the continuity of those pieces unfolds as a palpable structural feature. Inevitably, thereceptivenessoflistenersto different kinds ofcontinuitywill vary according to an innumerable number of determining factors shaped by social, culturaland artisticexperiences. But thesearediscourseswith which anysearch formusicalmeaningmustengage;moreoftenthannottheapplicationofnarrative theoryconstitutessuchaquest.Inthissense,theapplicationofnarrativeideastoa piece of music might be seenas offering something akinto a theoretical middleground, offering a more interdisciplinary slant on more traditional, structuralist perspectives that emphasise the self-suf?iciency of musical forms. As Rose RosengardSubotnik writes: ‘Structural listeninglooksonthe ability ofa unifying principle to establish the internal “necessity” of a structure as tantamount to a guaranteeofmusicalvalue’.Intheseterms,whatmightbedescribedas the‘inner logic’ofamusicalcompositionrendersitdiscreteandwhole,withitsdevelopment (often in the Classical mould) audibly expressing the composition’s own ‘selfdetermination’(Subotnik1996,159). Bycontrast, morerecent poststructuralistleaningsinscholarshipdisplay a willingness to navigate the intricate networks of ‘extra-musical’ forces that contribute to musical meaning; they offer what Alastair Williams describes as ‘a powerful critiqueofmusic’sinstitutionsandmethodologies,anddomuchtobring musicology into general humanities discourses, preventing perception of it as an isolateddisciplinewithitsownnarrowconcerns.Ithighlightsthetextualqualities of music and its discourses, demonstrating just how interdependent they are’(Williams 2001,41). Althoughhetakescaretoemphasisethewaysinwhich 165 ExperiencingTime such scholarship presents a ‘continuous transformation’ of the traditions of structuralist thought, Williamsdoes not shyaway fromhighlighting theneglectit seekstoaddress(2001,21–22): Like materialist criticism, structuralism recognised that cultural artefacts, including music, are underpinned bydeep structures; but unlike materialism, it failed to understand that self-regulating sign systems might be culturally determined.Althoughstructuralismdaringlybroke the notion of musicalmeaning awayfromauthorialintentandscandalisedestablishedhumanistnotionsofart,its fetish of detachment refused to contemplate the social mediation of apparently abstractstructures(Williams2012,230). Lawrence Kramer scrutinises further this vague attitude towards the locationofmeaning. Criticising a perceived inclinationof music analysts to prize notionsofunitythathavebeenlargelydiscardedbyliterarytheorists(to‘totalise’, as heputs it), he argues that narratology has actedas a‘methodological halfway houseinwhichmusicalmeaningcanbeentertainedwithoutleavingthesafehaven of form’ (L. Kramer 1995, 98–99). Kramer exercises particular caution when it comes to the formal implications of narrative readings, describing narrative elements as ‘forces of meaning’ rather than of structure, and portraying the narrative condition as ‘fractious and disorderly’: ‘Structure and unity are its playthings, and its claims to truth are strongest where most contingent, most mixedupwiththeperplexitiesofidentityandpower,sexanddeath’(1995,119.) The enquiries of poststructuralism certainly go some way towards providing the more open-minded theoretical basis necessary for analysing a varietyofcompositionalstyles.ContrarytoLawrenceKramer’spessimisticviewof narrative as a catalyst for formal interpretation, scholars have explored ways of expanding narrative theory to account for contemporary music that might be thought of as being ‘fractious and disorderly’ in character. Noting the apparent desires of many recent composers to ‘reject the paramountcy’ of narrativity in musicthroughthesubversionofaudienceexpectations,JannPasler(2008)seeksa moreadaptiveapproachthatinvitescomparisonwithJonathanKramer’sinclusive temporal outlook. She outlines three broad types of alternative narrative developed by composers in the course of the twentieth century. The ?irst – ‘antinarrative’ – might be thought of as a counterpart to Kramer’s ideas of 166 ExperiencingTime multiple-time, describing musical works in which conventional narrative expectations are continually aroused only to be frustrated, subverted or offset through structural juxtapositions, contrasts and jump-cuts. The second – ‘nonnarrative’ – does not negate the idea of narrative altogether but rather structuresmusical featurestraditionally indicativeofsuch linearity in awaythat doesnotful?il theirsupposednarrativefunction; muchminimalist music, withits non-directedsenseofpulseandtonalbearing,mightbedescribedintheseterms. Pasler’sthirdcategory –‘nonnarrativity’–isdistinct from‘nonnarrative’; as with Kramer’s ‘vertical time’, it concerns music that shuns any discernible organising principle, structure or syntax, and thus attempts to ‘erase the role of memory’(Pasler2008,39–43). Perhaps of greater relevance, though, is Pasler’s assessment of novel approaches to musical narrative developed by composers within the last two decades of the twentieth century, highlighting what she views as attempts to reconcile the diverging paths forged by styles that seeks to emphasise either structuralprinciplesoreaseofperception.Althoughshefocusesprimarilyontextbased works – operas by John Cage andHarrisonBirtwistle, andsong cycles by BernardRands–herconclusionsholdwiderrelevance: Thesenarrativesborrowthe mostimportantattributesoftraditional narratives– the use of signiSieds, well-deSined structures, conSiguration, unifying reference points,transformation,andmemory.Buttheycontinuetorespondtothe modern desire for expressing the multiplicity of existence, fragmentary and seemingly irrationalorders, and meaningsthat gobeyondthose thatareknown.[…] Evenif theirconSiguration isnotthatof a dramaticcurve, theirstructuresgenerallyhave clearly deSined beginnings and endings, and they reach closure of one sort or another.[…]Butperhapsmostimportant, suchworksmayincorporatemorethan onenarrative,eithersuccessivelyorsimultaneously.(2008,46–47) Byron Almén is similarly receptive to less conventional narrative types, notingthe frequentabsenceofaperceivable ‘topic’(aprimary expressivefeature oftenestablishedearlyinapiece,frequentlyde?inedinoppositiontoanothertopic in the manner of Robert Hatten’s ‘markedness’ principle (1994, 291)) in many serialandminimalistworks.Theabsenceofthiscontrast–andthusdirectedness, Alménasserts– caninturnproducepieces thatfailtosupportnarrativereadings 167 ExperiencingTime (Almén 2008, 90–91). Although he deems the questions as to the limits of narrativity that these non-narratives raise as beingbeyond the remit ofhis own enquiries, Almén’s own theoretical framework proves particularly compelling. Lookingtoevadeanoutlookinwhichmusicalnarrativeisderivedprimarilyfrom literary modes, heproposes amoreproductive‘sibling’model inwhichbothare indirectly related as ‘distinct media sharing a common conceptual foundation’ (Almén 2008, 12–13). Indeed, he suggests that this theoretical distinction proves to bealiberatingfactor for musical meaning, withthe lack of semantic speci?icity inherent in literature and drama facilitating ‘wider applicabilityandgreater immediacy’for musical narratives. Many ofhis working de?initionsofmusicnarrativere?lectthisconcernforreceptionandsemantics: It is a psychologically and socially meaningful articulation of hierarchical relationshipsandourresponsestothem.Itinvolvesthe coordinationofmultiple structure of meaning at multiple levels. It crucially depends on a conSluence of factors–abstractconventionsof meaning, speciSicmusico-temporalsuccessions, and individual interpretation both conscious and unconscious. It is capable of supporting multiple interpretive strategies invoking different political and temperamentalimperatives.(2008,27) Dynamicforms Ultimatelythemappingofmoredetailedconstructssuchasnarrativeontomusical form is a matter of interpretation. Whether such processes prove helpful or not with regard to perceiving and forming an understanding of particular pieces of music will vary, often drastically, according to a wide range of factors; these include thestyle andcharacter of thework in question, the performance ofthat work, the context ofthat performance, and disposition andframeofmindofthe audience. Ofcourse, suchvarietystandsas aseemingly unsurpassableobstacleto anyeffortto developadetailedtheory that mightaddressallkinds ofmusic with somedegreeofsuccess.However,thiswouldbetomissthepoint:anyembraceof diversity is boundto involve, in turn, anequallyopen-mindedapproachtowards theoretical variety. Asfar as narrativegoes, the mosthelpful unity that mightbe identi?iedacrossmusicalstylesistheiruniversaltime-boundcharacter.Forallthe 168 ExperiencingTime ways in which composers have manipulated their forms to subvert a linear experience – whetherthrough theuseofdiscontinuous features, or total elusion via anattempttoinvoke anon-narrative–theoverridingtemporal experienceof their work will invariably include fundamental parameters of start- and stoppoints, ifnotthe formal closureofa recognisable beginning andendas Jonathan Kramerdistinguishes(Kramer1982, 1). Similarlimitationsapplyinliteratureand other media.31 Indiscussing the‘menu-driven tree structure’that websites offer theirreaders, allowingthemto createtheirownsequenceratherthansuccumbto anenforcedlinearity, PeterElbowaptlynotes that suchtime-savingstrategies do not enable an avoidance of time altogether: ‘They let us escape an enforced sequence through a text, but they do nothing to help us escape sequence itself. Human readers are still stuck with the ability to read only a few words at a time’(2006,653). Any counter-claim to this overruling linear reality, like the assertion of narrative, might well be considered the product of an illusion. However, these illusions retain crucial importance as the products of subjective musical experience.Ifanything,thecontrastsandcon?lictsbetweenthebroaderpassageof timeandthedistortionsofthewayitisexperiencedmighthelpinformanalysis.A palpabletensionis ofteninducedbetweenthis overridingconnectionofduration andthemusicalsubversionscontainedwithinitthatmightconfrontordefyit.The reassuring onward stability of thepassage of time ensures a broader continuity that is nevertheless allowing of and receptive to experiences of internal discontinuity.SusanneLangertouchesonthis tensionthroughher preferencefor multipletemporalformsovera‘one-dimensional’time: Butlife isalwaysa dense fabricof concurrenttensions, and as each of them isa measure of time, the measurementsthemselves donot coincide. Thiscausesour temporalexperience tofallapartintoincommensurate elementswhichcannotbe all perceived together as clear forms. When one is taken as parameter, others become‘irrational’,outoflogicalfocus,ineffable.Sometensions,therefore,always sinkintothe background;somedrive and some drag, butforperception theygive 31 Almén presents an interesting critique of Nattiez’s inference that causality is a prerequisitefornarrative, utilising examples from literature –including ashortstoryby KazuoIshiguro–todemonstratethatconnectionsbetweeneventsareultimatelymade by theobserverratherthanbytheauthororcomposer(Almén,2008:30–32). 169 ExperiencingTime qualityratherthanformtothepassageoftime,whichunfoldsinthepatternof the dominantanddistinctstrainswherebywearemeasuringit.(1953,112–13) Langer’s hesitationtoincludenotions offormhereisseeminglytiedto her widertemporaloutlook.Actualexperience,sheasserts,hasno‘closedform’;rather it is memory that creates form, shaping experience ‘into a distinct mode, under which it can be apprehended and valued’. ‘It is the real maker of history,’ she writes, ‘not recordedhistory butthe sense ofhistoryitself, the recognition of the past as acompletely established(thoughnotcompletely known)fabric ofevents, continuous inspaceand time, and causally connectedthroughout’. However, the emphasis she places upon memory as a selection of the many impressions of presentexperiencehintsatthemoresigni?icantpartthatin-the-moment listening mightplay;indeed,sheassertsthat‘torememberaneventistoexperienceitagain, but not in the same way as the ?irst time’ (1953, 262–63). The immediacy of experienced event does contribute to a broader impression of musical construction,notjustasanabstractedmemorybutasanencounterthatmustbein somewayrelivedinorderforitsrolewithintheformtobeadequatelyrealised. It is the wider temporal, andthus formal signi?icanceofsuchmoments in musical performances that are at risk of neglect within theories that place emphasis uponacceptedperceptual hierarchies ofmusic: rhythmic andmetrical groups,segments andproportions. Therecanbeno doubtthatthewaysinwhich wederivemeaningfromthesenotionsfeatureheavilyinformalthought.However, this can come at the expense of a consideration of how particular events and passages can in?luence overall structural impressions. These moments do not necessarily have to subvert larger structural continuities; rather they can sometimes pull them into focus, or temporarily render them unimportant inthe minds oflisteners. Articulatingor identifying the effect of such moments canbe particularlydif?icult,notleastgiventhemercurialnatureofsubjectiveexperience: thecharacterofmomentsmayneverappearthesamewaytwice, andwhatmight seem a particularly lucid and signi?icant passage during one hearing of a work mightwellslipbyalmostunnoticedduringanother.Buttherecanbenodoubtthat inordertoaccountforsuchevents,broaderideasofformshouldretaina?lexibility in-keeping with this subjectivity. Just as the musical relationships that help to 170 ExperiencingTime create perceptual continuities within pieces may shift and alter, so should conceptionsofformmaintainasenseofdynamism. There can be little doubt that the unusual temporality found in these instancesisamajorcontributortotheirsigni?icance.Examplesofdescriptionsand explorationsofcomparablephenomenaappearacrossabroadrangeofliterature. Edward T. Hall proposes the cultural notion of ‘sacred time’ as an immersive, removedalternativetothepassageofordinary‘profane time’ (Hall 1984, 25–26, discussedinKramer1988,16–18,andinLushetich2014,77–78).JonathanKramer asserts that music possesses the ability to re?lect both sacred and profane time (Kramer1988,17),aconclusionechoedbyBarbaraBarryinheroutlineofmusical time comprising adialectic between?inite‘structured’ andin?inite ‘transcendent’ modes. These ideas have been adapted to narrative terms; Pasler suggests that momentsofnarrativetransformationserveto interrupt thelinearityofamusical work (Pasler 2008, 33–36), whilst Almén makes reference to points of crisis in piecesandtheireffectsuponperceivedresolution(Almén2008,22). Passagessuchastheseseemto facilitateaphaseofanti-hierarchicaltime, a signi?icant temporal experience that might appear at once isolated from and profoundly connected to its musical surroundings. It is in these moments that some kind of recognised formal signi?icance – whether a convergence or divergenceofmaterial,achangeindirection,amotivicrecasting,areturntoearlier ideas,orarestart–enablesanimmersivetime.A heightenedawarenessoftimeis promptedinlisteners, enablingabroader perceptual‘space’inwhichthecontent anditswiderrelevancecanbeexploredbeyondtheregularityofcontinuouslinear time. It might be argued that such phenomena constitute some of the closest experiences to ‘timelessness’ (as an immersive moment set apart from a comparatively‘timed’context)thatmusiccanprovide.Thecasestudythatfollows willbeginby exploringtwosuchexamples andtheirimpactwithinthecontext of two very different musical works: the ?irst movement of Beethoven’s ‘Eroica’ Symphony and Kaija Saariaho’s piano trio Je sens un deuxième coeur. Utilising parallelpassagesat theheart ofbothpieces asaspringboardforconsiderationof theirwiderdesigns,someofthenarrativeimplicationsfortheperceivedtemporal formswillbeexplored. 171 Eight NarrativePossibilities KaijaSaariaho&LudwigvanBeethoven Many ofthe analyses within this thesis – whether explicitly or not –began with speci?ic landmarks in musical structures, catalytic passages in long-term forms. Thespringboardforthiscasestudytakestheshapeofabriefparallelbetweentwo pieces, acorrespondencethatischaracterisedbymelody. Thischapter,inasense, comestheclosesttoutilisingLawrenceKramer’s‘hermeneuticwindows’approach as astartingpoint, withhisnotionof‘structural tropes’proving particularly apt: ‘Sincetheyarede?inedintermsoftheirillocutionaryforce,asunitsofdoingrather thanunits of saying, structural tropes cut across traditional distinction between form andcontent. They can evolve from anyaspect of communicative exchange: style, rhetoric, representation, and so on’(1990, 9–10). An examination ofthese two passageswill giveway to anexplorationofthebroaderarchitectures ofboth pieces, and the manner inwhich their temporal narratives mightfacilitatethese momentsofsigni?icance. The?irstpassagecanbefoundat thecentreofKaijaSaariaho’s (b. 1952)Je sens un deuxième coeur for viola, cello and piano (2003). Here, an episode characterised by dissonance and a rhythmic drive of relentless force reaches a point ofburn-out. Itgivesway to ashroudedatmosphereasthe thirdmovement begins, a slowly lapping piano accompaniment underpinning the strings as they present the ?irst notable gestures of melodic unison in the course of the piece (thirdmovement, bars1–10).Arching?iguresecho fragmentsofpreviouslyheard material before repeatedly disintegrating into whispered harmonic trills, discernible pitch content ebbing away atop a dissonant, tonally static accompaniment. The self-perpetuating, onward insistence of the preceding movement has all but vanished, with the music seemingly recoiling from its ferocity,retreatingintoitself.Asenseofdisillusionmenttakeshold,claustrophobia setting in as the sameharmonic shapes are treaded andretreaded, the abilityto generateanylastingmotionseeminglydisabled. 172 NarrativePossibilities ThesecondpassageconstitutesaparticularlydistinctivepassageinWestern musical history. Theopening Allegro con brio ofBeethoven’s (1770–1827)Third Symphony (1804) reaches near-total meltdown at a structural point that early listenersmusthaveassumedwouldsignalahomecomingtotheopeningmaterial. Asuccessionofdizzyinglyrapidmodulationsprecipitates–insteadofatriumphant return–acataclysmicseries ofjuxtaposedchords, violentsyncopationandbrutal dissonance threatening to wipe the slate clean of the established metre and harmony (?irstmovement, bars248–79).32 Melodic content, too, is undersiegeas WilliamKindermandescribes:‘So unrelentingisthis rhythmic fragmentationand compressionthatthethematicmaterialisvirtuallydissolvedinto nothingatabout that point when the recapitulation would normally be expected’ (1995, 91). As brutal unison string chords ricochet and fade in the fallout, a coiling melody emerges inthewoodwind, onealtogetherdistinctfromthethemes that havethus fartakencentre-stageinthework.Theforeignnatureofthesubjectismatchedby thekey in whichitis presented: E minor, one step away from the furthest tonal pointfromtheE♭-majortoniconadominantcycle.Theresultsareaudiblyalien,a senseofdisorientationaroused. Thedetachment andloss thatcanbeexperiencedinboth ofthese passages might seem to lie at odds with the rigorous structures they sit within. In these passages,timeappearsdistorted,asifdetached,orreleased,fromitssurroundings. Beethoven’s?irstmovementisunquestionablylinearincharacter,itsrestlesstonal desire imbuing its duration with a seemingly irrepressible urgency. In spite of numerous small-scale metrical disruptions, the product of this design is an overridingtemporal continuity.It is inthewakeofthedevelopmentalclimaxthat thisprogressiveapproachisbrie?ly calledintoquestion, withthedistant E-minor melodyseeminglyhighlightingthealienatingcostofsuchprogress.Saariaho’strio, meanwhile, at times gives the outward impression of a similar kind of driven continuity inthetwo fastersegments that?lankthiscentral movement. However, this chapter will exploretowhat extentthesurface linearity of thesemovements affects temporal character of the work at large, and indeed how this apparent 32 Whilst the ‘Eroica’ has been treated to a rich reception history of analyses and commentaries,theywillrarelyformpartofthediscussionhere,withtheexceptionofScott Burnham’s dissection of the work in light of heroic tropes (1995). For an insightful considerationofthisreceptionhistory,seeLockwood1982. 173 NarrativePossibilities advancement canbe reconciledwith the static disquiet at the core ofthe work. Throughanevaluationofbothofthesepassageswithintheirrespectiveworks,itis hoped that they can be shown as ‘structural tropes’, constituting formal proceduresthatalso emergeasrecognisableexpressiveacts(L.Kramer1990, 10). Their roles within the perceived temporalities of the works are particularly signi?icant, offeringat once a sense ofdetachment from the temporal journey at large whilst simultaneously pulling the course of that journey into focus. The purpose of this case study, with regard to the discussion in Chapter Seven (Experiencing Time), is not to map out or advocate speci?ic narrative plans for these pieces. Rather it is to highlight potential interpretive levers – perceptible formal and temporal elements ofthe music rooted in conceptions of continuity, energyandperspective–thatmightserveasabasisforsuchreadings.Ultimately, itisthewayinwhichthesestructuresmightbeheardandunderstoodovertime– bothinthemomentoflistening, andinretrospect–thatwillpavethewayforthe discussionofapproachestomusicalforminthetheoreticaldiscussionthatfollows inChapterNine(UnderstandingTime). Surfacebalance Although these two works were conceived almost two centuries apart, and take verydifferentcourses withregardtomusicalstyleandsubstance,thecomparable sensationsofdisorientation–emotional,temporalandspatial–thatareinducedat theirstructuralcoresofferarevealingparallel. Itisobviousthattheseapparently relatedends are achieved through differing means. Nevertheless, a glance at the wider architectural properties of both pieces reveals a shared emphasis on balanced proportion. The ?ive segments of Saariaho’s trio are lent a collective symmetry throughtheir placement:three slow sections intercededby two faster episodes, barnumbers, metronome marks, andtypical performance durationsall corresponding to create two approximate movement types. The central slow movement lies perceptually furthest from therelative clarity ofthe opening and 174 NarrativePossibilities Movements Bars Crotchetpulse(bpm) Duration 1.Iunveilmybody 35 c.40(withinsenzatempo) 3’37 2.Openuptome 88 c.92–104 1’59 3.Inherdream,shewaswaiting 58 c.66 4’03 4.Letmein 96 c.86 2’17 5.Ifeelasecondheart 56 c.63 4’48 Fig.8.1:Saariaho,Jesensundeuxièmecoeur,formalscheme Sonataformcomponent Exposition Development Recapitulation Bars 304 244 274 Sub-component Bars Duration Firstexposition 153 2’45 Expositionrepeat 151 2’42 Departure 126 2’22 Return 118 2’06 Recapitulation 159 2’55 Coda 115 2’30 Fig.8.2:Beethoven,‘Eroica’Symphony,Uirstmovement,formalscheme closingsections,itssti?linginactivityanddisorientationpresentingastarkcontrast tothefasteroutburststhatimmediatelybookendit(seeFigure8.1).33 The opening Allegro con brio of Beethoven’s Third Symphony broadly follows the architectural patterns of sonata form. Conventionally speaking this might give the impression of a bipartite form, with the repeated exposition balanced out by a brief development section and a rounding recapitulation. However, evenjust comparing the‘Eroica’ to earliersymphonic ?irst movements serves to indicate an expansion, its 15-minute-plus timescale easily eclipsing predecessors. What proves fascinating, however, is not the expansion itself but where ithasoccurred.Farfromsimplybeingstretchedoutwards,Beethovenseeks 33 Durations taken from recording listed in primaryresource list (Jonathan Moerschel, viola;EricByers,cello;GloriaCheng,piano.HarmoniaMundi:HMU907578). 175 NarrativePossibilities to change the structural make-up of the music from within, identifying and broadeningthesectionstypicallygrantedlessscope(seeFigure8.2).34 Thesonataformis transformedfromabipartite to atripartite form, with exposition, development, and recapitulation granted relatively equal weighting. Paradoxically, whatmightbeviewedasamanipulation–astructuraldeformation, asHepokoskiandDarcywoulddescribeit–oftheclassicalforminfactalignswith the very ethos of that outlook, as de?ined by Charles Rosen: ‘the symmetrical resolutionofopposingforces’(1997,83);indeed,itisthepalpablestrainprecisely of the attempt to provide this kind of rhetorical balance that might enhance a ‘deformational’reading, with Beethoven seemingly applying – in Hepokoski and Darcy’swords–‘compositionaltensionandforcetoproduceasurprising, tensionprovokingorengaging result’(2006, 617).Furthermore,itispossibletoviewthe forminanincreasinglyepisodic manner,sub-dividingthesestructuralboundaries torevealsixapproximatelycomparablesmallersegmentsofbetween115and159 bars in length, eachassuming a different role in the developing narrative ofthe piece. To achieve a heightened mode of expression, the scope of the musical narrative has been broadened to encompass a greater sense of journey and con?lict. The principle expansions are found in the development and the recapitulationsections,bothofwhicharedoubledinconventionalsizerelativeto the formal proportions of the movement. Rather than simply propelling the materialthroughpointsoftensionandclimaxbacktowardsthetonic,Beethoven’s development sectionhere takes the shapeof two gestures, the ?irst carrying the music further away from tonic stability before a return occurs throughout the second. Thecataclysmicbreakdownthatoccurs justbeforetheE-minorlandmark ofdisorientationliesatthetraditionalpointofrecapitulation.Insteadofproximity tostability, audiencesarepresentedwithapalpabledistancefromit,themusicin an apparent state of deconstruction rather than reconstruction. In spite of this apparent deformation, it is still notable that the fundamental changes contained within the development might still be understood according to the normative zones that Hepokoski andDarcy outline, witha sequenceoflinking, preparatory, 34 Durations taken from recording listed in primary resource list (La Chambre Philharmonique,conductedbyEmmanuelKrivine.Naïve:V5258). 176 NarrativePossibilities centralaction, andretransitional functionsemerging (2006, 229–30). Indeed, the violenteruptionatthecentreofthesectionmightbethoughtofasanampli?ication oftheveryqualitiesthatWilliamCaplin(1998)ascribesto thetypical‘core’ofthe development, projecting ‘an emotional quality of instability, restlessness, and dramatic con?lict’ (1998, 142); Caplin’s description of the musical features that mighthelptocreatetothiseffectproveparticularlyrelevantifcarriedtoextremes: ‘Thedynamiclevelisusuallyforte,andthegeneralcharacterisoftenoneofSturm und Drang. The core normally brings a marked increase in rhythmic activity projected by conventionalised accompanimental patterns. Polyphonic devices – imitation, canon, fugal entries – can contribute further to the complexity of the musicaltexture’(1998,142). Thecoda,meanwhile,achievestheparadoxofcallingthestabilityofthetonic into question precisely by af?irming it, ‘recapitulating the entire process of the movement,‘ as Burnham asserts (1995, 23). The entire movement could theoretically conclude with the close of the ?irst part of the recapitulation, a gradualfadeoccurringinthetonickey.Itisatthispoint,however,thattheprimary themeisforceddownwardsviatwooutbursts,the?irstinD♭,thesecondinCmajor paving the way for the coda – a two-step motion derived from the subversive manoeuvre from E♭ to C♯ in the celli in bars 6–7. Through a series of further modulations, the tonic is eventually re-established and ecstatically stated at the movement’s close. More generally, it demonstrates a further questioning of the security and dominance of the tonic framework and the primary material that accompanies it, the varied perspectives granted through the tonal and thematic distanceofferedintheexpandedsectionsactingtoweakenthesenseofhierarchy. Paradoxically,itisthroughaheightenedsenseofproportionalbalanceintemporal formthatapalpabledegreeofinstabilityisreinforced. Internalnarratives Metaphors involving human actionsengage the imagination more directly, overtly andpowerfullythan those detailing facelessprocessesthat are meaninglyorganic. (Burnham1995,8) The subject matters that served as inspirations for both pieces are strikingly different. Forming a major part of the mythology surrounding the piece, 177 NarrativePossibilities Beethoven’s ‘muse’is well known:theoriginal scoreoftheworkboretheheader ‘Buonaparte’. The composer had originally conceived of dedicating the work to NapoleonBonapartebuthadinsteadoptedforhispatronPrinceLobkowitzforthe practical purposes of obtaining both a première and a fee. The First Consul of Francehadinsteadassumedtheapparentstatus ofsubject, the personi?icationof the ideals of freedom and equality that had permeated the recent French Revolution.AshispupilFerdinandRiesrecalled,itwaswhile?inishingthepiece,in May 1804, that Beethoven furiously withdrew the title-page inscription upon hearingofNapoleon’sallbutself-appointmentas‘Emperor’,declaring:‘Sohetoois nothing more than an ordinary man! Now he will also trample all human rights under foot, and only pander to his own ambition; he will place himself above everyoneelseandbecomeatyrant!’(Sipe1998, 54–56). The political catalyst for theworkwas,nevertheless,somethingthatBeethovenmadelittleefforttoconceal, subsequently revealingtheinspirationbothtohispublishers (describingit asthe real title) and ?inally naming the work as an ‘heroic symphony, composed to celebrate the memory of a great man’ (Robbins Landon 1974, 93–94). Heroism itselfhadbecomethesubject. Jesensundeuxième coeurgrewinitiallyfromSaariaho’s work onhersecond operaAdrianaMater,premièredthreeyears afterthecompletionofthetrioatthe OpéraBastilleinParis.Thestage-workconcernsamotherinanunnamedmodern countryonthe vergeofinsurgenceandwar. Asthe opera’s directorPeter Sellars explains(2012),thecontentofeachmovementstemsfromparticularscenesinthe opera.Themusic ofthe?irstmovement is –intheopera –thewoman’s dreamof freedominaclaustrophobicsti?lingworld:‘Thegestureofunveilingisprovocative but innocent, adult but celebrating a sensuality that moves deeply inside every human being.’ The second section is utilisedas heralcoholic boyfriend violently appeals to her to let him into her house, while the central alienated movement takestheformofadreamsequenceinwhichwaractuallybreaksoutintheircity, familiarlandscapesravaged:‘Strange,stolenmomentsoftendernesscontrastwith horror –watchingata distanceina dream theterrible thingsthat humanbeings are capable of.’ The vision becomes a reality and the music of the fourth movement, most shockingly, accompanies asceneinwhichthewoman’sdrunken boyfriend, now a member of the local militia, attempts and succeeds to batter 178 NarrativePossibilities down the door – he enters, and rapes the woman. The trio closes – in an intriguingly circularmanner– withthestartingpoint for theopera: themother’s sensed physical relationship with the unborn child she bears as a result of the horriblyviolentact: Theemotionaldepththatwe associate withanymothercarryinganychildismade deeper by the fact that her sisterencouragesher to have an abortion, to kill the monster that is growing inside her, a living embodiment of her violation. This motherchoosestokeepthe child, and singing toit asshe carriesitinside her, she decidesthathervoicewillhelpshapethischild.Thischildwillnotbeamonster,but aloving,whole,sane,andvaluedhumanbeing.(2012,9–10) Although both composers may have approached the compositional process withmoreconcrete images inmind, the ties between thepieces andtheir initial subjectmattershavebeendeliberatelyweakened.Beethoven’sresponseto–what was inhis eyes – Bonaparte’s eventual trans?igurationinto theverymonsterthe manhadsetouttodestroy,wastoremovehisstatusasthestandardbearerofthe symphony. The composer’s convictions regarding the work itself remained unblemished. The relationship between Saariaho’s music and its subject matter, meanwhile,isdemonstratedinhergeneralattitudetowardsopera: It’salways the inner space thatinterests me. And in a waythatmakesmyoperas verydifSicultto stage. In Emilie, thiswomanis writing aletterfor90 minutes–so whatdoyoudowiththat?It’sveryprivate:everything ishappeninginthiswoman’s mindduringone nightwhenshe’sworking.Likeallof myoperas,itshouldhave the effectofbeingfundamentallyprivate music,musicthatIwanttocommunicatewith theinnerworldofmylisteners,justasitexpressesmyinnerimagination. (Saariaho andService2011,14) Accordingly, it is this communication withthe internal – andits side-effect appealto theuniversal–thatallowsthetrio totakeonalifeofitsownbeyondits operaticgenesis.Whilethetitlesofeachmovementreferspeci?icallyto signi?icant fragments of Amin Maalouf’s libretto, only a comprehensive knowledge of the opera itself would allow a listener to apply a speci?ic ‘synopsis’. Saariaho’s programmenoteforthetrioallowsaglimpseonthealtogetherseparatethematic content that served as a compositional catalyst, emphasising a twice-abstracted takeuponthepiece: 179 NarrativePossibilities The title of the Sirst section, ‘I unveil my body’, became a metaphor: the musical material introduced was orchestrated to reveal the individual characters of the three instruments and their interrelations. The second and fourth partsboth start from ideasof physical violence. In the contextof this trio the violence has turned intotwostudies on instrumental energy. Part three isa colourstudy inwhich the threeidentitiesaremeldedintoonecomplexsoundobject.Thelastsectionbringsus to the thematic starting point of my opera, again very physical: the two hearts beatinginapregnantwoman’sbody.(2003) Thesubjects ofbothworks might, in a somewhat obvious sense, be saidto encompasstheconceptofan‘other’.Beethoven’ssubject–heroism–isastatethat canonlytrulybeidenti?iedinrelationtoitssurroundings,morespeci?icallysome kindofopposition.Heroicqualities,likemostcharactertraits,areatleastpartially de?ined by their opposites; the performance of heroism typically involves overcoming something. While the ‘other’ of Saariaho’s opera may ?luctuate accordingtothedevelopmentoftheplot(theboyfriend,thesister,con?lictandwar itself),thecomposerindicatesthatthecentralimageattheheartoftheabstracted trio is of the relationshipbetween a mother and her unborn child. It presents a fascinatingparadox–the‘other’thatisfoundwithin,aninternaldialogue. Thisliteralinternalisationoffersthepotentialforanew wayofviewingboth pieces. In Saariaho’s conception of motherhood, the narrative may be said to concern an attempt to understandoneselfas much as it does to understandthe ‘other’withinoneself– aninterdependenceisat workhere. Meanwhile,although Beethoven’s subject of heroism could on its surface be seen to concern con?lict withanexternal?igure,amoreclassically-groundedconceptionoftheheroechoes theideaofaninwardperspective. This redirectionofexpectationsis summed up eloquently by Joseph Campbell in his dissection of protagonist narratives in culturalmythologies: ‘Wherewehadthoughtto traveloutwardsweshall cometo thecentreofourown existence; where wehad thought to be alone, we shall be with all the world’ (2008, 18). Both the Allegro con brio ofthe ‘Eroica’ and the macro-symmetryofJesensundeuxièmecoeur,foralltheiroutwardviolence,might insteadbeheardasgrapplinginwardly. 180 NarrativePossibilities Fulcra In spite of the surface linearity that the ?ive-movement structure of Je sens un deuxième coeurpresents,itstemporalexperiencewouldseem to possess facetsof circularity. There are numerous points ofaudible return, recognisable harmonic andmelodicshapesfrequentlyre-emerginginthecourseofthework. Ratherthan taking the form of speci?ic materials that recur in a leitmotivic fashion, the signi?icanceoftheserecurrencesseems tolieinthesonoritiesthemselvesandthe tonal power that they gain through their very repetition and recasting. In attemptingto makefurther senseofthesestructuralmarkers,itisusefulto draw upon an idea presented by another ?igure featured in this study, the British composerThomasAdès. Heexpressesapreferenceforcertainpitchesaspointsof audiblerecurrenceinthecourseofawork: It’ssomething in the waythat Ihearall music, actually, this idea of there being a single note – a particular pitch on a particular instrument – that has a crucial function acrosswhole structures... You see iteverywhere: in BeethovenorMozart, HaydnorChopin:there will be anote that will be afulcralpoint forwhole pieces. Andoftenitwon’tbethetonic.Oftenitwillbeanotethathasbecomeanobsession, aroundwhichthewholepiecehinges.(AdèsandService2012,48) Certainly an obvious ‘fulcrum’ emerges in the course of the ?irst movement through the repetition of octave G♮s in the bass-line of the piano. Initially resoundedtwice(bars 1–7),theoctaveisdisruptedby theintroductionofaB♭in place of the lower G♮ (bars 8–11). After anseries of alternate bass resonances (bars12–28:A♮ –A♭–D♮–E♭–F♯), G♮ returnsintheformofatremolo pedalthat lastsfrombar29tothecloseofthemovement,underpinningtheascenttoaclimax inbothdynamicandactivitylevels(bar31)andthefadethatfollows. WhilstG♮ certainlyappears tobeestablishedassomethingofabassfulcrum in the course of the ?irst movement by virtue of its recurrence – the ‘obsessive’ character suggested by Adès very much demonstrated – its role within a tonal contextisnotquiteclear. Althoughitsfunctionwouldseemtoencompassthatofa tonic,providingapotentialbasisforastableframework, notransparentharmonic hierarchy is subsequently outlined. Indeed, the very repetition and grounding natureoftheG♮pedalseemstoinciteakindofperceptualrestlessness;ratherthan 181 NarrativePossibilities Fig.8.3:Jesensundeuxièmecoeur,secondmovement,bars54–57 providing security, as the G♮ is comprehensively assimilated into the accepted harmonicgeographyofthemusic,agrowingneedforchangesets in. Thusbythe closeofthemovementakindofauralclaustrophobiahastakenhold;themusical content has seemingly peaked without precipitating a new direction, its accumulated potential energy now in need of an outlet. In this sense, the pedal approachesthefunctionofadominantratherthanatonic,providingaspringboard ofsortsforthekineticoutburstthatfollows. The harmonic grounding that is presented at the opening of the second movement provides a step away from the established fulcrum and, in doing so, opens up the possibility for what could be viewed as a second focal point: continuedreiterationsofA♮dominatetheopening28bars(interestinglyA♮proved to be the ?irst fully-?ledged bass departure from G♮ in the course of the ?irst movementatbar12).Followingaseriesofswiftharmonicjolts, theA♮fulcrumis reasserted at a structural landmark, a climactic, fortissimo point of emphasised rhythmicconvergenceamidthericocheting dialogueat bar 55(seeFigure8.3). It lands almost exactly at the ‘goldensection’ ofthe movement, afrequent peak of aestheticinterestinthetemporalandarchitecturalschemeofapiece,the55thbar of a total of 88 (the Golden Ratio of 88 being 54.38699101166787); it is also notablewithregard to itssigni?icance withintheFibonacci sequence, 55and A♮ also features within theviolent, thrice-repeated, nine-note chordthat brings the movementto itsclose, itselfaconglomerationofsigni?icant harmonicbasspedals thatoccurinthecourseofthemovement(seeFigure8.4). 182 NarrativePossibilities Fig.8.4:Jesensundeuxièmecoeur,reductionsofclosingsonoritiesof secondandfourthmovements Movements Openingfulcrum sonorities Closingfulcrumsonorities 1.Iunveilmybody G♮inbass 2.Openuptome A♮outlinedinbass 3.Inherdream,she A♮inhigherregisters,F♯ A♮inhigherregisters,F♯ waswaiting andF♮inbass andF♮inbass A♭/A♮trillleadingtoG♮ G♮andA♮includedwithin emphasisinbass dissonantoutbursts 4.Letmein G♮pedal 5.Ifeelasecondheart G♮inbass G♮&A♮includedwithin dissonantoutbursts G♮pedal Fig.8.5:Jesensundeuxièmecoeur,tabledetailingfulcrashifts Taking the idea ofG♮ and A♮ as competing, orat thevery least interacting, fulcra has interesting implications, not least with regardto the circularity ofthe work. Simply taking the presence of these two notes within the opening and closing gestures of each movement reveals a traceable harmonic narrative (see ?igure 8.5). With A♮ having G♮ as the bass grounding at the outset of the second movement,thedisorientationattheoutsetoftheensuingcentraldreamsequence seems to arise from the absence of such lower-register clarity. Although the movement is introduced by A♮s in the strings, the notes seep in via the higher registers, with any meaningful tonal sway immediately displaced by the dissonanceinthelefthandofthepiano:F♯andF♮ (thirdmovement, frombar2). Thislossoftonalclarityinwhatfollowswouldappear–atleastinpart–tobedue to the absence of a clear fulcrum. Indeed, it might be suggested that for the majority of the movement, the concept is broadened to instead encompass the 183 NarrativePossibilities Fig.8.6:Jesensundeuxièmecoeur,thirdmovement,bars1–3 entirearea surrounding G♮ and A♮. Semitone relationships dominate muchofthe lower-registercontentthroughout.Inthisway,F♯-F♮andits‘dominant’pairingC♯C♮ holdgreat sway in the early stages of the movement (bars 1–26), repeatedly disrupting any audible security established by the fulcra; see Figure 8.6 for an exampleoftheclashesandinteractionsbetweenF♯-F♮.inthepianoleft-hand, and G♮ intheright-hand,allbeneathsustainedA♮sintheviolaandcello).A♮doesbegin to show as something ofatemporary arrival point, struck uponfrequently atthe closeofslowlydescendingleft-handphrases in thepiano (frombar32onwards) beforeemergingbrie?ly inde?initiveoctaves (bars40–41).G♮ also emerges asthe lowervoice ofanostinatopiano phrase(combinedwithE♮ andF♮),onebarlong, that appears erratically at ?irst (in bars 42, 45 & 48) before enjoying an undisturbed?ive bars ofrepetitiontowards the closeofthe movement (bars 50– 54).ItisnonethelesssupplantedbythereturnoftheF♯-F♮octavepairingfromthe openingofthemovementinthe?inalbars(bars55–58). Whathasthus farremainedalargelyhorizontal dialoguebecomes avertical onefromtheoutsetofthefourthmovement,thetwofulcrasetdirectlyagainstone another. The initial piano trill creates a haze of A♭ andA♮, a hangover from the chromatically muddiedwaters ofthe previous section. Therepeatedpatternthat then quickly evolves in the lower registers of the piano spans a ninth, G♮ at its 184 NarrativePossibilities Fig.8.7:Jesensundeuxièmecoeur,fourthmovement,bars1–4,(piano) Fig.8.8:Jesensundeuxièmecoeur,fourthmovement,bars40–42,(piano) lowestpoint,A♮atitshighest. Althoughtonal weightinitiallyseemstoliewithG♮, its depthcombinedwitha?irstbeat emphasis,addednotesandarapidshiftfrom straight semiquavers to quintuplets and ?inally sextuplets allows a displacement, withG♮ nowactingasanupbeat,A♮asthedownbeatofeachostinato gesture(see Figure8.7). Letmeintakestheformofanexaggerated, manicreturntothefastmaterial of the structurally symmetrical second movement. Discontinuity permeates the musical landscape, manifesting itself in the shape of unexpected ‘jump-cuts’ precipitated by sharp, dissonant tutti chords that curtail the perpetuating sequences.Eachrenewalofsequentialactivityfollowingtheseinterruptionsseesa newmoveinthepowerstrugglebetweenthetwofulcra,G♮orA♮usuallyemerging as repeated punctuations of patterns, oftenaudible as the lowest pitch: take, for example, the appearancesofG♮ from bars 16and19, orA♮ frombars 12and23. Thecyclingfour-note pattern(B♮ – A♮ – A♯–G♮) thatappears in thebass ofthe pianofrombar34onwardsinconjunctionwithrapidright-handscales–andthat eventuallydominatesthe?inal passages ofthemovement–seesbothfulcrapitted againstone anotheroncemore,G♮ againassumingthestance ofabass upbeat,A♮ ringingoutanoctave higher thantherest ofthephrase(seeFigure8.8). Evenas thepatternbecomesmisshapenanddeformedtowardsthecloseofthemovement (bars74–92),thetwofulcraremainwithinitsgraspwithnotableconsistency,the 185 NarrativePossibilities Fig.8.9:Jesensundeuxièmecoeur,openingsofUirstandUifthmovements, reductiontohighlightreversalofnoteseries(violaandcello) reintroductionofchromatic elements incloseproximityultimately doing littleto dull their impact. The two notes even assume roles within the chord that is frequently utilised as a sudden interruption, almost always pairedin the strings (with frequent piano backing) withanadditional A♭, a chromatic blurring again recallingthedisorientationofthecentralmovement(bars54–58,63,67and69). Finally, both fulcra are crucially contained within the 10-note chord that violentlyconcludesthe movement(seeFigure8.4). Closelyrelatedto theparallel ?iguration that concludes thesecondmovement, thechordseems to performthe function of wiping the tonal slate clean, allowing a con?ident bass octave reassertion of G♮ from the very start of the ?inal movement. In audibly circular fashion, the music here in many ways mirrors the opening of the entire piece, broaderarching gestures stillpresentyetnowunderpinnedbyaquickermetrical motion. Indeed, a reversal ofthe opening rise-and-fall idea in the strings canbe heardwithinthe?irstthreebars, E♮–F♮–C♯nowpresentedinretrogradewithan intercedingD♮nowintroducedinthecello(SeeFigure8.9). Intriguingly, the bass resonances presented in the lowest registers of the pianoalsoecho –atleastinitially–thebroaderpathofthe?irstmovement:aB♭is soon introduced in place of one of the octave G♮s (from bar 5), with octave A♮s introduced (from bar 9) followed by A♭s (from bar 13). After further episodes rootedbynotablytriadicbassnotes(B♭andD♮)aswellasextendedspellswithA♮ and A♭, it falls to a seven-bar G♮ pedal to conclude the work (bars 50–56), the unresolved sensation of the close of the ?irst movement now displaced and 186 NarrativePossibilities counterbalanced by a sense of return. The perception lies far closer to that of a tonic,the?irstfulcrumcon?irmedasthetruearchitecturalfoundation. Insearchofstability Whilst the essential theory of two properties interacting and competing can certainly betransferredfrom Je sensun deuxième coeur to the ?irst movement of the‘Eroica’,itisdif?iculttoapply‘fulcrum’labelstospeci?icsonoritiesorelements. Expandingthe‘fulcra’conceptsomewhat,itispossibletoviewBeethoven’sAllegro con brio architecture as comprising a dialogue created by motions between two extremes of a spectrum: stability and instability. The resulting sensation is of musical content held in an ever-present but shifting tension between these two poles.Itis,perhaps,whatBurnhamtouchesonwhenhedescribesthe‘latenttrend towards death’hehearsintheC♯ofbar seven(1995, 22). Goingfurther, itmight beportrayedas a two-way relationship, inherent tendencies ofone towards the other:stabilitytowardsself-destruction,instabilitytowardsresolution. Inthecourseofthe‘Eroica’,stabilitymanifestsastheverybuildingblocksof conventional Classical tonality: thetriaditself. Forits?irst four bars, theopening theme of the work takes the shape of an unambiguous expression of this, remarkably utilising only the three constituents of the tonic chord with the downbeat emphasis falling solely on E♭ (see bars 3–6 in Figure 8.10). Its supremely static nature presents aparadoxical subject, onthe one handa blank motiviccanvasripefordevelopmentonaccountofitssimplicity,andontheothera statement of stability so bold that it almost seems to demand its own deconstructionif anything new is to come from it. Its ?igurationalso raises new ideaswhencontrastedwiththetwoexplosivetuttiE♭outbursts thatcomebefore it: avertical expressionofthetriad(twochords)followedbyahorizontalone(an arpeggiatedsubject).Therelationshipbetweenthetwogesturesatthisstageinthe work presents two expressions of energy: potential and self-perpetuating, the lattercastingthe arpeggio shapeinadynamic rather thanastatic manner. While thetriadicpurityofthisthemeremainsunmatched,manyofthethemesthatfollow all outline thetriadto somedegree, the threenotes providing theframework of 187 NarrativePossibilities Fig.8.10:‘Eroica’,Uirstmovement,bars1–14(violins,violasandcellos) much of the subsequent motivic construction and development. Even the ‘new’ melody that appears inthe wakeofthecentral implosion(frombar284)audibly tracestheE-minortriadwithitsphrasedcontours. Indeed, theapparentnoveltyof thethemeis,inmanyways, afacade;thesubjectisinfactafusionofearlierideas taken from the exposition (see Figure 8.11). The result is a fresh and unusual perspectiveonhighlyfamiliarmaterials. The stable manoeuvres of the these triadic ?igures interact with broader gestures of instability that initially stem from a motivic cell introduced in the seventhbar, a two-part semitonestepdownwards inthe celli from E♭ to C♯, the harmonicresultbrie?lytakingtheshapeofadiminishedchordonG♮. (seebars7– 11inFigure8.10)Thetonalconsequenceisthequickestablishmentofapalpable relationshipbetweenstableandunstabletonalforces;RobertHattendescribesthe C♯ as a ‘seed of instability’ (1994, 121). Almost immediately (from bar 9), the 188 NarrativePossibilities Fig.8.11:‘Eroica’,Uirstmovement,thematicderivationofE-minordevelopment repulsion from thetonic createdthroughthe sharpenedsubmediant is corrected throughadiametricassertionofthemediant,are-attractiontoE♭inducedthrough areversalofthesemitonedropinthebass.Inmanyways,thisC♯ mightbeseenas representative of the subversive ‘opposition’ against which the heroism of the movement might be judged. However, it seems particularly signi?icant that this chromatic disruptionemergesaudiblyfromthecellothemeitselfratherthanfrom a different source. Here, Hatten’s concept of ‘markedness’ – an asymmetrical evaluationofdifferentoropposingfeatures (1994, 34–43)–is evokedwithinthe samebroadmelodicshape.AswiththeconceptualnarrativeofJesensundeuxième coeur,theopposition,andthecon?lictthatensues,stemsfromwithin. Thesemitoneslippervadestherestofthemovementalmostas prominently asthetriaditself,at?irstfacilitatingmultipleshiftsawayfromE♭(bars17–24)that haveto thenbereversed,furtherdestabilisingthestatusofthekey.Inmanyways, its aural status as the tonic – as a de?inite point ofdeparture – rarely seems in doubt; rather the effect is of the very signi?icance of the tonic and its broader structural implications being called into question, an initial statement of unparalleledstabilitytendingtowardschaos.Theresultofthesesubversionsupon thewiderarchitecturemaywellbeagradualdislodgingofanauralrelianceonthe role of the tonic. The effect on the exposition repeat is profound, witheven the initialstabilitynowperceptuallysubvertedfortheaudience,E♭almostassuminga mirage-likequality. Asthemovementprogresses,thechromatic slipisconstantlycastandrecast in apparent attempts to counteract its destructive tendency, to normalise the gesturewithinamoreconventionaltonalframework. Thepeakofthis struggleis 189 NarrativePossibilities Fig.8.12:‘Eroica’,Uirstmovement,harmonicreduction,bars248–84 reached at the core of the development section, ever-continuing drops and violently syncopated chromatic shifts creating strained modulations, eventually reachingapoint ofno return (seeFigure 8.12foranharmonic reductionof this passage). As the onward rhythmic motion begins to disintegrate, a diminished chordonD♯–underpinnedbyA♮–momentarilygiveswayto two barsofCmajor in its second inversion (bars 274–75). The suddenunalloyed major triad seems frighteninglyalienatthispointinthework,thefourbarsthatfollowcomprisingan equally terrifying F-major chord in the second inversion riddled with sevenths, invoking achaotic collision of F major andA minor(bars 276-279). Rather than precipitatingalong-awaitedstandardmodulatoryreturnto thetonicviathenow theoreticallytouchableB♭dominant,anentirelydifferentharmonicrouteissought throughanunsettlinglyspelledB-majordiminished-seventhchordcloudedfortwo bars byanadded?lattenedninthfor theswitchtotheaudiblyforeignterritoryof E-minor(bars280-84). Burnham insightfully notes the role that the linearity – both tonal and temporal–ofthemovement’sdesignplaysinthedisorientationexperiencedhere: ‘Forifwedo?indourselvesinwhatmayretrospectivelybeadjudgedanimpossibly remote harmonic realm, we are made to feel the ineluctable continuity of the process throughwhichwearrivedthere’. Heisalsorightto notethatthepassage constitutesa‘long-rangeunderlyingtonal preparationofEminor’(1995, 11–12); thesustainedB-majortriadsinbars262–65actasamajorcontributorinaf?irming theeventual move throughaperfect cadence(bars 280–284). However, itcannot 190 NarrativePossibilities Bars Tonalleaning 284–91 Eminor 292–99 Aminor 300–07 Cmajor 308–12 Cminor 313–15 A♭ major–D♭ major–B♭ major 316–19 E♭ major 320–29 E♭ minor 330–37 G♭ major 338 B♭ major Fig.8.13:‘Eroica’,Uirstmovement,tonalleanings,bars284–338 beemphasisedenoughthat thisprocedureisembeddednotonlywithinlayers of dissonance but also within apolyphonic ‘pulling apart’of boththe harmonic and metricalfabric. Ashasbeennoted, theE-minorthemethatthenemergesisnotasnovelasit may appear, essentially derived from pre-existing – and audibly recognisable – compositional elements andprovidinga characteristic outline ofthe new triadic tonal basis. Perhaps the disorientation here stems not from the content’s unfamiliarity, but precisely from its haphazard familiarity; the theme takes the shape of a recollective conglomeration of the core motivic ideas of the work, concepts that now teeter on theedgeofirrelevanceinthe wakeofsuch abrutal assault on – and dismantling of – the traditional tonal scheme. With a desolate extension of the development sectionnow unfolding wherea triumphant return homewouldconventionallysit,thisisnotsimplyadenialofauralexpectations,but aviolentrejectionofthem. In the wake of this tonal implosion, it is the semitone slips that drive the music onwardsinitswake, incessantupwardgear-shiftssettinginasthepassage seemstostriveforanalternativedirectionwithrenewedvigour(seeFigure8.13). ThesearchextendsinsuchafranticmannerthatE♭majorisinfactstruckuponin 191 NarrativePossibilities its early stages, though its lack of relevance to the immediate harmonic scheme leaves it bypassedinfavourofits ownminorkey, proofofa full tonal alienation achieved(bars316-22). Thefrenzieddriveofthemusiceventuallyreachesapoint of burn-out, stalling at a B♭-major-seventh chord (from bar 378)with theadded ?lattened-ninthintroducedinthe ?irst violins from bar382(adirect referenceto thesameintervallicadditioninbars282–83aheadofthemovetoE-minor).Inthe moment of listening, the horn call of the returning ?irst subject (bars 394–95) seems to surface ‘prematurely’ , arriving before the ensuing nod to a dominant seventhintheviolins hasbeengivenachancetoresolvetothetonic, preempting aural expectations that a point of return might be imminent. Certainly the appearanceofthemotifseemstojarwiththecontext:semi-quaverrepetitions in the violins providing a skeletal reference to the dominant-seventh harmony (adjacent A♭ and B♭). It is a discontinuity that seems to echo with the by-now strengtheneddesireforareturn to the tonic realm, perhaps a hang-upfrom the metrical disruptions and jump-cuts that have taken place throughout the developmentsection.However,thisdiscontinuityisabsorbedintothecontinuityof thewholeinretrospect inthewaythat it providesanewperspectiveonthe?irst subject;tonalemphasisnowfallsuponthe?ifthratherthanthetonic,precipitating the?inaltuttirushtotherecapitulation(bars394-98). Whentherecapitulationgraduallyslowstoahalt(bars551–56),theE♭tonic successfully re-established as an audible point of return, the movement could hypotheticallyconcludeveryeasily. Butjustaswiththecorrespondingjunctureat thecentreofdevelopmentsectionatwhichtherecapitulationisdenied,Beethoven projects thearchitecturefurtherahead,delayingtheconclusionofthe movement. The fading reminiscences of the primary triad subject are thrust downwards througha broadening of thesemitone slip, D♮ and C♯becoming D♭ andC♮ (bars 557–64).35 The most notable aspect of this extension is the enharmonic transformationofC♯toD♭, thevery representationofinstabilitynowassimilated as part ofa potential solution to the form of the movement. What this brief but signi?icantharmonicshiftcreatesisanopportunityforare-routetothetonic with theintent ofestablishing a greatersenseofstability. Therepulsive powerofthe 35 Othercommentatorswho haveargued thisinclude Sipe (1998, 103), Burnham(1995, 21)andBasilLam(1966,122). 192 NarrativePossibilities semitone slipis harnessed as a tool to emphasise theaudiblepower of thetonic triadviaanincreaseintonal momentumforthe?inalapproachtoit.Morebroadly speaking, the establishment of a ?inal ‘coda’ section con?irms a new sense of balanceandsymmetry ofstructure–the sonataformis here no longer bipartite, buttripartite. Self-destruction Thewiderresultofthisperceivedinstabilityisarigorousinterrogationofthetriad itselfengineeredthroughchangingperspectivesuponit.Beyondmerelysettingup a hierarchical system of harmonic interactions and patterns of antecedence and consequence, the ‘Eroica’ seems to call into question its very fabric and, more broadly, tonality itself as a means by which a framework can be provided for musical structure. Throughtheheavilytriadic characteroftheinitialmaterial,the repeated chromatic subversions that disrupt it, and the subsequent attempts to reassertconventionaltonalpowerandstability, aninwardexaminationofmusical functionisprecipitated. The‘Eroica’isoftenhighlightedbycommentatorsonaccountofitsperceived outwardviolence:itsbrutalrhythmicdisregardforitsmetre,itsblatant?loutingof traditionalstructuralboundaries.ConradWilson,afterdescribingthe‘unstoppable momentum’ of the ?irst movement, draws attention to the second in terms of notably public gesture: ‘The music, complete with sonorous oration, is hugely atmospheric and at times thunderously graphic’ (2003, 34). Perhaps, though, its most compelling force is directed within, spiralling inward. The centre of the movementtakestheformofanimplosionratherthananexplosion. Thesimplicity of thecoresubject from whichthework stems–the E♭-major sonority – is such thatitsverynatureisultimatelyplacedbeneaththemicroscope;itisthetriaditself thatonehearsdismantledandevaluated.Thisquestioningmightevenbeextended to thebroaderformitselfwithregardtothewayinwhichthe structurehasbeen manipulated. In drawing attention to the reshaping of form and its parallel implications forexpressivecontentthroughthe course ofthenineteenthcentury, Hepokoski andDarcysuggestthat‘thepresenceofanysonatadeformationwhose implicationsextendoverthegenericstructureofthewholepiecewouldseemipso 193 NarrativePossibilities facto to call into question the legitimacy of the sonata strategy to provide a solutiontothecompositionalorexpressiveproblemathand’(2006,254). Theinteractions of tonal stabilityandinstability across theentire structure facilitateabroadersenseof?luctuatingtensionswithinanauralmagnetic?ield.The overall feeling is oneof departureandreturn, withthe symmetrical sonata-form extensionprovidingaperfectvehicleforabalancedperceptualnarrative,thepoint of greatest alienation occurring at the very centre of the movement and precipitating a parallel ‘homecoming’. The piece can be viewed as a three-part structure, with a six-part subdivision, each pairing interacting in a very direct, almost antecedent-consequent fashion. The tonal and structural uncertainties of the ?irst airing of the exposition allow for a development of these doubts and instabilitieswithinitsrepeat.Whentheopeninghalfofthedevelopmentleadsnot torecapitulationbuttocrisis,thesecondhalf–afteraninitialdisquiet–comprises are-energisedhuntforformaldirectionandclarity.Whenitis?inallyreached,the recapitulationsuccessfullytraversessequencesofmaterialoncemoreto bringthe musicbacktoE♭,butthecodathatfollowsservestorealignandreassertthetonic withanend-weighting that brings the ?inal section into line with a symmetrical structural scheme. The temporal consequences are paradoxical: the intense compressionofclimacticeventsandofmetricalenergycontrastswiththeextreme lengthofthestructuralandtonaljourneytoenableamusicaltimethatappearsat onceshortandlong,condensedandexhaustive. Ratherthanpresentingcalm,innerre?lection,theintrospectionofthe‘Eroica’ is never lackinginforce. Its processofself-analysis reveals aninwardly-directed violence, a constant desire to undermine its own characterthrough therepeated testingofitsabilitytomaintainits shape whenput underextremepressurefrom diametric forces; in musical terms, this is expressed through an examination of tonal function through the subversion of systematic triadic structures through recurringchromaticanddissonantfeatures.Themovementdoesnotsomuchtake the form of an ‘outward’ development as an internal assault, representing a barrage of attempts to undermine the signi?icance of the major triad. Here the introspectiveprocess provesviolentinmanysenses, takingtheformofanalmost frenziedchippingawayatoneselftoaccesssomethingwithin. 194 NarrativePossibilities Freshperspectives Interpreting Je sens un deuxième coeur according to the conception of fulcra certainly aidsanarchitectural understandingofthe piece, providingaframework foritsconstruction. Thenotionofafulcrum–ahingeorasupport–impliesstasis, anobjectthatmayfacilitatemovementandchangebutinitselfremainsunaltered and immovable. Whilst both G♮ and A♮ often reappear in the same guise, their characters andtheir broadermeanings are transformedacross the courseofthe work.G♮,forinstance,isfrequentlymanifestedasoctavesinthelowerregistersof the piano. While its persistent, often pedal-like presence in the ?irst and last movementsprovescomparableinmanyrespects,howanaudiencemighthearthe fulcrum maywell be radically different at the endof the work thanat the start. This is principally to do with the changes in the musical energy that the pedal facilitates. The early predominance of G♮ as a grounding for the piece incites a desirefor,andultimatelyprecipitates,change.Althoughitispresentedinthesame essential manner in the?inal movement, what is perceivedis apointofarrival, a return to a familiar landmarkwhich, althoughactingearlieras a springboardfor departure, can now be settled upon for the purposes of closure. The fulcra do indeedaccordwithastatic interpretation, but therangeofdifferent perspectives offereduponthemchangethroughoutthecourseofthepieceasaconsequenceof the harmonic shifts that occur around them. A parallel couldevenbe drawn, in terms of traditional tonal function, with a transformation of the same sonority fromadominanttoatonic. Whiletheideaofapiececenteringaroundapairoffulcraisconceivable, itis worthobservingthattwo pivot-pointsinfactinteract, provingas complementary to one another as they are competitive. Mirroring its earlier introduction (?irst movement, bar 12), the assertion of A♮ at the opening ofthe second movement does not simply challenge theauthorityof G♮. Rather, it offers a temporary but much-needed resolution, realising the change in trajectory – and indeed the releaseofrhythmicenergy–thattheclosingpedalofthe?irstmovementdemands. When the two fulcra do develop a more notably combative relationship in the fourthmovement, theimmediateconsequences may well appear violent, but the 195 NarrativePossibilities endresult–inthe?ifthmovement–isarecapitulationofthetonalcollaborationof theopeningofthework. The co-operative facets of the relationship between the two fulcra are demonstratedbestinthethirdmovementbytheabsenceofG♮.WhileA♮maintains a strong presence, it is rarely in so de?initive a form as the bass octaves that permeatetheotherslowmovementsinthework. Oftenassumingpositionsinthe higher registers, it is frequently juxtaposed with other surrounding chromatic notes, F♮ andF♯ initially occupying the lower regions. With the previously lucid basstonalitynowblurredandmuddiedbyalackofclarity,itbecomesobviousthat the disappearance of G♮ creates a fulcral imbalance, one that has an expressive functioninthesenseofdisorientationthatthisabsencehelpstoarouse. Notonly are the two focal points of the work interdependent, but the stability and orientationofthepieceseemsto dependonboththeexistenceandfunctioningof theirrelationship. The fulcra might be thought of as serving as an underlying aural anchor, emphasisingforanaudiencethetheebband?lowoftensionthroughoutthework. Crucially, apreciseunderstanding oftheserecurring sonorities andtheir rolesis not required. Themanner inwhichtheirinteraction withoneanother permeates eachmovement might besaidto bring aboutasubconsciousaural delineationof thebroadermusicalarchitecture; it is possibletosensethechangeinperspective, theinclinationstowardsdepartureandreturn, thecontrasts betweencon?lict and cooperation. These changes are also re?lected on a smaller scale through the motivic material from which the content of the piece is constructed. In a masterstrokeofeconomy, thecomposerensuresthatasenseofauralcontinuityis establishedby placingemphasisnotononespeci?icsubjectormelodicshape, but instead upon the relationships within a three-note formation: two notes a semitoneapartplacedwithathirdnoteofamoredisparateinterval–twoobjects in close proximity juxtaposed with a third object that provides harmonic perspectiveonthatpair. Ratherthanbeingpresentedastheorganicbasis forthe work,the?iguredoes notdominateitsopeningstages,presentedinsteadwiththe utmost subtlety, integratedwithinabroaderrising gestureinthepiano line(see Figure8.14). 196 NarrativePossibilities Fig.8.14:Jesensundeuxièmecoeur,Uirstmovement,three-notemotif emergence,bars26–28(piano) Fig.8.15:Jesensundeuxièmecoeur,secondmovement,bars9–17 It is in the second movement that the motif is perpetuated in an almost obsessivemanner, theopeninglow A♮s inthepiano immediatelygivingway to a repeatedpatternalternatingthefulcrumwithG♭andF♮(bar3).Thecellocutsthe pianoshort,presentinganewsequential?igurationofthesamethree-noteidea:F♮, G♭, C♮ (bars 4–6). It in turn is interrupted by the viola witha third, contracted sequence: C♮, E♮, D♯ (bars 7–8). The pianofulcrum returns for two bars (bars 9– 10),precipitating, frombar11,a tuttiinwhichfragmentedfacets ofthemotifare expressedineachinstrumentalline(seeFigure8.15). Withtheprecedentnowsetfortheproliferationofthe?igure, itpervadesthe entiremovement,harmonicgearshiftsrelyingprimarilyonsuddenre-calibrations, compressions andextensions ofthe motifitself. Indeed, themovement seems so ?ixatedwiththepatternthatitissoonfullyabsorbedastherecognisablematerial from which the music is constructed. Propelled through various harmonic gravitations the effect is soon one of disorientation, the consequence being the brutal burn-out atthe close of themovement, the motifnotably appearinginthe ?inalchordintheleft-handofthepianowithabarelyrecognisablebutnonetheless signi?icantconventionaltonalleaningtowardstheoriginalfulcrum(bars86-88:D♮, F♯,G♮). 197 NarrativePossibilities Fig.8.16:Saariaho:Jesensundeuxièmecoeur,thirdmovement, violaandcellomelody,bars4–7 Fig.8.17:Jesensundeuxièmecoeur,fourthmovement,reductionsof interruptingchords,selectedbars Fig.8.18:Jesensundeuxièmecoeur,Uifthmovement,bars1–3(piano) The ?igure becomes more thematically distinct in the central slow movement.The?irstmomentofnotable,sustainedmelodicunisonintheworkisin fact a re-imagining of the motif, the three notes (A♮, B♭, E♮ – a notable leaning towards the triadic features of the second fulcrum) traced by viola and cello delicatelyasifinaslow-motionfree-fallfrombars4(seeFigure8.16).Themelodic developmentsthatfollowcontinuetotracevariationsonthemotif. Thereturntoviolenceinthefourthmovement seesthemotifmutated,with added notes serving to increase its dynamism as the members of the trio are seeminglythrownforwardonacollisioncoursewithoneanother. Herethethreenote patterns are not as clearly de?inedas intheearlier, parallel fast movement, instead absorbed within longer gestures of greater momentum. While both the treatment of material and the modulatory behaviour accords with the earlier 198 NarrativePossibilities episode, it is this loss of control and de?inition that brings about a second cataclysm, frequent vertical interruptions comprisingmultipleexpressionsofthe motifeventuallyleadingtoarecasting ofthesecondmovement’s?inal chord(see Figure 8.17). Finally, the motif is adapted in the ?ifth movement to assume a speci?ic falling gestureintheupper registers ofthepiano twinnedwithafurther vertical expressionofitinthelefthand(seeFigure8.18).Whilethepreciseshape of thepattern changes throughout themovement, the?igure essentiallytakes on thestatus ofamercurial ostinato, still present at the verycloseofthe work ina morerhythmicallystraightforwardmanner. Renewedfocus Listening to Je sens un deuxième coeur sets in motion a paradoxical temporal experience; though it undoubtedly encompasses episodes of dynamism and surfacelinearity, theultimateeffectisofabroaderstasis. Thoughtheinteractions betweenthethree-notemotivicintervalsandthetonalfulcraprovidesensationsof moment-by-momentchange,theoveralleffectislessofalinearjourneybutrather acyclical one,inwhichemphasisis placednotonchangesinthecontentitselfbut on the changing perspectives of listeners upon that content. The kaleidoscopic process of the same materials being recast and reinterpreted allows for fresh views on familiar ideas. The constant manoeuvres ofrealignment create varying degreesofvisibilityofthemusicalcontent,resultinginablurred?irstmovement,a ?ixated second, a disorientated glimpse of clarity and alignment in the third, a distorted fourth, and a calmer, accepting ?ifth. Whereas the sense of alienation experienced in the E-minor passage at the heart of Beethoven’s ?irst movement stems precisely fromarealisation–throughalinearcontinuityofdesign– ofthe vasttonaldistancethathasbeenhithertotravelled,thedespondencythatmightbe perceived in the third movement of Saariaho’s trio arises from an awareness – articulatedbythere-calibratedmotivicmaterial–ofhowlittledistancehasinfact beentraversedinspiteoftheenergyexpended.Thesenseofdisorientationinboth pieces does originate in a heightened awareness of the experienced formal 199 NarrativePossibilities continuity, but these comparable sensations arise from very different musical properties. Moving beyondthesework-speci?icinstances, muchofthetheoretical discussion that follows (Chapter Nine: Understanding Time)will dwell uponthe tensions that might develop between such unique, disruptive gestures, and the wider, continuous, supposedly uni?ied forms they appear within; indeed, the question as to whether such con?licting conceptions require some kind of reconciliatoryapproachhasbeenthesubject ofsome debateamong analysts and musicologists. AnarrativedrawnfromJesensun deuxièmecoeurmightnottaketheshape ofanoutwardjourney,butratherofanintrospection.Emphasisisplacednotupon a distance travelled or a transformation achieved, but on a heightened selfknowledge facilitating new views upon pre-existingideas. Theinwardprocess of self-directed violence and contemplation showcased throughout the piece is comparableto theparallelaction inBeethoven’s ‘Eroica’. Andalthoughthe direct consequence of this interactionbetween stability and instability seems to be, in both works, aninclinationtowards a self-destructionthat seems to threatenthe veryarchitectureofthemusic,theconsequenceis infactakindofresolution.The ‘chipping away’ identi?ied in the ‘Eroica’, and the constant desire to realign and rearrangeresultsinanewsenseofself-discovery,inthesamewaythatasculpture isconstructedfromablockofstonebytheremovalofouter,super?luousmaterial in a bid to uncover the willed form within. Saariaho presents this process comprehensively.Bytheendofthepiece, thesamesetofessentialmaterialisstill being utilised, but it hasstruck uponafreshcharacter, arenewedalignmentwith itself. Beethoven’sstretchofmusic isonlythetipoftheicebergwithregardtothe broaderformoftheentirework, but it setsthe verysameprocessinmotion, one that reaches its apotheosis in the driving simplicity ofthe ?inale and, perhaps it mightbeargued,intheinvigorated,triadic-enforcedclassicismthat characterises thecomposer’ssequel,hisFourthSymphony. 200 Nine UnderstandingTime Formalimpulses Timebecomesmatterinmusic;thereforecomposingisexploringtimeasmatterin all itsforms: regular, irregular.Composingiscapturingtime andgivingita form. (Saariaho2000,111) KaijaSaariahomakesaprofoundconnectionbetweentimeandform.36Forher,the act of composition involves a direct engagement with, and mediation between, these two perceptual concepts. Indeed, the openness with which she addresses both ideas bears great relevance here. Time comprises a dynamic experience, varying in regularity; any compositional form that it might be ‘given’constitutes justoneofmanypotentialoptions. Musical formscanbeasnumerousandvaried asthedifferenttemporalimpressionstheyarticulatefortheiraudiences.Effective performances allow listeners the opportunity to ‘compose’ forms, harnessing common‘organisingimpulses’tostructuresequencesofeventsinwaysthatmight facilitatemeaning. Althoughnumerousculturalfactorscanhaveasubstantialimpactuponthe precise nature of these impulses, they amount to a seemingly universal human predispositiontoattempttomakesenseofauditoryinformation,tounderstandits sequence. Indeed, such in?luencing factors serve only to enhance the inherent dynamismofmusicalacts. Creativeattemptsto relivethepastinduceparticularly meaningful paradoxes (as shall be underlined in the ?inal case-study of Chapter Ten). The onward-bound asymmetry of temporal experience imbues musical repetitionwith both a desire to return to thepast and a tacit acknowledgement that it can only be accessed as memory. Compositional approaches such as developing variation prove especially interesting precisely because they demonstrate – and indeed incite – a conscious engagement with both past and futurethroughpresent-tensemusicalchange. 36 Kaija Saariaho’s thoughts on composition and time 2009,54,andRofe2001,81. 201 are discussed further in Moisala UnderstandingTime Saariaho’s comments touch upon an ongoing tension for composer, performerandlistener:althoughparticularaspectsofitscontentscanberecorded and reproduced, time cannot be ‘captured’ or retained. Though controllable elementsofeventscanberepeated,thesubjectiveandecologicalcontextsofthose events cannot. We can never hear, or by extension understand, something quite the same way twice; as listeners, our organising impulses are unavoidably dynamic. The case studies in this thesis are intended to support a position that embracesthismercurialstateofaffairsratherthancircumventorturnablindeye to it. The interplay between various musical continuities and discontinuities in compositions both old and new ensures the emergence of fresh formal perspectives,notleastwhenthesepiecesareplacedsidebyside. With regard to meaning, the complex musical interactions perceived by listeners are entwined with the social networks of performance situations. In seeking to account for some of the nuances of these relationships, Christopher Smallproposed‘musicking’asaverbthatencompassesallmannerofparticipation withinperformance, listening included. Questions of the meaning and value of a ‘work’ – a fragile concept in these terms – are therefore relocated to speci?ic performance situations(Small 1998, 9–10). David Burrows(1997)places similar emphasis upon music as performance, drawingparallels withdynamicalsystems theories, time-dependent understandings of causal processes utilised across a rangeof?ields.Heportraysworksas‘perceptualexercises’, aligningmuchoftheir valuewiththewayinwhichtheydemandanactof‘temporalsynthesis’onthepart oflisteners(1997,533).Withtheintentionofavoidingastableconceptionofform, he asserts that the ‘primary identity’ of a work constitutes an ‘emergent that accompanies theveryprocess of synthesising theimpressions madeby a?low of sounds’ (1997, 545). Nevertheless, his views regarding musical meaning seem strangelyconclusive: Music gives us concrete, sensorially grounded, but at the same time, safely contained exercisein managing thedynamicalsystemsthatconstitute ourlives.It also offers us a consequent glowing sense of our competence in doing so. Life resistscomprehension;musicinvitesit.Participatinginmusicisaccompaniedbya renewedsenseofmastery,suchasmodelsprovideforawiderangeofproblematic phenomena,overtheprocessesofourself-creation.(1997,545) 202 UnderstandingTime Small, by contrast, presents the more compelling possibility that perception and theprocessesofmentalorganisationthataccompanyitconstituteanencodingthat even more comprehensively mirrors our ecology (1998, 50–56). The af?irming closurethatBurrowsachievesisthusreplacedbyafarmorerealistic, open-ended complexity: If, as Ihave suggested, musicking isan activitybymeansof which we bring into existence a setof relationships thatmodel the relationshipsof ourworld, not as theyarebutaswewouldwishthemtobe,andifthroughmusickingwelearnabout andexplorethoserelationships,weafSirmthemtoourselvesandanyoneelsewho maybe paying attention,andwecelebrate them, the musickingisinfacta wayof knowing our world – not that pre-given physical world, divorced from human experience, that modern science claims to know but the experiential world of relationshipsinallitscomplexity–andinknowing it, welearnhowtolive wellin it.(Small,1998,50) Itisanholisticallymindedapproachsuchasthisthatoffersthepotentialfor amorerealisticappraisalofmusicalexperience–itselfanetworkofphysical and psychological relationships–andthewaysinwhichavarietyofdistinct butoften overlappinginterpretationsmightbedrawnfromit.Performancesmightbesaidto constitute temporal ‘spaces’ comprising amalgamations of musical and social interactions. A musical work might accordingly be taken as signifying a kind of blueprint for how certain aspects ofthattimespanwill play out aurally, withthe manner of this structural process inviting readings of a particular leaning. But cruciallyitisherethatthereachofthecomposedworkisexceeded. AsEricClarke observes, listeners retain an ‘utterly individual’ perspective incorporating their ‘skills, needs, preoccupations, and personal history’ (2005, 125). Indeed, he expresses a preference for an expanded view of perceptual meaning, encompassing not only the immediate acoustic and geographical contexts of a performance but also cultural, ideological and emotional factors frequently dismissed as too abstract; rather, he argues, these phenomena also constitute ‘sources’,sincethey ‘constitute theconditionsandcircumstancesthat giveriseto themusic’(2005,189–90). 203 UnderstandingTime Autonomy AlthoughClarkedevelopsaparticularlyconvincingecologicalaccountofperceived musical meaning, he remains open to the ways in which notions of the musical work can impact aural experiences. He provides an incisive evaluation of the autonomy with which works are often imbued, moving past the surface incompatibilitybetweenthisassertionandanecologicalapproachtodiscussways inwhichthetwooutlooksmightbene?itoneanother.37 Perhapssurprisingly,facets of ecological listening areoften found to play into autonomous sensibilities, with thevery act ofattending to soundsthemselves(rather thanas signi?iers ofother subjectsorobjects)imbuingpieceswithadegree ofself-governance (2005, 126– 155).Itispreciselythroughthismodeofreceptionthatmorestructurally-minded readingsofcompositionscan?lourish: Musicalautonomymaybe an illusion,butit hasgivenrise toa kindof listening that has particular characteristics and preoccupations. This style of listening arises from the interaction of a number of factors: listening circumstances, the relationshipbetweenperceptionandaction,theorganisationofmusicalmaterial, andlisteners’predispositions.(2005,154) For Nicholas Cook, the autonomy of a work also emerges through its repetitionasan‘independentandrepeatablecontext’, bothwithinits formandof itsform,withmusicaleventsgaining‘akindofobjectiveidentitybyvirtueoftheir relationship to this context: when a theme is repeated in a symphony, one’s experienceoftherepetitionisnotasubjectiveone(“IfeellikeIdidbefore”)butan objective one (“this bit is like the previous bit”)’ (Cook 1990, 38). The acknowledgementthatthis autonomyisanaesthetic?igmentdoesnotnecessarily preclude it from featuring in more grounded ecological approaches. It is a paradoxical duality that is re?lected in temporal perception. The overriding, onward nature of timedoes not invalidate listening experiences that threatento alter,subvert,ortranscendthatlinearityinaperceptualmanner.Thechallengesto temporal continuity that many performances offer are largely illusion, the 37 Clarke followsthisdiscussionbyprovidinganinsightfulanalysis of a worksteepedin the compositional trappings of the autonomous tradition – the Sirst movement of Beethoven’sStringQuartetinAminor, Op.132–byutilising ecologicalprinciples(2005, 156–88) 204 UnderstandingTime products of cultural constructs. But these illusions contribute to the value we ascribe to musical experiences, as the emphasis upon such phenomena – durational distortion, circularity, stasis, impressionsoftimelessness– throughout thisthesisdemonstrates. Unity Ofcourse, theseconceptual interrelationships leave a considerable challenge for scholarswillingtoaddressthem.ArnoldWhittall(1999)providesanastutesurvey of attempts to reconcile the formalist, analysis-driven approaches of the autonomoustradition,andthe‘worldly’relativismofnewmusicology,highlighting the dif?icult ofproducing an‘interpretative musicology that is adequately plural andadequatelycoherent’(1999,101).Heexpressesparticularconcernsregarding themarginalisationofanalytical techniques, inparticular thosesuchas Heinrich Schenker’sthatemphasiseprinciplesoforganiccoherence,andtheeffectthatthis mighthaveuponthemusicologicallandscape: A deconstructed musicology ceases to be musicology at all if it resists direct engagement with composer and composition, and side-steps the possibility that worksof artmaybe defencesagainstthe worldasmuchasproductsoftheworld. Itis understandable that committed deconstructionists should (single-mindedly) regardtheideaofalessmonolithicbutstillwork-centredmusicologyasseekingto achieve the old coercive objectives byonly slightlydifferent means. Yet, for that very reason,those same committed deconstructionists, intheirzealtotransform musicologyintosomething else,maybereluctanttoacceptthatmuch,ifnotall, of what they desire can actually be better achieved from within an enriched musicologythanfromoutsideit.(1999,100) WhilstWhittallbalanceshisconcernswithabroaderreceptivenesstowards anintegratedmusicological approach, Robert Morganexpresses something more akinto alarmat whatheperceives to bearecent ‘anti-unity’leaning inanalytical writing (Morgan, 2003). Troubled by an apparent opposition to coherence as a point of focus for interpretation, he embarks upon detailed critiques of ?ive analysesofcanonic repertoire(byKo?i Agawu, Daniel Chua, JosephDubiel, Kevin Korsyn and Jonathan Kramer), seemingly highlighting a certain futility – an 205 UnderstandingTime apparent dearth of meaning – in their emphasis upon disunifying elements in musical works: ‘Once disunity is asserted, they have nothing more to say of an analytical nature.Unityiscertainlynot theonlythingworthanalysing,but,inthis musicatleast, thealternativeisnotdisunitybutadifferentanalyticalperspective altogether’(Morgan2003,43).Whilstheconcedesthatcertainkindsofintentional musical disunity can be meaningful, such meaning is only rendered possible throughitsconnectionwithothermatters,inotherwordsviaanoverridingunity. Toassertdisunityinacompositionisnotonlyto labelthatworkafailure,butalso tocurtailanalyticalcommentary‘immediatelyandentirely’(2003,27). Many of the arguments Morgan presents simply stem from structuralist aesthetic preferences; his invocation of the notion of an ‘objective account of music’ – and more speci?ically the idea that an anti-unitarianist position might eliminatethepossibilityofit– speaksvolumes(2003,22).However, itisdif?icult toreconcilehisclaimedembraceofapost-structuralistdesireto evolveandadapt analytical conceptions(2003,41–43)withhisapparentunwillingnesstolendany validity to the ways in which others might hear the same pieces of music. Appraisinganalyses ofworks byHaydn,Mozart, BeethovenandBrahms, heseeks explicitlyto‘dissolve’theargumentsagainstunitymadebyotherscholarsthrough therecognitionofparticular‘readilyperceivable’unifyingfeaturesofthemusic. Inevitablysuchsingle-mindedprescriptivismhasdrawnforcefulresponses from those it criticises. Daniel Chua (2004)?inds Morgan’s treatment ofthe ?irst movementofBeethoven’s StringQuartetinAminor, Op.132,unsettlingprecisely onaccountofitsdisregardoftemporalimpressions,asifthis‘dissolving’approach couldrender thepiece ‘rational, transparent and coherent’: ‘There is not even a processofformalstruggleinhisanalysis,sincehisanalyticalinsightsarebasedon static structural identities. The disruptive features and gestures that I see as integraltothearticulationoftheformintimeareneutralisedbyMorganasmerely surface variation in space’ (Chua 2004, 354–55).38 Jonathan Kramer (2004), meanwhile,callsMorganoutonhisfailuretogofurtherinde?ininghisconception of unity and his attempted denial of a potentially enriching interplay between unityanddisunity.Kramerarguesinsteadforabroadernotionofcoherence‘based 38 KevinKorsynalsooffersanincise rebuttalof Morgan’scriticismofhisBrahmsanalysis inKorsyn,2004. 206 UnderstandingTime on differences as well as similarities, on lack of precedent (of certain events or segments)aswell as clearprecedent’(J. Kramer2004, 368). Expressing empathy with scholars anxious at the prospect of traditional analytical tools losing their relevance, he persuasively calls for the same kind of integrated musicology ponderedbyWhittall, openingupmoreformalistmethodsto frameworksthatare notbasedsolelyonthe‘elucidationofunity’: The analysesthatI most value do not try to prescribe how a piece ought to be heard,butrathertheysuggestwaysthatitmightbeheard.Andthosewaysshould, andforme sometimesdo,respondtootheraspectsoftheworkthanjustitsunity. Apieceof musicislikeaperson,orlikelife.Itisnottotallyneat.Notallpartsofit belong togetherinclear-cutways.Itcandostrangethings. Itcanbe easiertolove than to understand. It can contain moments of irrationality, of disorder, even of chaos – which can be appreciated as important contributors to meaning and experience.(J.Kramer2004,369–70) Kramer’s desire to demote unity from its ‘privileged position as a universal or necessarycondition’(2004, 370)ispre-echoedbyFredEverettMaus(1999)who not only ?irmly denies that analysis necessarily equates a search for unity, but aboveall treatswithscepticismanyclaims regardingunity oritsabsence‘thatdo notgiveacentralclaimtomusicalexperience’(1999,188).Mausalsoexploresthe plurality ofwhat can bemeant when issues of unity are discussed. He points to inconsistencies in the language used to address unifying musical elements, highlightingthesubtlebut nonetheless importantdistinctionsbetweenseemingly relatedterms: synthesis(discrepantitemsbroughtinto satisfactory relationship), integration(acceptanceofinternaldiversityovertime),integrity(eventsovertime preservinganddisplayingacorevalue),andlogic (eventssucceedingoneanother withasenseofnon-empiricalnecessity)(1999,183–86). Indeed,perhapsitmight beconcludedthatthetemporalaspectto whichMausrefersconstitutesoneofthe most consistent elements across these notions, that unity at once comprises continuityandcoherencethroughtheplayingoutofmusicalelementsovertime. Perhaps most signi?icantly, musical experiences can elicit a sense of paradox through the way in which they are often able to sustain contrasting analytical approaches such as those discussed. Performances can support interpretations that emphasise both unity and disunity, presenting a perceptual 207 UnderstandingTime coexistence of contrasting characteristics. In a further echo of the ecological mirroringthatSmallproposes (1998, 50–56),coherent orcontinuous readings of works can be drawn from an amalgamated network of musical and social relationshipsthatmightjustaseasilyfacilitateanemphasisuponincoherenceand disruption.Amusicalform mightpossessthecapacity tobeheardsimultaneously asconclusiveandambiguous, ‘closed’and‘open’.Inthespirit ofthispotential for paradox – and in the acknowledgement emphasised throughout this thesis that music seemingly possesses the ability to articulate things about time that words cannot–thisthesiswillbegintodrawtoaclosewithone?inalcasestudy,apairing of musical works by Jean Sibelius and Thomas Adès. On the face of it, their alignment is particularly close: two symphonies for large orchestras, lasting approximately twenty minutes in length, both cast in single-movement forms demarcated byintricate sequences ofrelated tempo changes. Ofgreaterinterest, though, arethewaysinwhichbothpieceshighlighttheprofoundincongruitiesof long-termrepetition.Throughaspectsoftheirconstruction,theysuggestdifferent ways of understanding recurring content in changing contexts. Ultimately, both pieces facilitate meaning through their reconciliation of journeys that are experienced as simultaneously onwardand circular. Mirroringbroader temporal experience, they somehow af?irm a dynamic, Heraclitean ?lux whilst raising the possibility of a static, Parmenidean ideal. Like this thesis, their conclusions are openended;closureisbothattainedanddenied.Perhapstheencouragementsuch musicoffersusaslistenersiscomparabletowhatE.M.Forsterasksofthenovelist: Afterall,whyhas anovel to be planned?Cannotitgrow?Whyneeditclose, asa playcloses?Cannotitopenout?Insteadofstandingabovehisworkandcontrolling it, cannotthe novelist throwhimself intoit and be carriedalong to some goalhe doesnotforesee?([1927]2005,95) 208 Ten EnergyandEquilibrium ThomasAdès&JeanSibelius Thisprojecthasrevolvedaroundjuxtapositionsofoldandnew,drawingattention to the different ways in which various composers have approached temporal issues through their structuring of musical ideas. These observations have been primarily utilised as catalysts for wider discourses addressing aspects of our experiences of time. I have deliberately tried to avoid emphasising direct comparisonsbetweenmusical works. Thisclosingcasestudy – twinning Thomas Adès’sTevotwithJeanSibelius’sSeventhSymphony–willbeanexception.Inmost respects, it provides the most likely of pairings within the thesis: two onemovement orchestral works, both lasting approximately 20 minutes, both purportedly engaging withthe symphonic tradition. Itcertainly seems thatthese surface similarities are the product of design rather than accident; as will be shown, AdèshimselfhasexpressedhisownthoughtsonSibelius’smusic(another unique aspect of this pairing) and it seems quite plausible that Tevot might be viewedasanextensionofthisengagement. However, Iwouldsuggest that theirmost profound connectionsare aural. Considerbothopenings:twogestures–oneascending,theotherdescending–that in spite of their simplicity, seemingly hold the potential for the forms that will unfold. At the beginning of the Seventh Symphony, a rising scale fragmented through several instrumental parts obliquely references several potential keys before offsetting these mounting expectations by coming to rest on an entirely different harmonic plane (see Figure 10.1); the arrival at an entirely unrelated triadcreatesanimmediatefrictionbetweentwosetsofsonorities,acomplextonal tensionthatwillcometode?inetheunfoldingoftheworkandrequiresresolution overtime.AttheoutsetofTevot,meanwhile,stratosphericcascadesoffalling?ifths seamlesslyemergeintheupperstrings,theiroscillationsunderlinedbysustained woodwind to create the impression of a chromatically descending chorale-like texture(seeFigure10.2).Theeffectisnot so muchofadirectsourceofharmonic con?lict; rather a tonal restlessness takes hold, a seemingly perpetual series of 209 EnergyandEquilibrium Fig.10.1:Sibelius,SymphonyNo.7,reductionofbars1–4 Fig.10.2:Adès,Tevot,reductionofbars1–4 onward-leaningmodulationsengenderinganaudibledynamismthatwillprovidea continuingsourceofstructuraldirection. Bothoftheseopeningspossess cellularqualities:themusical tensionsthey containultimatelyprovedecisiveinthewayinwhichtheirbroaderformsplayout. This audibly organic mode of composition can be viewed not only as an engagement withthe symphonic tradition butalso as anexpression of temporal thought. Through different harmonic, rhythmic and motivic vocabularies, both Adès and Sibelius offer striking perspectives on issues of continuity, recurrence anddirection. Theycreatelarge-scalemusical structuresthat double asengaging, 210 EnergyandEquilibrium wordlessnarratives,encouraginglistenerstoconsidertowhatextenttheapparent closurethese pieces providetranslates into a senseof catharsis, and to question connectionsbetweentimeandmeaning.Thiscasestudywillexploresomeofthese ideasthroughanalyticaldiscussion,examiningselectedpassagesfromacrossboth works in order to re-emphasise the broader paradoxes – stasis and dynamism, closureandopenness – that haveunderpinnedthe temporalperspectives offered by this thesis. The epilogue that then follows will offer a brief consideration of some of the implications these broader ?indings might have for an open-ended outlookuponmusicandtime. Symphonicrenewal JustasJeanSibelius(1865–1957)summarisedthe?inaleofhisSymphonyNo.3in Cmajor, Op. 52(1907)as ‘thecrystallisationofideas fromchaos’(Tawaststjerna 1986, 66), the work as awhole might besaidto represent astylistic watershed. Presented through notably sparse orchestration, its three relatively brief movements announce a departure from the late-romantic gestures that had dominatedthe composer’s previous efforts in thegenre. Characteristics latent in his earlier music here emerge, with a renewed sense of motivic economy and formal concision seemingly referencing Classical tendencies. As Tim Howell observes,‘muchthatisoriginal–progressive–aboutSibelius’scompositioncomes notfromarejectionofearlierpracticebutfromitsreinterpretation’(2001,37–38). Many of the features presented in the Third Symphony would subsequently develop through the course of the composer’s four further contributions to the genre; HaroldTruscott evengoesso faras to draw a‘genealogical tree’fromthe worktotheremainderofSibelius’signi?icantorchestraloutput(1967,92–98).The composer’s broader preferences are exhibited deftly in his later works, with his oft-quotedremarks to Mahler regarding the ‘profound logic’ of symphonic style and structure (Rickards 1997, 96) clearly re?lected in both the organic developmentsandthepared-downinstrumentationofthoseworks. Sibelius’s determination to rely solely upon what he deemed necessary reaches its zenith in his Symphony No. 7, Op. 105 (1924). Here his prior 211 EnergyandEquilibrium experimentsinformalcompression–executedtovaryingextentsintheThirdand Fifth Symphonies – culminate in one extraordinary, 20-minute-plus unbroken span, characters andcontrasts ofconventionally separatemovementsassimilated into a single cohesive stretch of music. The label ‘symphony’ was ascribed tentatively by the composer; even at the time of its Stockholm première on 23 March 1924, it was still entitled ‘Fantasia sinfonica’, and it was only following careful subsequent consideration that the name change was undertaken (Murtomäki1993,242). Whileitsstatusasasymphonyhasrarelybeenquestioneddirectly,scholars have often struggled to reach a consensus regarding its structure. Although the work exhibits an undeniably changing, episodic form, delineating it accordingto moreconventionalexpectations hasnotnecessarilyprovedeasy.Truscott, to give an early example, expresses a personal struggle to come to terms with the architecture of the work, asserting its one-movement plan to be ‘a contrivance ratherthanagrowth[…]nomoreaone-movementsymphonythanisSchumann’s Fourth’ (1967, 92–98). Cecil Gray overcomes such dif?iculties by attempting to reconcile the piece with conventional design, claiming it to comprise four successiveinterconnectedmovementswhilstsimultaneouslyconstituting‘asingle andindissolubleorganism’(1935,71).However,SimonParmet’ssuggestion–that it wouldbefruitlesstoattempt areadingofitsform thathingesupon‘terms and concepts borrowedfrom anearlierperiod’(Parmet 1959, 127; also discussedby Murtomäki1993,245–46)–provesinsightful;hisportrayaloftheworktakesinto accountitsperformeddurationandrevolvesaroundmusicaldevelopmentsframed bytwoC-major‘cornerstones’placedateitherendofthework(Parmet1959,128– 29).Writingmorerecently,VeijoMurtomäkiplacesemphasisuponnovelelements in his interpretation of the work, proclaiming it to be neithera singular sonataform expanse nor aconglomeration of several movements but rather‘something newandrevolutionaryinthehistoryofthesymphony’(1993,242). Other modern contributors, however, appear morecontent to adapt more conventional constructions in their readings. Edward Laufer, for example, draws uponSibelius’soriginalintentionfor‘anHellenicrondo’toconcludethesymphony. Usingthisdescriptionasaspringboard,hemapsarondostructureonto thework, envisioninga ‘boldrefashioningofthe classical design’as a meansto athorough 212 EnergyandEquilibrium senseofmusical continuity: ‘By not concentrating thedevelopmental passages in onelargersectionas inasonataformmovement, butbyplacingthemthroughout so as to introduce and thereby enhance the expositional sections, a sense of continuous growth, cumulation, and completion of sections is achieved’ (Laufer 2001, 355). Nevertheless, perhaps amongthe most convincing interpretations of the symphony is that provided by Arnold Whittall who highlights an interplay between a wider sense of structural symmetry and a more episodic leaning towards ‘imbalance and instability’. His more conceptual framing of the compositionalarchitectureoftheworkprovesparticularlyuseful:‘Oneofthemost remarkableaspectsoftheSeventhSymphonyisthesenseinwhichitsubvertsthe essentials ofsymmetrical stabilitywhilenevercompletelylosingsightofpositive, af?irmative modes of expression: balancing modernism and classicism, in other words’(Whittall2004,62–63). The balances that Sibelius managed to strike with his SeventhSymphony have proved particularly in?luential in the years since its composition, not only helpingtoopenthe?loodgatestonumerousotherone-movementorchestralworks – whether the word ‘symphony’ features as a title or not – but also helping to reiterateanolderworkingde?initionofthegenre.Beyondsimplymakingreference to surface structures or orchestral forces, the term ‘symphonic’ engages more keenly with the organic character and musical content of a piece, implying something ‘extended and thoroughly developed’ (Larue, Wolf, Bonds, Walsh and Wilson,Grove).Onaccountofits‘totalunity’,theSeventhevenservesasapointof closure for Lionel Pike in his exploration of the symphonies of Beethoven and Sibelius, withthework conforming to Pike’s de?initionof‘symphonic’as thevery kindofuni?ied,interconnected‘profoundlogic’thatSibeliuspropoundedtoMahler (Pike 1978, 203). Meanwhile, composer David Matthews has cited Sibelius’s symphoniesasadirectin?luenceonhisown,pointingtotheseeminglyparadoxical ‘truestasis’theyattain‘throughenergyandmovement’(Dufallo1989,154):‘Ihave learnt a lot from his control of pace, his welding together of different kinds of movement, his imperceptible transitions from fast to slow or slow to fast.’ Matthews associates theSeventh in particular withakindof symphonic essence (Matthews1993,190):‘TheSeventhSymphony…isalwaysmovingsymphonically; evolving, changing direction, sometimes with slow deliberation, sometimes with 213 EnergyandEquilibrium athleticswiftness.’SuchdynamismresonateswithHowell’sperceptiveimpression ofthe‘continuousdevelopment’presentinthework(aSibelianhallmark), andits relianceupon‘contextratherthancontenttode?inefunction’(Howell1989,86) Symphonicresolution? The kind of momentum Matthews describes does indeed seem to pervade the symphony, anadvancing dynamismpalpableinthe ‘workingout’ofthe music. A sense ofunmistakable development is imbued without the uni?iedsweep of the workbeingdamaged;onthecontrary,musical progressionseems to enhancethe structuralprolongation. Writtenjusttwoyearsafterthesymphony,thetonepoem Tapiola,Op.112isoftenusedbyscholarsasalitmustestforthesymphonicnature oftheSeventh. Atasurfaceglance, itwouldappeartobearmuchincommonwith the symphony: a single-span, twenty-minute orchestral work with its material derivedorganicallyfromitsopeninggestures.However,itisinhowtheworkplays out that the differences emerge. Stephen Walsh highlights the ‘dialectical and dynamic force’ of the Seventh, pointing to its exceptional ability to settle largescale musical con?licts in just one extended movement: ‘As a descriptive and imaginative work Tapiola is a considerable achievement. But it can hardly be denied that the symphony, in satisfactorily resolving more complicated issues within the same time-span, is musically and intellectually the more substantial work’(Walsh,Grove). Intriguingly, it is through this comparisonofpieces that Thomas Adès (b. 1971)– a Britishcomposer – arrives atvery differentconclusions. His notion of symphonicgravitatestowardsamusical impulseto resolve– to ‘closeacircle’, as heputsit.Withthisinmind,heexpressestheviewthatthesymphoniesofSibelius betray a con?lict between this inclination to conclude and an ‘inner desire’(one inherentinthematerial)toventureoutwardsintonewterritories: The conSlictbecomes more powerful asthe symphoniesgoon. Inthe Fifth itisa huge struggle which isachieved, in the Sixth it seemsso powerfulthatit has to happenjustoffstage,andinthe Sevenththereisa sense thatalthoughhe makesit in the endhe isall butbroken bythe effort. Itbecomesan increasinglyagonising process. Butin thetonepoems,he isreleased from theconSlictofhavingtomake 214 EnergyandEquilibrium an abstract argument that functions logically. So the end of Tapiola is deeply conclusive, but the end of the Seventh Symphonyis painfullyinconclusive.(Adès andService2012,172) ItisinterestingthatwhatWhittall,forexample, identi?iesasasuccessful fusionof ‘fundamentalelements oftraditionwithfreedom and?lexibility’(2004, 61), Adès seeminglyhearsasapointofextremeartisticfriction.Thecomposerhighlightsthis asaparticularlyprogressiveandin?luentialaspectofSibelius’scontributiontothe genre: I’msayingthatwithSibelius,thefunctionofsymphoniccompletenesspassedfrom the‘abstract’intothe ‘metaphorical’,andIthinkithasstayedthere.Ithinkhewas the Sirst to break,painfully, themistakenidea thata symphonic argumenthadto haveasortofstructuralordertoit.(AdèsandService2012,173) However, with regard to the broader tradition he has reservations, expressing misgivings with regardto the expectations of ‘aninevitable kind of structure or decorum’ that he feels accompany the ‘symphony’ title (2012, 173). It seems signi?icantthen,givensuchqualms, thatthelabelisonehehasemployed,utilising it to describe Tevot, a work for large orchestra composed from 2005–6 and premièred on 21February2007 bythe BerlinPhilharmonic Orchestra underthe directionofSirSimonRattle.39 The titleofthework carries severalmeanings. In modern-day Hebrew it signi?ies ‘vessels’, adapted in musical terminology to represent bars of music; however, in its singular form – tevah – it is utilised speci?icallyintheBibletorepresenttwouniquevessels: Noah’sarkandtheNileboundreedbasketinwhichthebabyMosesisplacedbyhismother(Adès2007:iii, andGrif?iths 2014, 7). Describing the titleas being like a ‘gift’, Adès outlines the waysinwhichitsmeaningprovidedaconceptualspringboardforthecomposition: Ilikedtheideathatthebarsofthemusicwerecarryingthenotesasasortoffamily throughthe piece. And theydo, because withoutbars, you'd have musical chaos. ButI wasthinking aboutthe ark, the vessel, inthe piece as the earth. The earth would bea spaceship, ashipthatcarriesus-and severalotherspecies!-through 39 Adès’s1997 work forlarge orchestra Asylahasalsobeen describedasa symphonyby numerouscommentators(forexample GrifSiths2014, 7), notleastonaccountof itsfourmovement structure. However, the composer himself has not invoked the label to the workin soexplicita manneraswithTevot;inthissense,Asylaisa symphonybyformal allusionratherthanbyovertdesign. 215 EnergyandEquilibrium thechaosofspace insafety. Itsoundsabitcolossal, butit'stheideaoftheship of theworld.(Service2007) It seems likely that – in writing a 20-minute, one-movement symphony – Adès wouldhavebeenalltooawareoftheparallelsthatmightbedrawnwithSibelius’s Seventh.Indeed,givenhisapparentwillingnesstodiscusshisviewsuponSibelius’s music, it would beunwiseto rule out the possibility that these surface allusions maywellbedeliberate.Certainly, whenTomServiceintroducesAdès’sownmusic into their discussionofSibelius, the composeris quick to invoke bothTevot and Polaris– ashorter orchestralcompositioncompletedin2010–inmuchthesame comparative mannerashehasjustspokenoftheSeventhSymphony andTapiola (AdèsandService2012,172–73). Interestingly, though, he does seem to haveintended Tevot to be imbued withthekindofmusicalresolutionthathe?indsSibelius’ssymphonytobelacking. Service’sattempttoassociateTevotwithAdès’s1997orchestralworkAsylaviathe suggestion that the title of the more recent work implies a ‘haven-like place of refuge–anasylum’drawsaparticularlyde?initiveresponsefromthecomposer:‘A havensoundsasifoneishidingfromsomething,andIdon'tthinkthataboutTevot. Inthis piece, it'smorelikea?inalresolution–areal resolution– ratherthanthat oneisescapingfromsomething’.Indeed, Adèsisunafraidofemphasisingthegoaldirected facets of the work, discussing it in terms of an abstract narrative: ‘I thought of the piece as one huge journey, but in order to make that journey truthful, to give it movement, there had to be many quite sudden and instant changesoflandscape’(Service2007). Tonalenergy Attheendofagreatsymphonythereisthesensethatthemusichasgrownbythe interpenetrativeactivityofallitsconstituentelements.Nothingiseverallowedto lapse into aimlessness, or the kind of inactivity that needs artiSicially reviving… The great thing to keep constantly in mind is that no single element is ever abandoned, ordeliberatelyexcluded,thatthecomposermustmasterthemalland subordinatethemtothedemandsofthewhole.(Simpson1966b,10) 216 EnergyandEquilibrium Althoughmade four decades beforeTevot hadbeen completed, Robert Simpson’s observations regarding successful symphonies seem as relevant to the work of Adès as they do to that ofSibelius. Bothcomposers exercise precise control over thewayinwhichmaterialsarepresentedandstructured,exhibitingparticularskill in their handling of musical energy. Whilst this energy management is related principally to aspects of tempo and rhythm, it also extends beyond pulse-based issuestoencompassmotivicandharmonicdevelopment. Although Sibelius’s symphony – still rooted in post-romantic formal principles – inevitably exhibits tonal governance in a comparatively cogent manner,itisworthemphasisingthatTevotalsodisplaysaconsideredtreatmentof sonority and its bearing upon large-scale structure. Adès sidesteps a more traditional hierarchical framework infavourofanever-shiftingharmonicgravity, immediately establishingthis dynamismwiththe passagedescribedatthe outset of this chapter. This cellular ?igure – an open ?ifth followed by a falling minor second – is in fact characteristic ofthe composer’s style, as outlinedby Dominic Wells (2012,6–12). The‘5+2’progression,as Wellsdubsit, surfacesasacommon featureinanumberofworksinthecomposer’scatalogue.40However,whilstWells points to many of these instances in terms of their melodic effect, he highlights three works in particular upon which the progressions have a more notably harmonic bearing: The Tempest (2003–4), Violin Concerto (2005), and Tevot (2007).Optingtodiscussonlythe?irsttwoofthesepieces,heoutlinesthewaysin whichboth exhibit the clearestablishment oftonic keys that are thensubverted throughafallingminorsecond(Wells2012,11–13). Tevot,bycomparison, displaysaheightenedsenseoftransience. Nosooner has the?irstopen?ifthsoundedintheviolins, ?luteandpiccolothanafurther?ifth is extended downwards. The ensuingsemitone fall in the second bar creates the model for the parallel descending sequences that then emerge, new chains entering at regularintervals. Adès’s propensity to utilise open?ifthsasacatalyst 40 Wellsmakesreference to variedappearancesof the ‘5+2’ Sigure in Arcadiana(1994), Asyla(1997),The FayrfaxCarol(1997),ThesePremisesare Alarmed(1998), JanuaryWrit (1999), and America: A Prophecy (1999), as well as in The Tempest (2003–4), Violin Concerto(2005),andTevot(2007). 217 EnergyandEquilibrium for both harmonic and melodic content has been frequently noted.41 However, here this approach is extended yet further, with these descending chains of oscillating determining both subject and tonality. The ‘5+2’ progression is embedded as a stratospheric sequence, with interrelated streams of ?ifths now cascading downwards in apparent perpetual motion, its passage continually renewedintheupperreachesofeachinstrument(seethewoodwindreductionsin Figure10.2for anexampleoftheorchestrationaldetail, andthetreblecleflinein Figure 10.3 for an harmonic reduction of this sequence). John Roeder notes the multidimensional effect of a comparable ?igure in a bass oboe passage in the secondmovementofAsyla,observingthewayinwhichonelinemelodicsequences ofdescendingsemitonesseparatedbylargerintervalshelpstogivetheimpression ofseparatescalesoccurringindifferentregistral bands(2006,126–27).Whilethe proliferationofthis ideathroughoutmultipleinstruments attheopeningofTevot certainly heightens this kind oftemporal multiplicity, his largerpoint – that this kindofwritinghelpsto establishcontinuity–stillstandshere.However, thistype of polyphonic construction avoids the completion of the transformational pitchchange cycles thatoccur in muchofAdès’s music, asourceofclosure for Roeder (2006,127). Thegenerallackofemphasisuponthebeginningorendofthesecycleshas aharmonic bearing. Instead ofany hierarchybeingestablishedandsubsequently uprooted,the‘tonality’oftheworkmovesbyallusion,withpassingnodstovarious sonorities hintingat atonalcentrein constantmotion:amercurial point ofaural reference.Theeffectisalso rhythmic:theonlyjudgeofsmall-scalepulsebeingthe triplet quaver-semiquaver oscillations of the violins, whilst on a larger scale listeners are encouraged to gauge the passing of time by the gradual semitone descents. Comparisons might be drawn here with the composer’s Piano Quintet (2000)inwhichPhilipStoeckeridenti?iescyclicstructuresthataresuperimposed, juxtaposed and extended to such a degree that ‘the underlying cyclic source is essentiallyunrecognisable’(2014,59). Theintroductionofacontrasting?igureinthelowerwindandstringsfrom thefourthbaroffersanaudiblefoothold,providingatemporalmarkerbeyondthe 41Forexamples,seeBarkin2009,168;Fox2014,47;Roeder2006,146&151;Venn2006, 108–9;Whittall2003,22. 218 EnergyandEquilibrium Fig.10.3:Tevot,reductionofharmonicchangesthataccumulate withineachbar(bars1–13) perpetual harmonic descent as it develops through the opening minutes of the work (see the bass clef line in Figure 10.3 for an harmonic reduction of this subject).Theblock-likehomophonicgesturecreatesatonaljuxtaposition,sporadic successions of three-part chordchanges inciting anindependent rate of motion, but one seemingly united more broadly with the free-?loating tonality. Indeed, whilst these harmonic shifts remainconsonant in isolation – largely comprising interrelated major triads with one additional note – the harmonic clashes that emerge with the descending ?ifths material create a cluster-chord effect. Nevertheless, a small thematic contrast is notable, with upper lines in the modulationsoftentracingsubtlebutunmistakablestepwiseascents. Thisopeningpassageprovescellularinanumberofsenses.Principally,itis through the interaction between these two parallel ideas that the sense of perpetualmotionthatpervadestherestoftheworkisestablished.Inconjunction, the gestures present three different kinds of tension: between harmonic clarity and ambiguity, between ascent and descent in pitch, and between a contentgeneratedneedtosustaintonalmobilityandanevidentinherentdesiretoresolve. The form of the piece is devoted to settling these frictions. The only additional featureofnoteisabriefhornmotif:amajesticupwardleapofaminorsevenththat occurs in bar 21. In spite of its simplicity, it remains strikingly prominent, occurringnotonlywithinaspacebetweenthechordal ?iguresbutconstitutingthe 219 EnergyandEquilibrium only noticeably wideintervallic jumpwithinthecontext ofanintricateorchestral texturecharacterisedbystepwisemovements. ThecellularfunctionoftheopeningtoSibelius’ssymphony,meanwhile,has beennotedbyseveralcommentators.Theinitialwhite-notescaleinthestringshas beendescribedintermsofavarietyofharmonicfunctions,predominantlyasbeing intheC-majortonic(Howell 1989, 87),inG majoras adominanttothattonic on accountoftheinitialG♮ timpaniroll(Howell1989,87,andMurtomäki1993,261), andinAminoronaccountofthecello notethatfollowsit(Pike1978,204).These readings not only serve to underline a degree of tonal uncertainty at this early stage, but each also grants the ensuing A♭ minor chord a notably subversive presence. However,ascompellingastheseperspectivesremainwithregardtothe long-term unfolding of the symphony, they inevitably require a degree of familiarityonthepart of anaudience. Withoutthe ability to identify thenotes of the scale by ear, or prior understanding of the sequence of musical events, the symphonymay emergefora ?irst-time listener in an unsettlingly vaguemanner, notesascendingstepbystepwithlittleindicationoftherolestheymayassumein anykindofbroadertonalscheme. Withoutdoubt, theA♭minor chordsitsatoddswithwhathas precededit, but arguably more by its novelty (its ?irst and?ifth degrees areabsent from the preceding material) than by a particular tonal jarring within the context of any establishedkey.TheTristan-esquechromaticslipsthatoccurinitswakeunderline further the notion that no clear tonal centre has thus far been cemented; the overridingsensationmight well beoneofsearching, thegradually shiftingchordshapes throughout the passage lending it an almost improvisatory quality. The harmonictensionpresenthereisindeedpalpable,butnotyetinawaythatmight makebroaderstructural sense. Thelong-range tonal potentialofthese sonorities remainsaurallyveiledforthetimebeingasfarasanaudiencemightbeconcerned. Giventhis initial ambiguity, the passages that ensue – usually lying beneaththe umbrellalabelofan‘introduction’–assumeacrucialrole,servingnotjusttoaf?irm C major as a key of central importance but to establish it in the wake of such uncertainty. Although clear allusionsto this tonic emerge throughthe leaningsofboth melodies and pedal points from the seventh bar onwards, the sequential 220 EnergyandEquilibrium repetitionsthatensuemaintainnodstowardsmoredissonantroutes.A♭continues to featureprominently,althoughisfrequently audibly normalisedwithinFminor ?igures. Indeed, it is through this process of harmonic familiarization and assimilationthatthe dominantisreassertedin bar 21, preparingtheway forthe richly polyphonic string passage that follows in which C major is repeatedly underlinedwithincreasingemphasis.Thereassertionthatbeginsatbar50incites a full convergence, the entire ensemble uniting on an unmistakable perfect cadenceinbars59–60,thearpeggiatedtrombonetheme–itselfseeminglyderived with inaudible subtlety from the second violin line from bars 35–43, as John Gardnerhaspointedout(1977,912)–cappingthe?irstsigni?icantpointofarrival in the work. Howell points to the accumulative process of this introductory passage in support of his broader notion of the ‘continuous development technique’that pervades boththe thematic and thetonal course ofthe work; for him,theopeningsegmentactsasaminiaturisedre?lectionofthisprinciplethrough its ‘initial denialof,buteventualpreparationfor, theestablishmentofCmajorby reinterpretation of the same elements which interrupted that goal in order to con?irm it’(1989, 87). Inthis sense, it comes as no surprisethat itis viathe reemergence of A♭s andE♭s that the climax is eventually curtailed, the ensemble joltedinto an F-minor diversion from bar71. As the ensemble departs from the stability it has so elaborately established, it becomes clear that an audible balancingacthasbeensetinmotion. Temporalmultiplicity:Sibelius Thehandlingofrhythmicenergythroughoutbothworksamountstofarmorethan justalinear-mindedebband?low.Rather,instilledcontinuitieshelptocreatemore complex perceptual structures, granting listeners the impression ofa pluralistic temporalexperience. Sibeliusdoes not go so farasto support thetempochanges outlined in theSeventhSymphony withmetronomemarkings; Parmet relays the composer’sgeneralaversiontoemployingthem,drawingparallelswithBeethoven in his assertion that tempi are best intuited rather than prescribed (1959, 4). However, even without such speci?icity, the symphony emerges as an equally 221 EnergyandEquilibrium Speedtype Tempo(Timesignature) Bars Duration Slow Adagio(3/2) 1–92 0’00–7’58 Unpochettmenoadagio 93–100 7’58–8’20 Pocoaffret. 101–128 8’20–9’37 PocoapocoaffrettandoilTempoal 129–133 9’37–9’47 Formerw =new w. (6/4) 134–155 9’47–10’15 Vivacissimo 156–212 10’15–11’09 Transitional Fast Rallentandoal... Transitional Formerw =new e. (3/2)atbar220 213–221 11’09–11’24 Slow Adagio 222–236 11’24–12’23 Transitional Pocoapocomenolentoal... 237–241 12’23–12’35 Formerw =new w. (6/4) 242–257 12’35–12’59 Allegromoltomoderato (withfermataatbar255) 258–282 12’59–13’51 Transitional Unpochett.Affrettando 283–284 13’51–13’54 Moderate Allegromoderato 285–289 13’54–14’02 Transitional Pocoapocomenomoderato 290–408 14’02–16’49 Vivace 409–448 16’49–17’24 Presto 449–463 17’24–17’35 Pocoapocorallentandoal... 464–475 17’35–17’49 Adagio(3/2) 476–495 17’49–19’10 Largamentemolto 496–505 19’10–20’10 Affetuoso 506–521 20’10–21’47 TempoI 522–525 21’47–22’17 Moderate Fast Transitional Slow Fig.10.4:SymphonyNo.7,tabledisplayingtempochangesanddurations complex construction, with its many speed changes deployed in what on the surfacemightnotappeartobeanovertlysystematicmanner(seeFigure10.4).42 42 Durations taken from recording listed in primary resource list (London Symphony Orchestra,conductedbySirColinDavis.LSOLive:LSO0552). 222 EnergyandEquilibrium Aninitialfootholdmightbegainedbyidentifyingrecurrences.Mostnotable arethe threeAdagiopassages that bookendand intersect thestructure. Thetwo stretchesthatliebetweencomprisenoticeablymorechangeable,fastermusic,with littleinthewayobviousrecurrence.However, thesevariedspeedsmayinturnbe sorted into two broader categories: fast music (including Vivacissimo, Vivace, Presto) and moderate, transitory music (the gradual acceleration to the ?irst Vivacissimo, theAllegromolto moderatoand theAllegromoderato). Inrelationto themusical content theypresent, these three tempo groupings – slow, moderate andfast–serveagreaterpurposethansimplyoutliningdifferentspeedsatwhich themusicmoves.Theyrepresentthreeparalleltemporalthreads, ongoingstrands of development, eachacting in independent but ultimately interconnected ways. The paradoxical simultaneity of both slow and fast music is enhanced by the middle-groundtransitionsthat,inbridgingthetwoextremes,alsoofferglimpsesof the way in which they interlock. The rallentando (bars 213–22) passage that connects theVivacissimo withtheensuingAdagio,doesmorethansimplyjointhe dots; thecarefully staggeredmetrical shifts of thechromatic scales inthe strings heightenthecontinuityoftheformalchange,drawingattentiontothepotentialfor long (‘slow’)phrase structures infast music, andto the presenceofrapid, scalic, harmonically unstable gestures within more tonally secure, metrically slower content. This presence ofthefast withintheslow–andviceversa –isreinforced bythefactthatwhatisthennotatedas anaccelerationto Allegromoltomoderato (frombars237–57)mighteasilyinfactbeheardasaspeedchangeintheopposite direction.Inasimilar way, thelater jumpto Presto(bar449)isinfactmadeasa meansbywhichtoreachthesubsequentAdagioratherthanasanendinitself,the propulsive string sequences providing a candid, moment-by-moment demonstration of theway thesame material canfunction within‘slow’ and ‘fast’ contexts.Viewingtheworkintermsofthesecontrastingyetcooperatingtemporal levels may offer a reading that supports the seamless mercurial but nonetheless logicalauralimpressiontheSeventhSymphonyleaveswithaudiences. Itsmusical energy is directednotinonedirectionbutinthree, creating adynamicmultilevel structure. Tempo changes require less in the way of departure and arrival but rather an aural readjustment; focus can fall on fast-moving detail, or a slowermovingbiggerpicture,oritcantransitionbackandforthbetweenthetwo. 223 EnergyandEquilibrium Fig.10.5:SymphonyNo.7,trombonetheme,bars60–70 Thethree passages of‘slow’ music that punctuatethe SeventhSymphony havebeenfrequentlyshownnotonlytoframethearchitectureoftheworkbutalso toimbueitwithstability.ForWhittall,itisthecontrastthattheseepisodesprovide inwhichthe‘strengthandoriginality’ofthepiececanbefound;hewritesofthem as‘themostexplicitthematicandtonalpillarsoftheuni?ieddesign’,describingthe ‘imbalance and instability’ that emerges in the surrounding music (2004, 63). Certainlythesesections exhibitaclear degreeofconsistency withtheirrecurring trombonetheme(seeFigure10.5)acting–viaanotablystablearpeggiatedshape– as an aural af?irmation of the key of C: the major mode in the bookending segments,theminormodeinthecentralone. Pike draws a further parallel with Beethoven in the apparent acknowledgement of both composers that themes invariably prove more memorable thantonalities (1978, 209). However, it wouldcertainly seem inthe case of theSeventhSymphonythat Sibelius isintent onutilising both. Periods of transience–bothintermsofpulseandtonality–aredominatedbyscalicmelodic activity;thelinear,seeminglygoal-directednatureofsuch?iguresdirectlyconveys motion and provides an accumulation – and, at points, an over-saturation – of harmonic material that contributes to anoverriding loss ofstability. Meanwhile, the three passages that oversee an arrival at the C♮ sonority, and provide assurances of its tonal signi?icance, are prominently capped by the trombone theme;itsharmonically?irm,arpeggiatedshapenotonlyreinforcesthesecurityof the ?irst C-major episode, but proves an important factor in instilling stability thereafter.Atthesepointsinthesymphony, subjectandsonorityacteffectivelyas a unit, alerting listeners to anunmistakable recurrenceof motivic and harmonic content. Thesestatic aspects certainly lendawider senseofstability to theaural experience. Tonallyspeaking, theyoffercredence to thenotionoftheworkbeing 224 EnergyandEquilibrium ‘inC’,orperhapsratheronit,withthesonorityaf?irmedthroughclearlydelineated perfectcadencesinthecourseofeachAdagiopassage. However, even taking these passages inisolation, an image ofsuchstasis does not paint thefull picture. Thereis a paradox at play here. Threeostensibly staticformalsegmentsperformthesamestabilisingfunction,yetdosoinamanner that betrays a kind of musical development; they are not only affected by the harmonic shifts that take place in the interceding episodes but incite the tonal unrest that prompts them. Although they present essentially the same sonority, thesepassagesarealso indicativeof, andindeed receptiveto, change– amusical reminderthatrecurrencecannotcircumventanawarenessofthepassageoftime. Inthis light, the form of the SeventhSymphony seems to evidencea collision of whatHowell outlinesasadistinctionbetweentwoattitudestowardstemporality: functional, onward-leaning repetitionand retrospective, melancholic recollection (2013,103–104).WhenSibelius’semphaticattemptstorevisitthepastdirectlyfall victim(viaaudibleharmonicchanges)tothelinear-mindednarrative, theresultis aratherspecial hybridofrepetitionandrecollection. Whilsta desiretoreturnto theaf?irmation andsecurity oftheopening cadencepointbecomesapparent, the inevitable variations that in?iltrate the recurrences facilitate an onward, developmental function; the audible denial of a full return lends the passages a simultaneousairofreminiscence. Atsuchmoments, thesymphony might be said to possess ‘times’that,inspiteoftheiruni?iednarrativedirection,couldbeheard as‘facing’inoppositedirections. Temporalmultiplicity:Adès ConsideringTevotpurelyintermsofthemetronomemarksspeci?iedinthescore, itseemstofall intotwoapproximatehalves:the?irstcharacterisedbychange,the second by consistency. Reconciling this with an aural impression – and by extensionequatingthesetempochangeswiththerecordedclock timingsatwhich they occur – three structural segments in fact emerge: an initial longer period punctuatedbyregular?luctuationsinpulse(bars1–256)eventuallygiveswaytoa shorter but nonetheless more spacious passage that, by contrast, stays at one 225 EnergyandEquilibrium Bars Pulse Statedtempointerrelation Duration 1–52 r=c.80 Conmoto 0’00–3’58 53–91 e=c.80 formerr=newe 3’58–5’12 92–101 e=120 formerep =newe 5’12–5’25 102–111 e=108 – 5’25–5’36 112–125 e=92 – 5’36–5’53 126–141 e=80 – 5’53–6’15 142–184 e=160 formerr=newe 6’15–7’20 185–213 w=120 formerw. =neww 7’20–8’00 214–222 e=80 formere=newr(Tempoof‘F’,bar53) 8’00–8’15 223–250 e=c.108 formerr=newep 8’15–8’49 251–256 e=c.160 formerep=newe(Tempoof‘L’,bar142) 8’49–9’02 257–284 r=c.52 Calandomoltoerit… – 9’02–12’01 – 12’01–12’08 TempoI:previousrp =newr – 12’08–13’26 Atempo,serenomaconmoto 13’39–19’23 391–392 r=80 Pocopiulargamente – 19’23–19’37 393–398 e=c.80 – 19’37–19’54 Doppiomovimento:formerr=newe – 19’54–21’31 285–286 286–300 300–302 302–390 r=c.80 Rit. e=160 441–444 MoltorallentandoalUine 399–440 13’26–13’39 21’31–22’05 Fig.10.6:Tevot,tabledetailingtempochangesinscoreandperformancedurations notablyslower speed(bars257–285);thisstabilityseemsto precipitatethe ?inal, andindeedthelongeststructuralstagewhichreturnstoand(savefor threebrief pull-ups)maintainsasinglepulse,withthenotatedmotiondoubledatthecloseof theworkfrombar399(seeFigure10.6).43 On the face of it, this reading would appear to indicate three radically different passages of music. However, one feature would seem to hint at an underlyingcontinuity: apulseof80bpm–oritsdoubledexpressionof160bpm– recursfrequentlythroughthecourseofthepiece,apointofconstancyinthemidst 43 Durations taken from recording listed in primary resource list (Berliner Philharmoniker,conductedbySirSimonRattle.EMIClassics:4578132) 226 EnergyandEquilibrium of change (appearances highlighted by bold type inthe ‘Pulse’ columnof Figure 10.6). By equating the three occurrences of the 160bpm marking to its halved speeddemarcation,itispossibletoviewTevotaspossessingasingle,centralpulse, acore‘time’thatactsasapoint ofauralreferencefromwhichdeparturesmaybe made. Growing unrest in the opening passage seemingly prompts the ?irst departures from this central pulse. The perceived regularity of the established onward tonal ?lux and the steady interaction between contrasting ideas proves short-lived; frombar 24onwards, a gradual butnonetheless palpableprocess of divergencebegins to occuras subtleadditions to the orchestral texture beginto convolute the audible division between different gestures. The chordal progressions not only starttobecomemorefrequentbuteventuallybegintolose theirrhythmicunityand,byextension,theirharmoniccoherence;theseseparating strands ofsustainedmaterial servetomuddytheharmonicwatersfurther asthe descending?ifthspatternscontinue, chromaticin?lectionsnowcreepingintotheir trajectory. This ramping up of tonal tension is supported not only by an increasingly cluttered texture but also by a gradual ensemble crescendo that culminates in a moment of release at bar 53, most of the amassed orchestra suddenly dropping away to reveal an abrupt change in metre, content and structure.Skitteringwoodwindburst intoanongoingdialogueofangularstaccato triplet-quavers,pitchedpercussioncontributingglitteringpunctuations. In spite of the surface change from bar 53, an underlying continuity is perceivable;althoughits trajectoryis now fragmented, abroaderdescentof?ifths and minor seconds – and the mobile tonal centre that accompanies it – is still audible, even if the inclusion of new intermediary notes (thirds in particular) rendersitlessdirect(seeClarinet,bars53–54inFigure10.9).Thistransformation proves to be a blueprint ofsorts for theway inwhich the ?irst half of the work proceeds, with motivic changes precipitating audible structural changes whilst maintainingasenseofinterrelationbyunderliningorreframingdifferentfacetsof the materials with which the work began: a kind of varied repetition. The simplicityoftheshapesAdèsemploysproveespeciallyfunctionalinthisway, with different motivic fragmentations and expansions preserving asenseof cohesion, 227 EnergyandEquilibrium Fig.10.7:Tevot,examplesofmotivicdevelopmentsincorporatingormanipulating open-Uifthrelationships(cello,bars65–68,andviolin1,bars92–99) Fig.10.8:Tevot,trumpetmelody,bars142–44 eveniftracingthespeci?icoriginsandprocessesinvolvedinthesechangesproves trickyinthecourseoflistening. The two intervals that underpin the opening are adapted to produce material that performs different structural functions. The distinctive open ?ifth relationships are utilised to create notably dynamic passages (see Figure 10.7), beingattimes, invertedandaugmented(frombar65)andaccentuatedinangular motifs (frombar92). Meanwhile, thepotential for tonal frictioncontainedwithin the minor second relationship is audibly exploited as a way of ramping up structural tension. The ?irst noticeablederivationemerges as a sliding chromatic ?igure that develops through the strings (bars 72–91), its perpetual stepwise descentarecognisablenodtothesequentialscoringoftheopening,withsemitone patterns now enhanced througha more gradual, stepwise falling gesture. As the ?igurespreadsthroughouttheorchestra,itsdissonantcollectivepresenceservesto muddythetonalwaters, precipitatingmotivicandstructuralchangesfrombar92. However, the subject continues to plague the music, reappearing in violent glimpses(bars101–102andbars111–12)beforereturninginagrowinglyfrantic uni?ied version from bar 119; its chromatic effect upon the tonal direction necessitates a steadying structural change from bar 142, the trumpet solos (see 228 EnergyandEquilibrium Fig.10.9:Tevot,counterpointmotifsutilisedinbars53–91 Figure 10.8)underpinnedbyascendingpedals (B♮ – C♯ – D♮ –E♭ – E♮). A slower pacedbut more rhythmically angular reinvention ofthe theme takes holdinthe oboesfrombar175,snowballingthroughthefullorchestra;iteventuallygivesway toarecommencementofitsearlierslidingincarnation(frombar214),thoroughly saturatingbothtonalandtexturalpalates. Oneformal impression, here, might be a set of variations onthe opening passage, withthesimplicityofthe material allowing listeners to takefor granted its broaderunityandto focusmoreoveruponitsgesturalcontent, withlong-term dialogues emergingbetween ascending anddescendingtrajectoriesand between wideandnarrowintervals.However,thedynamicnatureofthisvariation-ledform becomesclearintheoverlapping,andoftenoutrightsimultaneous,presentationof itsdevelopments.Thisintricatereappraisalofmotifstakestheformofdivergences andconvergences, withnew ideas emerging anddeveloping inparallel with one another. Within a very short space of time of the skittering woodwind and percussion ?igure (from bar 53), it is placed in counterpoint ?irst with the metricallyjarringinversionandaugmentationof?ifthsfrombar65(aboldclashof descendingandascendinggestures),andsubsequentlywiththeslidingchromatic shapes,whichgraduallytakeprecedentfrombar72(seeFigure10.9). Thesequenceoflargelyinterrelatedtempo changesthattakesplaceacross the?irsthalfofTevot,whilstindicativeofanintricateformalcontinuity,onlypaints apictureofblock-like,verticallyimplementedchange.Passagesofcounterpoint,as above, point to further levels of development, transformations taking place in parallel rather thanindirectsuccession. Indeed, therhythmic varietyonoffer in such episodes adds complexity to the interpretation of pulse demarcation. 229 EnergyandEquilibrium Although the tempo itself may make frequent returns to reference points (principallythatof80bpmoritsdouble,160bpm)themetricalemphasiscontained withinthis framework isregularly shiftingby virtue ofthe material deployed. So characteristicdothesechangesbecomethatwithoutthevisual cueofthescoreor aconductor, determiningwhich gestures accordwith thebroadertimesignature andwhich?loutitprovesaparticularlydif?icult,ifnotaseeminglyirrelevant,task; theoverridingexperienceamountstosomethingmuchmore?luidandmercurial. Adès’sinclinationto employdifferent temporallevels inhismusichas not goneunnoticed. Christopher Foxhas producedadetailedexaminationofmultiple time-scalesinthe?irstmovementofhisViolinConcerto,highlightingshiftsinsmallscale (varying speed of semitone drops) and large-scale (differing instrumental ‘orbits’) recurrences (2014, 28–56). Paul Roeder, meanwhile, frames such compositionaltechniqueswithinthecontextofJonathanKramer’sobservationson themultiplicity of postmodernmusic. Surveying a quintet ofpiecescomposed in the 1990s, he concludes that while this music could indeed be deemed postmodern, such descriptions prove insuf?icient in accounting for its sheer temporalvariety, pointingtotheparadoxical manner inwhicha ‘narrative, linear interpretationmayemergequitereadilyfromthehigher-levelperceptionoflocally variousconcurrentperiodicitiesandtrends’(Roeder2006,149). AlthoughRoeder pointsto Arcadiana–withitsintricatewebofallusions,referencesandquotations – as the mostobvious exponent ofthese characteristics, heasserts thatthey are nonetheless facilitatedthroughfundamentalmusicalmeans,aboveallatreatment ofrhythm. Tevot certainly exhibits aspects of what Roeder terms ‘multiply-paced polyphony’(2006, 149), with particularthematicideas departingfrom viewonly toreappearinnewguises,oftenwithchangingrhythmicpropertiesallowingeither a cohesive or pointedly jarring counterpoint with parallel ?igures. Consider the variedappearances ofthe sliding chromatic descent ?igurediscussedearlier(see Figure 10.9), with its changing shape not only demonstrating a particularly malleable approach to motivic development but also expanding musical scope withoutsacri?icingcontinuity.Thisoverlappingtechniquecallstomindtheparallel temporalstreamsofSibelius’sSeventhSymphony,thestarkjuxtapositionof–and 230 EnergyandEquilibrium interaction between – different materials, metres and tempi engendering an audiblemultiplicity. Nevertheless, in spite ofthese apparent divisions, a clear linear narrative remainsinbothworks. Theinterrelatednatureofthematerialslendsthemusical discourseanunmistakablesingularity,disparateratesofmotionultimatelyunited in their direction, mobile tonal centres urging all textural components restlessly onwards.Beyondthis,themusic seemstoexhibitanobviouswillforitsseparated elementstoconverge,withanumberofepisodesnotonlyseekingtocombineclose and wide pitch intervals but also attempting, unsuccessfully, to reconcile the orchestrainmoreuni?iedtextures.Themostprominentoftheseattemptsseesthe entire ensemble save the horns unite on a disjointed, dissonant triplet-crotchet ?igure, descending semitonepatterns fragmentedby unpredictable leaps in pitch andirregularrhythmic breaks (bars223–250).Whenthehornsenter,itisonlyto compoundthe volatile distortions ofthis ?igure, their fanfare-like countermelody characterisedbytriadic shapes descendingbysemitonesteps. Tryas itmight,the violentpassage fails to forceany kindofresolutionand, shortly afterithas been curtailed by a reprisal of the arching, legato trumpet ?igure (bars 251–256), an abruptdrop intempo precipitates anunprecedentedstructuralchange(frombar 257).Withrhythmic momentumvastlydepleted, metricalde?initionisnow lostin a sighing ebb and ?low of dissonant clusters, throbbing punctuations, semitone ascents and descents still perceivable in the middle registers; the energy so relentlessly accumulated throughout the ?irst ten minutes of the work has dissipated,withlittleinthewayofresolutionachieved. Disruption As withTevot,itisthetensioninherent inthe?igures thatopenSibelius’sSeventh Symphony that incites structural change. The composer’s management of harmonic con?lict and competition emerges as a particularly potent tool for addressingissuesoflong-termresolution.Toaccordtonal changewiththeearlier mapping of three different temporal levels, a clear correlation emerges, with swifter,lesspredictablemodulationstakingplaceinthecourseofthefastermusic. 231 EnergyandEquilibrium Fig.10.10:SymphonyNo.7,reductionofstringsandhorns,bars106–8 Indeed, the ?irst tempo shifts are seemingly precipitated by an increase in harmonic activity: a build in musical energy is created by the content itself, sequential motivic exchanges across the orchestra inciting greater tonal motion withpulse following suit(bars 71–105). As the steadiness engendered bythe Cmajor cadence begins to fade, tonality becomes moretransient, with a variety of newharmoniesandpulsesexplored.Inthecourseofthisgradualaccelerando,that tonal instability is maintained through allusions to different harmonic realms. Listeners are left witha searching sensationas new sonorities –or ones at least audiblyremovedfromtherecentclimax–areexploredwithincreasingspeed. Nevertheless, anetwork ofreferences to theinitial disparity betweenthe tonic and its A♭ subversion serves to keep these new occurrences within the context of the pre-existing tensions. In addition to the extensive melodic explorationofscalic patterns alluding to thewhite-note ascent ofthe opening, a more speci?ic reference to thetonic appears inthe hornsat bars107–108witha brief recalling of the trombone theme from the ?irst grand cadence. This latter occurrence also acts as the?irst notable point of arrival withinthe course of this transitorypassage,afullcrescendoatopanE♮pedal(bars104–105inthetimpani anddoublebasses)culminatinginanincisivecontrarymotionscaleinthestrings. Thescaleplateaus into a middle-registerdissonancecharacterisedbywhole-tone relationships(F♯,B♭andD♮)thatis inturntransformedthroughatonicemphasis in thebass into a C-major resonance, withaddedsecondsand ?lattenedsevenths hinting at the juxtaposition of a G-minor triad; the resulting clash allows an alternative view, G-minor with an added sixth producing a Tristan-esque resonance(seeFigure10.10). A♭ proves animportant pivot point in the increasinglyscherzo-likemusic thatensues,withadescendingbassmanoeuvrefrombars115–18concludingwith two pointedA♭ majorchordsthat arethenenharmonicallytransformed,withthe 232 EnergyandEquilibrium resultingG♯shelpingtoprepareforthetransienceoftheforthcomingVivacissimo (frombar156).Althoughthekeychangetothree?latsatbar134provesindicative of the eventual direction of the music with regard to the forthcoming C-minor Adagio, itbearsmoreimmediaterelevancetothe on-goingexplorationsofE♭, for Howell ‘the only unequivocally and conventionally established secondary key’(1989,106).Inanycase,atthetimeofitsimplementationthisnotatedchange haslittleimpactonauralproceedingswiththestring?iguresintheapproachtothe Vivacissimoseeminglyhintingatanumberoftonalcentres,E♮andC♯ emergingas temporarycontenders.Fromhereon,thereislittleletupintonalmotionuntilthe arrival at G-major in bar 208; the unison chromatic gestures that follow in the stringsallowitspresencetobeprolonged, cementingitsstatusasthedominantto theminorratherthanthemajormodeofthetonicforatransformedreturnofthe cadencematerial. This alteration of the tonic mode for the central Adagio prompts a reconsideration. The?irstgrandC-majorcadencehasindeedprovedtobetheonly point of true stability in the whole work, one that not only required extensive af?irmation to be truly established but that then swiftly faded from view. The gradual increase in tempo that followed has been matched by a loss in tonal stability;ratherthananykindofconventional alternative key having beenfound, insecurity has takenhold, with?luctuations inenergynow supplanting a relative stasis.Pike’sinterpretationofthesymphonyascomprisingtwo tonalaxes–C♮,G♮ andD♮ontheonehand, A♭,E♭ andB♭ ontheother–seemsparticularlyaptinthis light (1978, 210–11). Ratherthanamoretraditionalhierarchicalapproachtothe tonal centres of the symphony, Sibelius establishes a careful balance between a number of keys, setting in motion what more often appears to be a kind of harmonic pendulum effect, coexistence more often chosen in favour of direct con?lict. As disruptive as the presence of A♭ may frequently appear to be, it precipitatesthestructuralinstabilitythattheotherwiselargelystaticC-majortonic requires for the work to play out, allowing its repeated reaf?irmations to demarcatethebroaderarchitecture. 233 EnergyandEquilibrium Attainingequilibrium Althoughitcanseemeasierto assignspeci?ictonalaxestotheformalsegmentsof the Seventh Symphony, the aural reality is that both are often present simultaneouslytovaryingextents,hintingatakindofequilibrium.Indeed,muchof the success of the single-span form depends on this, continuity of structure ensuredthroughthethoroughintegrationofcontrastingideas.Theappearancesof A♭ in the opening passages may be read as subversions but really they set in motion a tonal balancing act, introducing the very uncertainty that requires repeatedaf?irmationsofanarchitecturallyfunctionaltonic; asdisruptiveasthese features ?irst seem, they are revealed to perform a very different function over time.JustasC-majorresonancesarethenabletomaintainapresenceinthecourse of the faster transitions (at bar 107, for example), the in?luence of the many modulations within the realms of A♭ and E♭ necessitates the minor-mode conversionof thetonic for the central cadence. This also helps to emphasisethe continuingremnantsoffastermusic–abovealltheunderpinningchromatic-scales inthestrings – thatliebeneaththesurfaceoftheslowerchorale-likematerial in thewindandbrass. The consequences of this balance ofsonorities can be heard inthe faster musicthatensuesinthewakeofthecentralAdagiocadencepassage, inwhichthe earlier tonal transience is redeployed with notably less aural disorientation, a moredirectinterplaybetweenstableandunstableaxesbecomingmoreobvious.A brief but audible jolt to E major in bar 242 paves the way for a further miniaturisationofthetonalplanatlarge:twosuccessiveapproachestothetonicin itsmajormode.The?irstprovesunsuccessful, divertedthroughdownwardminorkey chromatic shifts to C♯ minorandC minor (bars 252–57);the secondis more fruitful,withunaccompaniedsequentialrepetitionsascendingquicklythroughG,A andB♭(bars 258–60).However, ratherthanatriumphantreturnto thetonic,the arrival at C major (from bar 261) seems to trigger a brief hesitationin onward momentum,anotatedpausehighlightingatonicpedaloverlaidbyaD-minortriad (bar265). Themelodies thatensueseemto continuethisharmonic juxtaposition, withthemelodicexchangesthatfollowseeminglyoutliningD-minorshapeswhilst 234 EnergyandEquilibrium exhibiting a clear audible gravitationtowards the tonic, with dominant leanings soonfollowing(bars266–274). Capitalising upon this uncertainty, the contrasting tonal axis continues to shape the unfolding form: a brieflurch to A♭ (bar 309) precipitates an A-minor diversion, with the passage eventually curtailed by a descending A♭-major arpeggio(bars320–21).Thischangeintonaldirectionpromptsalapseinenergy: a series of downwardmodulations eventually brings the ensemble to a point of rest, dissonant string dialogues giving the impression of a loss of rhythmic and harmonic direction (bars 334–336). However, a solitary dominant pedal in the hornsseems tooffer areminderofthe more stableaxis(bar337);thedissonant string sequence is reinitiated, the violas intercede with the arpeggiated melody that?irstmarkedthearrivalatAllegromoderato(frombar285),andbothrhythmic momentumandtonalstabilityarerestored. Fromhereon, thetwotonalaxes seemto achieveamoreobvious stateof equilibrium. Although a clear relationship between speed of tempo and rate of tonal changeis still evident, potential interruptions and diversions –suchas the prominent A♭ timpani punctuations (bars 346–48), and the two chromatically in?lected passages that engineer modulations to B♭ and E♭ (bars 359–362 and 370–374,respectively)–dolittletodisruptthe?lowandindeedtheupbeatnature of the material. Indeed, once the stuttering comma-led jump to Vivace has been navigated, even the winding harmonic shifts that eventually lead back to the dominantfortheonsetoftheAdagiobywayofthePresto(frombar449)seemfar less startling, with such manoeuvres having been somewhat normalised by the comparableproceduresthatpreparedthe?irstAdagio. Sibelius’s implementation of contrasting tonal axes offers a further separationoftherolesthatthesedifferentspeedscontributetothedevelopmentof the tonal plan. In essence, all three energy levels grant different temporal perspectivesuponthetonic,approachingthesonorityofC♮ bydifferentmeansand thus at different speeds. The three Adagio segments in essence offer three extendedperfect cadences,C–inbothits majorandminormodes– assertedand reasserted in audible ‘slow-motion’ but rarely without small tonal disruptions, principally through ?igures incorporating A♭. The moderate, transitory formal segments seem to offer more unsteady attempts to maintain this tonic, with 235 EnergyandEquilibrium passingharmoniccentres promptedbyearlierdisruptions(principallyA♭, E♭ and B♭). However, these new paths are not simply periods of instability, but rather necessary sojourns designed to strengthen the tonic resolve. Both ensuing fast sections act as extendedpreludes to the Adagio passages that follow, continuing theexplorationofmoredistantharmonicareaswiththeultimategoalofanarrival atthedominant, offering adirect routebacktothetonic. Itisinthis waythatthe passages of the greatest instability ultimately serve to reinforce the structural security ofthesymphonicform, withthemomentumofthework gearedtowards tonalrecurrence. Sonorityandmemory Most variation-based forms are self-perpetuating in character. Their structural direction is instilled through an inherent propensity to re-express; continual reinventionbecomestheauralgoal.Withoutembeddingmoreconventionalformal issues of contrast and con?lict within a variation-led piece, its conclusion will struggletoattainthesenseofrequiredresolutionthatotherdesignscanoffer.Ifit cannotoperatecyclically,returningto somethingapproachingitsbasicshape,the senseofanendingmightoftenbedeliberatelyimplementedthrougharampingup oftensionthatiseventuallyreleasedinaculminatingpassage. Bythemid-pointof Tevot, itappearsthatthis releasehasprovedelusive. Numerousreinterpretations ofthesamebasicgesturalharmonicideashavebeenaired,ofteninanoverlapping manner, all perpetuatingthesamesenseofmobiletonalgravity. Theresult, from bar 257, seems to have been a point of burnout: several increasingly violent rhythmiccollisionshavefailedtoprovideanykindofresolution,insteadleadingto a loss of energy: the drifting harmonic sequences – now aimlessly undulating rather than perpetually descending – are now underpinned by ominous fragmentations of the oscillating textures from the opening of the work. The broader formal frustration ofthis passage isseemingly vented throughafurther outburst, its?iguresascendingtoananguishedclimax,shiftsofsecondsandthirds colliding in orchestral-wide dissonance (bar 280). The composer’s take on variationformseemstohavearrived,fornow,ataparticularlybleakconclusion. 236 EnergyandEquilibrium Fig.10.11:Tevot,reductionofbars302–323 Itis atthispointthatawatershedoccurs. Witharesumptionoftheinitial tempo, Adèscalls upon the particularly distinctive sonorities and textures ofthe openingofthepiece–chainsof?ifthsintheupperstringsandwind–butgradually implementstheminascending,ratherthandescending, sequences(bars 287–302, withuni?iedascending patterns achievedfrombar 293). This retrogradegesture gives the impression not of a direct recapitulation, but of a speci?ically musical returnto arememberedpointinthework;thiseffectofa‘returnto’ratherthana ‘recurrenceof’isenhancedbythereversalofpitchdirection, aconcertedeffortto audiblyturnbackmusical‘time’.Reintroductionsofintermittentharmonicclusters in the brass and the upward leaping horn motif, bothnotable features from the openingofthework,underlinethistreatmentofmusicalmaterialassomethingto be actively navigated and explored by the listener rather than passively experienced. Eventually,this ascentplateaus into astratosphericchoraledividedamong the violins (from bar 303). This tentative succession of shifting consonant resonancesgivestheimpressionofadownward-driftingharmonicseries. Mediant 237 EnergyandEquilibrium completionsprovideafullharmonicrenderingoftheopen?ifthsthathavethus-far dominated. The heart of the shifting tonal centre that has pervaded the work is here revealed in its essence, as if its very genesis has been unveiled: a chain of interconnected, predominantly consonant sonorities – many integrating major triads – led perpetually onwards by a dynamic tonal gravity (see Figure 10.11). Theapparentabsenceofanyhierarchyinthisseriesnegatesanyimmediatedesire for resolution, imbuing the music with a new kind of stability characterised by clearerboundariesofharmonicandrhythmicenergy. This new consistency paves the way for one ?inal variation, a ?loating melody thatemerges in thepiccolos atop this harmonic bed (frombar314). The theme has an uncanny presence, bearing a striking novelty whilst still seeming familiar. It is in fact a hybrid subject, conglomerated from various aspects of precedingvariations. Itcomprisestwoparts:the?irst isadirectstepwiseascent– aninversionofthefallingsecondsoftheopeningthat,inits?irstfourbars,allowsa spelt-out traversal of the rising seventh interval of the horn call in bar 21; the second is a slower descent – tentative oscillations of tones and semitones are gentlyloweredinpitchinamore stabilizedversionofthecomparable?igurethat ?irst took hold in the lower strings from bar 72. More signi?icantly, this new materialconforms –bothmetricallyandharmonically–withitsbackground.The result is a gesture of post-romantic tranquility, and as the ?igure begins to proliferate in slow majestic counterpoint through the woodwind and onwards throughtheentireorchestra,itbeginstoaccumulateanalmostMahleriantension. Almost the entire second half of the work proceeds in the manner of one ?inal, grandvariation, melody andchorale?igures?inally unitedintheirsteady, onward tonal motion. As it might be understood in the act of listening, reconciliation between the con?licting ideas presented in Tevot is achieved through a ‘revisitation’ of the work’s ‘origins’, its essential matter realigned in order that it mightbeheardinamorecohesiveway.Thecomposer’sowntakeonStravinsky– thathismusicmightbeheardas‘sayinggoodbyetoaformertypeofwritingatthe sametimeaswelcominganewone’–seems apt inthis light. Inparticular, Adès’s interpretation of The Rake’s Progress proves especially telling: ‘[…] it’s almost as thoughthematerialhasatenderness,it’ssoftandmalleablebecauseit’spreparing 238 EnergyandEquilibrium for a metamorphosis; it’s the end ofone thing, the disintegration of one way of thinkingandthebeginningofanotherone…’(AdèsandService2012,76). Indeed,sopowerful doesthisnewly acquiredstability provethatitalmost seems that the onward tonal path must be deliberately diverted in order for a conclusionto bereached.Atthepeakofagigantictextural anddynamicbuild,the suddenstallingoftonalmotion–viasuccessivesustainedtriadsofCmajorandG major(bars393–98)–seemsto precipitateahugeensembleconvergenceonanA pedal,E♮ completingtheopen?ifthasoscillationsreappearintheviolinsand?lutes (bar399).Harmonicdynamismisnowreplacedbyblock-likechangesofsonority: two further reassertions of the orchestral chord, precipitated by solo trumpet ?igures, combine the pre-existing ?ifth of A♮ and E♮ withone a tone lower, bass emphasisfalling?irstuponG♮(bar415)andthenuponD♮(bar429). Theseseeminglyjolting reorientations areexplainedwithinthe context of the?inaloutburstinbar441:anemphaticreturntoanopen?ifthonA♮,underlined bytunedpercussioninthefollowingbar.Thechordisallowedtofadeintosilence, dying oscillations in the violins acting as a subtle aural reminder that Tevot has returnedto theveryresonancewith which it began. How conclusive this closing gesture proves depends upon the perspective of the listener. The circularity evident in the return to the opening sonority would certainly seem to exhibit a kindofclosure.However,itmaysimultaneouslynudgeaudiencestowardsideasof thein?inite; formalcircles, bytheirveryde?inition, provide closurewhilsthinting atthe ideathat theshape itselfcancontinue, repeating itselfwithout end. Inthis sense,however,Tevotoffersnotonecirclebut perhapssomething moreakinto a ?igureofeight.Tworeturnstotheopeningmaterial–oneatthecentreofthework, theotheratitsclose– suggesta broader kindofvariationstructure, a process of formal re-evaluation and reinvention. Alternate times are presented: whilst the work seemingly acknowledges that the past cannot be relived, attempting to repeat key events can inform new perspectives and provide different ways of approachingthesameideas. While Sibelius seemingly addresses the same kind of temporal concepts withhisSeventhSymphony,theresultingexperiencedoesnotnecessarilyproduce thiskindofcatharsis. Heretheunderlyingacknowledgementthatthepastcannot berelivedisrepeatedlychallenged,perhapsdeliberatelyso. WhilstTevottwice(at 239 EnergyandEquilibrium Fig.10.12:SymphonyNo.7,reductionofstringsandhorns,bars500–10 its centre and at its conclusion) makes clear references back to its opening material, these recurrences act as springboards for formal changes. By contrast, whilst the similarly positioned cadence passages in the Seventh Symphony do precipitate wider changes, they themselves become the focal points of the structure.Nosoonerhastheensembledepartedfromtheemphaticcertaintyofthe ?irstC-majorAdagiothanitexpressesadesiretoreturntoit,arecallingofboththe sonority and the trombone theme (bar 107–08) seemingly expressing dissatisfaction with the new harmonic agenda that is taking hold. Although the ensuingcentralcadence–aminor-keycompromisewiththecontrastingtonalaxis –allows aperiodofrelativeclarity, its effectdoeslittleto stabiliseproceedingsin the manner of the earlier episode. The con?idence of the trombone theme is underminedbythechromaticin?lectionsofthecontinuingfastermusic,itsreprisal renderedasafutileattempttoregainalostsecurity. Thisapparentneedtoreturntothepastiscon?irmedbythe?inalsegueinto Adagio, anemphaticattempt that comesfarcloser to achievingitsgoal. However, havingfacilitatedthereturnto themajormodeofthetonic in the?irst place, the alternatetonal axiscannotbeshaken.RepeatedF♯s inthestrings(frombar484) may appear supportive of the dominant but they pave the way for further dissonances, E♭s almost immediately creeping in in the horns andwoodwindto alludetotheminor-modeoncemore. TheF-minordiversionthat?irstappearedat bar 71, instead of serving to calm the climax, now sends the orchestra off on a violent upward sequence as it continues in search of its resolution. As the ensemble strays further from the safety of the tonic it resorts to a desperate 240 EnergyandEquilibrium attempt atstructural symmetry, curtailing thesequencewithaviolenttuttichord to allow the strings an opportunity to reprise their C-major-af?irming chorale. However, context wins out over content. The result is a dissonant, anguished descent; the realisation that the tonal axes must continue to coexist is further cemented as – following a further tutti punctuation – the strings continue their outburstwithaheldA♭ majorchordwithanaddedaugmentedsixthatbar500,a German sixth construction seemingly devoid, in any direct sense, of its conventional pre-dominant function(see Figure 10.12). A ?inal stuttering ascent stallsonanA♭ beforesinkingback to thedominant, horns andbassoonushering back in thetonic witha truncated echo of thetrombone theme(bar506–09), an apparent gesture of resignation in the wake of the failed attempt to regain the stabilityoftheopening Adagio. Vagueallusions to asymmetricaldesigncontinue with ?lute and bassoon providing fragmented slow-motion reminiscences of the ?littingthemetheyairedintheopeningpassages(bars511–17referencingbars7– 10)atopatremoloaccompaniment. Theclosingcadenceoftheworkunderlinesa resignationto the coexistenceofthetwo tonal axes, the prominentshift from B♮ upwards to C♮ in the strings perhaps offering a ?inal nod to the A♭ minor subversionwhichsettheformofthesymphonyinmotion.Emphasisisplacedonce again upon a tension that has audibly developed, yet seemingly remains as balanced–or, indeed,as inconclusive–asitdidwhenitwas?irstheard. To what extent this ending provides resolution may depend upon the perspective of a listener. As withTevot, theSeventhSymphony’sclosingevocationofanaspect of its opening seemingly poses further questions regarding the extent to which notionsofclosureandreturnmightintertwine. 241 Eleven Epilogue:Openendings Torememberaneventistoexperienceitagain,butnotinthesamewayastheSirst time.(Langer1953,263) Thetemporal experiencesofTevotand theSeventhSymphonyprompt questions regarding the nature of repetition. Points of return draw attention to circular aspectsofstructuraldesign,makinglistenersawareoftensionsbetweenstaticand dynamic formal characters. The way in which both pieces conclude warrants further consideration of beginnings and endings, of closure and continuation. Returnsmightinsomesenseconveyasenseofconclusion, butbythesametoken reawaken the impulses that began the journey inthe ?irst place. Intheseterms, musical repetition might be seen as engaging with long-term continuity in a paradoxicalmanner,evokinganattemptattemporalsymmetrycomparabletothat outlined by Søren Kierkegaard: ‘Repetition and recollection are the same movement, except in opposite directions, for what is recollected has been, is repeated backwards, whereas genuine repetition is recollected forward’ (1983, 89). Inasimilarmanner, this thesis has also exhibited circularcharacteristics. Just as many of the works analysed have been shown to engage with the same broad formal issues, seemingly new lines of enquiry have frequently led to recurrences ofwidertemporal questions.Thisremains,Iwouldargue,anecessity of exploring what will always amount to a subjective experience. Attempts to separate so broad and all-encompassing a phenomenon out into multiple componentswillultimatelyprovefrustrating.Ashasbeenshown,thediscussionof time will inevitably involve numerous other factors that might at ?irst glance appeardistinctbutoncloserexaminationconstituteanetworkofinterdependent, oftenoverlappingconcepts.AswiththeformsoftheseworksbyAdèsandSibelius, thisstudyhasservedtoaf?irmthepossibilityforthecoexistenceofbothstaticand dynamic temporal outlooks, and theplaceofboth withinmusicalanalysis. These are ideas that, whether they are stated or not, I would argue come into play whenever issues of continuity, repetition, energy and perspective are discussed 242 Epilogue:Openendings withregardtoideasofform.Indeed,thisthesishasmaintainedthatconsideration ofsuchconceptsmightprovideafruitfulspringboardforwaysofanalysingmusic that not only remain open to the multiplicity of time but to a diverse range of compositionalstyles. Manyofthetenetsofthisthesisgravitatetowards,orindeedareprompted by, what might be thought of as poststructuralist concerns: a desire to contextualisetheconstructionofmusicalcompositionswithinthecomplexwebof culturalrelationshipsandperceptualinteractionsthatencompassit. Nevertheless, the analyses presented here still bear something of a structuralist streak, emphasising the important roles that musical form can assume within these networks. Indeed, the underlying notion of temporal linearity (the necessary progressionfromabeginningtoanendingofsome kind)asafundamentalaudible continuitycouldevenperhapsbeportrayedas amoreconventionalrelianceupon unity as an analytical parameter. Notions of unity, coherence and stability have regularly featuredas essential issues inthese casestudies, even if the focus has beentheways inwhichtheyexistinbalance, orimbalance, withtheiropposites: disunity, incoherence and instability. The very acknowledgement of this tension wouldseemtoengagewiththeidea–oftentakenasagivenoftraditionalanalysis – that pieces of music should ‘make sense’, that they retain some kind of selfsuf?icient logic. In the end, this is at best a profoundly meaningful illusion that listeners might willingly buy into – at worstit might be consideredapotentially restrictive fallacy. Rose Rosengard Subotnik offers a helpful reminder that both music and its audiences prove considerably more diverse, asserting that the ‘rationalsubstratumofmusicalknowledge?inallyonsomeact,choice,orprinciple thatisnotitselfrationallydemonstrable’(1996,170): Onlysome musicstrivesforautonomy.Allmusichassoundanda style.Onlysome peoplelistentomusicstructurally.Everyonehasculturalandemotionalresponses tomusic.Thesecharacteristicsandresponsesarenotuniformorimmutablebutas diverse, unstable, and open-ended as the multitude of contexts in which music deSinesitself.(1996,175) As persuasive as analytical explorations of more formalist concepts like unitycanbe,notleastinlendingauralexperiencesasenseofretrospectiveclosure, theirpropensitytowardscatharsiscannotgrantthemdominationoveralternative 243 Epilogue:Openendings ways of hearing pieces. Eric Clarke attributes the cultural power that autonomy wields in part to the ‘intensely absorbing… perceptual meanings’music affords, but nevertheless insists that itis ‘justoneamongmany ways oflistening’(2005, 188).Thecontinuitiesanddiscontinuitiesdiscussedhereultimatelytaketheshape of interpretive suggestions – no more, no less. They are ways of reaching understandings ofpieces of music rather thanthe wayofreadingthem. Inthese terms, Joseph Dubiel’s notion of structure as a route to new meaningful comprehensions – a call to exploration – proves particularly resonant. It is, he writes, ‘a way to hold open the possibility of discovery, the possibility of responding aurally to something in a piece to which I was not antecedently attuned’(Dubiel2004,198). Though several analytical styles have been utilised, it has not been a concern ofthis study to advocate or developmore a speci?ic listening or indeed musicological strategy beyond a broader receptiveness to issues of perceived musical time and, accordingly, an open-minded approach to the diversity of meanings these experiences might facilitate.44 Mark Hutchinson, in his explorations of late-twentieth century repertoire (Hutchinson 2012 and 2016), similarlylocatesakindofunityinthepluralitythathisanalysesuncover. Through examinations of works by Ligeti, Adès, Saariaho, Takemitsu, and Kurtág, he convincingly argues that theexperiences ofpotent cohesionthey offer arise as a consequence of their ‘multi-layered and ‘sometimes seemingly-contradictory’ content rather than in spite of it (Hutchinson 2012, 37). He continues not by prescribing a speci?ic approach but rather echoing Whittall (1999) and Kramer (2004) in their call for an adaptive approach to pre-existing conceptual and analyticalframeworks(Hutchinson2012,279). I would propose, though, thatthe dynamic rede?initions ofcoherencethat Hutchinsonoutlinesmightnotnecessarilybelimitedtomorerecentmusic.Asthe case studies presented in this thesis have hopefully shown, even more familiar, canonic works can contribute to ongoing – some might say progressive – 44 Lawrence Ferrara (1984) suggests a phenomenological procedure that maintains an admirable emphasis upon repeated, ‘open listenings’ that focus gradually on different structural levels. However, the conclusions he draws are tied to notions of syntax, semanticsandontology,more speciSichierarchiesofmeaningthatliebeyondthescopeof thisthesis. 244 Epilogue:Openendings musicological and compositional dialogues. Time, I have suggested, is an everrelevantpointofconceptual focusinthisregard. It has been shown to provide a means by which formalist elements mightretaina voice withinpoststructuralist thought without precluding either froma place withinthe perceptual ecology of musicalperformance.Similarly,whilstoldandnewmusiccanbeheardassittingat stylistic odds, bothcanbe nevertheless shownto engage withessential issues of experienced continuity and its absence. Temporality itself can become a springboard for analytical endeavours that facilitate a dialogue between stylisticallydisparateworks.Time–astheessentialbindingforceofexperience– emergesasatoolbywhichcontemporarylistenersmight, forawhile,sidestepthe historicalandcultural contextsthatcouldsometimesappearatriskoflimitingthe impactofpieces. Ontheotherhand, timefrequentlyappearsunbound.Temporalexperience is, at its heart, inconsistent. It can seem fractious and unpredictable whilst nevertheless maintaining the same ecological reliability that allows us to coordinate countless social and cultural networks with its passing. Listening to music constitutesacreativeactthatdrawsusinto engagementwiththis paradox andthe impact it might have upon theway welive our lives. Whenwriters like Jonathan Kramer (1988, 5) and Nicholas Cook (2013, 126) ask, in their own fascinatingways,whethermusicunfoldsintimeorwhethertimeunfoldsinmusic, it is not that they expect to ?ind any kind of de?initive answer. Rather they recognise that both perspectives have a function in musicological and philosophical thought. Both present meaningful avenues of exploration, and neither should be closed off. The contradictions they present through their coexistenceencourageustoattempttounderstandfurtherourownexperiencesof timeanditsmeaning. In a study characterised by repetition and plurality, drawing a suitable conclusion is no easy task. However, perhaps something to be learned from the various listening approaches suggestedinthesepages isthatnotions likeclosure restalmost asmuchuponourattitudes towards experiences asthey douponthe nature of the experiences themselves. It is perhaps timely to acknowledge T.S. Eliot’s contention that circularity and changeare not always mutually exclusive, especiallywhentakinginto accountthetransformations ofperspectivethatresult 245 Epilogue:Openendings fromtheactofrevisiting:‘Weshallnotceasefromexploration/Andtheendofall our exploring/Will beto arrive wherewestarted/ Andknow the placeforthe ?irst time’ (Eliot 1944, 59). Going round in circles can, given the chance, prove meaningfulafterall. 246 PrimaryResources Scores Thecomposition date ispresented?irst, withthe publication datelistedafterthe publisherwhereitdiffers. Abrahamsen,Hans.2008.Schnee–Tencanonsfornineinstruments. Copenhagen:EditionWilhelmHansen. Adams,John.1982.ShakerLoopsforstringorchestra(1982Revision). NewYork:AssociatedmusicPublishers,1989. Adès,Thomas.2007.Tevotforlargeorchestra,op.24. London:FaberMusic,2014. Beethoven,Ludwigvan.1804.SymphonyNo.3inE-?latmajor,Op.55,‘Eroica’. Mainz:Eulenburg,2009. Benjamin,George.1997.Viola,Violaforvioladuo. London:FaberMusic,1998. Brahms,Johannes.1885.SymphonyNo.4inEminor,Op.98. London:Eulenburg,1998. Mozart,WolfgangAmadeus.1778.SonataforviolinandpianoinEminor,K.304. Leipzig:Breitkopf&Härtel,1879. Saariaho,Kaija.2003.Jesensundeuxièmecoeurforviola,celloandpiano. London:ChesterMusic. Schubert,Franz.1828.PianoSonatainB-?lat,D.960. NewYork:Dover,1970. Sibelius,Jean.1924.SymphonyNo.7,Op.105(RevisedEdition). Copenhagen:EditionWilhelmHansen,1980. 247 PrimaryResources Recordings Abrahamsen, Hans. 2009. Schnee. Ensemble Recherche. Music Edition, Winter & Winter:910159–2. Adams, John. 2000.Minimalist–Adams/Glass/Reich/Heath[inc. ShakerLoops]. LondonChamberOrchestra,conductedbyChristopherWarren-Green.Virgin Classics:724356185128. Adès,Thomas.2010.Tevot/ViolinConcerto/ThreeStudiesfromCouperin/Dances from Powder Her Face. Berliner Philharmoniker, conducted by Sir Simon Rattle.EMIClassics:4578132. Beethoven,Ludwigvan.2011.CompleteSymphonies[inc.SymphonyNo.3inE-?lat major, Op.55, ‘Eroica’]. La Chambre Philharmonique, conducted by EmmanuelKrivine.Naïve:V5258. Benjamin, George. 2004.Shadowlines/Viola, Viola/Three Studies/PianoSonata. TabeaZimmermanandAntoineTamestit,violas.Nimbus:NI5713. Brahms, Johannes. 1981. Symphony No. 4. Wiener Philharmoniker, conducted by CarlosKleiber.DeutscheGrammophon:457706-2. Mozart, Wolfgang Amadeus. 2007. Complete Sonatas for Keyboard and Violin, Volume4[inc. SonatainE-minor,K.304].RachelPodger,violin;GaryCooper. ChannelClassics:24607. Saariaho, Kaija. 2012. The Edge of Light: Messiaen / Saariaho [inc. Je sens un deuxième coeur]. Jonathan Moerschel, viola; Eric Byers, cello; Gloria Cheng, piano.HarmoniaMundi:HMU907578. Schubert,Franz.2004.MitsukoUchidaPlaysSchubert[inc.PianoSonatainB-?lat,D. 960].MitsukoUchida,piano.Decca:4756282. Sibelius,Jean.2004.SymphoniesNo.3&7.LondonSymphonyOrchestra,conducted bySirColinDavis.LSOLive:LSO0552. 248 Bibliography Abraham, Gerald. 1952. ‘The Symphonies.’ In Sibelius: A Symposium, edited by GeraldAbraham,14–37.London:OxfordUniversityPress. Abrahamsen, Hans. 2009. ‘Schnee (2006–08).’Linernotes for Hans Abrahamsen: Schnee.EnsembleRecherche.MusicEdition,Winter&Winter:910159–2. _______.2010.‘8thSacrumProfanumFestivalModernClassic–InterviewwithHans Abrahamsen.’YouTubevideo,5:33.Filmed2010.Postedbybiurofestiwalowe on 1 December, 2010. Accessed 1 September 2016. https:// www.youtube.com/watch?v=ShT8dVqggCg. Adams, John. 2008. Hallelujah Junction: Composing an American Life. New York: Picador. _______. 2014.‘ShakerLoopsforstring septet(1978)’.Accessed22February, 2013. www.earbox.com/chamber-music/shaker-loops. Adams, John, RebeccaJemianandAnneMariedeZeeuw. 1996.‘AnInterview with JohnAdams.’PerspectivesofNewMusic34(2):88–104. Adès, Thomas, andTomService. 2012. ThomasAdès: Full ofNoises, Conversations withTomService.London:FaberandFaber. Adorno, Theodor W. 1997. Aesthetic Theory. Translated by Robert Hullot-Kentor andeditedbyGretelAdornoandRolfTiedemann.London:AthelonePress. _______. 2005. ‘Schubert(1928),’translatedby JonathanDunsbyandBeatePerrey. 19th-CenturyMusic29(1):3–14. Adlington, Robert. 1997a. ‘Review of Shaping Time: Music, the Brain, and PerformancebyDavidEpstein.’MusicAnalysis16(1):155–71. _______.1997b:‘TemporalityinPost-tonalMusic.’PhDthesis,UniversityofSussex. _______. 2003: ‘Moving beyondMotion: Metaphors for Changing Sound.’Journal of theRoyalMusicalAssociation128(2):297–318. Agawu, Ko?i. 1999: ‘Formal perspectives on the symphonies.’ In The Cambridge Companion to Brahms, edited by Michael Musgrave, 133–55. Cambridge: CambridgeUniversityPress. Aitken,Stuart.1998.‘ReviewofThirdspace:JourneystoLosAngelesandOtherRealand-Imagined Places by EdwardW. Soja.’Geographical Review 88(1): 148– 51. 249 Bibliography Almén, Byron. 2003. ‘Narrative Archetypes: A Critique, Theory, and Method of NarrativeAnalysis.’JournalofMusicTheory47(1):1-39. _______.2008.ATheoryofMusicalNarrative.Bloomington:IndianaUniversityPress. Angrilli,Alessandro,PaoloCherubini,AntonellaPaveseandSaraMantredini.1997. ‘The in?luence of affective factors on time perception.’ Perception and Psychophysics59(6):972–82. Athanasopoulos,George,Siu-LanTanandNikkiMoran.2016.‘In?luenceofliteracy on representation of time in musical stimuli: An exploratory cross-cultural studyinthe UK, Japan, and PapuaNew Guinea.’PsychologyofMusic 44 (5): 1126-1144. _______.2008.ATheoryofMusicalNarrative.Bloomington:IndianaUniversityPress. Aristotle.1996.Poetics,translatedbyMalcolmHeath.London:PenguinBooks. Arnheim,Rudolf.1978. ‘AStrictureonSpaceandTime.’CriticalInquiry4(4):645– 55. Arstilla, Valtteri, and Dan Lloyd, editors. 2014. Subjective Time: The Philosophy, Psychology,andNeuroscienceofTemporality.London:MITPress. Augustine.1991.Confessions,trans.HenryChadwick.Oxford:OxfordUniversity Press. Baggott,Jim.2011.‘QuantumTheory:Ifatreefallsintheforest…’OxfordUniversity Press Blog, 14 February. Accessed 30 August 2016. http://blog.oup.com/ 2011/02/quantum. Bailey, Nicole, and Charles S. Areni. 2006. ‘When a few minutes sound like a lifetime: Does atmospheric music expand or contract perceived time?’ JournalofRetailing82:189–202. Barkin, Elaine R. 2009. ‘About Some Music ofThomas Adès.’ Perspectives of New Music47(1):165–73. Barry,BarbaraR.1990.MusicalTime:TheSenseofOrder.NewYork:Pendragon Press. Begbie,Jeremy.2000.Theology, MusicandTime.Cambridge:CambridgeUniversity Press. Bent, Ian D. ‘Hermeneutics.’ In Grove Music Online. Oxford Music Online. Oxford U n i v e r s i t y P r e s s . A c c e s s e d 2 1 F e b r u a r y , 2 0 1 4 , h t t p : / / www.oxfordmusiconline.com/subscriber/article/grove/music/12871. 250 Bibliography Bennett,DavidC.1975. Spatial andtemporal usesofEnglish prepositions:anessay instratiUicationalsemantics.London:LongmanGroup. Berger,Karol.2007.Bach’sCycle,Mozart’sArrow:AnEssayontheOriginsofMusical Modernity.Berkeley:UniversityofCaliforniaPress. Bernard, JonathanW. 2003. ‘Minimalism, Postminimalism, andtheResurgence of TonalityinRecentAmericanMusic.’AmericanMusic21(1):112–33. Beyer,Anders.‘Abrahamsen,Hans.’GroveMusicOnline.OxfordMusicOnline.Oxford U n i v e r s i t y P r e s s , a c c e s s e d 1 S e p t e m b e r , 2 0 1 6 . h t t p : / / www.oxfordmusiconline.com/subscriber/article/grove/music/46325. Bierwisch, Manfred.1996. ‘How muchspacegetsintolanguage?’InLanguage and Space, edited by Paul Bloom, Mary A. Peterson, Lynn Nadel, and Merrill F. Garrett,31–76.Cambridge:MITPress. Boltz, MarilynG. 1991. ‘Time estimationand attentional perspective.’ Perception andPsychophysics,49(5):422–33. Born, Georgina, editor. 2013. Music, Sound and Space: Transformations of Public andPrivateExperience.Cambridge:CambridgeUniversityPress. Bozarth, GeorgeS., and Walter Frisch. ‘Brahms, Johannes.’In Grove Music Online. Oxford Music Online. Oxford University Press. Accessed 6 September, 2016, http://www.oxfordmusiconline.com/subscriber/article/grove/music/ 51879. Bretherton,David.2012.‘ReviewofATheoryofMusicalNarrativebyByronAlmén.’ MusicAnalysis31(3):414–21. Brendel,Alfred.2001.AlfredBrendelonMusic:CollectedEssays.Chicago:ACappella Books. Bromberger, Eric. 2007. ‘About the Piece: Wolfgang Amadeus Mozart: Violin Sonata, K. 304.’ Accessed 23 February, 2015. http://www.laphil.com/ philpedia/music/violin-sonata-k-304-wolfgang-amadeus-mozart. Brown, Scott W. 1997. ‘Attentional resources in timing: Interference effects in concurrenttemporalandnontemporalworking memorytasks.’Perception & Psychophysics59(7):1118–40. _______.2010. ‘Timing,resources,andinterference:Attentionalmodulationoftime perception.’ In Attention and time, edited by Anna C. Nobreand Jennifer T. Coull,107–22.NewYork:OxfordUniversityPress. 251 Bibliography Brown, Scott W., and Alan N. West. 1990. ‘Multiple timing and the allocation of attention.’ActaPsychologica,75:103–21. Burkholder, JPeter. 1984. ‘Brahms andTwentieth-Century Classical Music.’19thCenturyMusic8(1):75–83. Burnham,Scott.1995.BeethovenHero.Princeton:PrincetonUniversityPress. Burrows,David. 1997.‘A DynamicalSystemsPerspectiveonMusic.’TheJournalof Musicology15(4):529–45. Butler, Chris. 2012. Henri Lefebvre: SpatialPolitics, EverydayLife and the Right to theCity.Abingdon:Routledge-Cavendish. Butler, David. 1992. The Musician’s Guide to Perception and Cognition. New York: SchirmerBooks. Cahill, Sarah. ‘Adams, John.’ Grove Music Online. Oxford Music Online. Oxford U n i v e r s i t y P r e s s , a c c e s s e d S e p t e m b e r 2 3 , 2 0 1 6 , h t t p : / / www.oxfordmusiconline.com/subscriber/article/grove/music/42479. Caldwell,Clare,andSallyA.Hibbert.1999.‘Playthatoneagain:Theeffectofmusic tempo on consumer behavior in a restaurant.’ European Advances in ConsumerResearch4:58–62. Campbell, Joseph. 2008. The Hero With A Thousand Faces (Third Edition). California:NewWorldLibrary. Caplin, William E. 1998. Classical Form: A Theory of Formal Functions for the Instrumental Music of Haydn, Mozart, and Beethoven. New York: Oxford UniversityPress. Carl,Robert.1991. ‘ReviewsofAnalyticApproachestoTwentieth-CenturyMusicby JoelLester;Meta+HodosandMETAMeta+Hodos:APhenomenologyof20thCenturyMaterialsandanApproachtotheStudyofFormbyJamesTenney;The TimeofMusic:NewMeanings,NewTemporalities, NewListeningStrategiesby JonathanKramer.’Notes47(4):1107–10. Casasanto,Daniel, OlgaFotakopoulouandLeraBoroditsky.2010.‘SpaceandTime intheChild’sMind:EvidenceforaCross-Dimensional Asymmetry.’Cognitive Science34.387–405. Childs, Barney. 1977. ‘Time and Music: A Composer’s View.’Perspectivesof New Music,15(2):194–219. Chua,DanielK.L.2004.‘RethinkingUnity.’MusicAnalysis23(2/3):353–59. 252 Bibliography Churgin, Bathia. 1998. ‘Beethoven and the New Development-Theme in SonataFormMovements.’TheJournalofMusicology16(3):323–43. Clark, Herbert. H. 1973. ‘Space, time, semantics, and the child.’ In Cognitive developmentandtheacquisitionoflanguage,editedbyTimothyE.Moore,27– 63.NewYork:AcademicPress. Clark, Philip. 2015. ‘Minimalism at 50’ Gramophone, 19 June, 2015. Accessed 23 September2016,http://www.gramophone.co.uk/feature/minimalism-at-50. Clarke, David. 2011. ‘Music, Phenomenology, Time Consciousness: Aeditations after Husserl.’ In Music and Consciousness: Philosophical, Psychological, and Cultural Perspectives, edited by David Clarke andEric Clarke, 1–24. Oxford: OxfordUniversityPress. Clarke, David and Eric F. Clarke, editors. 2011. Music and Consciousness: Philosophical, Psychological, and Cultural Perspectives. Oxford: Oxford UniversityPress. Clarke,EricF.1989. ‘Issues inLanguageandMusic.’ContemporaryMusicReview4 (1):9–22. _______.2005.WaysofListening:AnEcologicalApproachtothePerceptionofMusical Meaning.NewYork:OxfordUniversityPress. Clarke, Eric F., and Nicholas Cook, editors. 2004. Empirical Musicology: Aims, Methods,Prospects.Oxford:OxfordUniversityPress. Clarke, Eric F., and Carol L. Krumhansl. 1990. ‘Perceiving Musical Time.’ Music Perception:AnInterdisciplinaryJournal7(3):213–51. Clayton, Martin. 2000. Time in Indian Music: Rhythm, Metre, and Form in North IndianRagPerformance.Oxford:OxfordUniversityPress. Clifton, Thomas. 1983. Music as Heard: A Study in Applied Phenomonology. New Haven:YaleUniversityPress. Cohn, Richard L. 1999. ‘As Wonderful as Star Clusters: Instruments forGazing at TonalityinSchubert.’19th-CenturyMusic.22(3):213–232. _______. 2004. ‘Uncanny Resemblances: Tonal Signi?ication in the Freudian Age.’ JournaloftheAmericanMusicologicalSociety57(2):285–324. _______.2012.AudaciousEuphony:ChromaticismandtheTriad’sSecondNature.New York:OxfordUniversityPress. 253 Bibliography Cone, Edward T. 1974. The Composer’s Voice. Berkeley: University of California Press. Cook,Nicholas.1983.‘ReviewofMusicAsHeard:AStudyinAppliedPhenomenology byThomasClifton.’MusicAnalysis2(3):291–94. _______.1990.Music,Imagination,andCulture.Oxford:ClarendonPress. _______.1998.Music:AVeryShortIntroduction.NewYork:OxfordUniversityPress. _______. 2001. ‘Theorizing Musical Meaning.’ Music TheorySpectrum, 23 (2): 170– 195. _______. 2013. Beyond the Score: Music asPerformance. Oxford: Oxford University Press. Cook, Nicholas andMark Everist, editors. 1999. Rethinking Music. Oxford: Oxford UniversityPress. Cross, Ian. 1998. ‘MusicAnalysisandMusic Perception.’Music Analysis17(1):3– 20. Cumming, Naomi. 1997. ‘The HorrorsofIdenti?ication: Reich’s “DifferentTrains.”’ PerspectivesofNewMusic35(1),129–52. Cutietta, Robert A. 1993. ‘The Musical Elements: Who said they’re right?’ Music EducatorsJournal79(9):48–53. Dainton,Barry.2010.Timeandspace(Secondedition).Durham:Acumen. deMan, Paul.1983. ‘FormandIntentintheAmericanNew Criticism.’InBlindness andInsight:EssaysintheRhetoricofContemporaryCriticism(Secondedition), 20–35.London:Routledge. Damschroder, David. 2010. Harmony in Schubert. Cambridge: Cambridge UniversityPress. Deliège, Célestin. 1989. ‘On form as actually experienced.’ Contemporary Music Review4(1):101–15. Deliège, Irène. 1989. ‘A perceptual approach to contemporary musical forms.’ ContemporaryMusicReview4(1):213–30. Deliège, Iréne, and Marc Mélen. 1997. ‘Cue abstraction in the representation of musical form.’In Perception and Cognition ofMusic, edited byIrèneDeliège andJohnSloboda,387–412.Sussex:PsychologyPress. 254 Bibliography Deliège, Iréne, Marc Mélen, Diana Stammers and Ian Cross. 1996. ‘Musical Schemata in Real-Time Listening to a Piece ofMusic.’ Music Perception: An InterdisciplinaryJournal14(2):117–59. Deliège, Irène, andJohnSloboda, editors. 1997.Perception andCognitionofMusic. Sussex:PsychologyPress. Dell’Antonio,Andrew,editor.2004.BeyondStructuralListening:PostmodernModes ofHearing.Berkeley:UniversityofCaliforniaPress. Deutsch,Diana.1980.‘MusicPerception.’TheMusicalQuarterly66(2):165–79. Dowling, W. Jay. 1989. ‘Simplicity and complexity in music and cognition.’ ContemporaryMusicReview4(1):247–53. Drake, Carolynand Daisy Bertrand. 2003. ‘The Quest forUniversals in Temporal Processing in Music.’ In The Cognitive Neuroscience of Music, edited by IsabellePeretzandRobertJ.Zatorre,21–31.Oxford:OxfordUniversityPress. Droit-Volet, Sylvie, and Warren H. Meck. 2007. ‘How emotions colour our perceptionoftime.’TrendsinCognitiveSciences11(12):504–13. Dubiel, Joseph. 2004. ‘Uncertainty, Disorientation, and Loss as Responses to Musical Structure.’ In Beyond Structural Listening: Postmodern Modes of Hearing, edited by Andrew Dell’Antonio, 173–200. Berkeley: University of CaliforniaPress. Duffalo, Richard. 1989. Trackings: Composers Speak with Richard Duffalo. New York:OxfordUniversityPress. Dufourt, Hugues. 1989.‘Music andcognitive psychology:Form-bearingelements.’ ContemporaryMusicReview4(1):231–36. Dunsby, Jonathan 1981. Structural Ambiguityin Brahms: Analytical Approachesto FourWorks.Michigan:UMIResearchPress. Eagleman, DavidM. 2010. ‘Durationillusions andpredictability.’InAttention and time, edited by Anna C. Nobre and Jennifer T. Coull, 151–62. New York: OxfordUniversityPress. Earman, John. 1970. ‘Space-Time, or How to Solve Philosophical Problems and Dissolve Philosophical Muddles without Really Trying.’ The Journal of Philosophy,67(9):259–277. Egeland Hansen, Finn. 2006. Layers of Musical Meaning. Copenhagen: Museum TusculanumPress. 255 Bibliography Elbow, Peter. 2006. ‘The Music of Form: Rethinking Organization in Writing.’ CollegeCompositionandCommunication57(4):620–66. Eliot,T.S.1944.FourQuartets.London:FaberandFaber. Elliot,J.H.1929.‘BrahmsasSymphonist.’TheMusicalTimes,70(1036):554. Elliott, Richard. 2011. ‘Public consciousness, political conscience, andmemory in Latin American nueva canción.’ In Music and Consciousness: Philosophical, Psychological, and Cultural Perspectives, edited by David Clarke and Eric Clarke,327–39.Oxford:OxfordUniversityPress. Epstein, David. 1985. ‘Tempo Relations: A Cross-Cultural Study.’ Music Theory Spectrum,7:34–71. _______. 1987. Beyond Orpheus: Studies in Musical Structure. New York: Oxford UniversityPress. _______. 1990. ‘Brahms and the Mechanisms of Motion: The Composition of Performance.’ In Brahms Studies: Analytical and Historical Perspectives, Papersdelivered atthe InternationalBrahmsConference Washington, DC, 5-8 May1983,editedbyGeorgeS.Bozarth,191–228.Oxford:ClarendonPress. _______.1995.ShapingTime:Music,theBrain,andPerformance.NewYork:Schirmer Books. Erickson,Robert.1963.‘Time-relations.’JournalofMusicTheory7(2):174–92. _______.1975.SoundStructureinMusic.Berkeley:UniversityofCaliforniaPress. Evans, Edwin. 1935. Handbook to the Chamber and Orchestral Music of Johannes Brahms:Secondseries,Op.68totheend.London:WilliamReeves. Fachner, Jörg. 2011. ‘Drugs, alteredstates, andmusical consciousness: reframing timeandspace.’InMusicand Consciousness:Philosophical, Psychological,and CulturalPerspectives,editedbyDavidClarkeandEricClarke,263–76.Oxford: OxfordUniversityPress. Ferrara, Lawrence. 1984. ‘Phenomenology as a Tool for Musical Analysis.’ The MusicalQuarterly70(3):355–73. Firmino, Érico Artioli, José Lino Oliveira Bueno, and Emmanuel Bigand. 2009. ‘Travelling ThroughPitchSpaceSpeeds upMusical Time.’ MusicPerception: AnInterdisciplinaryJournal26(3):205–09. Fish,Stanley.1976.‘Interpretingthe“Variorum”.’CriticalInquiry2(3):465–85. Fisk,Charles.2001.ReturningCycles:ContextsfortheInterpretationof 256 Bibliography Schubert’sImpromptusandLastSonatas.Berkeley:UniversityofCalifornia Press. Forster,E.M.(1927)2005.AspectsoftheNovel.London:PenguinClassics. Fox, Christopher. 2004. ‘Tempestuous Times:The Recent Music ofThomas Adès.’ TheMusicalTimes145(1888):41–56. _______. 2014. ‘MultipleTime-ScalesinAdès'sRings.’PerspectivesofNewMusic 52 (1):28–56. Fraser, Julius T. 1978. Time as ConUlict: A ScientiUic and Humanistic Study. Basel: Birkhäuser. _______.1985.‘TheArtoftheAudible“Now”.’MusicTheorySpectrum,7:181–84. Friedman, William J. Abouttime: Inventingthe Fourth Dimension. Cambridge: MIT Press,1990. Frisch, Walter. 1982. ‘Brahms, Developing Variation, and the Schoenberg Critical Tradition.’19th-CenturyMusic5(3):215–32. _______. 1984. Brahmsandthe Principle ofDeveloping Variation. London: University ofCaliforniaPress. _______. 2000. ‘"You Must Remember This": Memory and Structure in Schubert's StringQuartetinGMajor,D.887.’TheMusicalQuarterly84(4):582–603. _______.2003.Brahms:TheFourSymphonies.NewHaven:YaleUniversityPress. Frisch,WalterandAlfredBrendel.1989. ‘”Schubert’sLastSonatas”:AnExchange.’ New York Review of Books, 16 March, 1989. http://www.nybooks.com/ articles/1989/03/16/schuberts-last-sonatas-an-exchange/. Gardner,John.1977.‘Sibelius7.’TheMusicalTimes118(1617):912. Gay,Peter.1977.‘Aimez-vousBrahms?Re?lectionsonModernism.’Salmagundi36: 16–35. Gentner, Dedre. 2001. ‘Spatial metaphors in temporal reasoning.’ In Spatial schemasin abstractthought, editedby MeridethGattis, 203–22. Cambridge, MA:MITPress. Gentner,Dedre,MutsumiImai,&LeraBoroditsky.2002.‘Astimegoesby:Evidence for two systems in processing space–time metaphors’. Language and CognitiveProcesses,17(5):537–565. Goehr, Lydia. 1992. The Imaginary Museum of Musical Works: An Essay in the PhilosophyofMusic.Oxford:ClarendonPress. 257 Bibliography Gooddy, William. 1969. ‘Disorders of the Time Sense.’ In Handbook of clinical neurology, edited by Pierre J. Vinken and George W. Bruyn, 229–50. New York:Wiley. _______.1977.‘TheTimingandTimeofMusicians.’InMusicandtheBrain,editedby Macdonald Critchley and Ronald A. Henson, 131–40. London: William HeinemannMedicalBooks. Gray,Cecil.1934.Sibelius.London:OxfordUniversityPress. _______.1935.Sibelius:TheSymphonies.London:OxfordUniversityPress. Greene,DavidB.1982.TemporalProcessesinBeethoven’sMusic.NewYork:Gordon andBreach. Grif?iths,Paul.1985.NewSounds,NewPersonalities:BritishComposersofthe1980s inConversationwithPaulGrifUiths.London:FaberandFaber. _____. 2014. Programme note on Thomas Adès, Tevot (2007). City of Birmingham Symphony Orchestra, Thomas Adès (conductor), Symphony Hall, Birmingham,11June,2014.17–19. Grimes, Nicole. 2012. ‘The Schoenberg/Brahms Critical Tradition Reconsidered.’ MusicAnalysis31(2):127–75. Grimley,Daniel M,editor.2004. TheCambridgeCompanion toSibelius.Cambridge, CambridgeUniversityPress. Grünbaum,Adolf.1973.PhilosophicalProblemsofSpaceandTime(Secondedition). Boston:Reidel. Gurvitch, Georges. 1964. The Spectrum of Social Time. Dordrecht: D. Reidel PublishingCompany. Hall, EdwardT. 1984. The Dance ofLife: The OtherDimension of Time. New York: Doubleday. Hanslick,Eduard.1957. TheBeautifulinMusic.TranslatedbyGustavCohen,edited byMorrisWeitz.NewYork:TheBobbs-MerrillCompany. Hargreaves, Jonathan. 2008.‘Music as Communication: Networks ofComposition,’ PhDthesis,UniversityofYork. Hasty, ChristopherF. 1981a. ‘Rhythm inPost-Tonal Music: Preliminary Questions ofDurationandMotion.’JournalofMusicTheory25(2):183–216. _______. 1981b. ‘Segmentation and Process in Post-Tonal Music.’ Music Theory Spectrum3:54–73. 258 Bibliography _______. 1984. ‘Phrase Formation inPost-Tonal Music.’Journal ofMusic Theory 28 (2):167–90. _______. 1986. ‘OntheProblem ofSuccessionandContinuityinTwentieth-Century Music.’MusicTheorySpectrum8:58–74. _______.1997.MeterasRhythm.NewYork:OxfordUniversityPress. Hatten,RobertS.1994.MusicalMeaninginBeethoven:Markedness,Correlation,and Interpretation.Bloomington:IndianaUniversityPress. Hepokoski, James. 2009. Music, Structure, Thought: Selected Essays. Farnham: Ashgate. Hepokoski, James, and Warren Darcy. 2006. Elements of Sonata Theory: Norms, Types, and Deformations in the Late-Eighteenth-Century Sonata. New York: OxfordUniversityPress. Hinckfuss,Ian.1975.TheExistenceofSpaceandTime.Oxford:ClarendonPress. _______. 1988.‘AbsolutismandRelationisminSpaceandTime:A FalseDichotomy.’ TheBritishJournalforthePhilosophyofScience39(2):183–92. Hodges, DonaldA. andDavidC. Sebald. 2011. Musicin the Human Experience:An IntroductiontoMusicPsychology.London:Routledge. Horwich, Paul. 1978. ‘On theExistenceofTime, Space, andSpace-Time.’Noûs 12 (4):397–419. _______. 1987. Asymmetriesin Time: Problemsin the PhilosophyofScience.London: MITPress. Howat, Roy. 2003. ‘Reading betweenthe lines oftempo and rhythm inthe B ?lat Sonata, D960.’ In Schubert the Progressive: History, Performance Practice, Analysis,editedbyBrianNewbould,117–138.Aldershot:Ashgate. Howell, Peter, Ian Cross and Robert West, editors. 1985. Musical Structure and Cognition.London:AcademicPress. Howell, Tim. 1989. Jean Sibelius: Progressive Techniques in the Symphonies and TonePoems.NewYork:GarlandPublishing. _______. 2000. ‘Restricting the Flow: Elements of Time-scale in Sibelius’ Sixth Symphony.’TijdschriftvoorMuziektheorie,5(2):89–100. _______. 2001. ‘“Sibelius theProgressive.”’In SibeliusStudies, edited byTimothy L. Jackson and Veijo Murtomäki, 35–57. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. 259 Bibliography _______.2013.‘Brahms,KierkegaardandRepetition:ThreeIntermezzi.’19th-Century MusicReview10(1):101–17. Howell, Tim, Jon Hargreaves and Michael Rofe, editors. 2011. Kaija Saariaho: Visions,Narratives,Dialogues.Farnham:Ashgate. Hubbard, Phil,RobKitchinandGillValentine,editors.2004. KeyThinkerson Space andPlace.London:Sage. Hugo,Victor.1982.LesMisérables. TranslatedbyNormanDenny.London:Penguin Classics. Husserl, Edmund. 1991. On the Phenomenology of the Consciousness of Internal Time (1893–1917), translated by John Barnett Brough. Dordrecht: Kluwer AcademicPublishers. _______. 2014. ‘The Structure of Lived Time,’ translated by James Mensch. In Subjective Time:ThePhilosophy,Psychology,andNeuroscience ofTemporality, editedbyValtteriArstillaandDanLloyd,61–74.London:MITPress. Hutchinson,Mark.2012.‘Rede?iningcoherence:interactionandexperienceinnew music,1985-1995.’PhDthesis,UniversityofYork. _______. 2016. Coherence in New Music: Experience, Aesthetics, Analysis. Abingdon: Routledge. Imberty, Michel. 1993. ‘How do we perceive atonal music? Suggestions for a theoreticalapproach.’ContemporaryMusicReview,9:325–37. Jackson,TimothyL.2001.‘Observationsoncrystallizationandentropyinthe musicofSibeliusandothercomposers.’InSibeliusStudies,editedbyTimothy L.JacksonandVeijoMurtomäki,175–272.Cambridge:CambridgeUniversity Press. Jackson, Timothy L., and Veijo Murtomäki, editors. 2001. Sibelius Studies. Cambridge:CambridgeUniversityPress. Johnson,Julian. 2015. OutofTime: Musicand the MakingofModernity. NewYork: OxfordUniversityPress. Johnson, Mark L. andSteveLarson. 2003: ‘”Something in the Way She Moves” – MetaphorsofMusicalMotion.’MetaphorandSymbol18(2):63–84. Johnson, Timothy A. 1994. ‘Minimalism: Aesthetic, Style, or Technique?’ The MusicalQuarterly78(4):742–73. 260 Bibliography Kantonen, Taito Almar. 1934. ‘The In?luence of Descartes on Berkeley.’ The PhilosophicalReview43/5:483–500. Karl, Gregory. 1997. ‘Structuralism andMusical Plot.’ Music Theory Spectrum, 19 (1):13–34. Keil, Charles M. H. 1966. ‘Motion and Feeling Through Music.’ The Journal of AestheticsandArtCriticism24(3):337–49. Kellaris, JamesJ.,andRobertJ. Kent. 1992.‘Thein?luenceofmusiconconsumers’ temporal perceptions: Does time ?ly when you’re having fun?’ Journal of ConsumerPsychology1(4):365–76. Kellaris, James J., and Susan P. Mantel. 1996. ‘Shaping time perceptions with background music: The effect of congruity and arousal on estimates of ad durations.’PsychologyandMarketing,13(5):501–15. Kerman,Joseph.1985.Musicology.London:FontanaPress. Kierkegaard, Søren. 1983. Fearand Trembling, Repetition:Kierkegaard’sWritings, VI.Princeton:PrincetonUniversityPress. Kinderman,William.1995.Beethoven.NewYork:OxfordUniversityPress. Kivy,Peter.2002.IntroductiontoaPhilosophyofMusic.Oxford:ClarendonPress. Knapp, Raymond.1989.‘TheFinaleofBrahms’sFourthSymphony:TheTaleofthe Subject.’19th-CenturyMusic13(1):3–17. Kogler,Susanne.2003.‘”Timelessness”and“ReleasedTime”–FranzSchubertand Composition Today.’ In Schubert the Progressive: History, Performance Practice,Analysis,editedbyBrianNewbould,89–100.Aldershot:Ashgate. Korsyn, Kevin. 1999. ‘Beyond Privileged Contexts: Intertextuality, In?luence, and Dialogue.’InRethinkingMusic,editedbyNicholasCookandMarkEverist,55– 72.Oxford:OxfordUniversityPress. Kramer, Jonathan D. 1973. ‘Multiple and Non-Linear Time in Beethoven’s Opus 135.’PerspectivesofNewMusic11(2):122–45. _______.1978.‘MomentForminTwentiethCenturyMusic.’TheMusicalQuarterly64 (2):177–94. _______.1981.‘NewTemporalitiesinMusic.’CriticalInquiry7(3):539–56. _______. 1982. ‘Beginnings and Endings inWestern Art Music.’Canadia University MusicReview3:1–14. 261 Bibliography _______.1985.‘StudiesofTimeandMusic:ABibliography.’MusicTheorySpectrum7: 72–106. _______. 1988. The Time ofMusic: New Meanings, NewTemporalities, NewListening Strategies.NewYork:SchirmerBooks. _______. 2004. ‘The Concept of Disunity and Musical Analysis.’ Music Analysis 23: 361–72. Kramer, Lawrence. 1990. Music as Cultural Practice: 1800–1900. Berkeley: UniversityofCaliforniaPress. _______. 1995. Classical Music and Postmodern Knowledge. Berkeley: University of CaliforniaPress. _______. 2002. Musical Meaning: Toward a Critical History. Berkeley: University of CaliforniaPress. _______. 2005. ‘Saving the Ordinary: Beethoven’s Ghost Trio and the Wheel of History.’BeethovenForum12(1):50–81. _______. 2007. WhyClassical Music Still Matters. Berkeley: University of California Press. _______.2010InterpretingMusic.Berkeley:UniversityofCaliforniaPress. Lakoff, George. 1993. ‘The Contemporary Theory ofMetaphor.’ In Metaphor and Thought (Second edition), edited by Andrew Ortony, 202–51. Cambridge: CambridgeUniversityPress. Lakoff,GeorgeandMarkJohnson.1980.MetaphorsWeLiveBy.Chicago:University ofChicagoPress. Lalitte, Philippe, and Emmanuel Bigand. 2006. ‘Music inthe Moment? Revisiting theEffectofLargeScaleStructures.’PerceptualandMotorSkills103:811–28. Lam, Basil.1966.‘LudwigvanBeethoven.’InTheSymphony,VolumeOne:Haydn to Dvořák,editedbyRobertSimpson,104–74.Aylesbury:PenguinBooks. Langer, Susanne K. 1953. Feeling and Form: A Theory of Art Developed from PhilosophyinaNewKey.London:RoutledgeandKeeganPaul. Larson, Steve. 1997.‘TheProblemofProlongationin“Tonal”Music:Terminology, Perception,andExpressiveMeaning.’JournalofMusicTheory41(1):101–36. Larue, Jan, Eugene K. Wolf, Mark Evan Bonds, Stephen Walsh, Charles Wilson. ‘Symphony.’ In Grove Music Online. Oxford Music Online. Oxford University 262 Bibliography Press. Accessed 1 September, 2016, http://www.oxfordmusiconline.com/ subscriber/article/grove/music/27254. Latham, Alan. 2004. ‘Edward Soja.’In KeyThinkerson Space andPlace, editedby PhilHubbard,RobKitchinandGillValentine,269–74.London:Sage. Laufer,Edward.2001.‘ContinuityandDesignintheSeventhSymphony.’InSibelius Studies, edited by Timothy L. Jackson and Veijo Murtomäki, 352–90. Cambridge:CambridgeUniversityPress. Layton,Robert.1965.Sibelius.London:J.M.DentandSons. Le Poidevin, Robin andMurray Macbeath, editors. 1993. The PhilosophyofTime. NewYork:OxfordUniversityPress. Lefebvre, Henri. 1991. The Production ofSpace, translatedby Donald NicholsonSmith.Oxford:BlackwellPublishing. _______. 2013. Rhythmanalysis: Space, Time and EverydayLife, translated byStuart EldenandGeraldMoore.London:Bloomsbury. Lerdahl, Fred, and Ray Jackendoff. 1983. A Generative Theory of Tonal Music. London:MITPress. Leman, Marc. 2008. Embodied music cognition and mediation technology. London: MITPress. Lewin, David. 1986. ‘Music Theory, Phenomenology, and Modes of Perception.’ MusicPerception:AnInterdisciplinaryJournal3(4):327–92. Lewis, C.S. 1961. An Experiment in Criticism. New York: Cambridge University Press. Lippman, Edward A. 1984. ‘Progressive Temporality in Music.’ The Journal of Musicology3(2):121–41. Lochhead,Judy. 2016.ReconceivingStructure in ContemporaryMusic: NewToolsin MusicTheoryandAnalysis.NewYork:Routledge. Lockwood, Lewis. 1982. ‘”Eroica” Perspectives: Strategy and Design in the First Movement.’InBeethovenStudies3,editedbyAlanTyson,85–106.Cambridge: CambridgeUniversityPress. London, Justin. 2004. Hearing in Time: Psychological Aspects of Musical Meter. Oxford:OxfordUniversityPress. Lushetich,Natasha.2014.Fluxus:ThePracticeofNon-Duality.Amsterdam:Rodopi. 263 Bibliography Mailman, Joshua Banks. 2007. ‘Review of Repetition in Music: Theoretical and MetatheoreticalPerspectivesbyAdamOckleford.’PsychologyofMusic,35(2): 363–375. March, Daniel. 1997. ‘Beyond Simplicity: Analytical Strategies for Contemporary Music,’PhDthesis,UniversityofYork. _______. 2011. ‘From the Air to the Earth: Reading the Ashes.’ In Kaija Saariaho: Visions, Narratives, Dialogues, edited by Howell, Tim, Jon Hargreaves and MichaelRofe.3–14.Farnham:Ashgate. Margulis, Elizabeth Hellmuth. 2005. ‘Review of Decentering Music: A Critique of ContemporaryMusicalResearchbyKevinKorsyn.’PsychologyofMusic,33(3): 331–37. Marston, Nicholas. 2000. ‘Schubert’s Homecoming.’ Journal of the Royal Musial Association125(2):248–70. Matthews,David.1993.‘LivingTraditions.’TheMusicalTimes134(1802):189–91. Maus, Fred Everett. 1988. ‘Music as Drama’. Music Theory Spectrum, 10 (10th AnniversaryIssue):56-73. _______.1991.‘MusicasNarrative.’IndianaTheoryReview11:1–34. _______.1997.‘Narrative, DramaandEmotioninInstrumentalMusic.’TheJournalof AestheticsandArtCriticism55(3):293-303. _______. 1999.‘ConceptsofMusicalUnity’. InRethinkingMusic,editedby Nicholas CookandMarkEverist,171–92.Oxford:OxfordUniversityPress. McAdams, Stephen. 1989.‘Psychologicalconstraints onform-bearing dimensions inmusic.’ContemporaryMusicReview4(1):181–98. _______. 1999. ‘Perspectives on the Contribution of Timbre to Musical Structure.’ ComputerMusicJournal23(3):85–102. McClelland, Ryan. 2009. ‘Brahms and the Principle of Destabilised Beginnings.’ MusicAnalysis28(1):3–61. McTaggart, J.M.E. 1993. ‘TheUnreality ofTime.’In The PhilosophyofTime, edited by Robin Le Poidevin and Murray Macbeath, 23–34. New York: Oxford University Press. Originally publishedas ‘Time’inThe Nature ofExistence, ii (Cambridge:CambridgeUniversityPress,1927). Mellor, D.H. 1993. ‘The Unreality ofTense.’InThe PhilosophyofTime, editedby Robin Le Poidevin and Murray Macbeath, 47–59. New York: Oxford 264 Bibliography University Press. Originally published inReal Time (Cambridge: Cambridge UniversityPress,1981). Mensch, James. 2014. ‘A Brief Account of Husserl’s Conception of Our Consciousness of Time.’ InSubjective Time: The Philosophy, Psychology, and NeuroscienceofTemporality,editedbyValtteriArstillaandDanLloyd,61–74. London:MITPress. Metzer, David. 2009. Musical Modernism at the Turn ofthe Twenty-First Century. NewYork:CambridgeUniversityPress. Meyer, Leonard B. 1956. Emotion and Meaning in Music. Chicago: University of ChicagoPress. Micznik, Vera. 2001. ‘Music and Narrative Revisited: Degrees of Narrativity in BeethovenandMahler.’JournaloftheRoyalMusicalAssociation126(2):193– 249. Miller, Izchak. 1984.Husserl,Perception,andTemporalAwareness.Cambridge:MIT Press. Moisala,Pirkko.2009.KaijaSaariaho.Urbana:UniversityofIllinoisPress. Molleson, Katie. 2015. ‘A composer fortheseason.’The Herald, 14January, 2015. Accessed 1 September, 2016. http://www.heraldscotland.com/arts_ents/ 13197029.A_composer_for_the_season/. Morgan, Robert P. 2003. ‘The Concept of Unity and Musical Analysis.’ Music Analysis22(1/2):7–50. Mundle,C.W.K.1967.‘TheSpace-TimeWorld.’Mind76(302):264–69. Murphy, Scott. 2009. ‘Metric cubes in some music of Brahms.’ Journal of Music Theory53(1):1–56. Murtomäki, Veijo. 1993.Symphonic Unity: The Development ofFormalThinking in the Symphonies of Sibelius, translated by Henry Bacon. Helsinki, Studia MusicologiaUniversitatisHelsingiensis. Musgrave, Michael. 1979. ‘Schoenberg and Brahms: A study of Schoenberg’s responsetoBrahms’s musicas revealedinhisdidacticwritingsandselected earlycompositions.’PhDthesis,KingsCollegeLondon. _______. 1983. ‘Brahms the Progressive: Another View.’ The Musical Times 124 (1683):291–94. 265 Bibliography _______. 1990. ‘Schoenberg’s Brahms.’ In Brahms Studies: Analytical and Historical Perspectives, Papers delivered at the International Brahms Conference Washington,DC,5-8May1983,123–138.Oxford:ClarendonPress. _______, editor. 1999. The CambridgeCompanion toBrahms.Cambridge:Cambridge UniversityPress. Nattiez,Jean-Jacques. 1990.‘CanOneSpeakofNarrativityinMusic?’Translatedby KatharineEllis.JournaloftheRoyalMusicalAssociation15(2):240–57. Newbould, Brian, editor. 2003. Schubert the Progressive: History, Performance Practice,Analysis.Aldershot:Ashgate. Newell,Robert.1976.‘FourTiersontheFoundationofTime.’InternationalReview oftheAestheticsandSociologyofMusic7(2):147–74 Nice, David. 2013. ’St Lawrence StringQuartet, LSOStringOrchestra, Adams, LSO St Luke’s.’ The ArtsDesk, 24January, 2013. www.theartsdesk.com/classicalmusic/st-lawrence-string-quartet-lso-string-orchestra-adams-lso-st-lukes. Nobre,AnnaC., andJenniferT.Coull,editors. 2010.Attention andtime.NewYork: OxfordUniversityPress. Norris, Christopher. 2005. ‘Music theory, analysis and deconstruction: How they might (just) get along together.’ International Review of the Aesthetics and SociologyofMusic,36(1):37–82. Oakes, Steve. 2003. ‘Musical tempo and waiting perceptions.’ Psychology and Marketing20(8):685–705. Ochs, Elinor, and Lisa Capps. 1996. ‘Narrating the Self.’ Annual Review of Anthropology25:19–43. Ockelford, Adam. 2004. ‘On similarity, derivation and the cognition of musical structure.’PsychologyofMusic32(1):23–74. _______. 2005. Repetition in Music: Theoretical and Metatheoretical Perspectives. Aldershot:Ashgate. Orlov, Henry F. 1979. ‘The Temporal Dimensions of Musical Experience.’ The MusicalQuarterly65(3):368–78. Osmond-Smith David. 1983. ‘The retreat from dynamism: a study of Brahms’s Fourth Symphony.’ In Brahms: Biographical, documentary and analytical studies,editedbyRobertPascall.Cambridge:CambridgeUniversityPress. 266 Bibliography Paddison, Maxand IrèneDeliège, editors. 2010. ContemporaryMusic: Theoretical andPhilosophicalPerspectives.Farnham:Ashgate. Pascall, Robert, editor. 1983. Brahms: Biographical, documentary and analytical studies.Cambridge:CambridgeUniversityPress. _______.1989.‘GenreandtheFinaleofBrahms’sFourthSymphony.’MusicAnalysis8 (3):233–45. Panagiotidi, Maria and Stavroula Samartzi. 2010. ‘Time estimation: Musical trainingand emotional contentofstimuli.’PsychologyofMusic 41 (5): 620– 629. Parmet,Simon. 1959. The SymphoniesofSibelius:A Studyin Musical Appreciation. London:Cassell. Pasler, Jann.2008. ‘NarrativeandNarrativityinMusic.’InWritingThrough Music: EssaysonMusic,CultureandPolitics.Oxford:OxfordUniversityPress. Peretz,Isabelle, andRobertJ.Zatorre, editors. 2003.TheCognitiveNeuroscienceof Music.Oxford:OxfordUniversityPress. Pike,Lionel.1978.Beethoven,Sibeliusandthe‘Profoundlogic’:StudiesinSymphonic Analysis.London:AthlonePress. Pöppel, Ernst. 1978. ‘Time Perception.’ In Handbook of Sensory Physiology, III, editedbyRichardHeld, HerschelW. LeibowitzandHans-LukasTeuber, 713– 29.Berlin:Springer. Potter, Keith. ‘Minimalism.’ In Grove Music Online. Oxford Music Online. Oxford U n i v e r s i t y P r e s s . A c c e s s e d 2 2 F e b r u a r y , 2 0 1 3 , h t t p : / / www.oxfordmusiconline.com/subscriber/article/grove/music/40603. Powell, Richard. 2014. ‘Accessible Narratives: Continuity in the Music of John Adams.’ContemporaryMusicReview33(4):390–407. Prior, ArthurN.1993. ‘Changesineventsandchangesinthings.’InThePhilosophy of Time, edited by Robin Le Poidevin and Murray Macbeath, 203–20 New York: OxfordUniversity Press. Originally publishedinPhilosophy37(1962): 130–47. Quinton, Anthony. 1993. ‘Spaces andTimes’ in The PhilosophyofTime, editedby Robin Le Poidevin and Murray Macbeath, 36–46. New York: Oxford UniversityPress. 267 Bibliography Reynolds, Jack. 2004. ‘Chapter Six: Decision.’InUnderstanding Derrida, editedby JackReynoldsandJonRoffe,46–53.London:Continuum. Rice, Timothy. 2003. ‘Time, Place, and Metaphor in Musical Experience and Ethnography.’Ethnomusicology47(2):151–79. Rickards,Guy.1997.JeanSibelius.London:PhaidonPress. Rijn, Hedderik van, and Niels A. Taatgen. 2008. ‘Timing of multiple overlapping intervals:Howmanyclocksdowehave?’ActaPsychologica129(3):365–75. RobbinsLandon,H.C.1974.Beethoven:ADocumentaryStudy.London:Thamesand Hudson. Roeder,John.1997.‘ReviewofMeterasRhythmbyChristopherF.Hasty.’Journalof theSocietyforMusicTheory–MusicTheoryOnline4(4):1–6. _______. 2006. ‘Co-operating Continuities in the Music of Thomas Adès.’ Music Analysis25:121–54. Rofe, Michael. 2008. ‘ShostakovichandtheRussianDoll: DimensionsofEnergy in theSymphonies,’PhDthesis,UniversityofYork. _______. 2011. ‘Capturing Time and Giving it Form: Nymphéa.’ In Kaija Saariaho: Visions, Narratives, Dialogues, edited by Howell, Tim, Jon Hargreaves and MichaelRofe.81–106.Farnham:Ashgate. _______.2014.‘DualismsofTime.’ContemporaryMusicReview33(4):341–54. Rosen, Charles. 1988. Sonata Forms: Revised Edition. New York: W. W. Norton & Company. _______. 1997. The Classical Style: Haydn, Mozart, Beethoven. London: Faber and Faber. Rostand,Claude.1955:Brahms:Volume2.Paris:ÉditionsLeBonPlasir. Rowell, Lewis. 1979. ‘TheSubconscious Language ofMusical Time.’ Music Theory Spectrum1:96–106. _______.1990.‘ReviewofTheTimeofMusic:NewMeanings,NewTemporalities, New Listening Strategiesby Jonathan D. Kramer’. Journal ofMusic Theory34(2), 348–59. Rupprecht, Philip. 2005. ‘Above and beyond the Bass: Harmony and Texture in GeorgeBenjamin'sViola,Viola.’Tempo59(232):28–38. 268 Bibliography Saariaho,Kaija.2003. ProgrammenoteforJe sensun deuxième coeur. MusicSales. Accessed 21 February, 2014. http://www.musicsalesclassical.com/ composer/work/14333. Saariaho, Kaija and Tom Service. 2011. ‘Meet the Composer.’ In Kaija Saariaho: Visions, Narratives, Dialogues, edited by Howell, Tim, Jon Hargreaves and MichaelRofe.3–14.Farnham:Ashgate. Said,EdwardW.2008.‘UntimelyMeditations(reviewofMaynardSolomon’sLate Beethoven).’InMusicattheLimits:ThreeDecadesofEssaysandArticles. London:Bloomsbury. Saariaho, Kaija. 2000. ‘Matter and Mind in Music.’ In Matter and Mind in Architecture,editedbyPirkkoTuukkanen.Helsinki:AlvarAaltoFoundation. Saslaw, Janna. 1996. ‘Forces, Containers, and Paths: The Role of Body-Derived ImageSchemasintheConceptualizationofMusic.’JournalofMusicTheory40 (2):217–43. Schmalfeldt, Janet. 2011. In the Process of Becoming: Analytic and Philosophical Perspectives on Form in Early Nineteenth-Century Music. Oxford: Oxford UniversityPress. Schoenberg, Arnold. 1975a.Style and Idea:Selected writingsofArnoldSchoenberg, edited by Leonard Stein and translated by Leo Black. London: Faber and Faber. _______. 1975b. ‘Brahms the Progressive.’ In Style and Idea: Selected writings of ArnoldSchoenberg,editedbyLeonardSteinandtranslatedbyLeoBlack,398– 441.London:FaberandFaber _______. 1994. Coherence, Counterpoint, Instrumentation, Instruction in Form. Ed. Severine Neff and trans. Charlotte M. Cross and Severine Neff. Nebraska: UniversityofNebraska. Schwarz,K.Robert.1996.Minimalists.London:Phiadon. Sellars, Peter. 2012. ‘The Edge of Light: Music of Messiaen and Saariaho.’ Liner notesforTheEdgeofLight:Messiaen/Saariaho.GloriaCheng(piano),Calder Quartet.HarmoniaMundi,HMU907578,CD. Sera?ine, MaryLouise.1984.‘TheDevelopmentofCognitioninMusic.’TheMusical Quarterly70(2):218–33. 269 Bibliography Service,Tom.2007.‘WritingMusic?It’slikeFlyingaPlane:TomServiceonThomas Adès.’TheGuardian,26February,2007.Accessed1September2016, https:// www.theguardian.com/music/2007/feb/26/classicalmusicandopera.tomservice. _______. ‘Minimalism at 50: how less became more’ The Guardian, 24 November, 2011. Accessed23 September 2016, https://www.theguardian.com/music/ 2011/nov/24/minimalism-at-50. _______.2012.‘Schubert:Ferocious,tender,sublime.’TheGuardian, 19March,2012. Accessed 22 February, 2013. https://www.theguardian.com/music/2012/ mar/19/schubert-ferocious-tender-sublime. Shakespeare, William, Jonathan Bate, and Eric Rasmussen. 2007. The RSC Shakespeare:TheCompleteWorks.Basingstoke:PalgraveMacmillan. Shanon, Benny. 2011. ‘Music and ayahuasca.’ In Music and Consciousness: Philosophical,Psychological, andCulturalPerspectives,editedbyDavidClarke andEricClarke,281–92.Oxford:OxfordUniversityPress. Sheldon, Deborah A. 1994. ‘Effects of Tempo, Musical Experience, and Listening Modes on Tempo Modulation Perception.’ Journal of Research in Music Education42(3):190–202. Shields,Rob. 2004.‘HenriLefebvre.’InKeyThinkerson Spaceand Place,editedby PhilHubbard,RobKitchinandGillValentine,208–13.London:Sage. Shoemaker, Sydney. 1993. ‘Time Without Change.’ In The Philosophy of Time, editedbyRobinLePoidevinandMurrayMacbeath,63–79.NewYork:Oxford UniversityPress.OriginallypublishedinTheJournalofPhilosophy66(1969), 363–81. Simpson, Robert, editor. 1966a. The Symphony: Volume 1. Aylesbury: Penguin Books. _______.1966b.TheSymphony:Volume2.Aylesbury:PenguinBooks. Sipe, Thomas. 1998. Beethoven: Eroica Symphony. Cambridge: Cambridge UniversityPress. Small, Christopher. 1998. Musicking: The Meanings of Performing and Listening. Connecticut:WesleyanUniversityPress. Smart,J.J.C.1949.‘TheRiverofTime.’Mind58(232):483–94. Smith, F. Joseph. 1979. The Experiencing of Musical Sound: Prelude to a PhenomenologyofMusic.London:GordonandBreach. 270 Bibliography Smith, Neil Thomas. 2015. ‘Mathias Spahlinger's passage/paysage and “the BarbarityofContinuity.”’ContemporaryMusicReview34(2–3):176–86. Smith,PeterH.1994. ‘BrahmsandSchenker:A MutualResponsetoSonataForm.’. InMusicTheorySpectrum16(1):77–103. _______. 1996. ‘Youreap whatyousow: Someinstances ofrhythmic andharmonic ambiguityinBrahms.’MusicTheorySpectrum28(1):57–97. Soja,EdwardW.1989.PostmodernGeographies:TheReassertionofSpaceinCritical SocialTheory.London:Verso. _______. 1996. Thirdspace: Journeys to Los Angeles and Other Real-and-Imagined Places.Oxford:BlackwellPublishers. Spence, Charles. 2010. ‘Prior entry: Attention and temporal perception.’ In Attention and time, edited by Anna C. Nobre and Jennifer T. Coull, 89–106. NewYork:OxfordUniversityPress. Stambaugh, Joan. 1964. ‘Music as aTemporal Form.’The Journal ofPhilosophy61 (9):265–80. Strickland, Edward.1991. AmericanComposers:Dialogueson ContemporaryMusic. Bloomington:IndianaUniversityPress. Stoecker, Philip. 2014. ‘Aligned Cycles in Thomas Adès’s Piano Quintet.’ Music Analysis33(1):32–64. Subotnik, Rose Rosengard. 1996. Deconstructive Variations: Music and Reason in WesternSociety.Minneapolis:UniversityofMinnesotaPress. Swed,Mark.1989.‘JohnAdams.’TheMusicalTimes130(1761):662–64. Swinkin,Jeffrey. 2012.‘Variationas ThematicActualisation:TheCaseofBrahms’s Op.9.’MusicAnalysis31(1):37–89. Tawaststjerna, Erik. 1986. Sibelius – Volume II:1904-1914, translated by Robert Layton.London:FaberandFaber. Taylor,Benedict.2016.TheMelodyofTime:MusicandTemporalityintheRomantic Era.London:OxfordUniversityPress. Teller,Paul.1991.‘Substance,Relations,andArgumentsabouttheNatureofSpaceTime.’ThePhilosophicalReview100(3):363–97. Tillmann, Barbara, andEmmanuel Bigand. 1996. ‘Does Formal Musical Structure AffectPerceptionofMusicalExpressiveness?’Psychologyofmusic24:3–17. 271 Bibliography Traugott, Elizabeth C. 1978. ‘On the expression of spatio-temporal relations in language.’InUniversalsofHumanLanguage,Volume3:WordStructure,edited byJosephH.Greenberg,369–400.Stanford:StanfordUniversityPress. Truscott,Harold. 1966.‘JeanSibelius(1865-1957).’InTheSymphony,VolumeTwo: Elgar to the Present Day, edited by Robert Simpson, 80–103. Aylesbury: PenguinBooks. Tse, Peter Ulric. 2010. ‘Attention underlies subjective temporal expansion.’ In Attention and time, edited by Anna C. Nobre and Jennifer T. Coull, 137–50. NewYork:OxfordUniversityPress. Venn, Edward. 2014. ‘ThomasAdès’s“Freaky,Funky, Rave”.’MusicAnalysis33(1): 65–98. _______. 2015. ‘Thomas Adès and the Spectres of Brahms.’ Journal of the Royal MusicalAssociation140(1):163–212. Wagner, Richard. 1988. Wagner on Music and Drama, A compendium ofRichard Wagner’sprose works, selectedand arranged by Albert Goldman and Evert Sprinchorn,andtranslatedbyH.AshtonEllis.NewYork:DaCapoPress. _______. 2008. Beethoven. Translatedby William AshtonEllis. MiltonKeynes: Dodo Press. Walsh,Stephen.‘1901–18:Mahler,Sibelius,Nielsen,’in‘Symphony.’InGroveMusic Online. Oxford Music Online. Oxford University Press. Accessed 31 August, 2016, http://www.oxfordmusiconline.com/subscriber/article/grove/music/ 27254pg3#S27254.3. Weber, William. 1994. ‘The intellectual origins of musical canon in eighteenthcenturyEngland.’JournaloftheAmericanMusicologicalSociety47:488–519. _______. 1999.‘TheHistory ofMusical Canons.’InRethinkingMusic, editedbyMark EveristandNicholasCook,336–55.Oxford:OxfordUniversityPress. Weinert,Friedel.2013.TheMarch ofTime:Evolvingconceptionsoftime inthe light ofscientiUicdiscoveries.London:Springer. Weingard,Robert.1977.‘Space-TimeandtheDirectionofTime.’Noûs11(2):119– 31. Wells, Dominic. 2012. ‘Plural Styles, Personal Syle: The Music of Thomas Adès.’ Tempo66(260):2–14. 272 Bibliography Whittall, Arnold. ‘Form.’ In Grove Music Online. Oxford Music Online. Oxford U n i v e r s i t y P r e s s . A c c e s s e d 3 1 A u g u s t , 2 0 1 6 , h t t p : / / www.oxfordmusiconline.com/subscriber/article/grove/music/09981. _______. 1999. ‘Autonomy/Heteronomy:The ContextsofMusicology.’InRethinking Music, edited by Nicholas Cook and Mark Everist, 73–101. Oxford: Oxford UniversityPress. _______. 2004. ‘The later symphonies.’ In The Cambridge Companion to Sibelius, editedbyDanielM.Grimley,49–65.Cambridge,CambridgeUniversityPress. Williams, Alastair. 1995. New Music and the Claims of Modernity. Aldershot: Ashgate. _______.2001.ConstructingMusicology.Aldershot:Ashgate. _______. 2012. ‘Constructing Meanings and Subjectivities in Music: Theories and Practices.’ In Constructing the Historiography of Music: The Formation of Musical Knowledge, edited by Sandra Danielczyk, Christoph Dennerlein, Sylvia Freydank, Ina Knoth, Mathias Maschat, Lilli Mittner, Karina Seefeldt andLisbethSuhrcke,227–40.Hildesheim:GeorgOlmsVerlag. Williams,Rowan.1989.‘PostmodernTheologyandtheJudgementoftheWorld.’In PostmodernTheology:Christian Faith in a PluralistWorld,editedbyFrederic B.Burnham,92–112.NewYork:HarperCollins. Wilson, Conrad. 2003. Notes on Beethoven: 20 Crucial Works. Edinburgh: Saint AndrewPress. Yamada, Kōun, trans. 2004. The Gateless Gate: The Classic Book of Zen Koans. Boston:WisdomPublications. Yuasa,Jōji.1993.‘TemporalityandI:FromtheComposer’sWorkshop.’Perspectives ofNewMusic31(2):216–28. Ziv, Naomi, and Elad Omer. 2010. ‘Music and time: the effect of experimental paradigm,musicalstructureandsubjectiveevaluationsontimeestimation.’ PsychologyofMusic39(2):182–95. Zwart, P.J. 1976. About Time:Aphilosophical inquiryinto the origin and nature of time.Oxford:North-HollandPublishingCompany. 273